You are on page 1of 870

MU SL I M BA N U ISR AEL

T H E M A H DI X AN D
PROPHET JESUS X
AT TH E E N D OF T I M E S

M U H A M M A D J O N E LYA

Muhammad Jonelya, 2011


The author appeals to you not to copy or reproduce this work without
prior permission. JazakAllah Khairan. The author may be contacted at
his email address jonelya@yahoo.com.
ISBN: 978-146-6481-855
All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be produced, stored
in a retrieval system, or transmitted, in any form or by any means,
electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise without
the prior permission of the author.
This revised edition published in 1437H / 2016 by

SWORD PUBLISHING
Level 23, Nu Tower 2, Jalan Tun Sambathan, Kuala Lumpur Sentral
50470 Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia

The author wishes to acknowledge and thank


the following two web sites for use of their adth database.

http://www.iid-alraid.de/Hadeethlib/hadethb.htm
http://library.islamweb.net

Printed in
Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia

Dedicated to all the

Refugees (Guraba)
who will join Imam Mahdi X
and Prophet Isa X, in
bringing Peace to the World.
InshahAllah!

Contents

Preface ......................................................................................................... 13
Introduction ............................................................................................... 17
BOOK I
THE LOST TRIBES OF ISRAEL, IMAM MAHDI X
AND PROPHET ISA (JESUS) X
Who Are the Lost Tribes of Israel............................................................ 33
Introduction to the Tribes of Muslim Banu Israel ................................ 37
Proof of Muslim Banu Israel from the Quran and adth .................. 43
The Living Proof of the Pathans Israeli Origin
in the Form of Israeli Names .................................................................... 99
Medieval References of Muslim Scholars about
the Israelite Origin of Pathans................................................................ 163
References of Western Scholars about the Israelite
Origin of Pathans ..................................................................................... 171
Some pathans are not from Banu Israel ................................................ 183

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

BOOK II
MISCONCEPTIONS ABOUT IMAM MAHDI X
AND PROPHET JESUS X
A QURAN AND HADITH VIEW
Why misconceptions have appeared? Because of people
leaving references to the Quran and adth ....................................... 189
Misconception no 1: The majority of the arabs will join
the Mahdi X and Prophet Eisa X ...................................................... 197
Misconception No 1: Imam Mahdi X will remain as Kaliph
even after the arrival of Prophet Eisa X ............................................. 229
Misconception no 3: The purpose of the arrival of Prophet
Eisa X is only to kill the dajjal .............................................................. 257
Misconception no 4: Only Imam Mahdi X will lead prayers
after the arrival of Prophet Eisa X ....................................................... 267
Misconception no 6: Baseless explanations of the word
Banu Isaac (Children of Prophet Isaac X in adth about conquest
of constantinople in a Muslim........................................................ 273
Misconception no 7: An army lead by Mansoor from
Tranxonia will come to help Imam Mahdi X .................................... 293
Misconception no 8: The dajjal will come among the
non arabs ................................................................................................... 299
BOOK III
SIGNS OF THE ARMY OF THE DAJJAL
PART 1
The location of the first appearance of the Dajjal ................................ 313
Analysis of the adth about Zul Khuwaisara of
Banu Tamim tribe of the Najad ............................................................. 335
8

Contents

Solid proof that the The Eastern area of Affliction and


Najad are both the same, and that the Dajjal will appear
from the Najad ......................................................................................... 353
Banu Tamims attack on Imam Mahdi X........................................... 361
The Horns of Satan And Its Meaning ................................................ 367
The great affliction of the Mudar tribe ................................................. 373
Proof that the name Mudar and Banu Tamim stands
for the same tribe ..................................................................................... 377
The Heartless Tribe of Rabia and Banu Tamim having Camels........ 391
The End of Banu Tamim Tribe by Imam Mahdi X ...................... 395
The Punishment of Banu Tamim .......................................................... 403
The Difference between the East of Imam Mahdi X
and the East of affliction ...................................................................... 405
Proof that the East of Affliction is from the Najad .......................... 411
Confusion between Iraq and Najad ....................................................... 421
Further discsussion regarding the Horns of Satan appearing
from Najd (and not Iraq) ........................................................................ 427
The meaning of Reading the Quran but not passing
through their throats. ............................................................................ 441
Two Very Important adth telling about the Eastern
location of Najad ...................................................................................... 449
Resemblance between the afflictions of the Najad and
the Wahhabi Movement ......................................................................... 453
The Dress of the Army of the Dajjal ...................................................... 461
Very Important Information .................................................................. 483
9

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

A Beautiful Essay...................................................................................... 487


Comments by famous scholars about
Muammad Ibn Abdul Wahhab ........................................................... 493
BOOK IV
SIGNS OF THE ARMY OF THE DAJJAL
PART 2
Faces like a Shield..................................................................................... 523
Location of the people who have faces like Shields?............................ 527
The Second Location of People with Faces like Shields ...................... 543
Does the above adth points towards the Mongols of the past?
(Genghis Khan and Hulugu) .................................................................. 549
The Children of Qantura ..................................................................... 553
Mongol and Central Asian Turks are related ....................................... 559
The Dajjals Army of Hypocrites and Non Muslims........................... 569
BOOK V
TWELVE SIGNS OF THE ARMY OF PROPHET JESUS X
AND IMAM MAHDI X
Introduction ............................................................................................. 591
First Sign ................................................................................................... 597
Second Sign ............................................................................................... 613
Third Sign ................................................................................................. 637
Fourth Sign ............................................................................................... 661
Fifth Sign ................................................................................................... 669
Sixth Sign .................................................................................................. 683
10

Contents

Seventh Sign.............................................................................................. 687


Eight Sign .................................................................................................. 711
Ninth Sign ................................................................................................. 723
Tenth Sign ................................................................................................ 735
Eleventh Sign ............................................................................................ 791
Twelfth Sign .............................................................................................. 799
BOOK VI
AFFLICTIONS OF THE DAJJAL IN THE MODERN TIMES,
IN LIGHT OF THE QURAN AND HADITH
The Main Target of the Dajjal and His Affliction ............................... 813
The Basis for the affliction of the Dajjals Army .................................. 825
What should the Muslim Banu Israel (and all the Muslims) do in this
situation? ................................................................................................... 837
Last adth ............................................................................................... 851

11

Preface



How to get benefit from this book InshahAllah
The knowledge of the Quran and adth written in this book can be
understood properly if the reader follows the commandments in the
adth that will save us from the afflictions of the End of Times.
These are following commandments:

Memorize and read the first ten, and last ten verses of surah AlKahf, many times daily.

Read the complete surah Al-Kahf every Friday.

Avoid all kind of media, especially news media, and completely


cut off oneself from the news of the world. Do not listen, do not
watch and do not even discuss the news at all.

Keep to your homes as much as possible, unless going out of


the homes for daily life needs, prayer and preaching Islam.

13

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Keep busy in worship of Allah , and preach Islam as much as


possible.

If these directions are followed then these adth and Quranic


verse about the End of Times can easily be understood InshahAllah.
May Allah Az wa Jal make this effort beneficial for all. Ameen.

14




.
.

Introduction



Why I wrote this book?
I didnt write this for the sake of telling history.
I wrote this book only to tell the world the real intentions of the
People of the Book.
The People of the Book also know about the coming of Jesus X,
and they also know that Muslim Banu Israel (The Pathans) will join
them because the Quran has clearly told us that:






002:146
)
(

002:146
17

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Those to whom We gave the Scripture (Jews and Christians)


recognize him (Muammad U) as they recognize their sons.
But verily, a party of them conceals the truth while they know
it (2:146)
This is the main reason for the continuous oppression and killing
of the Pathans since 1979. They still continue using fake reasons of the
so called Taliban, Al-Qaeda, War on Terror, etc., etc. All these reasons
have the sole purpose of the elimination of Muslim Banu Israel who will
join Israeli Prophet Eisa / Jesus X and bring Islamic rule to the world.
The present situation of Muslim Banu Israel is just like that at the
time of Pharaoh of Egypt, who also killed them because of fear of Israeli
Prophet Musa (Moses X). Today they are killed due to the coming of
the Israeli Prophet Eisa X among them.
The continuous oppression on Pathans is only making them
worthy to be the chosen ones.
The Quran tells us that:

002:214
()
()
( ) ( )

18

Introduction

()
002:214 ( )
Or do you think that you will enter Paradise while such [trial]
has not yet come to you as came to those who passed on before
you? They were touched by poverty and hardship and were
shaken until [even their] messenger and those who believed
with him said: When is the help of Allah coming?
Unquestionably, the help of Allah is near. (2:214)
Yes indeed, this high levels can never be achieved without:
1. Extreme hardships and torture for the sake of Allah ,.
2. Great afflictions and remaining steadfast.
3. Being expelled from homes for Islam (being refugee for Islam).
Also if we see the following verse, it is clearly told, that the criteria
for Khilafa of Islam in this world is extreme hardship, and patience for
the sake of Allah.



028:005


( )
028:005
And We wished to do a favor to those who were weak (and
oppressed) in the land, and to make them rulers and to make
19

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

them the inheritors (28:5)


We can see that most of the Pashtun population has been expelled
from their homes since 1979, both in Pakistan and Afghanistan using
different fake reasons of so called Jihad, Taliban, Al Qaeda, and War on
Terror, in the Seraiki Province. There is no Al-Qaeda, no Taliban, no
terrorists, no racists or drug dealers. All these are just self-made
illusions to eliminate the Pathans and also hide their real intentions
behind it.
But all this oppression will only make them worthy to be the chosen
ones of the sacred army of Prophet Isa/Jesus X and Imam Mahdi X
InshahAllah.
Take a map and check all the locations where Muslim Pathans from
Banu Israel, who speak the Pashto language, are located. You will find
that at all these places some reason is created for their elimination.
In Afghanistan, first there was the Russian Invasion in 1979, and
surprisingly the war only took place in the Pashtun areas, and only the
Afghan National Army (Pashtuns at that time), fought with the so called
Mujahedeen (also Pashtuns) in Pashtun areas, leaving millions of
Pashtuns killed, and millions homeless. After Russia, the so called
Mujahedeen fought with each other, and this time also only in the
Pashtun areas. Then the Taliban illusion was launched, and again in
the Pashtun areas only. It is for this reason the Pashtun population of
Afghanistan has been reduced from 80% to just 28%. Once Afghan and
Pashtun was Pashtun majority country. The word Afghan always meant
Pashtun but now the oppressors are even changing the meaning of the
word Afghan to hide their genocide.
20

Introduction

Today Pashtuns are killed using different illusions in Afghanistan,


Pakistan and also Iran.
All this oppression has the sole purpose of the elimination of
Muslim Banu Israel to stop the final victory of Islam under the
leadership of Imam Mahdi and Banu Israeli Prophet Eisa X. Little they
know that Pharaoh of Egypt tried to do this but failed and, InshahAllah,
they will also fail to stop the Army of Israeli Prophet Eisa/Jesus X.
The People of the Book are only afraid of the Army of Mahdi
It should be noted that the non-Muslims are not afraid of the Muslims
of the End of Times, except for the Muslims who will join those sacred
Armies. The Majority of the Muslims will be weak in the eyes of other
nations as told in this adth.


( )

21

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


()
904 : : -
Narrated Thawban \: The Prophet U said: The people will
soon summon one another to attack you as people when
eating invite others to share their dish. Someone asked: Will
that be because of our small numbers at that time? He replied:
No, you will be numerous at that time: but you will be scum
and rubbish like that carried down by a torrent, and Allah will
take fear of you from the breasts of your enemy and last
enervation into your hearts. Someone asked: What is wahn
(enervation). Apostle of Allah ,: He replied: Love of the
world and dislike of death.1
The millions of Pashtun homeless refugees will join
Prophet Eisa X InshahAllah.
Expulsion from homes or homeland is a great sacrifice. Those Muslims
who remain patient on this great sacrifice are greatly rewarded as told
in the Quran

1. Sunan Abu Daud, adth 904, Vol. 3.


22

Introduction







003:195




()
003:195
So those who emigrated or were evicted from their homes or
were harmed in My cause or fought or were killedI will surely
remove from them their evil deeds, and I will surely admit them
to gardens beneath which rivers flow as reward from Allah, and
Allah has with Him the best reward. (3:195)
We can see that in the adth its told that people who will be
expelled from their homes or homeland will join the army of Prophet
Eisa X in the End of Times.

, ( )











: ,


: ,
:

, :

214 : .
23

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

214 : .
Narrated from Hazrat Abdullah bin Umar \, he said that:
Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said that, that the most
Dear to Allah are the Guraba. When asked who the
Guraba are, our Dear Prophet U said that the Guraba are
those who have escaped with their Deen (Islam) (i.e.:
Refugees). Allah will join them with Sayyidna Eisa (Jesus X)
Bin Mariam X.2
And also from this adth that tells us that the poor Muhajirin
(Muslims who have left their homes as refugees) will be appointed the
Leaders.
The world of Islam will seek the help of the Muslim refugees

( )

2. Kitab Zohd-al-Kabir Bayhaqi, adth 214.


24

Introduction



:
:



.





5266 :



( )






:
5266 :
It was narrated from Abdullah bin Amr bin As \ that the
Messenger of Allah U said: When the treasures of Persia and
Rome are opened for you, what kind of people will you be?
Abdur-Rahman bin Awf said: We will say what Allah has
commanded us to say. The Messenger of Allah U said: Or
something other than that. You will compete with one
25

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

another, then you will envy one another, then you will turn
your backs on one another, then you will hate one another, or
something like that. Then you will go to the poor among the
Muhajirin (Muslim refugees) and appoint some of them as
leaders of others.3
So these homeless Pashtun refugees will InshahAllah have the
crown of Caliphate.
InshahAllah these Pashtun refugees will bring peace to the world
under the leadership of Imam Mahdi X and Prophet Eisa X.
Note: The above adth also clearly tells us that the Meaning
of Guraba (Aliens) of the End of Times. In the previous
adth it means the homeless refugees of Islam.
The poor Muslim Banu Israel will rise, InshahAllah, as it did when
Pharaoh of Egypt tried to kill them all.



028:005

( )

028:005 ( )
And We intended to favor those (Banu Israel) who were held
as weak in the land, and to make them leaders and make them
inheritors (28:05)
3. a Muslim, adth 5266.
26

Introduction

This will happen again InshahAllah with Banu Israel when Israeli
Prophet Eisa X will lead them to victory.




033:062


033:062
(Such was) the practice (approved) of Allah among those who
lived aforetime: No change wilt thou find in the practice
(approved) of Allah (33:62)
This book is only an attempt to make the worldespecially the
Muslims worldrealize this great human disaster and do something to
stop this crime or at least pray for them.
Note: In all the chapters, when I mention the followers of
Prophet Eisa / Jesus X and Imam Mahdi X, I am referring
to the first initial followers. Of course thereafter all pious
Muslims will join this sacred army. InshahAllah.
Pray for them, and read and memorize the first ten, and last
ten verses of Surah Al-Kahf of the Quran (also read the
complete Surah every Friday) to save yourself from the
illusions of the Dajjal (Anti-Christ) and find the truth
InshahAllah.
May Allah , make this effort easy to understand and useful
for everyone. Ameen.

27

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

28

B
BOOK I

THE LOST TRIBES OF ISRAEL,


IMAM MAHDI X
AND PROPHET ISA (JESUS) X




.
.

Chapter 1

Who Are the Lost Tribes of Israel

Israel is actually the title of Prophet Yaqb (Jacob) X. Some scholars


say Israel means the Traveler of the Night. But this cannot be right as
Israel is not Arabic name. Prophet Yaqb X did not speak Arabic.
So trying to find the meaning of Israel in Arabic is not justified.
In fact, Israel is an Aramaic name. El means Allah and Isra
means servant or slave. So, Israel means the Slave of Allah or
Abdullah.
Prophet Yaqb (Jacob) X is the son of Prophet Ishaq (Isaac) X,
and grandson of Prophet Ibrahim (Abraham) X. Prophet Yaqb
(Jacob) X had twelve sons and the offspring of his family are today
known as the Banu Israel (The Children of Israel).
The twelve tribes according to Bible are the following. Jacobs
twelve sons (in order):
1. Reuben,
2. Simeon,
3. Levi,
4. Judah,
33

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

5. Dan,
6. Naphtali,
7. Gad,
8. Asher,
9. Issachar,
10. Zebulon,
11. Joseph
12. Benjamin.
These are the ancestors of the twelve tribes of Israel.
Today people see that in Israel only the sons of Judah are to be
seen. The Jews are mainly the sons of Judah, and that is why they are
called Jews. (However a small minority of Tribe of Benjamin also exists
as the Jews claim).
The ten tribes of Israel disappeared from Biblical, and all other
historical accounts after the kingdom was destroyed in about 720 BC by
ancient Assyria. The last thing known about them was that these Tribes
of Israel went towards the east.
In this book about the search of the Lost Tribes of Israel among
Muslims. I have used the following references to identify the Lost Tribes
of Israel:
1. Islamic references of the Quran and authentic adth.
2. Living references in the shape of existing Biblical Israeli Names
3. References from Muslim Scholars.
34

Chapter 1 of Book I

4. References from non-Muslim Scholars.


May Allah make this book easy to understand and make the reader
gain useful knowledge. Ameen. (Allahumma salay ala Muammad).
Important Note: The knowledge of the Quran and adth
written in this book can be understood properly if the reader
follow the commandments in the adth that will save us from
the afflictions of the End of Times. These are following
commandments. I have described the requirements in the
introduction to this book.

35

36

Chapter 2

Introduction to the Tribes of


Muslim Banu Israel

The Quran tells us about two divisions among the Progeny of Prophet
Isaac X.




037:113


037:113 ( )
We blessed him [Abraham] and Isaac: but of their progeny are
(some) that do right, and (some) that obviously do wrong, to
their own souls. (37:113)
Again the Quran tells of the division of Muslims and nonMuslims amongst the Banu Israel at the time of Prophet Musa X.


007:159

37

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

007:159 .
Of the people of Moses there is a section who guide and do
justice in the light of truth. (7:159)
This clearly shows that family of Prophet Isaac X (or the family
of his son Prophet Israel, is divided in two groups both in his life and
afterwards (since the Quran is for all times till the end of time and not
only for the time of Prophet Isaac X).
1. Muslim Banu Isaac or Banu Israel (Banu Israel also means Banu
Isaac since Isaac is father of Israel).
2. Non-Muslim Banu Isaac (i.e.: the Jews which make only 2 out
of 12 tribes of Banu Israel / Isaac).
Who Among Muslims Belong to the Lost Tribes of Israel?
According to the Encyclopedia Britannica (1997)4, the following groups
of people are said to be from the Lost Tribes of Israel.
Peoples who at various times were said to be descendants of
the lost tribes include the: Nestorians, the Mormons, the
Afghans, the Falashas of Ethiopia, the American Indians, and
the Japanese.
Now, from among all listed above, the only Muslims said to be
from Banu Israel are the Afghans (the Pathans), and from the same area

4 Personally I dont give any importance to the references of the people of the
book but I am writing this reference of Britannica only for those who believe
in these references.
38

Chapter 2 of Book I

where the Army of Mahdi will rise. Since the Army of Mahdi will be
from the Muslims from Banu Israel, hence the Pathans are the lucky
ones to make the majority of that sacred armyInshahAllah.
Amongst Muslims only the Pathan, or Pashtun, or Pakhtun, or
Ethnic Afghan are known to be amongst the 10 lost tribes of Israel.
Who are Pathan or Pashtun?
Pashtuns are an ethnic/religious group of people, living primarily
in Afghanistan, Pakistan, and eastern Iran who speak Pashto or Pakhto
language and have an indigenous religion. The Pashtuns are the worlds
largest patriarchal tribal group in existence. The total population of the
group is estimated at 52 million. (This population numbers are from
1979 but no one knows what is the population, as millions of innocent
Pashtun Muslims have been killed since the 1979 so called Soviet
Invasion).
Pathans are the largest ethnic group in Afghanistan. In fact the
word Afghan is synonymous to Pashtun as told in the following
reference:
Until the term Afghan came to mean any native of
Afghanistan, Pashtuns were called Afghans.5
Note: The people of the Book used their media to change the
meaning of the word Afghan so that the genocide of
Pathans in Afghanistan can be concealed.

5. Encyclopedia Encarta http://encarta.msn.com/encyclopedia_761587080


/Pashtuns.html.
39

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

The Israeli origin of Pathans is not only an oral tradition.


Theory that the Pashtun or ethnic Afghans are descendants from the
ancient Israelitesmore precisely, from the perspective of Jewish
history the Lost Ten Tribes of Israelhas a longstanding basis as a
tradition among the Pashtun themselves. It was widely accepted by 19th
century British scholars, and has been accepted by some reasonably
recent and prominent individuals such as Itzhak Ben-Zvi, second
President of Israel. Ref: www.pakhtun.com/israeliSource.htm. Ben-Zvi6
says in his books:
The claim of Afghans to be the Banu Israel (Children of
Israel) is not founded on oral tradition alone. It is supported
by ancient monuments, old inscriptions, manuscripts, and
historical works, many in the public domain, and many others
in private collections.
Written references older than 1,000 years
Apart from our own reference, the oldest written reference we find
is Hudud-al-Alam, written in 982 A.D. by an Arab Geographer which
clearly tells us that PATHANS are not from BANU ISRAEL.
The word Afghan ... first appears in history in the Hudud-alAlam, a work by an Arab geographer who wrote in 982 A.D.
Until the advent of the modern Afghan state in the 18th
century, the word Afghan has been synonymous with
Pashtun.

6. Second President of Israel.


40

Chapter 2 of Book I

It is a pity how the west changes history in order to hide the


elimination of Pathans in Afghanistan. They even changed the meaning
of the word Afghan which always meant the PATHANS or
PASHTUNS.
Now, in modern times some of the Western Historians tell us that
the Pathans are from the ARYANS, and deny the ancient claim of the
Pashtuns that they belong to the Lost Tribes of Israel. It does not make
any sense that someone from outside denies the claim of a whole
Nation.
Why some of the western writers want to hide the truth?
This is told in the Quran.






002:146
)
(

002:146
Those to whom We gave the Scripture (Jews and Christians)
recognize him (Muammad) as they recognize their sons. But
verily, a party of them conceals the truth while they know it
(2:146)

B
41

42

Chapter 3

Proof of Muslim Banu Israel


from the Quran and adth

The Quran tells us about the division of Banu Israel in two groups
The Quran tells us about the two divisions among the Progeny of
Prophet Isaac X.





037:113


037:113 ( )
We blessed him (Abraham) and Isaac: but of their progeny are
(some) that do right, and (some) that obviously do wrong, to
their own souls. (37:113)
Again the Quran tells the division of Muslims and non-Muslims
amongst the Banu Israel at the time of Prophet Musa X.

43

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


007:159

007:159 .
Of the people of Moses there is a section who guide and do
justice in the light of truth. (7:159)
The same is told again in this verse and also it shows that Banu
Israel is scattered all around the world



007:168



( )
()
007:168 ( )
And We cut them up into communities on the earth; some of
them righteous, and some of them otherwise; and We proved
them with good and evil that haply they may return. (7:168)
We again see the same division between Muslims and non-Muslim
Banu Israel at the time of Prophet Eisa X.














.
061:014
44

Chapter 3 of Book I

( ) ()



061:014 .
O ye who believe! Be ye helpers of Allah: As said Jesus the son
of Mary to the Disciples, Who will be my helpers to (the work
of) Allah? Said the disciples, We are Allahs helpers! then a
portion of the Children of Israel believed, and a portion
disbelieved: But We gave power to those who believed, against
their enemies, and they became the ones that prevailed. (61:14)
Who are the Muslim Banu Israel?
We shall make this discussion in two parts. InshahAllah.

Discussion Part 1: Proving that Muslim Banu Israel will be the


first to join Imam Mahdi X and Prophet Eisa / Jesus X.

Discussion Part 2: Signs of the Banu Israelis who will join Imam
Mahdis X Army.

Discussion Part 1Proving that Banu Israel will join Imam


Mahdi X
Mainly the Banu Isaac (or Banu Israel) will fight the Battle of
Armageddon with the Romans (The West).
45

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

The Armageddon with the Christians will be fought by the Banu


Isaac Muslims and not the Arab Muslims as it is clear from the following
three adth:






46

Chapter 3 of Book I


Abu Huraira \ reported Allahs Messenger U as saying: The
Last Hour would not come until the Romans would land at
al-Amaq or in Dabiq. An army consisting of the best
(soldiers) of the people of the earth at that time will come
47

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

from a city (to counteract them). When they will arrange


themselves in ranks, the Romans would say: Do not stand
between us and those (Muslims) who took prisoners from
amongst us. Let us fight with them; and the Muslims would
say: Nay, by Allah, we would never get aside from you and
from our brethren that you may fight them. They will then
fight and a third (part) of the army would run away, whom
Allah will never forgive. A third (part of the army), which
would be constituted of excellent martyrs in Allahs eye,
would be killed and the third who would never be put to trial
would win and they would be conquerors of Constantinople.
And as they would be busy in distributing the spoils of war
(amongst themselves) after hanging their swords by the olive
trees, the Satan would cry: The Dajjal has taken your place
among your family. They would then come out, but it would
be of no avail. And when they would come to Syria, he would
come out while they would be still preparing themselves for
battle drawing up the ranks. Certainly, the time of prayer shall
come and then Jesus X son of Mary would descend and
would lead them in prayer. When the enemy of Allah would
see him, it would (disappear) just as the salt dissolves itself in
water and if he (Jesus X) were not to confront them at all,
even then it would dissolve completely, but Allah would kill
them by his hand and he would show them their blood on his
lance (the lance of Jesus X Christ).7

7. a Muslim, Kitab al-Fitan, adth 2897.


48

Chapter 3 of Book I

Important Note: The word Madina here means a CITY and


not particularly the city of Madina because in Arabic the word
for city is Madina.
The above adth tells us of the biggest fight with the Christians,
or the Armageddon.
We see these points in this adth:
1. 1/3rd of the Muslims will survive after this Armageddon.
2. These 1/3rd Muslims will conquer Constantinople.
Now, which Muslims are left to conquer Constantinople after the
Armageddon (with the West)?
The following adth will clear this question as it is plainly stated that
these Muslims are from the BANU ISHAQ (BANU ISAAC).








:

:
:




:
:


: :


:

:


--

49

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





!










)







50

Chapter 3 of Book I



)
)
(
Abu Huraira \ reported Allahs Apostle U saying: You have
heard about a city the one side of which is in the land and the
other is in the sea (Constantinople). They said: Allahs
Messenger, yes. There upon he said: The Last Hour would not
come unless seventy thousand persons from Banu Ishaq
would attack it. When they would land there, they will neither
fight with weapons nor would shower arrows but would only
say: There is no god but Allah and Allah is the Greatest, that
one side of it would fall. Thaur (one of the narrators) said: I
think that he said: The part by the side of the ocean. Then they
would say for the second time: There is no god but Allah and
Allah is the Greatest that the second side would also fall, and
they would say: There is no god but Allah and Allah is the
Greatest, that the gates would be opened for them and they
would enter therein and, they would be collecting spoils of
war and distributing them amongst themselves that a noise
would be heard and It would be said: Verily, the Dajjal has
come. And thus they would leave everything there and would
turn to him.8

8. a Muslim, Kitab al-Fitan, adth 2920.


51

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Misconception about the above adth about Banu Isaac


(Children of Prophet Isaac).
Some consider the Romans as the Children of Prophet Abraham X
(from his younger son Prophet Isaac) just as the Arabs who are Children
of Prophet Abraham X (from his elder son Prophet Ismael). For this
reason they call Romans as the Children of Isaac.
This is totally baseless as the following adth clearly tells us that
the Romans are from a totally different lineage than the Arabs as the
adth in below note 9 proves9.

9. Before reading these adth, remember that Prophet Ibrahim X has two
sons i.e. Prophet Ismail X and Prophet Isaac X. Also Prophet Ibrahim X
ancestor is one of the 3 sons of Prophet Nh X whose name is Saam.


.


: :
1179
Sayyidina Samurah \ reported from the Prophet that he said:
Saam was the father of the Arab, Haam the father of the Ethiopians
and Yaafith of the Romans. (Jamia Tirmidhi, Vol. 2, adth 1179)


: .
52

Chapter 3 of Book I

Further proof from the Quran and adth about Roman ancestry
can be found in the book Misconceptions about the End times which
is included in this collection.
We come back to our previous discussion now.
So this proves that Banu Isaac will fight against the Christians in the
Armageddon, and 1/3rd of them will be left behind to conquer



329 : :
Sayyidina Samurah \ reported from the Prophet U that he said,
Saam was the father of the Arab, Yafith the father of the Romans
and Haam the father of the Ethiopians. And the narrator called
Rooh said in the city of Baghdad that Prophet Noah has 3 sons,
namely, Saam, Haam and Yafith. (Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 9,
adth 329)
Also at many places, Holy Quran only mentions one son of Prophet Ishaq e.g.
021:072




() () ( )
021:072
And We bestowed upon him Ishque (Isaac), and (a grandson) Yaqb
(Jacob). Each one We made righteous. (21:72)
The above references prove that Romans have a different ancestor than
Prophet Ibrahim X and that proves son of Prophet Ibrahim X i.e. Prophet
Isaac X is not their ancestor. Further discussion about the single son of
Prophet Ishaaq X can be found on page XX.
53

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Constantinople.
Now we have two more points by reading the above adth:
1.

After conquering Constantinople these 1/3rd Muslims will


hear a cry of the coming of Dajjal.

2.

Then these 1/3rd Muslims will start preparing for prayers


(Salat) before the war when Prophet Sayyidna Eisa (Jesus) X
will come.

Now when the Army of Mahdi will be waiting for the Prayers (Salat)
what will be the situation of the Arabs?
This is told in the following adth. When these two events will be over
then a small number of Arabs will join these forces as told in this adth.

:
...
.
.
! : )).
. . . ))

adth continues ,....

) .
. (

54

Chapter 3 of Book I


( )
!

( )


.

/ 958 / 3
Narrated by Hazrat Umama a long adth from our Dear
Prophet where Umm Sharik said: Where would be the Arabs
then in that day? (Meaning why the Arabs wont come
forward and fight for Islam). He U said: They would be small
in number? And from those remaining Arabs, most of them
will be in Bait-ul-Muqaddas (Sham), and their leader will be
a pious man (Mahdi). When their leader will move forward
to lead the morning prayers, then, Hazrat Eisa/Jesus X will
descend from the sky. The leader will step back so that Hazrat
Eisa X will lead the prayers but Hazrat Eisa X will put his
hand on his back between his shoulders and say: Move
forward and lead the prayers because the Iqamah was called
for you. Then the Imam (Mahdi X) will lead the prayers for
55

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

all people (This is a part of a long adth which can be read


in the given reference).10
This adth (along with the above two adth) clearly tells us that
the Arabs will join only when Banu Isaac Muslims will be preparing for
war, and at the time of Salat, Prophet Eisa X will come.
Two points are cleared here that:
1.

The majority of the Arabs will not take part in the war with
the Christians, and

2.

The majority of the Arabs will not participate in the conquest


of Constantinople.

The Arabs will come (in a very small number) when Banu Isaac
Muslims will be preparing for prayers (Salat) after the conquest of
Constantinople (before war against the Dajjal) and when Prophet Jesus
X arrives.
Please be clear that these two adth tells us that:
1.

The time of waiting for Salat (prayers) and coming of


Prophet Jesus X (Eisa) is after the Armageddon with
the

Christians,

and

AFTER

the

conquest

of

Constantinople.
2.

Also the following adth again clearly tells us that non


Arabs of the east will fight the Great Wars of the End of
Times.

10. Sunan Ibn-e-Majah, Kitab al-Fitan, adth 4077.


56

Chapter 3 of Book I

: : .
:

! : .
.





Umm-e-Sharik reported: I heard Allahs Messenger U as
saying: The people would run away from the Dajjal seeking
shelter in the mountains. She said: Where would be the
Arabs then in that day? He said: They would be very few.11
And also it is clearly told of the Great Wars at the End of Times,
whereon Arabs from the east will make up these lucky armies:

. .
:
)):
.((

11. a Muslim, adth 2896, page 1904, Volume 3, 2945.


57

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X






Narrated Hazrat Abu Huraira \: When great wars will
occur, then Allah , will rise an army from the non-Arabs
who will be greater riders, and will have better weapons than
the Arabs. Allah , will support His Deen (Islam) by them.12
Banu Israeli Muslims in Mahdis Army and Mahdi living
among Banu Israel
Please check this fact from the following adth


( (
:



:


:







:
:




12. Sunan Ibn Majah, adth 971, page 778, Volume 3.


58

Chapter 3 of Book I




.
187 .7367 : .






( )



187 .7367 : .
Narrated Hazrat Umama \ who reported that Rasulullah U
said: You and the Romans (Christians) will have four peace
treaties. The fourth peace would be at the hand of a person
who would be from the Al-e-Harqul (family of Roman King
Heraclius). This peace treaty would be for seven years.
Rasulullah U was asked who would be the Imam of the
Muslims at that time. Rasulullah U said: That person would
be from my family, his age would be 40 years, his face would
be bright as a start, and a black spot would be on his right
59

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

cheek. He would be wearing two Qutwani Shawls. He will


appear exactly as the person from Banu Israel. He will rule for
20 years and will conquer the cities of the Mushrikeen
(Idolaters).13
We have this results from the above adth:
1.

Imam Mahdi X is living among Banu Israel, and

2.

Thats why he is wearing the clothes of Banu Israel.

Can the tribe of Banu Israel described in the above adth


point towards the non-Muslims?
This is not possible as the Quran has told us that misguided persons are
not be related to the Prophets of Allah , as we can see in the following
verse where the misguided son of Prophet Noah X is not considered
from the family of Prophet Noah X.







.11-46-
()

()
()
(11-46)

13. Kanz-ul-Aamal, page 268, adth No. 3868. Tabarn narrated it in alMujam-ul-kabr (8:101 #7495), Musnad-ush-shmiyyn (2:410 #1600); and
Haytham in Majma-uz-zawid (7:318-319).
60

Chapter 3 of Book I

(Allah) said, O Noah, in fact, he (Noahs son) is not a part of


your family. Indeed, he is (a man of) bad deeds. So do not ask
Me something of which you have no knowledge. I exhort you
not to be among the ignorant. (11:46)
(Allah) said: O Noah (Prophet Noah), in fact, he (Noahs son)
is not a part of your family. Indeed, he is (a man of) bad deeds.
So do not ask Me something of which you have no knowledge.
I exhort you not to be among the ignorant. (11:46)
Conclusion
We have proven from the Quran and the adth that the majority of
Muslim Banu Israel will join Imam Mahdi X and Prophet Eisa X,
InshahAllah. Also we have seen that Imam Mahdi X will be living
among the Muslim Banu Israel and would have adopted their Israeli
culture.
Part 2 of proof of Muslim Banu Israel in Quran and adth
Signs of the people of Banu Israel who will join Imam Mahdis Army.
Now, keep in mind the above adth so that now we shall search for the
Banu Isaac among the Muslims who will join Imam Mahdi X.
In other words, it also means that if we search for the Muslims who
will join Imam Mahdi X then we can find out who are the Banu Isaac
among the Muslims.
We shall do this by the following steps.
1. Finding the Geographical Location of Mahdis Army from the
61

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

adth.
2. Finding the Culture of Mahdis Army from the adth.
3. Finding the specific race of the Mahdis Army from the adth.
4. Finding any special feature of the Mahdis Army from the
adth.
1. Finding the Geographical Location of the Army of Mahdi.
Sign 1: The Army of Mahdi will come from the east.

:

)): :
. .
)) . .(( .
: .(( .
. . .



( )




62

Chapter 3 of Book I



( )
Thawban \ reported that our Dear Prophet U said: Three
people will fight for your treasure (and get killed). All three of
them will be sons of a ruler but none of them will get the
treasure. Then black flags will appear from the east and will
kill you as no one (in history) has killed you before. Then our
Dear Prophet U said something that I didnt remember. Then
again our Dear Prophet U said if you see him, then give him
your allegiance, even if you have to crawl over ice, because he
is the Khalifa of Allah ,, the Mahdi. (This adth is a
(Most Authentic) according to the standards of a Bukhari
and a Muslim).14
Note: There are many more adth also about the army of the
east helping the Mahdi X, but only these two are written so
that the discussion doesnt become too lengthy.
Sign 2: The Army of Mahdi will be from the Khurasan.
The following two authentic adth further prove that the east in the
above adth means Khurasan.

14. Hakim Mustadrak, Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 8432.


63

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

-



2427 : :
Thoban \ (companion of our Dear Prophet Muammad U)
reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: When
you see that black flags have appeared from the Khurasan, go
to (join) them even if you have to walk over ICE on your
knees, as the Khalifa of Allah the MAHDI will be among
them.15








1599 : :
Abu Huraira \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet
Muammad U) reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad

15. Masnad Ahmad, Volume 9, adth 2427.


64

Chapter 3 of Book I

U said: Black flags will appear from the Khurasan, Nothing


will stop them until they will be placed at Elya (The Holy Land
of Jerusalem)16.
The above three adth are authentic.
All the above 3 adth are a adth. The famous adth scholar Ali
Mutaqqi says about the above adth (of Masnad Ahmad) that these are
authentic, and further says in the beginning of his book that:


( , . , , )


) .
( , . , ,
Translation: Muhaddith Ali Muttaqi said that all the adth
of Masnad Ahmad are Maqbl

17

even if it is Daif 18, it is

16. Masnad Ahmad, Volume 4, adth 1599.


17. Acceptable (Maqbl)The adth that is found to be reported by truthful
and acceptable narrators. It is ruling is that it is obligatory to accept and act
upon it.
18. Daif, ( ),
is the categorization of a adth as weak. Ibn Hajar described

the cause of a adth being classified as weak as either due to discontinuity in


the chain of narrators or due to some criticism of a narrator.
65

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

almost equal to Hasan19 adth. (Ref: Muntakhab Kanzaul


Amal, Ali Hamish, page 8, Vol. 1).
Also another famous adth Scholar, Ibn Hajar, agreed.



7


( )
68

Translation: The famous scholar of adth, Hafiz Ibn Hajar,
also accepted the same rule about Masnad Ahmad, and said
that there is no Daif adth in Masnad Ahmad. Also Ibn
Hajar did not accept the ruling of Ibn Jauzi considering some
of the adth of Masnad Ahmad as Daif. In fact Ibn Hajar
wrote a book called Al-Qaul-ul-Masdd in which he proved
the claim of Ibn Jauzi wrong, and proved that even these
adth were not Daif. (Reference from Muntakhab Kanzul

19. Hasan, ( ),
linguistically means good and there exist somewhat

convergent technical definitions, however, in general, it expresses the


categorization of a adths authenticity as acceptable for use as a religious
evidence, however, not established to the extent of a.
66

Chapter 3 of Book I

Amal, Ali Hamish, page 8-9, Volume 1).20


Now so far we have found out that:

The Mahdis Army will be from the east , and

That the Khurasan is located in the east .We all know that the
Pashtun live in the east, and in the Khurasan.

Sign 3 The Army of the Mahdi will be from a place with ice.
The same adth quoted above.
Check the following adth (repeated before) in which the word
ice is used when the forces of Imam Mahdi X are mentioned:

:

)): :
. .
)) . .(( .
--.(( .
. . :
.

20. Page 68 and 75 of the book Aqeedah Zahur-e-Mahdi by Dr.Mufti Nizamud-din Shamzai.
67

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

( )






( )
Thawban \ reported that our Dear Prophet U said: Three
people will fight for your treasure (and get killed). All three of
them will be sons of a ruler but none of them will get the
treasure. Then black flags will appear from the east and will
kill you as no one (in history) has killed you before. Then our
Dear Prophet U said something that I didnt remember. Then
again our Dear Prophet U said: If you see him them, give him
your allegiance, even if you have to crawl over ice, because
he is the Khalifa of Allah, the Mahdi. (The given adth is
most authentic (a) according to conditions of a
Muslim and a Bukhari).21

.
. . . .
. .
) --.((
21. Hakim Mustadrak, adth 4084, Kitab-al-Fitan.
68

Chapter 3 of Book I

4082-(
Page 240

( )


()




4082( )
240 ..
Narrated by Hazrat Abdullah Bin Masood \ that our Dear
Prophet U said: A Nation carrying black banners will come
out of the east. They will instruct the people to do good, but
the people will refuse; they will fight until they are victorious,
and the people do as they asked, but they will not accept it
from them until they hand over power to a man from my
household. Then the earth will be filled with fairness, just as
it had been filled with injustice. If any of you live to see this,

69

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

you should go to him even if you have to crawl across ice.22


And also the following adth (also previously mentioned
therefore I have not used the Arabic text of these adth here)
Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said that: When you hear
the news of black flags coming from the east, then, you must
join them even if you have to crawl over ice (to reach them).23
Thoban \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet Muammad U
reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: When
you see that black flags have appeared from the Khurasan, go
to (join) them even if you have to walk over ice on your
knees, as the Khalifa of Allah, the MAHDI will be among
them.24
There are more adth also telling of the emergence of Imam
Mahdis X army from a place with ICE or a cold climate place. We all
know that the Pashtuns live in a cold climate area where snow falls.

22. Al Asha by Muhammad Barzanji, page 240. Also Sunan Ibn Majah, adth
4082, Kitab-al-Fitan. Also page 10 in the Book Signs before the Day of
Judgement by Ibn Kathir. Also page 100 in book Islam Main Mahdi ka
Tasawwer by Prof Yusuf Khan of Jamia Ashrafia, Lahore, Pakistan.
23. Musnad Ahmad 5:277. Also in Sunan Ibn Majah. Also adth 5225 in
Mishkat al Masabeeh.
24. Baiqahee and Ahmed in Dalael-e-Nabowat, adth No 5225 in Mishkat-ulMasabeeh.
70

Chapter 3 of Book I

2. Finding the Culture of Banu Israelis Forming the Mahdis Army.


Sign 4 The Mahdi will be wearing Israeli clothes and will
have people from Banu Israel in his Army.


( )
:






:

:






:

:








187 .7367 : ..






( )


187 .7367 : .
71

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Narrated Hazrat Umama \ who reported that Rasulullah U


said: You and the Romans (Christians) will have four peace
treaties. The fourth peace would be at the hand of a person
who would be from the Al-e-Harqul (family of Roman King
Heraclius). This peace treaty would be for seven years.
Rasulullah U was asked who would be the Imam of the
Muslims at that time. Rasulullah U said: That person would
be from my family, his age would be 40 years, his face would
be bright as a star and a black spot would be on his right
cheek. He would be wearing two Qutwani Shawls. He will
appear exactly as the person from Banu Israel. He will rule for
20 years and will conquer the cities of the Mushrikeen
(Idolaters). 25
We have this result from the above adth.
Imam Mahdi X will be living among Banu Israel and thats why he is
wearing the clothes of Banu Israel.
What is meant by Qutwani shawls?
Qutwani shawls resembles the TALLIT of present day, as called by
the Israelis. Both Qutwani cloak and TALLIT have fringes (tzitzit) on
the borders and it is mostly made of wool. It generally falls across the
head, neck, and shoulders. However the Qutwani cloak is larger and

25. Kanz-ul-Aamal, page 268, adth No 3868. Tabarn narrated it in alMujam-ul-kabr (8:101 #7495), Musnad-ush-shmiyyn (2:410 #1600); and
Haytham in Majma-uz-zawid (7:318-319).
72

Chapter 3 of Book I

more conspicuous prayer shawl than the Tallit.26


Now, the Qutwani cloak has following features:

They are made of wool (as many scholars described it).

They are wrapped around the body (as the above adth also
mentions).

It has fringes on it is borders.

It is a warm dress for cold weather.

The Qutwani cloak is exactly like the shawls worn by the Pashtuns
of Afghanistan and Pakistan and it is also worn in the same way like the
Qutwani cloak described in the adth and it is explanation.
In fact these shawls are often the necessary part of the Pashtun
dress (in contrast to the present day Jews who wear the so called Tzitzit
as a symbol, and which are much smaller to be wrapped around the
body. In fact it has just become a something to show off by Jews and not
essential part of dress).
The above mentioned adth telling that Imam Mahdi X would
be from the family of our Dear Prophet U but would not look like our
Dear Prophet U in appearance, clearly tells us that the Mahdi will not
be living among the Arabs. His appearance described as wearing
Qutwani shawls, and looking like a person from Banu Israel shows that
he must be living among the Pathans for a long time, and
therefore Imam Mahdi X would be dressed also like the Pathans.

26. Encyclopedia Britannica, 1997.


73

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Remember that the Family of the Beloved Prophet


Muammad U is all over the world and have adopted
different cultures.

Figure: Qutwani Shawls of the Pathans.


Another adth telling that Imam Mahdi X will not be wearing
the dress of the Arabs:

:
:
:

:



74

Chapter 3 of Book I


.. :








.
.
897 : :
Hazrat Ali \ looked at his son, Hassan, and said: This son of
mine will be a leader, just like he was named by our Dear
Prophet Muammad U, and soon a person will be born from
his progeny whose name will be like the name of your
Prophet. He will have the akhlkaq (character) of your Prophet
U) but his khalaq (appearance) will not be like him. Then he
told a long story and said that he will fill the earth with
Justice.27
The Family of our Dear Prophet is all over the world and
have adopted different cultures.
27. Sunan Abu Daud, Vol. 3, adth 897.
75

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

So, Imam Mahdi X will be from the family of the Prophet U


but living among the Banu Israel, and therefore will not be
wearing clothes of the Arabs.
Now we have located the area from where the Army of Mahdi will
come, also the appearance of Mahdi X, and his army.
3. Finding the specific race of the Army of Mahdi from the adth.
We should know that Sayyidina Isaac X is the father of Sayyidina Israel
X, so Banu Israel and Banu Isaac have the same meaning. Also
Sayyidina Haroon (Aaron) X is from Banu Israel.
Sign 5 Banu Isaac will be in Mahdis Army.
This has already been discussed and the adth of a Muslim quoted
before here in this article. One of those adth is quoted again below.
Abu Huraira \ reported Allahs Apostle U saying: You have
heard about a city the one side of which is in the land and the
other is in the sea (Constantinople). They said: Allahs
Messenger, yes. There upon he said: The Last Hour would
not come unless seventy thousand persons from Banu Ishaq
would attack it 28

28. a Muslim.


76

Chapter 3 of Book I

Pathans wearing Israeli Qutwani shawls in daily life


Sign 7 The Tribe of Qais or Kash will be in Mahdis Army
The following authentic adth tells us about the fight of the Qais tribe
with a Sufyani (a person from the Arab tribe of Quraish) who is enemy
of Imam Mahdi X).




77

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Narrated by Hazrat Abu Huraira \: our Dear Prophet U said:


A person called Sufyani will appear from the suburbs of
Damascus and his general followers will be the people of the
Kulaib Tribe (a branch of Arab Banu Tamim tribe). He will
attack (so fiercely) that he will cut the bellies of women and
kill children. To fight against him, the people of the Tribe of
Qais will gather. Sufyani will fight them and kill them so much
that no valley will be left without their dead bodies.29
Where is the tribe of Kash or Kish or Qais?
Qais Abdur Rashid Khan (575-661 C.E.) Also known as Kash. Qais is
a legendary ancestor of the Pashtun race. It is said that he travelled to
Makkah and Medina in Arabia during the early days of Islam. (He is
believed to be the 37th descendent of King Saul (or Malik Talut in the
Quran).
The children of Israel, in Gore (a place in Afghanistan), preserved

29. Hakim Al-Mustadrak, Volume 4, page 520, Kitab al Fitan, adth 8586.
78

Chapter 3 of Book I

their knowledge of the unity of God and the purity of their religious
belief, and on the appearance of the last and greatest of the Prophets
(Muammad U) the Afghans of Gore listened to the invitation of their
Arabian brethren, the chief of whom was Khalid (or Caled), son of
Waleed, so famous for his conquest of Syria, and marched to the aid of
the true faith, under the command of Qais, afterwards surnamed Abdul
Rasheed. His name is actually KASH or KISH but the Arabs
pronounced it QAIS.30
QAIS or KASH is actually the name of numerous personalities of
the Children of Israel according to the chapter of Chronicles in the
Bible, such as the following examples:
Jeiel the father of Gibeon lived in Gibeon, and the name of
his wife was Maacah. (Chronicles 30) His firstborn son:
Abdon, then Zur, Kish, Baal, Nadab. (Chronicles 29)
Gedor, Ahio, Zecher, (Chronicles 32) and Mikloth, who
became the father of Shimeah. (Chronicles 33) Ner became
the father of Kish, Kish of Saul, Saul of Jonathan, Malchishua,
Abinadab, and Esh-baal. (Chronicles 12)
The following are those who came to David at Ziklag, while
he could not move about freely because of Saul son of Kish;
they were among the mighty warriors who helped him in
war. (Chronicles)

30. Makhzan-e-Afghan.
79

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Kash Abdur Rasheed had his name from his Banu Israeli forefathers.

Fig: Pashtun Tribes Genealogy31

The following figure shows the genealogy of majority of the Pathans.

31. The Pathans 55O B.C.-1957 A.D., By Sir Olaf Caroe. Also Wikipedia.com.
80

Chapter 3 of Book I

In Pakistan and Afghanistan we find many places where the Pashtuns


live and by the name of KISH/KASH such as:

DASHT-E-KASH (a desert in southern Afghanistan).

The city of Kish Khenjak in Afghanistan located at Velayat-e


Oruzgan.

The Solomon mountain range is also know by Pashtuns as the


KASH GHAR (The Mountain of KASH or QAIS).

The HINDU KASH mountain range.

The KASH GHAR in China is also named after KASH since he


was the King of this area and a famous personality.

There are several other cities by his name which can be seen in
the detailed list of Biblical Israeli names in the next chapter.
InshahAllah.

4. Finding any special feature of Army of Mahdi.


A mighty warrior nation, a valiant warrior nation will attack and
destroy the Jewish kingdom once again!
Please read the following verses carefully. (The translation in Urdu is by
Hussain Ahmad Madni and in English is from Ifran-al-the Quran)





017:004



017:005

017:006

81

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X



017:007
017:008



017:004

()
( )
) 017:005
(
( )
()017:006 ( )


( )



017:007( )
) ()
82

Chapter 3 of Book I

(
017:008
And We categorically conveyed to the Children of Israel in the
Book: You shall make mischief twice in the land, and employ
a violent defiance (against obedience to Allah) (17:04)
So when the promised first time of the two came to pass We
brought upon you those of our servants who were great
warriors. Then, in (your) search they penetrated up to your
dwellings. And (this) promise was sure to be fulfilled. (17:05)
Then We turned the victory over them to your favor and helped
you with (affluence in) wealth, and children, and increased
your numerical strength (as well). (17:06)
Whenever you did good, it was to your own advantage, and
whenever you committed evil, it was to your own disadvantage.
So, when the time of the fulfillment of the second prophecy drew
near, (We raised other enemies that would) disfigure your faces
and enter the Temple (of Jerusalem), as they had done the first
time, and destroy whatever they would lay their hands on.
(17:07)
It may well be that (after this) your Lord will have mercy on
you, but if you revert to the same (rebellious and defiant
behaviour), then We too will get back to the same
(tormenting once again). And We have made Hell a prison for
the disbelievers. (17:08)
Please concentrate on the two main points and words described in
83

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

the verses(4-8) of Srah Banu Israel:




We brought upon you those of our servants who were great
warriors. (07:04)
Allah destroyed the Jews in Al-Quds before by a mighty warrior
nation and if they disobey again, it is a promise that it will happen
again.

() .......
... ( )

But if you do this again, We shall do that again (7:08)
So, we have two points to consider in this verse:
1. If Banu Israel is having control of the Holy Land (Jerusalem),
and
2. They are not on the right path (of Islam),
Then Allah will send a mighty warrior nation to destroy them.
Today we see the both conditions fulfilled as the Jews (The
misguided Banu Israel) are in control of Jerusalem. So once again a
great warrior nation will come to destroy them.

84

Chapter 3 of Book I

The Warrior Nature of the Muslims in Prophet Eisas X Army


The following adth confirms the warrior nature of the Army of Imam
Mahdi X and Prophet Eisa X.



: .

.395. :
Jabir \ b. Abdullah reported: I heard the Messenger of Allah
U say: A section of my people will not cease fighting for the
Truth and will prevail till the Day of Resurrection. He said:
85

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Jesus X son of Mary would then descend and their


(Muslims) commander would invite him to come and lead
them in prayer, but he would say: No, some amongst you are
commanders over some (amongst you). This is the honor
from Allah for this Ummah.32
We are all well aware of the fact that Pathans have always fought
for Islam and never been defeated just as the above adth tells.
This adth also confirms what is told in the above Quranic verses
that a famous warrior nation will destroy the misguided Banu Israel
(Jews) in Holy Land.
The meaning of i.e. commanders in the above
adth of a Muslim
We should remember that the commander-in-chief of the Muslims
armies will be Prophet Eisa X and not Imam Mahdi X. Following
someone in Salat does not indicate his superiority because our Dear
Prophet Muammad U also prayed behind Sahaba like Sayyidna Abu
Bakar \ and Abdur-Rehman bin Auf \.
Also it should be noted that there are many adth stating that
Prophet Sayyidna Eisa X will be the Khalifa of Islam at that time.
Now, the meaning of the last words of the above adth are cleared
by the following adth.

32. a Muslim, Vol. 1, adth 395.


86

Chapter 3 of Book I

)
394 : : (
It is narrated on the authority of Abu Huraira \ that the
Messenger of Allah U observed: What would you do when
the son of Mary X would descend amongst you and would
lead you as one amongst you? Ibn Abi Dhib on the authority
of Abu Huraira \ narrated: Your leader amongst you. Ibn
Abi Dhib said: Do you know what the words: He would lead
87

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

as one amongst you mean? I said: Explain these to me. He


said: He would lead you according to the Book of your
Lord (hallowed be He and most exalted) and the Sunnah of
your Apostle U.33
This time the fierce warrior nation that will conquer
Jerusalem and punish Banu Israel on behalf of Allah , will
be from the Khurasan. InshahAllah!


.





.
Thoban \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet Muammad U)
reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: When
you see that black flags have appeared from Khurasan go to
(join) them even if you have to walk over ice on your knees as
the Khalifa of Allah, the MAHDI will be among them. (This
33. a Muslim, Vol. 1, adth 392, Kitab-ul-Eman.
88

Chapter 3 of Book I

adth is a (Most Authentic) according to the


conditions of a Bukhari and a Muslim).34


: -:

(
)

( )
)
(
Abu Hurairah (RA) says that Rasulullah (SAWS) said:
(Armies carrying) black flags will come from Khurasan (It is
meaning being: Land of the Rising Sun, meaning the east).
No power will be able to stop them and they will finally reach
Eyla (Baitul Maqdas / Jerusalem) where they will erect their
flags.35
The fierce warrior nation will be from Muslim Banu Israel.
Since the leader of the End Time Army of Islam will be the Banu Israeli
Prophet Eisa/Jesus X, therefore this also means that the fierce warrior
nation will be from Muslim Banu Israel. The Quran tells us about the
condition necessary for the coming of a Prophet:

34. Mustadrak Hakim, adth 8531.


35. Jamia Tirmidhi, Chapter of Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 2371.
89

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X






(14:04)



We sent not a messenger except (to teach) in the language of his
(own) people, in order to make (things) clear to them. (14:4)
This Quranic verse tells us two things:
1. That a Prophet comes amongst his own nation.
2. That a Prophet speaks the language of the nation to which he
was sent.
Like our Dear Prophet Muammad U, who is an Arab, and he
came amongst the Arabs, and he speaks Arabicin the same manner
as all Prophets before. Similarly, when Banu Israeli Prophet Sayyidna
Eisa/Jesus X will come, in the beginning, his own nation will be
around him, i.e.: Muslim Banu Israel.
Today only the Pathans are known to be from Banu Israel,
and at the same time they live in the Khurasan where the
Army of the Mahdi will appear. Further, they are famous
all over the world as a fierce warrior nation.

90

Chapter 3 of Book I

Conclusion 1
Therefore it means that the warning given in the Quran to the
misguided Banu Israel i.e.:




We brought upon you those of our servants who were great
warriors... (07:04)
This punishment of the Jews by Allah , in the Quran will be
fulfilled by the Pathans of the Khurasan. InshahAllah.
This the main reason for their genocide in Pakistan and
Afghanistan since 1979 using different names and different reason such
as so called Taliban, Al-Qaeda, War on Terror, etc., etc.
No matter how much they torture and kill them, with the help of
fake reasons in Pakistan and Afghanistan, this fierce warrior nation can
never be stopped. InshahAllah.
Conclusion 2
From the Quran and adth we found that Banu Israel will make the
majority of Prophet Eisas X and Imam Mahdis X army.
Now further we found out that:

They will come from the east.

They will come from Khurasan.

They will be from the tribe of KASH.


91

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

They will be wearing Qutwani Shawls.

They will be famous in the world as a great warrior nation.

So now, the only Muslim race that are:


I.
II.

Living in the east


Living in Khurasan

III.

Wearing the Qutwani Shawls.

IV.

From the Descendants of Kash or Qais.

V.

Famous as a Great Warrior Nation in the world.


Are Pashtuns and at the same time they are the only
Muslim race living in the same location and considered to
be from the:

VI.

Lost tribes of Israel

This proves from the adth that the Pashtuns are from the lost
tribes of Israel.
It also means that the Pathans are from that Banu Israel who will
join Imam Mahdi X, and Israeli Prophet Eisa X.
Objection
There are other races also living in Khurasan like the Tajik, Uzbek,
Hazara etc. races in Khurasan. Can they be from the Banu Israel who
will join Mahdi?
adth tells us that many people from those Turks of Khurasan
who have broad, round, fleshy faces(resembling almost like Mongols),
92

Chapter 3 of Book I

will join the army of the Dajjal.


Please check the following adth telling us about the army of the
Dajjal with faces like shields.
Narrated Amr \ bin Taghlib: The Prophet said: One of the
portents of the Hour is that you will fight with people wearing
shoes made of hair; and one of the portents of the Hour is that
you will fight with broad-faced people whose faces will look
like shields coated with leather. 36
The following adth tells us that these people, with faces like
shields, will be in the Dajjals Army.

:
.
:
)):
(( .
4072



36. a Bukhari. Volume 4, Book 52, number 178.


93

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

( )
952 : :
Narrated by Amr ibn Hurayth \ who quoted Abu Bakr Al
Siddiq \ as saying that Allahs Messenger U told them the
Dajjal would come forth from a land in the east called
Khurasan, followed by people whose faces resembled shields
covered with skin.37
Who in Khurasan have having faces like Shields (or flat faces)?
The Mongol or so called Turkic nations living in Khurasan have faces
just like that described in the adth. These include Tajik, Uzbek,
Hazara, Turkeman etc. It should be noted that these central Asian races
are originally Mongols but are Musilms and adopted Turkish culture.
Henry George Keene (1825-1915)38 writes:
A Mongol is merely a Turk in embryo a Turk little more
than a civilized and circumcised Mongol or Tartar. 39

37. Sunan Ibn Majah, Chapter Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 4078. Also in a
Tirmidhi. Also in Mishkat, adth 5251.
38. Fellow of the University of Calcutta; grandson of Henry George Keene
(1781-1864), orientalist (the brother-in-law of George Harris, first baron of
Seringapatam).
39. The Turks in India: Critical Chapters on the Administration of That
Country, by Henry George Keene, page 1-2.
94

Chapter 3 of Book I

Further discussion on this subject is beyond the scope of this book.


We can read more details regarding this in the book No. 4 in this
collection i.e. Army of the Dajjal Part II
InshahAllah you will find enough from adth about these Nations
of Khurasan who will join Dajjal.
Is the following adth Authentic?
Some people give as a reference the following adth about the End of
Times, but this adth is Daif (not authentic) and can never be used as
a reference. Also there is no other Authentic adth which supports the
meaning of the following adth.
95

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

:
:
:







. .






( )

:
897 :
A man called al-Harith ibn Harrath will come forth from Ma
Wara an-Nahr. His army will be led by a man called Mansur
who will establish or consolidate things for Muammads
family as the Quraysh consolidated them for the Apostle of
Allah U. Every believer must help him, or he said: respond to

96

Chapter 3 of Book I

his sermons.40
This adth is considered Daif (Not Authentic) according to Jamia
Sagheer.41

40. Sunan Abu Daud.


41. Daif, al-Jami al-Saghir, 6418.
97

Chapter 4

The Living Proof of the Pathans Israeli Origin


in the Form of Israeli Names

The living proof of the Israeli origin of the Pathans comes in the form
of numerous Biblical Israeli names of people and places in Pashtun
areas. Below are some of these examples of names/places common
among the Pathans and Banu Israel.
1. Pathan
Pashtuns also known as Pathans. Very few people know that Pithon is
the name of the great-grandson of King Saul, mentioned among a list
of hundreds of names chronicling the descendants of the Twelve Tribes
(Ref: Chronicles I , 8:35, Bible).
The son of Jonathan: Meribbaal. Meribbaal was the father
of Micah (8:34)
The sons of Micah: Pithon, Melech, Tarea, and Ahaz
(8:35)
Also in Israel in the Gaza Strip near Nablus there is a
famous Israeli check post by the name of AL-PATHAN. For
reference and info about AL-PATHAN check post please visit

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

http://www.imemc.org/article/17284.
2. Amran
The father of Banu Israels Prophet Moses X is called AMRAN, and
also there is a famous mountain range in the Pathan area of Afghanistan
known as KHOJEH AMRAN, this is close to the PISHIN district of
Pakistan. Also there are many other numerous towns by the name of
Amran.
3. Bannu
The full name of the eldest son of Prophet Israel / Jacob X is written
as Asher Bacher Bannu in the Talmud, and so is the name of famous
city of BANNU in the Pashtun province of KPK (North West Frontier
Province) in Pakistan.
For reference check: http://www.realtorah.com/BirchotHatorah.htm
4. Bacher
The full name of the eldest son of Prophet Israel / Jacob X is written
as Asher Bacher Bannu in the Talmud, and so is the name of a town
in the CHARSADDA district in the Pashtun province of KPK in
Pakistan. It is name is Jaan Bachar Banda.
For reference check: http://www.realtorah.com/BirchotHatorah.htm
5. Levani
Prophet Eisa X is from the tribe of Levi. Levi is one of the sons of
Prophet Yaqb X. Among the Pashtun there is a famous tribe by the
100

Chapter 4 of Book I

name of Levani.
6. Afridis
This famous tribe of Pashtuns is named after the son of Israel called
Ephraim or Afraim.
7. Gadoon
Gad is one of the twelve sons of Prophet Israel X and Gadoon is also a
famous tribe among the Pashtuns.
8. RabBanu
Reuben is among the twelve sons of Prophet Israel X and similar to
this we have the famous Pashtun tribe by name of RabBanu.
9. Shinwari
Simeon is among the twelve sons of Prophet Israel X, and similar to
this we have the famous Pashtun tribe by name of Shinwari.
10. Zabul
Zebulun is among the twelve sons of Prophet Israel X, and similar to
this we have the Afghan province by the name of Zabul. The fact is that
during the time Mahmud Ghaznavi, the whole of Afghanistan was
called ZABUL as the famous poet FIRDAUSI called Mahmud as
SHAH-E-ZABUL i.e.: King of Zabul. (This is ignored by the wicked
historians of the West.)

101

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

11. Kohat
A city in the KPK, and also meaning assembly in Hebrew. It is the
name of the second son of Levi, and father of Amran (Gen. 46:11). He
came down to Egypt with Jacob, and lived to the age of one hundred
and thirty-three years (Ex. 6:18).
Note: The so called great Western Historians also skipped this
important fact in their writings just to conceal the truth.
12. Khyber
A fort of the Jews during the time of our Dear Prophet Muammad U,
and also a place on the Pakistan and Afghanistan border which has the
same meaning as that of Hebrew, i.e.: fort.
13. Peshawer
This city in KPK province of Pakistan has it is name and location
present in the Torah. A place called HABER or HAWER is mentioned
as the place of exile of the lost tribes. Now, Peshawar is comprised of
two parts, the word PESH means the pass (which can be the famous
Khyber Pass) and the Habor or Hawer means city, and thus
PESHAWAR means the city after the pass.
(Ref: Kings II, 17 and 18; Chronicles 1, 5. Also check Chronicles 5:26 at
http://bible.cc/1_chronicles/5-26.htm).
The God of Israel stirred up the spirit of Pul king of Assyria,
and the spirit of Tilgath Pilneser king of Assyria, and he
carried them away, even the Reubenites, and the Gadites, and
102

Chapter 4 of Book I

the half-tribe of Manasseh, and brought them to Halah, and


Habor, and Hara, and to the river of Gozan, to this day.
14. Gazni
Above mentioned reference from Chronicles (Kings II, 17 and 18;
Chronicles 1, 5) tells us that GOZAN is the place of exile for the Banu
Israel. In Afghanistan we have the famous city of GAZNI similar to this
name.
Also in Afghanistan the river Amu was also called River Gozan
according to Afghani tradition. Therefore historian Saadia Gaon called
the Amu Darya the place of exile of the lost tribes.
(Ref: Kings II, 17 and 18; Chronicles 1, 5. See also Chronicles 5:26 at
http://bible.cc/1_chronicles/5-26.htm)
15. Children of Joseph
Yusufzai a Pashtun tribe that claim to be the descendant of Joseph
(Yusuf), i.e.: Prophet of Banu Israel.
16. Karak
This is a city in Jordan near the border of Israel. Also Karak is
mentioned in the Chronicles as a city where Prophet Musa / Moses X
went. It is also it is a district and city in KPK province of Pakistan.
17. Lugar
A province in Afghanistan and also a name of present day Israeli family
name, not to forget the famous wrestler LEX LUGAR.
103

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

18. Kabul
Kabul is the capital of Afghanistan and it is a Hebrew word. Cab
means unpleasant and Bul means city, meaning unpleasant city.
The word Cabul also exists in the Bible.
19. Moses X
MUSA is the name of well-known Israeli Prophet Moses X. There are
more than 150 towns and cities in Afghanistan and Pakistan by the
same name. Also we have a tribe by the name of Musa Kheyl.
20. Harun
HARUN is the name of Israeli prophet HARUN or AARON X. In the
Pashtun areas of Afghanistan and Pakistan there are hundreds of towns
and cities by this name like Harun Baba (in Nanagar province),
HARUN KALA (in Ghazni province), and HARUN KHEYL (in Khost
province). Also there is a tribe by the name of HARUN KHYL.
21. David
DAVID is the name of well-known Israeli Prophet Darud or David X.
There are many towns and cities in Afghanistan and Pakistan by the
same name like DAUD (in Ghazni), DAUD KHYL (in ZABUL). Also
we have a tribe by the name of Daud Kheyl.
22. Isa (Jesus)
We also have hundreds of towns and cities by the name of Banu Israeli
Prophet Isa X. We shall find these names in the detailed list of Biblical
104

Chapter 4 of Book I

Israeli names in the next chapter of this book. InshahAllah.


23. Suleman (Solomon)
Takht-e-Suleiman/Koh-e-Suleiman is the name of a place in the
Pashtun area of Pakistan. It means the Throne of the Israeli King
Solomon This place is situated in the mountain ranges also named
after King Solomon (Hazrat Suleiman) as Koh-e-Suleiman.
In fact there are numerous names of cities/town in the Pashtun
areas after the name of Solomon. There is also a tribe by the name of
Suleiman Kheyly (The People of Solomon).
24. Kash / Kish
Kash /Kish is the name of numerous personalities mentioned in the
chapter of Chronicles in the Bible, all from the Banu-Israel, such as:

A Levite of the family of Merari (1 Chr. 23:21; 24:29),

A Benjamite of Jerusalem (1 Chr. 8:30; 9:36),

A Levite in the time of Hezekiah (2 Chr. 9:12)

In Afghanistan many places are named after Kash / Kish, like the
desert of Dasht-I-Kash, which lies in the north of the Helmund. The city
of KASH is mentioned in the map of Afghanistan 1912 in the Library of
Congress USA. The main mountain ranges of Afghanistan are also
called the HINDU-KUSH and KASH ROD in the Nimroz Province.
We already discussed that Kash is the forefather of the Pathans and
is the descendant of King Saul (Malik Talut) in the Quran.
The detailed list about these names is in the next part of this book.
105

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

25. Harat
Also a place called HARA is mentioned as the place of exile of the lost
tribes, and HARAT is a famous city in Afghanistan.
(Ref: Kings II, 17 and 18; Chronicles 1, 5. Check in Chronicles 5:26 at
http://bible.cc/1_chronicles/5-26.htm).
The God of Israel stirred up the spirit of Pul king of Assyria,
and the spirit of Tilgath Pilneser king of Assyria, and he
carried them away, even the Reubenites, and the Gadites, and
the half-tribe of Manasseh, and brought them to Halah, and
Habor, and Hara, and to the river of Gozan, to this day.
26. Madian
In the Bible, Madian was where the Israeli Prophet Hazrat Musa X
spent 40 years between the time that he left Egypt, after killing an
Egyptian who had been beating a Hebrew (Ref: Exodus 2:11-15). In the
Pathan area of SWAT valley in Pakistan there is also a city with the same
name as MADIAN.
27. Mushi
MUSHI is the grandson of Prophet Israel X and son of LEVI. Also
many other Israeli personalities have this name in the Chronicles.
Similar to this we have many cities in Afghanistan by the same name.
Some examples of these cities are MUSHI (in Pervan), MUSH KANI (in
Baghlan), MUSH KHYL (in Ghazni), and MUSH KHURDEH (in
Ghor).
106

Chapter 4 of Book I

28. Places of Exile


In the he Biblical Book Isaiah it is said:
Isaiah 11:11-12: and he will raise a banner to the gentiles
and will gather the Banushed of Israel, and the dispersed of
Judah will he bring together from the four corners of the earth

The places of exile of the lost tribes mentioned in the books also
point out the present day Afghanistan. The locations of the Exile. Other
locations mentioned as places of exile were the river Gozan, Habor,
Halah or Lahlah, and Hara.
(Ref: Kings II, 17 and 18; Chronicles 1, 5; Also see in Chronicles 5:26 at
http://bible.cc/1_chronicles/5-26.htm.
The God of Israel stirred up the spirit of Pul king of Assyria,
and the spirit of Tilgath Pilneser king of Assyria, and he
carried them away, even the Reubenites, and the Gadites, and
the half-tribe of Manasseh, and brought them to Halah, and
Habor, and Hara, and to the river of Gozan, to this day.
Where are these places of Exile?
According to Saadia Gaon, River Gozan is the river north of the
city of Balach in the north of Afghanistan. The river is known today as
the Amu Darya, and is the border between Afghanistan and Russia.
Afghani tradition states that the whole river was once known as the
Gozan River.
Habor is located in the pass between Afghanistan and Pakistan,
and is called Pesh-Habor in Afghani (Pesh means Pass) after the city of
107

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

the pass. The city is known today as Peshawar.


Hara is the city of Harat near the Persian border. It is the third
largest city in Afghanistan. The prophecy of Isaiah states that the exile
will bring the tribes to the land of Sinim:
Behold, these shall come from far, and, lo, these from the
north and from the west, and these from the land of Sinim.
(Isaiah 49:12)
This implies that the exile may have started.
Detailed List of Israeli Names among Pathans
The following are the names of different cities/town of the Pashtun
areas of Pakistan and Afghanistan which resemble the Israeli Biblical
names.
The list is very long, so just a few names are written below. Due to
time constrains we did not search all the locations. For example I have
not searched the Baluchistan province of Pakistan which has a large
number of Pathans living there.
Note: AFG=Afghanistan; PAK=Pakistan; FATA=Federally
Administrated Tribal Area (in Pakistan)
First of all I start with the names of four famous Banu Israeli
Prophets, i.e.: Prophet Musa X, and Prophet Isa/Jesus X, and then
we shall continue with the detailed list further.

108

Chapter 4 of Book I

Prophet Ishaq (Isaac) X (The father of all Banu Israel)


Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Isaac

Isak

KPK

PK

33.14

71.23

2588

Isak
Chauntra

KPK

PK

33.14

71.23

2588

Isak Khel

KPK

PK

32.5

70.96

1177

Isaka

Kandahar

AFG

31.52

67.47

6637

Isakai

FATA

PK

33.84

71.24

2821

Eshaq
Kheyl

Vardak

AFG

33.77

68.57

8080

Esqz

Zabol

AFG

31.85

66.39

4265

Esqz

Zabol

AFG

32.64

65.59

3648

Esqz
Kalay

Zabol

AFG

31.82

67.41

6197

We continue further with the names of four famous Banu Israeli


Prophets, i.e.: Prophet Yusuf (Joseph) X, Prophet Yaqub (Jacob) X,
Prophet Musa (Moses) X, and Prophet Isa X, and then we shall
continue with the detailed list further.

109

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Prophet Yusuf (Joseph) X


Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Joseph
(Yusuf)

Ysaf Khel Kili

FATA

Pakistan

33.98

71.07

3917

Ysuf Kalai

FATA

Pakistan

33.93

69.96

6299

Ysuf Khel

FATA

Pakistan

34.39

71.35

2434

Ysuf Khel

FATA

Pakistan

33.88

70.17

5239

Ysuf Khn

FATA

Pakistan

33.79

70.79

6151

Ysuf Kili

FATA

Pakistan

33.93

69.96

6299

Ysuf San

FATA

Pakistan

33.66

70.23

3884

Yusef

Nimruz

AFG

30.98

61.9

1597

Yusef

Nimruz

AFG

30.8

61.8

1564

Yusef

Parvan

AFG

30.8

61.81

1601

Yusef

Parvan

AFG

30.98

61.9

1584

Yusof

Nimruz

AFG

30.98

61.9

1597

Yusof

Nimruz

AFG

30.8

61.8

1564

Yusof Kheyl
Kalay

Ghazni

AFG

32.12

67.47

6476

Yusof Mirza'i

Faryab

AFG

36.84

65.14

1043

Yusof Mirzo'i

Faryab

AFG

36.84

65.14

1043

Yusofabad

Herat

AFG

34.32

62.61

3592

Yusuf

Paktika

AFG

32.72

69.03

7696

Yusuf Mirzai

Faryab

AFG

36.84

65.14

1043

Yusufabad

Herat

AFG

34.32

62.61

3592

Yusufkach

Nangarhar

AFG

34.35

70.01

3418

110

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Yusufkalacha

Kandahar

AFG

31.59

65.99

3507

Yusufkheyl'

Lowgar

AFG

33.89

68.96

6400

Yusufkheyl'

Vardak

AFG

33.9

68.65

7440

Yusufkheyl'

Paktika

AFG

33.05

68.65

7280

Yusufkheyl'

Kandahar

AFG

31.56

66.7

4481

Yusufkheyl'kalay

Ghazni

AFG

32.12

67.47

6476

Yusufkheyl

Lowgar

AFG

33.89

68.96

6400

Yusufkheyl

Vardak

AFG

33.9

68.65

7440

Yusufkheyl

Paktika

AFG

33.05

68.65

7280

Yusufkheyl

Kandahar

AFG

31.56

66.7

4481

Yusufkheylkalay

Ghazni

AFG

32.12

67.47

6476

Prophet Yaqoob (Jacob) X


Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev
. ft.

Jacob

Ykbi

FATA

Pakistan

33.75

70.27

412
7

Yakub

Velayat-e
Ghazni

Afghani
stan

33.38

68.4

684
7

Yakubbeg

Velayat-e
Herat

Afghani
stan

34.95

62.18

327
0

Yakubi

Velayat-e
Nangarhar

Afghani
stan

34.41

71.09

317
5

Yakubkalay

Velayat-e
Kandahar

Afghani
stan

31.36

66.19

395
3

111

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Yakubkheyl

Velayat-e
Vardak

Afghani
stan

34.4

68.69

7805

Yaqubi

Velayat-e
Nangarhar

Afghani
stan

34.35

71.05

3494

Prophet Musa (Moses) X


Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Moses

Musa Khel

KPK

PK

32.93

70.64

1092

Musa Mena

KPK

PK

34.49

71.87

1423

Musa da Khu

KPK

PK

32

70.9

564

Musazai

KPK

PK

33.97

71.61

1033

Musazai

KPK

PK

31.68

70.36

711

Muse Ka Khuh

KPK

PK

32

70.9

564

Musa

Ghazni

AFG

33.7

68.28

8612

Musa Baba

Konar

AFG

34.61

70.78

2103

Musa Bandeh

Konar

AFG

34.77

70.95

4281

Musa Darreh

Bamian

AFG

35.19

67.43

9504

Musa Kala

Helmand

AFG

32.44

64.75

3425

Musa Kala

Lowgar

AFG

33.97

69.03

6345

Musa Kala

Kandahar

AFG

31.5

65.44

3044

Musa Karez

Kandahar

AFG

31.79

65.35

4288

Musa Kheyl

Parvan

AFG

34.93

69.14

5186

Musa Kheyl

Vardak

AFG

33.99

68.63

7660

112

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Musa Kheyl

Lowgar

AFG

33.67

68.88

8143

Musa Kheyl

Paktia

AFG

33.69

69.62

8438

Musa Kheyl

Ghazni

AFG

33.12

68.36

6929

Musa Kheyl

Zabol

AFG

32.49

67.11

6925

Musa Kheyl

Parvan

AFG

33.54

69.6

8254

Musa Kheyl

Paktia

AFG

33.44

69.37

7703

Musa Kheyl

Ghazni

AFG

32.77

67.79

6446

Musa Kheyl
Kalay

Zabol

AFG

32.3

67.18

5643

Musa Leq

Faryab

AFG

36.04

64.66

2175

Musa Khan Kali

FATA

PK

33.83

70.11

4639

Musa Khan Kili

FATA

PK

33.83

70.11

4639

Musa Khan Kot

FATA

PK

32.72

69.86

7719

Musa Kili

FATA

PK

33.57

70.33

3356

Musa Kili

FATA

PK

33.93

70.94

4212

Musa Mela

FATA

PK

33.59

70.94

3730

Prophet Isa (Jesus) X


Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Isa
(Jesus)

Isa Khel

FATA

PK

33.66

70.78

4921

Isa Khel

FATA

PK

33.81

71.39

2919

Isa Khel

FATA

PK

33.72

70.86

6079

113

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Isagai

FATA

PK

34.23

71.23

1889

Isagai

FATA

PK

34.23

71.21

1916

Isakai

FATA

PK

33.84

71.24

2821

Isa Khan

Nimruz

AFG

31.24

62.18

1584

Isadaykalay

Kandahar

AFG

31.69

66.86

5780

Isaka

Kandahar

AFG

31.52

67.47

6637

Isakah

Kandahar

AFG

31.52

67.47

6637

Isakhan

Kondoz

AFG

36.77

68.79

1217

Isakhan

Kondoz

AFG

36.76

68.79

1190

Isakheyl

Paktia

AFG

33.64

69.3

7782

Isakheyl

Parvan

AFG

35.11

69.28

5019

Isakheyl

Khowst

AFG

33.16

69.76

5643

Isakheyl

Kabol

AFG

34.59

68.98

7155

Isakheyl

Kondoz

AFG

36.67

68.84

1256

Isakheyl

Kapisa

AFG

34.85

69.66

4327

Isakheyl-Garbi

Paktika

AFG

32.67

69.13

7250

Isakheyl-Sharki

Paktika

AFG

32.69

69.18

7135

Isakheyl

Paktia

AFG

33.64

69.3

7782

Isakheyl

Parvan

AFG

35.11

69.28

5019

Isakheyl

Kondoz

AFG

36.67

68.84

1256

Isakheyl

Kapisa

AFG

34.85

69.66

4327

Isakheyl-Garbi

Paktika

AFG

32.67

69.13

7250

Isakheyl-Sharki

Paktika

AFG

32.69

69.18

7135

114

Chapter 4 of Book I

The Detailed List of More Israeli Biblical Names among Pashtuns


Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Aaron

Harun Kheyl

Khowst

AFG

33.38

70.13

3280

Harun-iDowom

Jowzjan

AFG

37.01

66.09

928

Harunkhel

Khowst

AFG

33.38

70.13

3280

Harunkhel

Ghazni

AFG

33.15

68.09

6820

Harunkheyl

Ghazni

AFG

33.15

68.09

6820

Abdan 1

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.03

66.12

3316

Abdan 2

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.05

66.11

3074

Abdan 3

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.04

66.12

3274

Abdan-e
Shebaqli

Balkh

AFG

36.7

68.02

1036

Abdan-iSebaqli

Balkh

AFG

36.7

68.02

1036

Abdana

Ghazni

AFG

33.31

67.2

9389

Aband

Parvan

AFG

35.47

69.88

9524

Abanda

Farah

AFG

33.28

64.65

9337

Aba

Farah

AFG

32.68

62.26

2286

Aba

Farah

AFG

32.67

62.16

2276

Aba

Helmand

AFG

32.24

64.69

3316

Aba Khel

FATA

PK

33.2

70.38

2486

Aba Khel

FATA

PK

32.55

70.27

3356

Aba Khel

KPK

PK

32.57

70.83

987

Aba Khel

KPK

PK

32.25

70.38

872

Abaddon

Abana

Abba

115

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Abdiel

Abdul Khel

KPK

PK

32.4

70.42

918

Abdul Khel

KPK

PK

32.4

70.91

1620

Abdul Khel

KPK

PK

32.31

70.98

1354

Abdyan

Nangarhar

AFG

34.45

70.47

1811

Abdan 1

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.03

66.12

3316

Abdan 2

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.05

66.11

3074

Abdan 3

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.04

66.12

3274

Abdan-e
Shebaqli

Balkh

AFG

36.7

68.02

1036

Abdan-iSebaqli

Balkh

AFG

36.7

68.02

1036

Abel

Abol

Ghowr

AFG

34.23

65.36

8749

Abel-bethmaachah

Machikheyl

Helmand

AFG

32.34

65.07

3208

Machikheyl

Helmand

AFG

32.34

65.07

3208

Macho Shlah

Kandahar

AFG

31.48

66.89

4970

AFG

35.93

64.76

2743

Abdon

Abelmaim

MAIMANA

Abelmeholah

Mahalleh

Herat

AFG

34.39

62.44

3569

Mahalleh

Badghis

AFG

35.58

63.64

3087

Mahalleh

Kabol

AFG

34.83

69.09

5682

Abi

Abeh

Farah

AFG

32.68

62.26

2286

Abidan

Abdan 1

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.03

66.12

3316

Abdan 2

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.05

66.11

3074

116

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

Abiezer

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Abdan 3

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.04

66.12

3274

Abdan-e
Shebaqli

Balkh

AFG

36.7

68.02

1036

Abdan-iSebaqli

Balkh

AFG

36.7

68.02

1036

Abezar

KPK

PK

32.28

70.52

790

Abezari

KPK

PK

32.97

70.58

1197

Abezr

KPK

PK

32.97

70.62

1145

AFG

33.91

65.8

8727

Abijah

Abegak

Abishalo
m

Sholam

FATA

PK

33.9

70.61

7477

Sholam

FATA

PK

32.46

69.7

6551

Sholam

FATA

PK

32.36

69.48

5400

Ab Shureh

Badghis

AFG

35.19

63.02

2352

Ab Sora

Badghis

AFG

35.19

63.02

2352

Abital

Ab-i-Tal

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.48

67.22

6935

Achan

Achanu

Nurestan

AFG

35.1

70.7

6584

Achan

Bamian

AFG

34.29

66.93

8999

Achah Mily

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.11

66.98

2706

Acha bazar

Ghowr

AFG

34.4

66.23

1107
6

Achah Khel

Vardak

AFG

34.32

68.7

8353

Achah Mily

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.11

66.98

2706

Achahkheyl

Vardak

AFG

34.32

68.7

8353

AFG

34.17

66.51

9737

Abishur

Achahmazar

117

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Achah Khel

Vardak

AFG

34.32

68.7

8353

Achini Bla

KPK

PK

33.96

71.47

1318

Achini Pan

KPK

PK

33.97

71.47

1279

Achaz

Achah

Takhar

AFG

36.95

69.55

2834

Achim

Achn

Nangarhar

AFG

34.08

70.67

4048

Achor

Acher

KPK

PK

34.94

72.62

5977

Achar

KPK

PK

34.94

72.62

5977

Achar

KPK

PK

34.98

72.67

6558

Adadah

Adadkhel

Nangarhar

AFG

34.26

70.22

3779

Adah

Adah

Nangarhar

AFG

34.36

70.47

2086

Adah

Ghazni

AFG

33.57

68.76

7988

Adaliah

Adali Kasm

Helmand

AFG

30.33

63.18

1981

Adar

Adawar

Lowgar

AFG

33.78

68.85

7463

Addin

Adin

Ghazni

AFG

33.26

68.47

6761

Addon

Ado

Zabol

AFG

32.11

67.12

5957

Ado

Zabol

AFG

32.11

67.15

6013

AFG

32.32

65.59

5364

Ado Kalay
Ado

KPK

PK

34.93

71.93

4685

Aden Kheyl

Paktia

AFG

33.45

69.07

7076

Adin

Ghazni

AFG

33.26

68.47

6761

Adithaim

Adat

FATA

PK

34.97

71.56

4517

Adnah

Adina

KPK

PK

34.22

72.27

997

Agar

Aga

Ghazni

AFG

33.46

68.19

7877

Adin

118

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Agar

Vardak

AFG

34.12

68.74

7030

AFG

32.53

65.37

3507

Agar
Aghowr Sang

Parvan

AFG

35.02

69.28

4724

Agorsang

Parvan

AFG

35.02

69.28

4724

Ahab

Ahab Khn

KPK

PK

34.2

72.39

1138

Amad

Amad Chnah

Paktika

AFG

32.34

68.38

7814

Amad Kalay

Paktika

AFG

32.52

68.32

6742

Amadchina

Paktika

AFG

32.34

68.38

7814

Amad Shah
Kali

FATA

PK

33.93

70.13

6292

Aman
Khaneh

Velayat-e
Paktika

AFG

32.75

68.99

8067

Aman Kheyl

Velayat-e
Paktika

AFG

32.55

68.88

6066

Aman Kowt

Velayat-e
Paktika

AFG

32.91

69.26

6837

Aman Kut

Velayat-e
Konar

AFG

34.96

71.27

3510

Amnzai

KPK

PK

34.35

72.38

2286

Amaziah

Amanzi

Velayat-e
Kandahar

AFG

30.21

66.05

3234

Baalah

Ab-Bala

Bamian

AFG

34.73

67.74

1016
0

Barak

Ab-i-Barik

Herat

AFG

34.74

62.42

4685

Ab-e Barik

Herat

AFG

34.91

62.72

3966

Ab-e Barik

Herat

AFG

34.74

62.42

4685

Agur

Aman

119

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Ab-e Barik

Badghis

AFG

34.65

63.78

7391

Ab-e Barik

Baghlan

AFG

35.86

69.75

8451

Ab-e Barik

Baghlan

AFG

35.87

69.73

7611

Ab-e Barik-e
Ghalmani

Badghis

AFG

34.9

62.7

3976

Ab-e Barik-e
Qowdi

Herat

AFG

34.91

62.72

3966

Bedad

Bdd Kalay

Konar

AFG

35.02

71.4

4025

Beera

Berai Kot

FATA

PK

32.96

70.08

2791

Bera mena

FATA

PK

34.32

71.46

2004

Bela

Velayat-e
Kandahar

AFG

31.58

67.12

5672

Bela

Velayat-e
Konar

AFG

34.76

71.08

2454

Bela

Velayat-e
Nangarhar

AFG

34.39

70.59

1666

Bela

Velayat-e
Nangarhar

AFG

34.35

70.74

1519

Bela

Velayat-e
Nangarhar

AFG

34.27

70.88

1414

Bela

Velayat-e
Laghman

AFG

34.62

70.23

2263

Bela Kheyl

Velayat-e
Ghazni

AFG

33.3

68.48

6814

Berea

Berai Kot

KPK

PK

32.96

70.08

2791

Besai

Besai

KPK

PK

33.07

69.7

6807

Belah

120

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Bethany

Betani
Tangay

Nangarhar

AFG

34.42

69.99

5889

Betanigangay

Nangarhar

AFG

34.42

69.99

5889

Bezai

Ab Bazan

Takhar

AFG

36.94

69.94

2795

Bezek

Bezkhel

Kabol

AFG

34.74

69.86

5921

Bezer

Bizarai

FATA

PK

32.97

69.56

5987

Bilgah

Bilgh

KPK

PK

34.52

72.67

4767

Bilgav

Ghazni

AFG

34.09

67.68

11637

BilagiKhuseyni

Vardak

AFG

34.38

68.3

9501

Binea

Binai Garhi

FATA

PK

33.69

71.3

3320

Calvary

Calvary Rakh

KPK

PK

34.2

71.98

967

Canaan

Kanan

Ghowr

AFG

34.4

64.77

8005

Darah

Dara

FATA

PK

34.71

71.22

3950

David

Daud Shah

FATA

PK

34.21

71.19

2093

Daud Shai

FATA

PK

32.47

69.87

5770

Daud Shah

KPK

PK

33.01

70.55

1272

Daudkalay

Paktika

AFG

32.78

68.55

6938

Daudkheyl

Zabol

AFG

32.6

67.59

6243

Daudkheyl

Zabol

AFG

32.6

67.59

6243

Daudzai

Helmand

AFG

32.43

64.48

4068

Daudzay

Zabol

AFG

32.64

66.74

7365

Dishan

Deshana

Takhar

AFG

36.19

70.08

6870

Dishon

Deshana

Takhar

AFG

36.19

70.08

6870

121

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Dodai

Doda

FATA

PK

34.66

71.33

3507

Dor

Dor Calay

Paktika

AFG

32.93

68.96

8769

Dor Kheyl

Kandahar

AFG

31.65

67.29

6089

Dor Kheyl

Helmand

AFG

30.93

64.15

2257

Dor Khkh

Badakhsh
an

AFG

38.25

70.79

7896

Dor Kowtkey

Khowst

AFG

33.28

69.82

4206

Dor Kowtki

Khowst

AFG

33.27

69.81

4232

Dura

Dora

Kandahar

AFG

31.29

67.11

6837

Ebed

Ebad Kala

Ghazni

AFG

33.43

68.61

6938

EbedI

Ghazni

AFG

33.14

67.28

10482

Enam

Enam

Lowgar

AFG

34.1

68.9

6712

Ephraim

Afridi TRIBE

Eshek

Eshaq Kheyl

Vardak

AFG

33.77

68.57

8080

Eshaqzay

Zabol

AFG

31.85

66.39

4265

Etam

Etam Khn

KPK

PK

32.87

70.44

1358

Ezer

Izir

Ghowr

AFG

34.79

65.35

8044

Ezra

Ezrya

Parvan

AFG

35.48

69.75

9770

Ezryah

Parvan

AFG

35.48

69.75

9770

Ezri

Izria

Parvan

AFG

35.48

69.75

9770

Gaal

Gal

KPK

PK

33.74

70.75

6830

Gal

KPK

PK

35.03

71.77

4550

Gal

KPK

PK

34.96

72.1

5134

Gal

KPK

PK

34.96

72.09

4921

122

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Gaash

Gash-e Sangi

Ghowr

AFG

34.57

64.88

8185

Gashbandi

Badghis

AFG

34.82

63.92

5803

Gaba

Sar-e Pol

AFG

35.31

66.01

9051

Gabah

Sar-e Pol

AFG

35.31

66.01

9051

Gad

Gd

Baghlan

AFG

36.22

68.74

1755

Gaddi

Gd

Baghlan

AFG

36.22

68.74

1755

Gd

Baghlan

AFG

36.24

68.76

1774

Gd

Baghlan

AFG

36.24

68.77

1781

Gd

Kondoz

AFG

36.77

68.94

1295

Gareb

Garib

Kandahar

AFG

31.42

67.21

6420

Garmites

Ab-i-Garmak

Badghis

AFG

35.74

63.83

2286

Ab-i-Garmak

Badghis

AFG

35.01

63.14

3054

Gat

Ghazni

AFG

32.22

68.05

7532

Gat

Kandahar

AFG

31.51

67.46

6515

Gat

Zabol

AFG

31.82

67.64

6794

Gat Kala

Kabol

AFG

34.65

69.76

3602

Gaza

Kabol

AFG

34.64

69.01

6804

Gazah

Herat

AFG

34.38

61.46

2542

Gaza

Herat

AFG

34.38

61.46

2542

Gaza

Kabol

AFG

34.64

69

6975

Gazai Khurd

Farah

AFG

32.1

62.89

2365

Gaza`i Kalan

Farah

AFG

32.11

62.9

2375

Gaza`i
Khvord

Farah

AFG

32.1

62.89

2365

Gabbai

Gath

Gaza

123

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Geber

Gebar

Vardak

AFG

34.5

68.23

9855

Geder

Gidar Shhi

FATA

PK

34.82

71.58

2828

Gidar

KPK

PK

34.14

71.56

967

Gidar

KPK

PK

32.92

70.59

1108

Gera

Geri

KPK

PK

34.24

73.47

2250

Gerar

Girrai

KPK

PK

34.53

72.26

3211

Geshur

Gishar

KPK

PK

34.8

72.54

7257

Gishar Banda

KPK

PK

34.77

72.73

5675

Giah

Giah

KPK

PK

34.11

73.34

6332

Gibbar

Gabar

KPK

PK

35.06

72.92

5190

Gabartota

KPK

PK

34.71

73.47

8549

Gidn

KPK

PK

35.34

72.6

6804

Godown

KPK

PK

34.3

71.92

1125

Gob

Gobhai

KPK

PK

34.45

72.97

3280

Golan

Golan Mena

Paktika

AFG

32.08

69.08

4648

Goshen

Gusheh

Ghazni

AFG

33.78

68.07

11141

Gusheh

Ghazni

AFG

33.73

67.72

10373

Gusheh

Ghazni

AFG

33.33

67.55

9281

Gozan

Gozan

Konar

AFG

34.97

71.38

6072

Gudgodah

Gud

KPK

PK

34.44

72.85

4019

Gud

KPK

PK

34.45

72.85

4219

Gud Gair

KPK

PK

34.56

72.87

5905

AFG

34.18

66.21

7906

Gideon

Guni

Gani

124

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Ganigay

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

AFG

32.42

65.88

5331

Ganikach

Konar

AFG

35.02

71.26

3415

Gur Dur

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.65

70.58

8182

Gur

Nangarhar

AFG

34.08

70.7

4114

Gur Bolaq

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.03

66.44

3487

Gur Bulaq

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.03

66.44

3487

Gur Bulaq 2

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.04

66.44

3628

Gur Dur

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.65

70.58

8182

Gur Kushan

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.19

70.52

4232

Gur Safid

Herat

AFG

33.97

62.1

4393

Gur-e Mar

Balkh

AFG

36.73

67.27

1318

Gur-e Mar

Balkh

AFG

36.75

67.34

1519

Hal

KPK

PK

34.24

72.55

1732

Hal

KPK

PK

34.18

73

2775

Hal

KPK

PK

34.29

72.95

2801

Hal

KPK

PK

34.3

72.98

2575

Hal

KPK

PK

34.18

73.06

4560

Hal

KPK

PK

34.18

73.13

4681

Halak

Halaka

Sar-e Pol

AFG

35.91

67.01

5616

Haman

Hamanag

Kapisa

AFG

34.96

69.66

6099

Hannah

Hanna Mari

KPK

PK

34

71.56

1079

Gur

Gur-baal

Halah

125

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Hanoch

Hanut

Herat

AFG

33.66

63.1

6968

Hanun

Hanut

Herat

AFG

33.66

63.1

6968

Hara

Herak

Faryab

AFG

35.73

63.94

2700

Herat

Herat

AFG

34.35

62.2

3077

Harban

KPK

PK

35.53

73.62

6230

Harban

KPK

PK

34.56

73.37

5275

Harbola

FATA

PK

31.44

70.06

4327

Harim

Haram

KPK

PK

35.7

72.04

10580

Hashem

Hashem
Kalay

Zabol

AFG

32.58

66.73

6466

Hashem
Kheyl

Nangarhar

AFG

34.24

70

4973

Hashem Kot

Khowst

AFG

33.2

69.78

4803

Hashemabad

Balkh

AFG

36.97

66.87

984

Hasham Kor

FATA

PK

34.47

71.33

2237

Hazbuz

Helmand

AFG

33.12

65

5626

Hazbuz

Zabol

AFG

32.54

66.56

6286

Hazarhatticon

Hazr
Jmech

Takhar

AFG

36.9

69.5

3254

Hazarmav
eth

Hazr Qgh

Baghlan

AFG

36.25

68.97

3438

Hazarshual

Hazr Som

Samangan

AFG

35.72

67.81

6541

Hazarsusah

Hazr
Somoch

Takhar

AFG

37.19

69.91

5780

Harbonah

Hazaraddar

126

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Hazo

Hazro

Paktia

AFG

34.17

69.65

7447

Hazor

Hazro

Paktia

AFG

34.17

69.65

7447

Helam

Halem Shar

Ghazni

AFG

33.73

68.3

8228

Halimkhel

Nangarhar

AFG

34.3

69.79

5390

Halaka

Sar-e Pol

AFG

35.91

67.01

5616

Hellkhl

Ghazni

AFG

33.02

67.79

7198

Halem Shar

Ghazni

AFG

33.73

68.3

8228

Halimkhel

Nangarhar

AFG

34.3

69.79

5390

Heli

Hel

KPK

PK

34.24

72.55

1732

Helon

Hel

KPK

PK

34.24

72.55

1732

Hermas

Haramsah

AFG

32.61

65.8

4228

Hezer

Hezar Bagh 2

Takhar

AFG

37.02

69.35

1827

Hezar
Bandeh

Nangarhar

AFG

34.63

70.44

4179

AFG

33.48

65.7

4767

Helek

Helem

Hezar
Derakht

Hezrai

Hezar
Jumech

Takhar

AFG

36.9

69.5

3254

Hezar Qagh

Baghlan

AFG

36.25

68.97

3438

Hezar Sib

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.33

70.44

6778

Hezar
Somuch

Takhar

AFG

37.19

69.91

5780

Hezreh-e
Khabuk 2

Badakhsh
an

AFG

36.86

70.45

6860

127

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev.
ft.

Hezreh-ye
DarrehyeBgh

Badakhsh
an

AFG

36.89

70.41

6164

Hezreh-ye
Dvneh

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.07

70.3

5150

Hezreh-ye
Gv

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.05

70.29

5200

Hezreh-ye
Larkaw

Baghlan

AFG

35.93

68.59

2171

Hezrehtiksar

Balkh

AFG

37.17

67.32

964

Hezron

Hazro

Paktia

AFG

34.17

69.65

7447

Hiel

Hil

KPK

PK

34.17

72.97

2664

Hilkot

KPK

PK

34.62

73.17

5469

Hill

KPK

PK

34.72

73.15

6712

Hal

KPK

PK

34.24

72.55

1732

Hal

KPK

PK

34.18

73

2775

Hal

KPK

PK

34.29

72.95

2801

Hal

KPK

PK

34.3

72.98

2575

Hal

KPK

PK

34.18

73.06

4560

Hal

KPK

PK

34.18

73.13

4681

Hillel

Hellkhl

Ghazni

AFG

33.02

67.79

7198

Hothir

Hotar

KPK

PK

34.28

72.96

2408

Hotar

KPK

PK

34.38

72.86

1866

Hotar

KPK

PK

34.34

72.85

1259

128

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Hotar

KPK

PK

34.72

73.15

6712

Hotar Mundi

KPK

PK

34.3

72.98

2549

Ibleam

Ibalam

Laghman

AFG

34.89

70.32

4740

Ichabod

Ich Kili

KPK

PK

35.14

71.88

4340

Ichharian

KPK

PK

34.36

73.07

3090

Ichhrian

KPK

PK

34.5

73.25

3277

Idalah

Idal Khel

FATA

PK

32.97

69.87

3546

Iddo

Idozi

Kandahar

AFG

30.06

66.06

3270

Ijon

Ijan

Farah

AFG

32.98

64.12

8599

Immer

Amir Khan

Nimruz

AFG

31.14

62.09

1568

Amir Kheyl

Parvan

AFG

35.24

69.16

7693

Amir
Mahbatah

Helmand

AFG

32.24

63.73

3238

Amir Mene

Kandahar

AFG

31.24

66.26

4304

Imni Kheyl

Paktika

AFG

33.16

68.8

7007

Imnikheyl

Paktia

AFG

33.48

69.02

7034

Imrah

Imratkheyl

Vardak

AFG

34.17

68.51

7742

Imri

Imratkheyl

Vardak

AFG

34.17

68.51

7742

Jaakan

Jakan

Kandahar

AFG

31.74

66.13

4048

Jakan

Zabol

AFG

31.76

66.28

4074

Jakan

Herat

AFG

34.34

62.23

3077

Jala

Ghazni

AFG

33.09

67.36

7873

Jala Banda

KPK

PK

33.15

70.96

1666

Jalam

Zabol

AFG

32.62

67.66

6482

Imnah

Jaala

Jaalam

129

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Jaanai

Janai

FATA

PK

32.42

69.47

6089

Jana

KPK

PK

35.05

72.35

5488

Jaasau

Jasaul

KPK

PK

34.69

73.06

3940

Jaasiel

Jasaul

KPK

PK

34.69

73.06

3940

AFG

32.78

66.66

9691

Jasowl
Jabal

Jabalok
Bnda

KPK

PK

35.13

71.91

4327

Jabin

Jabn Kt

Paktika

AFG

32.59

69.32

7582

Jachan

Jachha

KPK

PK

34.68

73.28

6492

Jacob
(Yaqub)

Yaqubi

Nangarhar

AFG

34.4

71.05

3494

Yaqubi

Nangarhar

AFG

34.4

71.05

3494

Yaqub Khan
Koruna

KPK

PK

34.2

71.85

964

Yaqubi

KPK

PK

34.2

72.27

971

Yaqubi
Banda

KPK

Pakistan

32.9

70.99

1384

Yaqb

KPK

Pakistan

32.9

70.99

1384

Jahaleel

Jall Bnda

KPK

PK

34.37

72.2

1233

Jahaz

Jahazi

Helmand

AFG

32.32

64.57

3651

Jakan

Jakan

Kandahar

AFG

31.74

66.13

4048

Jakan

Zabol

AFG

31.76

66.28

4074

Jakan

Herat

AFG

34.34

62.23

3077

Jakan-e
`Olya

Herat

AFG

34.35

62.23

3087

130

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Jalon

Jalo

FATA

PK

33.75

70.82

6469

Jehovahshalom

Sholam

FATA

PK

33.9

70.61

7477

Sholam

FATA

PK

32.46

69.7

6551

Sholam

FATA

PK

32.36

69.48

5400

Kadmiel

Kadamai

FATA

PK

33.9

70.55

8297

Kallai

Kalai

KPK

PK

34.81

72.94

1781

Kalai

KPK

PK

35.09

72.71

9809

Kalai Kandao

KPK

PK

33.88

72.04

2700

Kalai-Musai

Kabol

AFG

34.48

69.15

5977

Kalai-Naw

Badghis

AFG

34.99

63.13

3175

Kanah

Kanah

KPK

PK

34.17

73.46

5659

Kareah

Kare-i-Buza

Herat

AFG

35.22

61.34

2585

Karkor

Karakar

KPK

PK

34.62

72.28

4094

Kartah

Karta

Herat

AFG

34.33

62.22

3083

Kartah-ye
Mamurin

Kabol

AFG

34.53

69.11

5997

Kartah-ye
Pawan

Kabol

AFG

34.54

69.15

5948

Karta-iCahar

Kabol

AFG

34.51

69.14

5964

Kedar

Kadarkot

Paktia

AFG

33.39

69.35

7782

Kedemah

Kedam

KPK

PK

35.25

72.58

5065

Kenan

Kenn

Ghowr

AFG

33.7

63.85

7050

Kish

Ksh

Zabol

AFG

32.36

67.45

6902

131

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Ksh
Ksh Chnah

Zabol

Kesh
Khenjak

Kishi

Kishon

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

AFG

32.61

65.96

4678

AFG

32.46

66.92

5659

AFG

32.51

65.63

4629

Kesh Marun

Herat

AFG

34.13

61.47

3385

Kesh-ano
Kalcha

Kandahar

AFG

31.58

65.69

3248

Kishanabad

Baghlan

AFG

35.62

69.21

5255

Kishani

Ghazni

AFG

32.46

67.61

7506

Kishani

Kandahar

AFG

32.11

66.14

4803

Kishani
Kalay

Zabol

AFG

31.96

66.78

5124

KishanuKalacha

Kandahar

AFG

31.58

65.69

3248

Kshkh

Parvan

AFG

35.04

69

5764

Kishimkala

Lowgar

AFG

34.23

69.13

5980

Kishindi Bla

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.12

67.01

3018

Kishindi Pain

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.15

66.92

2496

Kishindih
Bala

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.12

67.01

3018

Kishindih
Pyn

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.15

66.92

2496

Kishkaraka

Helmand

AFG

32.98

64.91

4468

Kishn
Darreh

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.29

70.31

5875

132

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Gur Kushan

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.19

70.52

4232

Kshn

Takhar

AFG

37.27

69.84

5022

Koht

KPK

PK

33.59

71.44

1607

Koht

KPK

PK

33.71

72

797

Kora

Ghowr

AFG

33.54

63.97

7631

Kora

Kapisa

AFG

34.93

69.62

4767

Ladha

FATA

PK

32.57

69.83

5511

Ladha

KPK

PK

33.97

72.8

1466

Laadan

Laddan

KPK

PK

34.49

73.15

3307

Lachish

Lachi Kheyl

Lowgar

AFG

33.94

68.81

6725

Lachi Kheyl

Paktia

AFG

33.42

69.36

7621

Lachikhel

Kabol

AFG

34.56

68.96

6938

Lachi

KPK

PK

33.38

71.33

1479

Lachi

FATA

PK

34.44

71.39

2604

Lahairoi

Lahoray

Khowst

AFG

33.14

69.55

7267

Lahmam

Lahman

KPK

PK

34.8

73.66

11637

Lasea

Lase Jowayn

Farah

AFG

31.72

61.62

1669

Lazarus
(friend of
Jesus X
in Betany)

Laz

AFG

33.81

66.21

7349

Kohath

Korah

Laadah

Lekah

Lazari

Farah

AFG

33.11

64.04

6427

Lekah
Sheway

Kandahar

AFG

31.48

67.46

6643

133

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Levi

Lawi also
Levi tribe

KPK

PK

35.6

71.82

4694

Lud

Ludi Khel

KPK

PK

33.59

71.17

2486

Luz

Loz-Dakka

Nangarhar

AFG

34.21

71.06

1348

Maachah

Machikheyl

Helmand

AFG

32.34

65.07

3208

MachakuliBala

Vardak

AFG

34.43

68.14

10977

MachakuliPain

Vardak

AFG

34.45

68.15

10613

Machai

KPK

PK

34.3

72.29

1138

Machai

KPK

PK

34.67

72.68

4324

Machai
Dhanda

KPK

PK

34.58

72.91

7995

Machi Khel

FATA

PK

33.03

70.25

2345

Madi Khel

FATA

PK

33.2

70.53

1998

Madial

KPK

PK

35.03

72.42

5042

Maai

Mai-Darrahi-Curmi

Badghis

AFG

35.62

63.47

2129

Maaleakrabbim

Mali Kalay

Kandahar

AFG

31.68

67.13

6220

Mali Khel

Lowgar

AFG

34.11

69.15

6335

Mali Kheyl

Vardak

AFG

33.92

68.67

7372

Math

KPK

PK

34.84

71.79

3556

Mat

KPK

PK

31.52

70.46

705

Mat

KPK

PK

34.75

73.51

6886

Maadiah

Maath

134

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Mat Khn

KPK

PK

34.2

72.39

1138

Mate

Ghazni

AFG

32.78

67.73

6466

Machi

Machikheyl

Helmand

AFG

32.34

65.07

3208

Machir

Machar Beh

KPK

PK

34.51

71.91

1453

Madon

Madan

KPK

PK

34.32

73.12

3074

Mahalah

Mahala-iBpa

Herat

AFG

34.21

62.61

3602

Mahalleh

Herat

AFG

34.39

62.44

3569

Mahalleh

Badghis

AFG

35.58

63.64

3087

Mahalleh

Kabol

AFG

34.83

69.09

5682

Mahali

Mahlau

FATA

PK

31.45

70.09

3083

Mahanem

Mahan Ban
Banda

KPK

PK

35.07

71.92

6650

Mahandri

KPK

PK

34.68

73.57

5649

Mahli

KPK

PK

34.64

73.65

11030

Mahli

KPK

PK

34.96

73.88

10944

Mahli

KPK

PK

34.89

73.92

11108

Mahli

KPK

PK

34.88

73.77

12158

Mahli

KPK

PK

34.92

73.58

11414

Mahlu

KPK

PK

34.48

73.14

2952

Mamun

FATA

PK

34.83

71.36

3730

Mamun

KPK

PK

33.4

70.63

2614

Mamun

KPK

PK

34.16

71.58

944

Mahlah

Mammon

135

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Mamre

Mamrez
Pathan

KPK

PK

32.11

70.42

761

Manaen

Manan
Khona

Zabol

AFG

32.95

67.3

7047

Maon

Maon

KPK

PK

34.69

73.56

5013

Mara

Mara

Zabol

AFG

32.52

66.71

5836

Mara

Zabol

AFG

32.53

66.74

6181

Mara Sekh

Kondoz

AFG

37.18

68.79

1089

Mara

KPK

PK

33.01

70.53

1259

Maranatha

Maran Shah

FATA

PK

33.59

70.72

5055

Mareshah

Mari
Shahwali

KPK

PK

34.38

73.16

2831

Mark

Markhu

AFG

33.89

66.17

7604

Markuh

Nangarhar

AFG

34.34

70.61

2175

Markul

Ghazni

AFG

33.67

68.33

8129

Marowat

Paktia

AFG

34.17

69.72

7411

Marwat

KPK

PK

32.83

70.74

905

Marwat Kili

KPK

PK

33

70.83

1049

Marsenji

Kandahar

AFG

31.22

66.55

4570

Marsingay

Nangarhar

AFG

34.25

70.98

1384

Martha

Marta Dg

FATA

PK

34.24

71.24

1801

Martha

Marta Dg

FATA

PK

34.24

71.24

1801

Mash

Mash

AFG

34.3

66.57

9839

Mashal

Mashal

AFG

33.18

67.46

8277

Maroth

Marsena

Ghazni

136

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Masrekah

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Masrowk

AFG

34

66.39

8884

Masruk

AFG

34

66.39

8884

Masau

Farah

AFG

32.5

62.03

2178

Masaw

Farah

AFG

32.49

62.03

2148

Masau

Farah

AFG

32.5

62.03

2178

Masaw

Farah

AFG

32.49

62.03

2148

Matin

FATA

PK

34.39

71.35

2536

Matin

FATA

PK

34.58

71.5

2962

Matin

FATA

PK

34.21

71.46

1125

Matthan

Matanni

KPK

PK

33.8

71.57

1532

Matthanias

Matanni

KPK

PK

33.8

71.57

1532

Matthal

Matah

Parvan

AFG

35.45

69.75

9458

Matah

Zabol

AFG

31.84

67.58

6505

Matu

Faryab

AFG

35.75

64.09

3284

Matu

Faryab

AFG

35.75

64.11

3326

Matu

Faryab

AFG

Maidan Kili

KPK

PK

34.7

73.02

4717

Maidankhw
ar

KPK

PK

35.07

71.77

5501

Maidn

KPK

PK

34.97

71.74

4609

Maidn

KPK

PK

32.85

71.13

3612

Maidn

KPK

PK

32.87

71.12

2926

Maidn

KPK

PK

32.24

70.51

813

Maidn

KPK

PK

34.77

73.14

9914

Massa

Massah

Mattan

Matthew

Medan

137

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Maidn

KPK

PK

34.89

73.94

11742

Maidn

KPK

PK

34.59

73.45

7601

Maidn

KPK

PK

34.66

73.38

7401

Maidn

KPK

PK

34.79

73.51

7486

Maidn

KPK

PK

35.02

71.82

6000

Maidn

KPK

PK

35.03

71.73

6833

Maidn

KPK

PK

35.73

72.43

11361

Maidn
Bnda

KPK

PK

35.22

72.84

8963

Maidn
Bndai

KPK

PK

34.98

71.81

3592

Maidan

Vardak

AFG

34.45

68.79

7286

Maidan

Balkh

AFG

36.9

66.92

1030

Maidan

Ghowr

AFG

33.41

65.08

7185

Maidan
Chelqolach

Jowzjan

AFG

36.71

65.46

1400

Maidan
Qala

Khowst

AFG

33.64

70.12

4389

Maidan
Shahr

Parvan

AFG

34.4

68.87

7394

Mehida

Mehd
Kheyl

Khowst

AFG

33.37

70.01

3546

Mehir

Mehr`ali

Ghowr

AFG

34.56

66.59

10131

Mehuman

Mehman
Kalay

Paktika

AFG

32.3

68.39

7608

Mehmn

Ghazni

AFG

33.37

68.44

6850

138

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Mejarkon

Majar

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.32

66.16

2706

Majar

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.01

66.22

3156

Majar

Kondoz

AFG

37.13

68.87

1463

Melchi

Malchai
Charai

KPK

PK

35.21

72.65

9760

Mene

Mina Khel
Mela

FATA

PK

32.62

69.98

5895

Mina Kot

FATA

PK

32.96

70.32

2043

Mina Bnda

KPK

PK

35.01

72.8

8733

Mina
Khanda

KPK

PK

32.33

71.16

1220

Mina Khel

KPK

PK

32.89

70.98

1282

Mina Khel
Banda

KPK

PK

32.85

71.05

1528

Mehrabikhe
yl

Parvan

AFG

34.88

68.84

9432

Mehrb

Nimruz

AFG

31.01

61.89

1568

Mehrb
Khn Kalay

Khowst

AFG

33.27

69.95

4097

Mushi

Parvan

AFG

34.76

68.7

8067

Mush
Banda

KPK

PK

32.82

70.96

1135

Mashi

Balkh

AFG

36.7

66.95

1184

Mashi

Kandahar

AFG

31.07

66.33

3936

Mashi

Nimruz

AFG

30.28

62.05

1712

Mashikalay

Khowst

AFG

33.17

70.02

4931

Merab

Mushi

139

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Mashikheyl

Vardak

AFG

34.35

68.91

7276

Mashikheyl

Vardak

AFG

34.35

68.91

7276

Nam Derai

KPK

PK

34.8

72.38

3011

Nam Shh

KPK

PK

32.91

70.51

1164

Naamah

Nama Dn

KPK

PK

32.92

70.51

1167

Naarah

Nara

KPK

PK

34.54

73.35

3205

Nara
Kharkai

FATA

PK

34.88

71.41

4215

Nara Kili

FATA

PK

33.83

70.03

4849

Naashon

Nasu Kalay

Kandahar

AFG

31.64

65.03

3120

Nachor

Necha

Helmand

AFG

32.41

65.13

3448

Nagge

Nagay

Kandahar

AFG

31.01

66.57

5295

Nahallal

Nahara

FATA

PK

31.47

70.11

2775

Naharai

Nahr

Parvan

AFG

35.12

69.29

5039

Nahara

FATA

PK

31.47

70.11

2775

Nahr

Parvan

AFG

35.12

69.29

5039

Nahr-e
Kariz

Helmand

AFG

32.05

65.01

3540

Nahr-e
Khoshk

Ghowr

AFG

33.24

64.43

8585

Nahr-e
Sarj

Helmand

AFG

31.82

64.56

2683

Nahara

FATA

PK

31.47

70.11

2775

Nain Suk
Bnda

KPK

PK

34.98

72.72

6213

Naam

Nahor

Nain

140

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Nason

Nasow
Kheyl

Ghazni

AFG

33.34

68.46

6830

Nasokheyl

Ghazni

AFG

33.18

68.1

6814

Nasow
Kheyl

Paktika

AFG

32.66

68.36

6702

Nathan

Nathi
Bnda

KPK

PK

35.24

72.93

9750

Naum

Nauma

Samangan

AFG

36.01

67.17

4540

Naumazar

Ghowr

AFG

33.58

64.99

8690

AFG

34.03

65.62

8274

Naumurcha
Adeh
Nazrow

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.38

66.19

2398

Nazar Kheyl

Lowgar

AFG

34.26

69.14

6069

Nazar Kheyl

Nangarhar

AFG

34.4

71.02

3628

Necha Sufla

Helmand

AFG

32.42

65.05

3500

Necha Ulya

Helmand

AFG

32.42

65.05

3464

Nemuel

Nemleh

Nangarhar

AFG

34.3

70.1

3664

Ner

Ner

KPK

PK

34.87

73.13

6017

Neri

Ner

KPK

PK

34.87

73.13

6017

Nisan

Nishan Kili

KPK

PK

34.28

71.74

1082

Umar \

Umar \
Bek

Badghis

AFG

34.8

63.46

4461

Umar \
Khel

Baghlan

AFG

36.09

68.63

1893

Umar \
Khel

Kondoz

AFG

37.16

68.89

1128

Nazarite

Necho

141

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

On

Ona

KPK

PK

35.03

72.3

5682

Ophel

Opal

KPK

PK

34.86

72.81

4606

Paarai

Parai

KPK

PK

35.11

72.31

7040

Parai

KPK

PK

35.38

72.93

7608

Paraikas

KPK

PK

34.95

71.8

3267

Parai Banda

FATA

PK

34.44

71.57

3162

Pagiel

Pagol

Badakhsh
an

AFG

36.99

72.48

10665

Pai

Pai Kol

Vardak

AFG

34.42

67.69

9222

Pai Tawa

Samangan

AFG

36.06

67.27

4967

Pai Tawa

Samangan

AFG

36.06

67.3

5419

Pai Tawa

Samangan

AFG

36.06

67.29

5318

Pai Tawa 4

Samangan

AFG

36.08

67.27

4875

Pai Tawa 5

Samangan

AFG

36.09

67.28

4622

Pai Twa 1

Samangan

AFG

36.06

67.3

5419

Pai Twa 2

Samangan

AFG

36.07

67.27

5068

Pai Twa 3

Samangan

AFG

36.06

67.27

4967

Pai Khel

FATA

PK

32.97

69.84

3914

Pai
Makhmad
Kili

FATA

PK

33.1

69.99

3959

Palal

Palal

Ghowr

AFG

34.53

64.85

8392

Pallu

Paludar

KPK

PK

34.85

73.57

7880

Palukheylk
alay

Zabol

AFG

31.93

66.98

5925

142

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Palti

Palta

Badghis

AFG

35.16

64.51

6354

Paltu

Ghowr

AFG

34.25

64.27

8891

Paltui

Paktika

AFG

33.27

68.79

6883

Parah

Para

Takhar

AFG

36.19

70.09

7155

Para Kala
(village of
Para)

Vardak

AFG

34.12

68.23

8517

Paran

Parandeh
(village of
Paran)

Parvan

AFG

35.42

69.4

13316

Parnach

Parna Kham

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.17

70.63

5439

Parshandat
ha

Parsha

FATA

PK

33.12

70.18

3369

Parshan
Tang

FATA

PK

33.62

70.91

3930

Pasach

Pashat

FATA

PK

34.87

71.53

3106

Pashur

Pashutian

KPK

PK

34.55

73.01

4619

Pashat

FATA

PK

34.87

71.53

3106

Patra

Ghazni

AFG

32.87

68.1

6745

Patra

Vardak

AFG

34.37

67.43

9068

Patrah

Ghazni

AFG

32.87

68.1

6745

Pal Bahah

Ghowr

AFG

35.02

65.56

8024

Pal Khel

FATA

PK

32.97

69.84

3914

Pal Bisheh

Herat

AFG

33.58

62.18

4173

Pal Bsha

Herat

AFG

33.58

62.18

4173

Patara

Paul

143

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Pal Ba

Herat

AFG

33.58

62.18

4173

Pal Piri

Herat

AFG

34.35

62.4

3418

Pal

KPK

PK

34.31

73.43

2841

Pal Dheri

KPK

PK

34.22

72.39

1138

Palos Mela

FATA

PK

31.76

70.01

3526

Palos Punga

FATA

PK

32.68

70.19

4527

Palos Punga

FATA

PK

32.67

70.16

4373

Palosai

FATA

PK

33.67

71.3

3402

Palosai

FATA

PK

34.5

71.26

2276

Palosai
Ziarat

FATA

PK

34.5

71.24

2398

Palosa

KPK

PK

34.14

71.83

928

Palosai

KPK

PK

34.04

71.49

1079

Palosai

KPK

PK

33.88

71.95

2309

Palosai

KPK

PK

34.27

72.41

1236

Pedaiah

Pedah

Ghazni

AFG

33.28

67.7

10413

Pekod

Pekkot

Paktika

AFG

32.92

69.44

5692

Pelaiah

Pila-i-Surkh

Badghis

AFG

35.24

64.15

5639

Pilalimirka

Vardak

AFG

34.5

68.05

9475

Pila-i-Surkh

Badghis

AFG

35.24

64.15

5639

Pilalimirka

Vardak

AFG

34.5

68.05

9475

Peninnah

Pinin
Bnda

KPK

PK

34.63

72.37

5082

Peor

Phr

KPK

PK

34.07

72.67

1062

Paulus

Pelaliah

144

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Perez

Peruzbar

Bamian

AFG

34.75

67.07

8959

Perzi

Nangarhar

AFG

34.42

70.61

1722

Phalti

Paltu

Velayat-e
Ghowr

Afghani
stan

34.25

64.27

889

Piram

Piran

Khowst

AFG

33.34

70.02

3559

Piran
Samyeh

Baghlan

AFG

35.63

69.47

6558

Patn

Ghazni

AFG

33.61

68.21

8979

Mamrez
Pathan

KPK

PK

32.11

70.42

761

Patn

Paktia

AFG

33.48

68.91

6942

Patn Kheyl

Kandahar

AFG

31.16

66.5

4255

Patnkhl

Kandahar

AFG

31.16

66.5

4255

Patnkhl

Kandahar

AFG

31.07

66.57

4383

Patnkhl

Vardak

AFG

33.91

68.65

7349

Pathan Khel

Kandahar

AFG

31.07

66.57

4383

Patan Kalay

Paktika

AFG

32.04

68.65

6994

Patana

Paktika

AFG

33.18

68.8

6978

Patanah

Paktika

AFG

33.18

68.8

6978

Patanay

Paktika

AFG

32.69

69.04

8047

Pataneh

Paktika

AFG

33.18

68.8

6978

AFG

33.78

65.69

7168

Pithon

Patank
Patankhalay

Paktika

AFG

32.04

68.65

6994

Patankheyl

Vardak

AFG

33.91

68.65

7349

145

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Patankheyl

Vardak

AFG

33.91

68.65

7349

Patan

KPK

PK

35.1

73

3077

Pathankai

KPK

PK

34.56

73.21

4888

Pathn Seri

KPK

PK

34.37

73.07

2703

Pattan

KPK

PK

34.65

73.35

7746

Pattan
Kanauri

KPK

PK

32.08

70.54

695

Pathankai

KPK

PK

34.56

73.21

4888

Pattn
Danna

KPK

PK

34.25

73.44

5242

Poratha

Parata

FATA

PK

34.38

71.33

2375

Puah

Poya

FATA

PK

32.38

69.7

5321

Pudens

Pudin

Paktika

AFG

33.3

68.9

6883

AFG

34.18

66.33

9137

Pudina

Pul

Punon

Pur

Pudina

Ghazni

AFG

34.06

68.08

9071

Pudina

Bamian

AFG

34.44

67.13

9763

Pulsauz

Zabol

AFG

31.8

66.37

4235

Pul-i-Khesti

Faryab

AFG

35.85

65.19

3933

Pul Bela

KPK

PK

35.26

72.56

7450

Pul Bnda

KPK

PK

35.68

72.4

9727

Puna

KPK

PK

34.33

73.02

2916

Puna

Nurestan

AFG

35.83

71.35

9412

Pora

FATA

PK

32.27

69.54

4543

146

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Pr Gj

Badakhsh
an

AFG

38.08

71.23

9271

Putiel

Patal Kili

FATA

PK

33.79

70.19

4324

Raamah

Ramakhel

Ghazni

AFG

33.33

68.59

6850

Ramakhel

Laghman

AFG

34.73

70.14

2926

Rab-shakeh

Shakoh

KPK

PK

34.94

71.86

3822

Rachal

Rachalam

Konar

AFG

34.96

70.85

4478

Raddai

Riday

AFG

33.02

65.78

3874

Ragau

Raga

Zabol

AFG

32.83

67.29

6332

Raga

Paktika

AFG

32.06

69.04

5554

Raga

Paktika

AFG

32.95

69.37

6571

Raga

Nangarhar

AFG

34.32

70.83

1932

Raga

Nangarhar

AFG

34.06

70.67

4589

Raga

Nangarhar

AFG

34.3

69.81

5134

Riga

Ghazni

AFG

34.09

67.37

10065

Rigay

Kandahar

AFG

31.49

65.44

3126

Rigay

Helmand

AFG

31.86

64.77

2910

Rahim

KPK

PK

34.35

72.77

4822

Rahim Sar
Banda

KPK

PK

34.89

72.66

5853

Rahima

KPK

PK

34.18

71.86

964

Rahimkhan

Nimruz

AFG

31.16

62.02

1564

Rahimkhel

Ghazni

AFG

33.05

68.26

6889

Rahimkhel

Ghazni

AFG

33.33

68.56

6817

Raham

147

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Rahimkhel

Vardak

AFG

34.46

68.75

7463

Rakkath

Rakhisht

Parvan

AFG

34.93

69.11

5649

Rakkon

Rakhan

KPK

PK

34.94

73.86

9655

Ram

Ramgul

KPK

PK

34.95

71.6

3585

Ramjal

KPK

PK

34.67

72

2450

Ramjn

KPK

PK

34.55

72.85

5200

Ramkot

KPK

PK

34.47

72.95

3874

Ram Sher
Khel

FATA

PK

33.81

70.62

7493

Reba

Raba China

Baluchista
n

PK

30.48

69

4261

Rebekah

Rabaki

KPK

PK

32.88

70.56

1095

Rehum

Rahim Kor

FATA

PK

34.19

71.42

1145

Rahim

KPK

PK

34.35

72.77

4822

Rahim
Mena

FATA

PK

34.17

71.39

1272

Rai Qila

FATA

PK

33.99

71.3

2362

Rai-dauno

FATA

PK

34.83

71.57

2723

Rakhimkala
y

Kandahar

AFG

31.81

66.76

4904

Rakhimkhe
yl

Ghazni

AFG

33.05

68.26

6889

Rakhimkhe
yl

Ghazni

AFG

33.33

68.56

6817

Rakhimkhe
yl

Vardak

AFG

34.46

68.75

7463

Rei

Rekem

148

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Remmon

Romen

KPK

PK

35.99

72.1

10544

Resen

Resn

KPK

PK

34.62

73.35

6105

Reuben

RabBanu
tribe

Rezon

Razani

FATA

PK

32.79

69.89

5797

Rhoda

Rodakay

Paktika

AFG

31.73

68.78

5944

Rodikalay

Zabol

AFG

31.88

66.53

4452

Rod

Nangarhar

AFG

34.36

69.99

3615

Rod-i-Sirin
Tagab

Faryab

AFG

35.93

64.93

2854

Roda

KPK

PK

31.67

70.82

501

Rodi Khel

KPK

PK

32.07

70.83

600

Rodi Khel

KPK

PK

32.24

70.44

856

Rinnah

Rinay

Konar

AFG

35.13

71.48

6023

Rohgah

Roghani

Nangarhar

AFG

34.24

70.53

2782

Roghanqul

Ghowr

AFG

34.6

66.52

10301

Roganibula
k

Bamian

AFG

34.14

67.36

11181

Rom Kili

KPK

PK

36.23

72.18

6332

Romen

KPK

PK

35.99

72.1

10544

Rosh

Roshai Dab

KPK

PK

35.56

72.21

7952

Ruth

Ruti

Ghowr

AFG

34.13

63.7

7378

Sabaoth

Sobat

Bamian

AFG

34.24

67.12

9927

Sobat

Kandahar

AFG

31.52

65.25

2959

Rhodes

Rome

149

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Sobat

Kandahar

AFG

31.51

65.25

2969

Sabai

KPK

PK

34.53

72.85

4589

Sabah

Kandahar

AFG

31.33

67.33

6732

Sabakhel

Ghazni

AFG

32.76

67.77

6410

Sabtah

Sabat Khan

KPK

PK

34.31

71.94

1095

Sadoc

Sadokai

FATA

PK

34.86

71.56

2952

Sadokai
Banda

FATA

PK

34.91

71.58

4819

Sadu Khan

KPK

PK

34.71

72.84

6020

Sadu Khel

KPK

PK

33.85

72

2470

Sadak

Parvan

AFG

34.76

69.44

7421

Sadak Kalay

Zabol

AFG

31.99

68.07

7385

Salah

KPK

PK

34

72.37

918

Saleh Kor

FATA

PK

34.2

71.45

1095

Salamzi

Konar

AFG

35.16

71.33

4045

Salamkheyl

Kabol

AFG

34.44

69.67

7434

Salamkheyl

Paktia

AFG

33.76

69.36

8385

Salamkheyl

Baghlan

AFG

36.13

68.72

1942

Salim

Saleemabad

KPK

PK

34.45

71.92

1302

Salmi Khel

FATA

PK

32.39

69.84

4967

Salim
Khane
Khula

FATA

PK

33.9

70.65

6410

Salim

Zabol

AFG

32.2

66.47

4435

Sabeans

Salah

Salamis

150

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Salim

Ghowr

AFG

33.75

64.51

7562

Salim Bay

Badghis

AFG

34.86

62.96

4202

Salim Kheyl

Ghazni

AFG

32.82

67.84

6548

Salai

FATA

PK

32.98

70.24

2214

Salai Kili

FATA

PK

33.53

70.7

3687

Salai Kili

FATA

PK

33.53

70.7

3687

Salma

Herat

AFG

34.35

63.83

5488

Salmah

Herat

AFG

34.35

63.83

5488

Salmalik

Faryab

AFG

35.91

64.64

2831

Salmon

Salman
Kheyl

Paktia

AFG

33.34

69.34

7926

Salome

Salm Bek

KPK

PK

35.34

71.93

7562

Samaria

Samar

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.03

70.33

5495

Samar

Takhar

AFG

36.72

69.69

4524

Samar
Ghn

Takhar

AFG

37.12

69.87

4685

Samar
Kheyl

Nangarhar

AFG

34.37

70.58

1738

Samlah

Shamlagay
Kamar

Paktia

AFG

35

70.86

4855

Samos

Shamozi

Paktia

AFG

33.5

69.04

7093

Samuel

Semul

Nangarhar

AFG

34.74

70.61

6043

Shamulzai

Paktia

AFG

33.5

69.04

7093

Shamulzai

Zabol

AFG

31.91

67.65

6922

Sallai

Salma

151

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

Saph

Sarah ( so
many)

Sardis

Sargon

Sebat

Sela

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Shamulzah

Kabol

AFG

34.54

69

6548

Shamulzai

Kabol

AFG

34.54

69

6548

Shamulzai

Paktia

AFG

33.5

69.04

7093

Sap Dur

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.71

70.73

9120

Sapara

Khowst

AFG

33.51

69.89

4156

Saparzai

Kandahar

AFG

31.37

66.26

4061

Sara Khuna

FATA

PK

33.67

70.85

5124

Sara Khwa

FATA

PK

33.85

70.41

7660

Sara Khwa

FATA

PK

34.59

71.18

3454

Sardi Khel

KPK

PK

32.85

70.55

1010

Sarde

Sar-e Pol

AFG

35.84

65.89

4671

Sargandab

Ghazni

AFG

33.51

68.17

9219

Sargin

Nurestan

AFG

35.38

70.27

8415

Sebet

Kandahar

AFG

31.3

66.72

5150

Sobati Kach

KPK

PK

32.29

70.27

1607

Sela

Ghazni

AFG

33.2

68.42

6778

Sela

Ghazni

AFG

32.51

67.67

7260

Sela

Zabol

AFG

31.81

66.53

4816

Sela

Zabol

AFG

32.23

66.49

4481

Sela

Kandahar

AFG

31.48

66.9

5131

Sela

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.05

71.23

7296

152

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Sela

Zabol

AFG

31.95

66.68

4658

Sela-iGolestan

Ghowr

AFG

34.08

64.78

9330

Sela-i-Kalan

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.28

70.66

7765

Silo

FATA

PK

34.14

71.21

3070

Semache

Nangarhar

AFG

34.27

70.91

1397

Semache

Nangarhar

AFG

34.24

70.3

3681

Shabbethai

Shhbt

KPK

PK

34.76

72.01

3185

Shage

Shgay

Khowst

AFG

33.58

69.75

6824

Shaga

FATA

PK

32.68

70

5679

Shagai

FATA

PK

33.68

70.46

5452

Shagga

FATA

PK

32.8

69.51

6463

Shago

FATA

PK

34.83

71.62

3910

Shago Mian

FATA

PK

34.74

71.51

2746

Shalem

ShalamAlga
d Kili

FATA

PK

32.36

70.22

1870

Shalim

KPK

PK

35.93

71.81

5144

Shallum

Shalam
Kalle

KPK

PK

34.27

71.75

1079

Shalmai

Shalmi

KPK

PK

34.58

73.02

5508

Shalman

Shalmani

KPK

PK

34.86

72.61

6125

Shalmani

KPK

PK

34.81

72.79

4530

Shalmani

KPK

PK

34.65

72.76

2785

Shamar Kili

FATA

PK

33.76

71.12

4790

Semachiah

Shamariah

153

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Shamer

Shahmri
Kili

FATA

PK

32.72

70.01

5515

Shamir

Shamar
Khwar

KPK

PK

35.16

72.21

8225

Shamir

KPK

PK

31.7

70.65

567

Shamirai

KPK

PK

35.13

72.51

4875

Shama

KPK

PK

34.36

72.45

3805

Shama Khel

KPK

PK

32.9

70.66

1043

Shama

Zabol

AFG

31.93

67.68

7034

Shama Khel

Paktika

AFG

32.67

69.25

6761

Shama

FATA

PK

34.61

71.47

2460

Shammai

Shamai

KPK

PK

35.16

72.2

7700

Shammuah

Shemaoon

KPK

PK

34.37

71.9

1171

Shamsherai

Sham Serai

KPK

PK

34.71

72.95

4429

Shaphat

Shapot
Banda

KPK

PK

34.84

72.81

6450

Shapo abad

FATA

PK

33.98

70

7483

Shar

KPK

PK

35.2

72.59

9297

Shar

KPK

PK

35.38

72.27

9639

Shar

KPK

PK

35.15

72.67

9202

Shar

KPK

PK

34.7

72.98

2916

Shar Banda

KPK

PK

35.36

72.27

11020

AFG

33.13

68.84

AFG

32.29

69.14

Shammah

Sharar

Sharon

Sharona
Airstrip
Sharonikay

Paktika

154

5606

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

Shaveh

Shelah

Shema

Shemer

Shiloh

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Sharona

KPK

PK

34.81

72.62

7034

hwo
Kalay

Parvan

AFG

34.83

69.33

6601

Shawai

FATA

PK

34.71

71.35

3690

Shawai

FATA

PK

34.59

71.27

2516

Shawai
Kaskai

FATA

PK

33.04

69.56

7378

Shela

Ghazni

AFG

33.2

68.42

6778

Shela

Ghazni

AFG

32.51

67.67

7260

Shela

Zabol

AFG

32.12

67.16

6079

Shela

Zabol

AFG

31.81

66.53

4816

Shela

Zabol

AFG

32.23

66.49

4481

Shela

Kandahar

AFG

31.48

66.9

5131

Shela

Zabol

AFG

31.95

66.68

4658

Shama

KPK

PK

34.36

72.45

3805

Shama Khel

KPK

PK

32.9

70.66

1043

Shamiri

FATA

PK

32.84

70.14

3818

Shamir

KPK

PK

31.7

70.65

567

Shamirai

KPK

PK

35.13

72.51

4875

Shamar Kili

FATA

PK

33.76

71.12

4790

Shela

Kandahar

AFG

31.48

66.9

5131

Shela

Zabol

AFG

31.95

66.68

4658

Shelagay

Kandahar

AFG

31.22

66.5

4340

155

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Solomon

Seleman
Kalay

Helmand

AFG

30.5

63.36

1961

Selemani

Bamian

AFG

34.63

67.06

11341

Tanak Kili

KPK

PK

33.08

70.78

1217

Tanakki

KPK

PK

34.09

73.19

3556

Tanaca

Ghazni

AFG

32.82

68.2

6791

Tabeal

Tabelonav

Konar

AFG

34.99

71.46

6499

Taberah

Tabar

Badghis

AFG

34.71

63.31

6213

Tabor

Tabar

Badghis

AFG

34.71

63.31

6213

Tabar

Badghis

AFG

34.71

63.33

5928

Tabarkheyl

Vardak

AFG

34.38

68.72

7910

Tahaneh

Parvan

AFG

35.34

69.62

7975

Tahaneh

Ghazni

AFG

33.38

68.7

7322

Talma

Ghazni

AFG

32.89

67.49

7690

Talmastan

Ghowr

AFG

33.68

65.41

8061

Tamah

Tamai

KPK

PK

34.68

73.05

3982

Tanach

Tanak Kili

KPK

PK

33.08

70.78

1217

Tanakki

KPK

PK

34.09

73.19

3556

Tanak Kowt

Paktia

AFG

33.42

69.36

7411

Tappuah

Tapu-rak

Baghlan

AFG

35.83

68.77

2214

Tarah

Tara

Vardak

AFG

34.27

68.4

8608

Tarai

KPK

PK

34.78

71.79

2690

Tarala

FATA

PK

34.83

71.57

2769

Taralai

FATA

PK

33.75

70.41

5597

Taanach

Tahan

Talmai

Taralah

156

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Taralai

KPK

PK

34.5

72.71

4146

Taralay

Balkh

AFG

36.56

67.14

3910

Tarea

Tari

FATA

PK

33.73

70.79

6479

Tarsus

Tarsai
Punga

FATA

PK

32.5

69.52

8648

Tarsi Kalai

FATA

PK

33.94

69.95

6578

Tarsi Kili

FATA

PK

33.94

69.95

6578

Tabah Ayq

Balkh

AFG

36.32

66.79

2454

Tabai

Jowzjan

AFG

36.88

66.19

951

Tabai

FATA

PK

33.83

70.75

5830

Tabai

FATA

PK

34.81

71.6

3041

Tabai

FATA

PK

33.99

70.98

4747

Tekel

Takul

KPK

PK

34.66

73.44

4596

Telah

Tila

FATA

PK

32.48

69.88

5351

Tilai

KPK

PK

35.05

72.47

3864

Telem

Talaum

FATA

PK

33.12

70.56

1617

Terah

Tirah

KPK

PK

34.53

72.69

4393

Tirah

KPK

PK

33.73

71.01

7043

Tirah Kuha

KPK

PK

33.14

71.21

2555

Tirah

FATA

PK

33.49

70.47

3270

Thamah

Tamai

KPK

PK

34.68

73.05

3982

Tharah

Tara Kili

FATA

PK

33.92

70.85

4744

Tarai

FATA

PK

33.04

69.64

6161

Tarai

FATA

PK

33.86

71.2

2752

Tebah

157

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Thomas

Tams

Ghazni

AFG

33.74

68.21

8474

AFG

33.67

65.78

7345

Tams
Thummim

Thamoniak

KPK

PK

35.75

71.78

5246

Tiberias

Tebe

Sar-e Pol

AFG

35.99

66.38

3868

Tebar

Vardak

AFG

34.5

68.23

9855

Tirizai

Khowst

AFG

33.47

70.09

3513

Tirizi

Khowst

AFG

33.47

70.09

3513

Tob

KPK

PK

34.71

73.29

8425

Tobe

KPK

PK

34.19

73.24

3986

Toi-mast

Faryab

AFG

35.61

64.24

4465

Toi

KPK

PK

34.2

72.83

1473

Toi Mela

FATA

PK

33.68

71.28

3471

Toi Mela

FATA

PK

34.02

69.96

10938

Tola

FATA

PK

33.9

70.14

5623

Tola

FATA

PK

34.71

71.47

2837

Tola

KPK

PK

34.62

73.45

6062

Tola

Ghazni

AFG

33.07

68.11

6669

Tola Gachi

Samangan

AFG

36.42

67.94

3005

Tola Gachi

Samangan

AFG

36.36

67.92

3064

Tola Gachi
1

Samangan

AFG

36.42

67.94

3005

Tryphena

Trupia

FATA

PK

33.64

70.81

5049

Tyre

Tir

KPK

PK

35.01

72.63

6778

Tir

KPK

PK

34.09

73.01

1955

Tirzah

Tob

Toi

Tola

158

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Ucal

Ucak

Ghazni

AFG

34.12

67.69

10561

Ukulak

Ghazni

AFG

33.33

67.6

9924

Ulam

Ulamkul

Ghowr

AFG

33.74

64.73

8526

Ulla

Ula Kheyl

Ghazni

AFG

32.74

67.76

6420

Unni

Unay

Helmand

AFG

32.77

65.15

5915

Ona

KPK

PK

35.03

72.3

5682

Ura

KPK

PK

34.39

72.37

3244

Urai

KPK

PK

34.94

73.01

7798

Uri

Urai

KPK

PK

34.94

73.01

7798

Uthai

Ut Khel

Kabol

AFG

34.63

69.68

3307

Uta Kowl

Balkh

AFG

36.9

67.05

1043

Uzun Qul

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.14

70.32

6151

Uzhnu

KPK

PK

36.55

72.47

8635

Vaniah

Wana

Paktika

AFG

32.63

68.6

7467

Vashni

Wasnisar

Badakhsh
an

AFG

38.43

70.93

5121

Washan
Khel

KPK

PK

32.54

70.52

1535

Vasht

Helmand

AFG

32.08

64.64

3162

Vasti

Khowst

AFG

33.13

69.46

7870

Weti

Zabol

AFG

32.58

66.46

8418

Weti Pain

Zabol

AFG

32.55

66.5

7414

Zawna

KPK

PK

32.82

70.63

931

Ur

Uzzensherah

Vashti

Witty

Zaavan

159

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

Zabbai

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Zawana
Mena

FATA

PK

34.59

71.5

2644

Zabo Gai

FATA

PK

33.08

69.6

7765

Zabi

Farah

AFG

33.45

63.91

6758

Zabikhel

Kapisa

AFG

35.05

69.66

6932

AFG

33.92

66.02

9356

Zabo
Zaka 2

Jowzjan

AFG

36.44

65.81

1499

Zaka 3

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.41

65.82

1512

Zako

KPK

PK

34.96

72.07

5164

Zako
Ghkhai

KPK

PK

33.73

71.19

4422

Zaccur

Zakuri

Ghazni

AFG

33.38

68.39

6847

Zair

Zaher Kala

Khowst

AFG

33.27

69.88

4081

Zaher Kalay

Helmand

AFG

31.32

64.27

2404

Zaher
Khaneh

Zabol

AFG

32.48

66.57

6272

Zalemeh
Qal`eh

Sar-e Pol

AFG

36.06

66.29

3346

Zalemi

Ghowr

AFG

33.44

63.17

5380

Zano
Ghundai

KPK

PK

34.34

72.05

1141

Zanu

Ghowr

AFG

33.86

64.73

8428

Zarah
Gerdah

Ghazni

AFG

33.23

68.26

6712

Zarah Kal

Laghman

AFG

34.51

70.03

2391

Zaccai

Zalmon

Zanoah

Zarah

160

Chapter 4 of Book I

Biblical
Name

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Zarah Kal

Kabol

AFG

34.37

69.22

5977

Zarah Kal

Paktika

AFG

32.71

68.35

6643

Zarah Kal

Zabol

AFG

31.97

67.63

6781

Zarah Kal

Kandahar

AFG

31

66.27

3809

Zarah Kal

Zabol

AFG

32.08

66.74

5144

Zareh Kal

Vardak

AFG

34.02

68.62

8077

Zareh Kal

Vardak

AFG

34.21

68.62

7890

Zareh Kolh

Vardak

AFG

34.02

68.62

8077

Zareh Sar

Ghazni

AFG

33.32

68.58

6804

Zareh Shahr

Ghazni

AFG

33.32

68.58

6804

Zaretan

Zartangi
Banda

KPK

PK

33.28

71.53

1601

Zaza

Zazanwurs

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.34

70.74

9681

Zebah

Badakhsh
an

AFG

36.53

71.35

8884

Zebai

FATA

PK

32.8

69.74

7411

Zebul

Zabul

Zabul

Prov.

Zebulun

Zabul

Zabul

Prov.

Zechariah

Zich

Badakhsh
an

AFG

37.05

71.42

10505

Zicharw

Badakhsh
an

AFG

38.05

71.24

9232

Zelek

Ziloq

Baghlan

AFG

36.18

69.34

7066

Zelzah

Zilzila

Ghazni

AFG

33.46

68.36

7047

Zareah

161

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Biblical
Name

Zemira

Zerah

City/town

Region

Country

Lat.

Long

Elev. ft.

Zilzilat

Ghowr

AFG

34.16

64.15

7667

Zamirkheyl

Nangarhar

AFG

34.2

70.28

4041

Zamir
Kheyl

Ghazni

AFG

33.75

68.33

8011

Zira

Paktia

AFG

33.55

69.57

8520

Zira

Farah

AFG

33.03

63.85

5633

Ziragar

Nangarhar

AFG

34.48

70.93

3083

162

Chapter 5

Medieval References of Muslim Scholars


about the Israelite Origin of Pathans

Here are some examples of very old references from Muslim scholars
telling us about the Israeli origin of Pathans.
Article written by Navras Aafreedi.
Source: http://bechollashon.org/database/index.php?/article/2802
The Garden of the Learned in the history of Great Men and
Genealogies (717 A.H./1317 A.D.)
One of the oldest manuscripts in the world is Abu Suleiman
Daud bin Abul Fazal Muammad Albenaketis Rauzat ul
Albab fi Tawarikh-ul-Akabir wal Ansab (The Garden of the
Learned in the history of Great Men and Genealogies) written
in A.H. 717, in which the author traces the ancestry of the
Afghans to the Israelites.
Abu Sulaiman Dauds Rauza-ul-Bab Twarikh-ul-Akbar-walAnsab (The Garden of the Learned in the history of Great Men
and Genealogies) (A.H. 717/1310 C.E.) is considered the
earliest work on the subject of the Israelite origin of the Afridi
Pashtuns / Pathans. It discusses the history of the Afghan /

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Pashtun / Pathan nation since the time of Moses X. (Ref:


Benjamin, Joshua M., The Mystery of Israels Ten Lost Tribes,
and the Legend of Jesus in India, 2nd Edition, Mosaic Books,
New Delhi, p. 16).
The author in his Introduction explains that ever since the
times of Moses X the ancestors of the Afghans have had to
face great hardships. They were expelled from place to place
and exterminated. Their ancient ancestors were sacked more
than once and carried into captivity. In Chapter I a detailed
history of Yaqub (Jacob) is given and in Chapter II the
genealogies of the Afghan tribes are further traced.
The genealogies of the Pashtun/Pathan/Afghan tribes, right
up to King Saul are given in the second chapter of the book.
Note: It should be noted that this book is written in 717 Hijri
and we do find authentic adth written up to 1000 Hijri in
the adth books such as Mustadrak Hakim.
Book by Sheikh Mali Yusufzai (A.H. 816/1409 C.E.)
Sheikh Mali of the Yusufzai tribe wrote in Pushto a book on
the Israelite descent of the Afghans / Pashtuns / Pathans
between A.H. 816/1409 C.E. and A.H. 828/1412 C.E.
Book by Khan Kaju (A.H. 900/1493 C.E.)
Another work in Pushto on the same subject is ascribed to
Khan Kaju, written in circa A.H. 900/1493 C.E. In this book
it is also told that all Pathans belong to Banu Israel.

164

Chapter 5 of Book I

Tabaqat-i-Nasiri by Courtier of Sultan Shabuddin


Ghauri.42 (1259-1260 C.E.)
Upon these two works (i.e.: by Sheikh Mali Yusufzai 1409
A.D. and Khan Kaju 1493 A.D.) were based Tarikh-e-Hafiz
Rahmat and Khulasat al-Ansab of Hafiz Rahmat Khan.
Minhaj-i-Siraj Jurjari, who had close contact with the Ghurids
and held posts of qazi (qadi), khatib, sadr-i-jahan, and
principal of the Nasiriya Madrassa, who wrote in his Tabaqati-Nasiri (1259-1260 C.E.): In the time of the ShansBanu
dynasty there were people called Banu Israel living in Ghor,
and that some of them were extensively engaged in trade
with the neighbouring countries (Ref: Imamudin, op. cit., p.
200). Tabaqat-i-Nasiri is an encyclopaedic history from the
patriarchs and prophets, viz., Abraham X, Isaac, and Jacob,
to the time of Nasiruddin Mahmud. It is an invaluable source
of information for the history of the early Turkic sultans and
their maliks and amirs. (Ref: Habib, Muammad and Khaliq
Ahmad Nizami, eds., op. cit., p. xx)
Tarikh-e-Guzeedah and Majma-ul-Ansab (1326 A.D.)
Even before the political rise of Afghans / Pashtuns / Pathans,
Hamidullah Mustawfi had speculated that they were most
likely Israelites in his monumental work Tarikh-e-Guzeedah

42. Shabudding Ghauri (1150-1206), was a ruler of the Ghurid dynasty who
reigned over a territory spanning present-day Afghanistan, Pakistan and
northern India.
165

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

(A.H. 730/1326 C.E.), as stated by Neamatullah.43 This is a


general historical account dedicated to Khwaja Ghiyasuddin
Muammad, son and successor of Rashiduddin Fazlullah.44
Mustawfis Majma-ul-Ansab gives a detailed genealogy of
Qais (Kash), the tribal head of the Afghans / Pashtuns /
Pathans in a series of thirty-seven generations to King Saul
and forty-five generations to Abraham X. (Ref: Ibid)
Mirat-ul-Alam by Bukhtawar Khan
We find a detailed account of the journey of Afghans from
Israel to Afghanistan in Bukhtawar Khans Mirat-ul-Alam,
according to which Afghans are descendants of Israel (Jabob
/ Yacov / Yaqub) through King Saul.45
Akbarnama by Abu Fazl courtier of Emperor Akbar46
(1551-1602 C.E.)
An outline of the main tribal traditions of the Pashtuns /
Pathans / Afghans have been chronicled by Abul Fazl (15511602 C.E.) in Akbarnama. This also tells us about the Israeli
origin of the Pathans.

43. Imamuddin, op. cit., p. 205.


44. Habib, Muhammad, and Khaliq Ahmad Nizami, eds., op. cit., p. xxi.
45. Ibid., pp. 16-17.
46 Akbar the Great (23 November 1542-27 October 1605), was the third
Mughal Emperor of India.
166

Chapter 5 of Book I

Sulaiman Makus Tadhkirat al Awliya (allegedly of the


thirteenth century). (13th Century AD)
Slightly different versions are given in Sulaiman Makus
Tadhkirat al Awliya (allegedly of the thirteenth century C.E.).
He also has told us about the Israeli origin of the Pathans
Tadhkirat al-Abrar by Akhund Darwiza (1611 A.D.)
Another scholar Akhund Darwiza had declared the Afghans /
Pashtuns / Pathans to be Israelites in his Tadhkirat al-Abrar
(an account of his adventures in Afghan territories) in 1611
C.E.47
Mirat-al-Afghani of Khwaja Neamatullah courtier of
Emperor Jahangir48 (1621 A.D.)
Naematullah was the first historian to present a systematic
genealogical table of Pathans / Pashtuns / Afghans from Israel
/ Jacob. However he cant be given credit for propounding
theory of their Israelite origin because many others have done
research in this subject long before him. His book was
translated in English by Bernard Dorn in 1829.
Neamatullah sent five historians, viz., Qutb Khan, Sarmast
Khan Abdali, Hamza Khan, Umar Khan Kakarr and Zarif
Khan, to the Afghan / Pashtun / Pathan territories in AH
1030/1621 C.E. to investigate the descent of Afghans.

47. Ref: Imamuddin, op. cit., p. 206.


48 Mughal Emperor Jahangir who ruled India from 1605-1627.
167

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Naematullah writes:
Khaled sent a letter to the Afghans who had settled in the
mountainous countries around Ghor ever since the time of
the expulsion of the Israelites by Bokhtnasser, and informed
them of the appearance of the last of the Prophets. When this
letter reached them, several of their chiefs departed from
Medina; the mightiest of them, and of the Afghan people, was
Kais, whose pedigree ascends in a series of thirty-seven
degrees to Talut, of forty-five to Ibrahim X (Ref: Makhzani-Afghani (History of the Afghans) of Naematullah (1612
C.E.), translated By Bernhard Dorn.49
The Word Pashto
Another theory is that whenever people asked the Pathans / Pashtuns /
Afghans about their nationality, they replied in Hebrew phasq or
phasht. Phasq means to liberate, to make free, to split, while
phasht means to spread. The word Pashtun seems to have been
derived from this very word. (Ref: Imamuddin, op. cit., pp. 206-207.) In
Hebrew, Pasht is the name of a deity, and also of a city in Egypt. In the
Pashto language Pastu means an inner room with just one entrance,
which indicates that they might have migrated from Israel to their
present mountainous country and called themselves Pusht after a
village in Israel. (Ref: Ibid., p. 207.) Some believe that Pathans got their
name from Jonathans great-grandson Pithon.

49. Translated by Bernhard Dorn, Part I, Oriental Translation Committee,


London, 1829, p. 37.
168

Chapter 5 of Book I

The Three Tribes


According to Pashtun / Pathan / Afghan genealogies, Kish married the
daughter of Khalid ibn al-Waleed,50 from whom he had three sons
Sarban, Bitan and Ghurgasht. Sarban in turn had two sonsSacharj
Yun and Karsh. As per the tradition, the descendants of Yun are
Afghans / Pashtuns / Pathans. (Ref: Benjamin, op. cit., p. 16.)
Risal-i-Ansab-i-Afghana
Fareed-ud-Din Ahmad tries to prove the Israelite descent of
Pashtuns / Pathans / Afghans from King Talut (King Saul) in
his Risal-i-Ansab-i-Afghana.
Tarikh-i-Hafiz Rahmatkhani, by Hafiz Muammad Zadeek
(1770 A.D.)
This books deals with the early history of the Afghans, their
origin and wanderings in general. They particularly discuss
the Yusuf Zyes (the Yusufzai, Sons of Joseph) and their
occupation of Kabul, Bajoor, Swat, and Peshawar.
Syed Jamal-ud-Din Afghani51 (Tarikh-i-Afghana / History
of Afghans), and Syed Abdul Jabbar Shah (Munameen-iBanu Israel, ms)
It is worth mentioning the names of Syed Jalal-ud-Din

50. Famous companion and also one of the Generals of the Last Prophet
Muhammad U.
51. Sayyid Jamal-ad-Din Afghani, (1838-March 9, 1897), was a political activist
and Islamic ideologist in the Muslim world.
169

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Afghani and Syed Abdul Jabar Shah, the ex-ruler of Swat


(KPK, Pakistan), who have given genealogies of different
Afghan / Pashtun / Pathan tribes right up to King Saul and
conclude that the Afghans / Pashtuns / Pathans represent the
Lost Tribes of Israel. (Ref: Ibid., p. 17.)
Both these writers discuss the question exhaustively and come
to the conclusion that the Afghans represent the Lost Tribes
of Israel as viewed from the perspective of the Jewish /
Western world.
The Corrigendum of an Historic Fact by The Nawab of
Hoti, Sir Akbar Khan
The Nawab of Hoti, Sir Akbar Khan, writes in his famous
book The Corrigendum of a Historic Fact that in 570 B.C.,
the King of Babul Bukht Nasir ordered the two grandsons of
Afghana, Armia and Burkhia, to settle the Bin Yamin
(Benjamin) tribes in his kingdom. Hence they brought their
old grandfather to the hills of Herat and started living there.
Christ in Heaven on Earth by Khwaja Nazer Ahmad
Khwaja Nazer Ahmad proves in his book Christ in Heaven
on Earth that the Pashtuns belong to the lost tribes of
Israel.
Conclusion
The Pashtuns or Pathans are the worlds only claimants of Israelite
descent whose claim is backed by so many medieval references,
spanning hundreds of years.
170

Chapter 6

References of Western Scholars


about the Israelite Origin of Pathans

Here are some examples of Western scholars who agreed


on the Israeli origin of the Pathans
Henry Vansittart 1788
If we turn to Anglo-Western writers during the time of the
British Empire we find that they also have come to the same
conclusion. The first to reach such is Henry Vansittart. In a
letter, which appeared in Indian Researches, he commented
on the Israelite descent of the Afghans. He expressed the
opinion that the claim of the Afghans to be Banu Israel is
more than justified given his own observations of their
indigenous traditions. [Indian Researches, 1788, Vol. 2, 69.]
William Moorcroft 1819
William Moorcroft traveled during 1819 to 1825 through
various countries adjoining India, including Afghanistan.
The Khaibarees, he says, are tall and have a singularly
Jewish cast of features. At Push Kyun, within Afghan
territory, he came across a very old copy of the Old Testament

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

in Hebrew. [Moorcroft, Travels in Himalayan Provinces of


Hindustan and the Punjab; in Ladakh and Kashmir, in
Peshawar, Kabul, Kunduz and Bokhara ]
Henry Walter Bellew (1834-1892)
He said that: The true Afghans (The Pathans) called
themselves Banu Israel. In fact their claim would be at once
admitted and their country considered a second Palestine, for
in support of the belief there is the mount Moriah (Morah),
the peaks of Ilam and Dumah, the valley of Sodom (Sudhum),
the stream of Gadarenes (Gadhar), the plain of Galilee
(Jalala), for places; whilst for tribes there are the Amazites
(Amazai), the Moabites (Muhibwal), the Hittites (Hotiwal),
the Yusuz Zai (Children of Joseph), etc.52
Sir Alexander Brunes, 1835 A.D.
Sir Alexander Brunes in his Travels into Bokhara, which he
published in 1835, speaking of the Afghans said: The
Afghans call themselves Banu Israel, or the children of Israel,
but consider the term Yahoodi, or Jew, to be one of reproach.
They say that Nebuchadnezzar, after the overthrow of Israel,
transplanted them into the towns of Ghore near Bamean and
that they were called after their Chief Afghana they say that
they lived as Israelites till Khalid summoned them in the first
century of the Mohammadans Having precisely stated the
52. Page 75, The races of Afghanistan being a brief account of the principal
nations inhabiting that country. By Henry Walter Bellew MRCP (1834-1892).

172

Chapter 6 of Book I

traditions and history of the Afghans I see no good reason for


discrediting them the Afghans look like Jews and the
younger brother marries the widow of the elder. The Afghans
entertain strong prejudices against the Jewish nation, which
would at least show that they have no desire to claim
without just causea descent from them. [Sir Alexander
Brunes, Travels into Bokhara, Vol. 2, 139-141.]
Brunes was again in 1837 sent as the first British Envoy to the
Court of Kabul. For some time he was the guest of King Dost
Muammad Khan. He questioned the King about the descent
of the Afghans from the Israelites. The King replied that his
people had no doubt of that, though they repudiated the idea
of being Jews.
J.B. Frazer, 1843 A.D.
J.B. Frazer in his book, and historical and descriptive account
of Persia and Afghanistan, which he published in 1843, says:
According to their own tradition they believe themselves to
be descendants from the [Hebrews] they preserved the
purity of their religion until they met with Islam. [J.B. Frazer,
A Historical and Descriptive Account of Persia and
Afghanistan, 298]
J.P. Ferrier, 1858 A.D.
J.P. Ferrier wrote his history of the Afghans in 1858. It was
translated by Capt. W. M. Jesse. He too was disposed to
believe that the Afghans represented the Ten Tribes of Israel.
In support of his view he recorded, among others, a very
173

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

significant fact: When Nadir Shah marching to the conquest


of India arrived at Peshawar, the chief of the tribe of Yusuf
Zyes (Sons of Joseph) presented him with a Bible written in
Hebrew and several other articles that had been used in their
ancient worship and which they had preserved. These articles
were at once recognized by the Jews who followed the camp.
J.P. Ferrier, History of the Afghans, 4.
The Lost Tribes by George Moore, 1861 A.D.
George Moore published his famous work The Lost Tribes in
1861. He gave numerous facts to prove that these tribes are
traceable to the Afghans. After giving details of the character
of the wandering Israelites, he said: And we find that the very
natural character of Israel reappear in all it is life and reality
in countries where people call themselves Banu Israel and
universally claim to be the descendants of the Lost Tribes. The
nomenclature of their tribes and districts, both in ancient
Geography, and at the present day, confirms this universal
natural tradition. Lastly, we have the route of the Israelites
from Media to Afghanistan and India marked by a series of
intermediate stations bearing the names of several of the
tribes and clearly indicating the stages of their long and
arduous journey.
Moore goes on to say: Sir William Jones, Sir John Malcolm
and the missing Chamberlain, after full investigation, were of
the opinion that the Ten Tribes migrated to India, Tibet, and
Cashmere [Kashmir] through Afghanistan.
174

Chapter 6 of Book I

Moore has mentioned only three eminent writers on the


subject. But reference can also be made to General Sir George
Macmunn (Afghanistan from Darius to Amanullah, 215), Col.
G.B. Malleson (The History of Afghanistan from the Earliest
Period to the outbreak of the War of 1878, 39), Col. Failson,
(History of Afghanistan, 49), George Bell (Tribes of
Afghanistan, 15), E. Balfour (Encyclopedia of India, article on
Afghanistan), Sir Henry Yule (Encyclopedia Britannica,
article on Afghanistan), and the Hon. Sir George Rose (Rose,
The Afghans, the Ten Tribes and the Kings of the east, 26).
They, one and all, independently came to the same
conclusion. Another, Major H.W. Bellew, went on a political
mission to Kandahar and published his impressions in his
Journal of a Mission to Kandahar, 1857-1858. He then wrote
in 1879 his book Afghanistan and Afghans. In 1880 he was
sent, once again on another mission to Kabul, and in the same
year he delivered two lectures before the United Services
Institute at Simla: A New Afghan Question, or Are the
Afghans Israelites? and Who are the Afghans? He then
published another book: The Races of Afghanistan. Finally he
collected all his facts in An Enquiry into the Ethnography of
Afghanistan, which was published in 1891. [George Moore,
The Lost Tribes.]
An Enquiry into the Ethnography of Afghanistan by H.W.
Bellew
In this work he mentions Killa Yahoodi (Fort of the Jews)
(H.W. Bellew, An Enquiry into the Ethnography of
175

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Afghanistan, 34), as being the name of the eastern boundary


of their country, and also speaks of Dasht-i-Yahoodi (Jewish
plain) (ibid. 4), a place in Mardan District. He concludes:
The Afghans accounts of Jacob and Esau, of Moses X and
the Exodus, of the wars of the Israelites with the Amalekites
and conquest of Palestine, of the Ark of the Covenant and of
the election of Saul to the Kingdom, etc., etc., are clearly
founded on the Biblical records, and clearly indicate a
knowledge of the Old Testament, which if it does not prove
the presence of the Christians at least corroborates their
assertion that the Afghans were readers of the Pentateuch up
to the time of the appearance of Muammad U. (Ibid. 191)
Note: It is well understood and undisputed that there have
never been Christian communities in Afghanistan before or
for many centuries after the dawn of Islam.
Thomas Ledlie, More Ledlian, Calcutta Review, January,
1898
Thomas Ledlie wrote an article in the Calcutta Review, which
he subsequently elaborated and published in two volumes. He
expressed his views on the subject very clearly: The
Europeans always confuse things, when they consider the fact
that the Afghans call themselves Banu Israel and yet reject
their Jewish descent. Indeed, the Afghans discard the very
idea of any descent from the Jews. They, however, yet claim
themselves to be of Banu Israel. [Thomas Ledlie, More
Ledlian, Calcutta Review, January, 1898.]
176

Chapter 6 of Book I

Ledlie goes on to explain: Israelites, or the Ten Tribes, to


whom the term Israel was appliedafter their separation
from the House of David, and the tribe of Judah, which tribe
retained the name of Judah and had a distinct history ever
after. These last alone are called Jews and are distinguished
from the Banu Israel as much in the east as in the West. [Ibid.
7.]
Dr. Alfred Edersheim, the Life and Times of Jesus, the
Messiah
Among more contemporary writers Dr. Alfred Edersheim
says: Modern investigations have pointed to the Nestorians
and latterly, with almost convincing evidence (so far as it is
possible) to the Afghans as descendants from the Lost Tribes.
[Dr. Alfred Edersheim, the Life and Times of Jesus, the
Messiah, 15]
The Gates of India by Sir Thomas Holditch
Sir Thomas Holditch in his The Gates of India says: But there
is one important people (of whom there is much more to be
said) who call themselves Banu Israel, who claim a descent
from Cush and Ham, who have adopted a strange mixture of
Mosaic Law in Ordinances in their moral code, who (some
sections at least) keep a feast which strongly accords with the
Passover, and for whom no one has yet been able to
suggest any other origin than the one they claim, and claim
with

determined

force,

and

these

people

are

the

overwhelming inhabitants of Afghanistan.Sir Thomas


177

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Holditch, The Gates of India, 49.


There are many additional references, recorded incidents,
manuscripts and artifacts related to the Hebraic history of the Pashtuns
for the dedicated objective researcher who seeks them out.
The Exiled and the Redeemed, 1957 Itzhak Ben-Zvi (2nd
President of Israel)
In his 1957 classic The Exiled and the Redeemed, Itzhak BenZvi, second President of Israel, writes that Hebrew migrations
into Afghanistan began, with a sprinkling of exiles from
Samaria who had been transplanted there by Shalmaneser,
King of Assyria (719 B.C.). From the recurrent references in
the Book of Esther to the one hundred and twenty seven
dominions of King Ahasuerus, the deduction is permissible
that eastern Afghanistan was among them. [The Exiled and
the Redeemed, 176]
Ben-Zvi continues, The Afghan tribes, among whom the
Jews have lived for generations, are Moslems who retain to
this day their amazing tradition about their descent from the
Ten Tribes. It is an ancient tradition, and one not without
some historical plausibility. A number of explorers, Jewish
and non-Jewish, who visited Afghanistan from time to time,
and students of Afghan affairs who probed into literary
sources, have referred to this tradition, which was also
discussed in several encyclopedias in European languages.
The fact that this tradition, and no other, has persisted among
these tribes is itself a weighty consideration. Nations normally
178

Chapter 6 of Book I

keep alive memories passed by word of mouth from


generation to generation, and much of their history is based
not on written records but on verbal tradition. This was
particularly so in the case of the nations and the communities
of the Levant. The people of the Arabian Peninsula, for
example, derived all their knowledge of an original pagan
cult, which they abandoned in favor of Islam, from such
verbal tradition. So did the people of Iran, formerly
worshipers of the religion of Zoroaster; the Turkic and
Mongol tribes, formerly Buddhists and Shamanists; and the
Syrians who abandoned Christianity in favor of Islam.
Therefore, if the Afghan tribes persistently adhere to the
tradition that they were once Hebrews and in course of time
embraced Islam, and there is not an alternative tradition also
existent among them, the matter certainly deserves careful
and critical examination. [Extract from the book The Exiled
and the Redeemed]
New York Times Magazine, 42, August 25, 2002
The claim of Afghans to be the Banu Israel (Children of Israel)
is not founded on oral tradition alone. It is supported by
ancient monuments, old inscriptions, manuscripts, and
historical works, many in the public domain, and many others
in private collections. Of recent report is the 12th century
Hebrew cemetery a mile and a half from the base of the Tower
of Jam in the middle of a very desolate region of Western
Afghanistan. [New York Times Magazine, 42, Aug. 25, 2002]
International Encyclopaedia of Islamic Dynasties
179

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Ancient tradition of Pashtun tribes is described in


International Encyclopaedia of Islamic Dynasties. It written
that there is a tribal tradition that the Pashtuns originated in
Israel in the days of King Saul, from whom they claim descent
through a son, Irmia (Jeremiah), and a grandson, Afghana,
from whom the name Afghanistan is derived, with it is
inhabitants called Afghans. Pashtuns / Pathans / Afghans
maintain that they grew great in Israel, where they were
favorites of Daud (David) and Sulaiman (Solomon); and
where the latter assigned them to guard the temple from the
assaults of jealous demons. To aid them in this task, Sulaiman
(Solomon), master of djinns and afreets, taught the Afghans /
Pashtuns / Pathans the language of hell. At this time there
appeared a wicked magician, Bukht-ud-Nasir (Nebuchadnezzar), who scattered the tribes of Israel and sent the
Afghans, as the most obstreperous, far to the east, to the land
of Sham or Syria. From there they migrated to the mountains
of Ghor in western Afghanistan, and settled down, adhering
to monotheism, although surrounded by countless idolaters
and polytheists. As the legend goes, in the time of
Muammad, an Afghan / Pashtun / Pathan, Qais or Kish,
visited Mecca and embraced Islam, receiving the name Abdul
Rasheed. He returned to Afghanistan to convert his people,
and all the Pashtuns / Pathans / Afghans are the progeny of
his two sons, Sarban and Ghurgusht, and daughter Bibi
Matto. [Ref: Singh, Nagendra K., ed., International
Encyclopaedia

of

Islamic

Dynasties,

Vol.

Publications Pvt. Ltd., New Delhi, 2000, p. 35.]


180

I,

Anmol

Chapter 6 of Book I

Three Names of the Same Race with Different Meanings


Another theory is that whenever people asked the Pathans / Pashtuns /
Afghans about their nationality, they replied in Hebrew phasq or
phasht. Phasq means to liberate, to make free, to split, while
phasht means to spread. The word Pashtun seems to have been
derived from this very word. (Ref: Imamuddin, op. cit., pp. 206-207)In
Hebrew, Pasht is the name of a deity and also of a city in Egypt. In the
Pashto language Pastu means an inner room with just one entrance,
which indicates that they might have migrated from Israel to their
present mountainous country and called themselves Pusht after a
village in Israel (Ref: Ibid., p. 207). Some believe that Pathans got their
name from Jonathans great-grandson Pithon.
Pathans, Pashtuns, Pakhtuns and Afghans are names which are
often used interchangeably. There is nothing wrong in this usage, but
each name has it is own meaning. Those who inhabit plains and
plateaus are entitled to the name Afghan, which has a far wider
connotation than just being a subject of the modern state of
Afghanistan, founded only in 1747. The northern highlanders call
themselves Pakhtuns, while the southern highlanders are known as
Pashtuns. The appellation Pathan is the Indian variant of Pakhtanah,
the plural of Pakhtun.
The Tribes of Israel (English) by Rabbi Eliyahu Avichail
The book The Tribes of Israel (English) by Rabbi Eliyahu
Avichail. Copyright 5750 by Amishav. This book is the result
of 25 years research of Rav Eliyahu Avichails research and
fieldwork regarding the descendants of the Ten Tribes exiled
181

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

from the Land of Israel 2,700 years ago.


More References of Western Scholars about the
Israeli origin of Pathans:
The Way of the Pathans, by James W. Spain, Oxford Univ.
Press, 1962, pp. 27-29.
New Light on Zion by Mr. Avraham Zonenshein.
Rabbi Eliyahu Avichail, Rechov Epstein, 3B, Jerusalem,
Israel 96555.
Websites References:
http://www.nationmaster.com/encyclopedia/Pathan
http://www.dangoor.com/74069.html
http://www.dangoor.com/74039.html
http://www.jewishvirtuallibrary.org/jsource/vjw/Afghanistan.html
http://www.kulanu.org/pathan/israeliteorigins.html
http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Bnai_Israel

182

Chapter 7

Some pathans are not from Banu Israel

There is no doubt that the Pathans that who belong to the family of
Kash / Qais are no doubt from the Banu Israel.
But there are some other tribes among Pathans who only speak
Pashto language but originally are not from Banu Israel.
When Banu Israel came to Khurasan they mixed with other races
living there before. Also some Iranian and Mongol origin people came
to live with the Banu Israel. For this reason there are some tribes who
speak Pashto but they are not from the Banu Israel like for example the
so called Pashtun tribe of Ghilzai which is originally Mongol but some
of them speak Pashto
These Pashto speaking tribes have no relation with the following
Quranic verse.
The Quran tells us that a Prophet always comes:
1. Among his own people, and
2. Speaks the language (culture) of his people.






014:004

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


( )

014:004
We sent not a messenger except (to teach) in the language of his
(own) people, in order to make (things) clear to them. Now
Allah leaves straying those whom He pleases and guides whom
He pleases: and He is Exalted in power, full of Wisdom. (14:04)
This means that Jesus X will join only those Pathans who are:
1. Muslims.
2. Have the culture and language of the Pathans (Muslim Banu
Israel).
3. And have Israeli origin like Prophet Eisa X.
Note: It should be noted that Prophet Eisa X will follow
Islam and will not bring a new religion.

184

B
BOOK II

MISCONCEPTIONS ABOUT
IMAM MAHDI X
AND PROPHET JESUS X
A QURAN AND ADTH VIEW





.
.


Chapter 1

Why misconceptions have appeared?


Because of people leaving references to
the Quran and adth

The prophecies about the End of Times are clearly told in the Quran
and adth. These authentic references of the Quran and adth are
very clear and easy to understand. It is for this reason, that the founders
of the four schools of thought53 did not find the need to explain these
adth. It is left for the Muslims to read these references and
understand for themselves as everything is defined in a transparent
manner.
It is a pity that people started following books which described
these signs without any reference to the Quran and adth. People
followed these views simply because they thought that some great
scholar has said these things.
Only references to the Quran and adth are acceptable
In the following adth it is clearly stated that only Islamic reference are
53. The four great scholars of Islam, namely: Imam Abu Hanfia, Imam Malik,
Imam Shafi and Imam Ahmad bin Hanbal.
189

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

acceptable, and no other references should be given importance.

. .480 :
( )



:


:

:




51










51


: :
480
190

Chapter 1 of Book II

Our Dear Prophet Muammad U was presented with a


writing that was written on the shoulder bone of an animal,
then our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: It is enough to
make a nation astray when they leave what their prophet
brought for them, and turn their attention to what other
prophets brought, or leave their book and turn their attention
to other books.
After that our Dear Prophet Muammad U recited these verses
from the Quran;





51
And is it not sufficient for them that We revealed to you the
Book which is recited to them? Indeed in that is a mercy and
reminder for a people who believe54
The following adth clearly tells us that it is very dangerous to
follow the books of scholars blindly without the reference to the Quran
and adth.





: .



. 469.

54. Sunan Darimi, adth 480.
191

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





: :
469
Ibrahim Teemi narrates that Ibn Masood (companion of our
Dear Prophet Muammad U) came to know that some people
were having some written material which they liked very
much. Ibn Masood went to them and destroyed that written
material and said that:
Nations before you were destroyed because they started
reading books of their scholars and left the Book of their Rabb
(Allah ,)55
Note: Abdullah Bin Masood was ordering people to follow
both the Quran and adth as he is a great narrator of adth.
He was stopping people only from reading texts that are NOT
from the Quran and adth.

55. Sunan Darimi, Volume 1, adth 469.


192

Chapter 1 of Book II





.

















:
193

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

476 :
Amr bin Qais narrates that: I went with my father in a form
of delegation to Yazid (son of Khalifa Muawiya). This was the
time when Khalifa Muawiya died and we went to mourn his
father death and also congratulate him on his caliphate. At
that time we saw a person saying these words in a mosque:
O people, beware that it is one of the signs of the Judgement
day, that bad people will be elevated, and good people will be
placed at lower positions.
Beware that that it is one of the sigs of the Judgement day,
that there will be more speech and less practical deeds.
Beware that it is one of the sigs of the Judgement day that
people will read (or follow) Al-Muthnat and there will be no
person who will remove these Al-Muthnat.
People asked: What are Al-Muthnat?
He said: Al-Muthnat means anything that is written apart
from the Quran (and adth). It is compulsory for you that
you follow the Quran (and adth) as this will bring you
guidance, and through this you will be rewarded, and will be
judged (on Judgement Day).
The narrator says that this person was Abdullah bin Umar \
(companion of our Dear Prophet Muammad U).56
Note: Again it should be strictly noted that Abdullah Bin
56. Sunan Darimi, Volume 1, adth number 476.
194

Chapter 1 of Book II

Umar \ is definitely ordering people to follow both the


Quran and adth as he himself is a great narrator of adth
He is stopping people only from texts that are NOT from the
Quran and adth.
The following adth clearly tells us that we can only accept those
Islamic books by scholars who are writing with reference to the Quran
and adth (and not their own views).





.
:










195

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

477 : :
Marra Hadmani narrates that Abu Qarra Kindi brought some
writings from Shaam (Syria) and presented this writing in
front of Abdullah bin Masood \ (companion of our Dear
Prophet Muammad U).
Abdullah bin Masood \ brought water and washed away all
these writings and said that:
People before you were destroyed because they started
following books like these, and left the book that was revealed
to them from Allah ,.
Hussain, the narrator says that if in that piece of writing, there
were something related to the Quran and adth (tradition
of our Dear Prophet Muammad U then Abdullah bin
Masood \ would never have removed those writings. There
was definitely something written related to the People of the
Book (i.e.: Jews and Christians).57

57. Sunan Darimi, Vol. 1, adth number 477.


196

Chapter 2

Misconception no 1:
The majority of the arabs will join
the Mahdi X and Prophet Eisa X

Many people think that in the End of Times the Arabs will be the first
to join the Mahdi X, and that the majority of the Arabs will be in Army
of the Mahdi X, as written in some books like in the famous book
Asar-e-Qiyamat by Shah Rafiuddin at page 21. (Scan is given below
in Urdu language).

Translation:
It is told that after the appearance of the Mahdi X, the
Muslim Armies of Madinah will join the Mahdi in Makkah.
197

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

The Saints of Syria, Iraq, and Yemen will join the Mahdi X.
Countless Arab Muslims will join Imam Mahdis army
straight away. The Mahdi X will take out the treasure of
Kaba and distribute it amongst the Muslims.
Most of this is totally wrong because of the following points from
various authentic adth.
1. The Mahdi X will not be living in an Arab area.
2. The Mahdi X does not have the appearance of the Arabs.
3. Very few Arabs will join Imam Mahdi X.
4. Arabs will attack Imam Mahdi X soon after his appearance.
5. Imam Mahdis army will be attacked three times by the Arabs.
6. An Arab tribe will be made slaves by Imam Mahdi X.
7. The rule of the Quraish will be over by then.
8. Forty saints (Abdal) of Syria and forty saints (Asaeb) of Iraq
will join Imam Mahdi (AS) after the 3rd attack.
Now please check all the adth for above these points and
decide for yourself.
1. The Mahdi X will not be living in an Arab area.
Imam Mahdi X is from the Sadaat / Syeds family (i.e. the family of
Prophet Muammad U). But, Sadaats are spread all over the world
adopting different cultures and languages. You will find Sadaat families
speaking Persian, Turkish, Sindhi, Pashto, Urdu, etc., etc. In the same
way Imam Mahdi X will be a Sadaat living among the Muslim Banu
198

Chapter 2 of Book II

Israel of Khurasan as the following adth clearly tells us.





.
Thoban \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet Muammad U)
reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: When
you see that black flags have appeared from Khurasan, go to
(join) them even if you have to walk over ICE on your knees,
as the Khalifa of Allah MAHDI \, will be among them. (This
adth is a (Most Authentic) according to the conditions
of a Bukhari and a Muslim).58

58. Mustadrak Hakim, adth 8531.


199

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





1599 : :
Abu Huraira \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet
Muammad U) reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad
U said: Black flags will appear from the Khurasan, nothing
will stop them until they will be placed at Elya (The Holy Land
of Jerusalem).59



(:)

:

(:)
Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said that: When you hear
the news of black flags coming from the Khurasan, then, you
must join them even if you have to crawl over ice (to reach

59. Masnad Ahmad, Volume 4, adth 1599.


200

Chapter 2 of Book II

them).60
The above three adth are Authentic.
All the above three adth are a adth. The famous adth Scholar
Ali Mutaqqi says about the above adth (of Masnad Ahmad) that these
are authentic and further says in the beginning of his book that:


( , . , , )


) .
( , . , ,
Translation: Muaddth Ali Muttaqi said that all the adth
of Masnad Ahmad are Maqbool,61 even if it is Daif, 62it is
almost equal to Hasan63 adth. (Ref: Muntakhab Kanzaul

60 Masnad Ahmad 5:277.Also in Sunan Ibn Majah


61. Acceptable (Maqbool)The adth that is found to be reported by truthful
and acceptable narrators. It is ruling is that it is obligatory to accept and act
upon it.
62. Daif, ( ),
is the categorization of a adth as weak. Ibn Hajar described

the cause of a adth being classified as weak as either due to discontinuity in


the chain of narrators or due to some criticism of a narrator.
63. Hasan, ( ),
linguistically means good and there exist somewhat

convergent technical definitions, however, in general, it expresses the


201

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Amal, Ali Hamish, page 8, Vol. 1).


Also another famous adth Scholar, Ibn Hajar, said the same
thing;






( )


Translation: The famous scholar of adth, Hafiz Ibn Hajar
also accepted the same rule about Masnad Ahmad, and said
that there is no Daif adth in Masnad Ahmad. Also Ibn
Hajar did not accept the ruling of Ibn Jauzi considering some
of the adth of Masnad Ahmad as Daif. In fact, Ibn Hajar
wrote a book called Al-Qaul-ul-Masdood in which he
proved the claim of Ibn Jauzi wrong and proved that even
these adth were not Daif. (Reference from Muntakhib
Kanzul Amal, Ali Hamish, page 8-9, Volume 1).64

categorization of a adths authenticity as acceptable for use as a religious


evidence, however, not established to the extent of a a adth.
64. Page 68 and 75 of the book, Aqeedah Zahur-e-Mahdi by Dr. Mufti Nizamud-din Shamzai.
202

Chapter 2 of Book II

Remember Makkah and Madinah are international cities


and millions of Muslims all over the world are present
there. The appearance of Mahdi in Kaba at Makkah doesnt
mean that he is an Arabic person.
2. The Mahdi X does not have the appearance of the Arabs.
Please check this fact from the following adth:


( )
:




:

:





:
:









187 .7367 : ..






( )
203

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X



187 .7367 : .
Narrated Hazrat Umama \ reported Rasulullah U said: You
and the Romans (Christians) will have four peace treaties. The
fourth peace would be at the hand of a person who would be
from the Al-e-Harqul (familyof Roman King Harqul). This
peace treaty would be for seven years. Rasulullah U was asked
who would be the Imam of the Muslims at that time.
Rasulullah U said: That person would be from my family, his
age would be 40 years, his face would be bright as a start, and
a black spot would be on his right cheek. He would be
wearing two Qutwani Shawls. He will appear exactly as a
person from Banu Israel. He will rule for 20 years and will
conquer the cities of the Mushrikeen (Idolaters).65
We have two results from the above adth.
1. Imam Mahdi X will be living among Banu Israel.
2. Imam Mahdi X wears the clothes of Banu Israel.
Can the Banu Isaac in above adth points towards the nonMuslims?
This is not possible as the Quran has told us that misguided persons are
not related to the Prophets of Allah, as we can see in the following verse

65. Tabarani (Majam-al-Kabeer), Book 187, adth number 7367.


204

Chapter 2 of Book II

where the misguided son of Prophet Noah X is considered out of the


family of Prophet Noah X.








(11:46)

()

()
()
(11:46)
(Allah) said: O Noah, in fact, he (Noahs son) is not a part of
your family. Indeed, he is (a man of) bad deeds. So do not ask
Me something of which you have no knowledge. I exhort you
not to be among the ignorant. (11:46)

205

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

3. Very few Arabs will join Imam Mahdi X.

: : .
:

! : .
206

Chapter 2 of Book II

.





: --

Umm Sharik reported: I heard Allahs Messenger U as saying:


The people would run away from the Dajjal seeking shelter
in the mountains. She said: Where would be the Arabs then
in that day? He said: They would be very few.66
Also the following adth tells us that same thing; that Arabs will
be very few fighting the Dajjal:


:
. :
. : :
. : :

66. a Muslim, adth 2896, page 1904,Volume 3.


207

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X









4444 : : -

Narrated from Sayyidna Ayesha Siddiqah \. Once the
(future) difficulties at the time of the Dajjals appearance,
were mentioned. People asked: What will be the best type of
wealth at that time? our Dear Prophet Muammad U
replied: That strong slave who can give water to his master.
As far as food is concerned, there will be no food. People
asked: What would be the food of Muslims? Our Dear
Prophet Muammad U said: (The food will be) Tasbh
(Subhan Allah), and Takbir (Allahu Akbar), and Tamhd
(Alhamdulillah). I asked, Where would be the Arabs at that
time? Our Dear Prophet Muammad U replied,At that
time, the Arabs would be very few (Qaleel).67

67. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 9, adth 4444.


208

Chapter 2 of Book II

4. Arabs will attack Imam Mahdi X soon after his appearance.


The first attack on Imam Mahdi X will by Arab Rulers.








----
) 8395 ( )
136(

:


)
(
()
8395 ( )
136( )
209

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Narrated by Hazrat Abu Huraira \ from Hazrat Abu Qatada


\: our Dear Prophet said: People will be given allegiance
(baya) to a person (i.e. Mahdi) between the Ruken (Hajr-eAswad) and Mukam (Mukam-e-Ibrahim), and no one else
but the same people who are related to that place (citizens of
Makkah) will destroy the respect of Kaabah (as they will
attack Mahdi in the Kaabah where fighting is forbidden), and
when they will declare it Halal, then do not ask about the
killing of the ARABS (there will be a mass killing of Arabs).
Then Ethiopians (Africans) will come and they will desolate
it in such a way that it would never be a habitat, and these will
be the people who will take out it is treasure. (Authentic
adth according to the standards of a Bukhari and a
Muslim).68
The Rulers of Arabia will suffer a massive killing by hands of Mahdis
followers from the east

68 Mustadrak Hakim, adth 8385 Kitab-al-Fitan.Also in Masnaf Ibn Sheeba


Kitab-al-Fitan
210

Chapter 2 of Book II






( )






()
Thawban \ reported that our Dear Prophet U said: Three
people will fight for your treasure (and get killed). All three of
them will be sons of a ruler but none of them will get the
treasure. Then black flags will appear from the east and will
kill you as no one (in history) has killed you before. Then our
Dear Prophet said something that I didnt remember. Then
again our Dear Prophet said: If you see him, then give him
your allegiance, even if you have to crawl over ice, because he
is the Khalifa of Allah, the Mahdi X.
This adth is most authentic (a) according to the conditions
of a Bukhari and a Muslim.69
69. Ibn Majah and also Hakim Mustadrak.
211

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

5. Imam Mahdis army will be attacked three times by the Arabs.


We already have mentioned the first attack of Arabs on the Mahdi X
when he first appears in the Masjid Haram. Now we check the 2nd and
3rd attacks.
The 2nd attack on Mahdi will be by the Arab army of Syria, and this
army will be devoured by the Earth in the outskirts of the city of
Madinah, in the Arabian Peninsula.








.








212

Chapter 2 of Book II




.2740. : :
2
Harith b Abi Rabia and Abdullah b. Safwan \ both went to
Umm Salama, the Mother of the Faithful, and they asked her
about the army which would be sunk in the earth, and this
relates to the time when Ibn Zubair (was the governor of
Mecca). She reported that Allahs Messenger U had said that:
A seeker of refuge would seek refuge in the Sacred House,
and an army would be sent to him (in order to kill him), and
when it would enter a plain ground, it would be made to sink.
I said: Allahs Messenger, what about who was forced to join
them?? Thereupon he said: He would be made to sink along
with them but he would be raised on the Day of Resurrection
on the basis of his intention. Abu Jafar said: This plain
ground means the plain ground of Medina.70






70. a Muslim, Vol. 3, adth 2740.
213

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X






-



!





!




: :
6143
214

Chapter 2 of Book II

Narrated by the Mother of the faithful, Hazrat Umm Salma \


that once our Dearest Prophet Muammad U was sleeping in
my home, suddenly he U woke and said Inna Lillah I
asked: May my mother and father be sacrificed for you
Ya Rasul Allah U what is it? Why you are saying Inna Lillah
Our Dearest Prophet Muammad U said: An army from
my Ummah (nation) will come from Shaam (Syria) to capture
a person in Baitullah (Kaba). Allah Subhana hu will protect
that person from this army, and when they will reach from
ZUL-KHALIFA to MAQAM BAIDA, then they will all be
swallowed by the earth, and will rise from different places on
Judgement Day. I asked: Why is it that they will be
swallowed on the earth at same place but will rise at different
places (on Judgement day)? our Dearest Prophet said three
times that: some of the people will be taken in this army by
force.71
The 3rd attack on Imam Mahdi X will be by an Arab
from the Quraish.

71. Masnad Ahmad, adth 6143.


215

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X









( )







6581 : :
216

Chapter 2 of Book II

Narrated by Umm Salma \ that our Dearest Prophet


Muammad U said that: A disagreement will occur after the
death of a Khalifa (note here Khalifa doesnot necessarily
meana just Khalifa of Islam. It can mean a king or ruler of
any type), then a person will flee from Madinah to Makkah.
Some of the people in Makkah will come to him and take him
out against his will, and will give allegiance (bayah) to him
between Hajar Aswad (black stone) and Maqam Ibrahim.
Then an army from Sham (Syria) will come to attack to him,
but will be devoured by earth at the place of BAIDAH. When
people will see this, then the Abdal of Sham (Syria) and Asaeb
of Iraq (Abdal and Asaeb is a level of pious people from
Shaam and Iraq respectively, and their number is 40
according to other narrations) will come and give allegiance
(bayah) of him. Then a person from Quraish will come
forward, whose maternal family will be from Banu Kulaib (a
branch of Banu Tamim). That person in Makkah (Imam
Mahdi X) will send an army towards that Qureshi and will
overcome him. This battle will be called the BATH KULAIB
and a person is at great loss if he is not present at the
distribution of the booty of that Ghazwa (battle). He will
distribute the riches and act upon the Sunnah of Prophet
Muammad U, and Islam will put it is neck on the earth (i.e.:
Islam will spread) and he will rule for 9 years on earth.72

72. Masnad Ahmad, adth 6581.


217

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

6. An Arab tribe will be made slaves by Imam Mahdi X.

( )8402 :








: :



.
.



)
(

( )
( )
)-
8329
Narrated by Abu Huraira \ that our Dear Prophet
Muammad U said that: Disappointed will be the one who
does not receive the booty of the Kalb tribe (direct branch of
the famous Arab tribe of Banu Tamim), even if it is a single
Aqal (a small unit). I swear by the Name of the One who holds
my life, no doubt the women of Kulaib will be sold (as slaves)
in the way to Damascus until one of the women will be

218

Chapter 2 of Book II

returned back because of a broken ankle.73


Previously, in one adth, it has been told that the Arabs cannot be
made slaves, but in the above authentic adth, permission is given to
Muslims to make slaves of the Arabs. This permission is given in the
End of Times.
Banu Kulaib are Banu Tamim
Banu Kulaib are direct descendants of Banu Tamim as we can see in the
family background of Ibn Jarir (one of the greatest and most celebrated
Muslim poets). It stated:
Abu Hazra Jarir Ibn Atiya ibn Khudaifa (surnamed alkhatafa) Ibn Badr Ibn Salama Ibn Auf Ibn Kulaib Ibn
Yarbu Ibn Hanzala Ibn Malik Ibn Zaid Manat Ibn Tamim
Ibn Murr at-Tamimi (descended from Tamim).74
7. The rule of the Quraish will be over by then.




Its a part of a Long adth.....
.....

73. Mustadrak Hakim, Chapter of Fitan wa Malahim, adth 8329.
74. Ibn Khallikans biographical dictionary by Ibn Khallikan, page 294.
219

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X









.......
...Its a part of a Long adth



Its a part of a .......
...Long adth

(

)


220

Chapter 2 of Book II



( )







)
(


()
)
: continued ... (
958 :
Abu Umamah al-Bahili \ said: The Prophet U delivered a
speech to us, most of which dealt with the Dajjal and warned
us against him It is a part of a Long adth
The Prophet U said: Jesus X son of Mary will be a just
administrator, and leader of my Ummah. He will break the
221

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

cross, kill the pigs, and abolish the Jizyah (tax on nonMuslims). He will not collect the Sadaqah, so he will not
collect sheep and camels. Mutual enmity and hatred will
disappear. Every harmful animal will be made harmless, so
that a small boy will be able to put his hand into a snakes
mouth without being harmed, a small girl will be able to make
a lion run away from her, and a wolf will go among sheep as
if he were a sheepdog. The earth will be filled with peace as a
container is filled with water. People will be in complete
agreement, and only Allah will be worshipped. Wars will
cease, and the authority ofQuraysh will be taken away. The
earth will be like a silver basin, and will produce fruits so
abundantly long adth that continues 75
Note: You can find the completete text of this adth in the
end of this collection.
Banu Israeli Prophet Eisa X will rule

2109







75. Sunan Ibn Majah, adth 958.


222

Chapter 2 of Book II




.
2109 :
Sayyidina Abu Huraira \ reported that the Prophet U said:
By Him in Whose hand is my soul, Ibn Maryam (Eisa X)
will soon descend among you and He will rule justly. He will
break the cross, kill swine and abolish the jizyah, and wealth
will flow to such abundance that no one will take it.76
The Quran explains why the rule of the Quraish will be over.






. (14:04 )

( )

(14:04)
We sent not a messenger except (to teach) in the language of his
76. a Bkhari, adth 2109. Also Masnad Ahmad, 10944.
223

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

(own) people, in order to make (things) clear to them. (14:4)


This tells us two things:
1. A Prophet comes amongst his own nation, and
2. He peaks their own language.
Like our Dear Prophet Muammad U is an Arab, and he came
amongst the Arabs, and speaks Arabic, in the same manner it was with
all Prophets before.
Similarly when Banu Israeli Prophet Sayyidna Eisa X will come,
in the beginning, his own nation will be around him, i.e.: Muslim Banu
Israel.
Important Note: Prophet Eisa X will follow Islam and will
not bring a new religion. Therefore he will not come among
the non-Muslim Banu Israel, i.e.: the Jews.
This adth also explains why the Rule of the Quraish will be over.








. .
224

Chapter 2 of Book II




!




)
! ! (





2409 : :
Abdullah Bin Masood \ narrates that once we, the people
from the tribe of Quraish, were sitting in the company of our
Dear Prophet Muammad U, and there was no one from any
other tribe.
By the name of Allah, I have never seen any face among men
more beautiful than the face of our Dear Prophet Muammad
U. People started talking about ladies. Our Dear Prophet
225

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Muammad U joined them in their talk. I stood in front of


our Dear Prophet Muammad U. Our Dear Prophet
Muammad U said Tashahud (Kalima) and then said:
O people of Quraish (tribe), you deserve to be rulers with the
condition that you do not disobey Allah ,. When you start
disobeying Allah , then Allah , will appoint a person upon
you who will peel you off like the branch of this tree.
At that time our Dear Prophet Muammad U had a branch
of tree in his hand. Our Dear Prophet Muammad U peeled
it and it appeared shining white from inside.77
More adth about the rule of non-Arabs



-



1193 : :
Narrated by Abu Huraira \ that our Dear Prophet
Muammad U said that: The cycle of day and night will not
be over until a person from the Mawali (non-Arabs) called

77. Masnad Ahmed, Volume 2, adth number 2409.


226

Chapter 2 of Book II

JHEH-JAH will become the ruler (of the world).78


Important Note: The word Mawali or mawl (Arabic: )
is a term in Classical Arabic used to address non-Arab
Muslims.79
8. Forty saints (Abdal) of Syria and forty saints (Asaeb) of Iraq will
join Imam Mahdi X after the 3rd attack.
We have already read this adth before. I will paste only the translation
again.
Narrated by Umm Salma \ that our Dearest Prophet
Muammad U said: A disagreement will occur after the
death of a Khalifa (note here Khalifa does not necessarily
mean a just Khalifa of Islam .It can mean a king or a ruler),
then a person (Imam Mahdi X) will flee from Madinah to
Makkah. Some of the people in Makkah will come to him and
take him out against his will and will give allegiance (bayah)
to him between Hajar Aswad (black stone) and Maqam
Ibrahim. Then an army from Sham (Syria) will come to attack
him but will be devoured by the earth at the place of BAIDAH.
When people will see this, then the Abdal of Sham (Syria) and
the Asaeb of Iraq (Abdal and Asaeb is a level of pious people
from Shaam and Iraq respectively and their number is 40
78. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 4, adth 1193.
79 Princeton University webpage
http://www.princeton.edu/~batke/itl/denise/mawali.htm
and also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mawali
227

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

according to other narrations) will come and give allegiance


(bayah) to him. Then a person from Quraish will come
forward, whose maternal family will be from Banu Kulaib (a
branch of Banu Tamim). That person in Makkah will send an
army towards that Qureshi and will overcome him. This
battle will be called the BATH KULAIB and a person is at
great loss if he is not present at the distribution of the booty
of that Ghazwa (battle). He will distribute the riches and act
upon the Sunnah of our Prophet Muammad U, and Islam
will put it is neck on the earth (i.e.: Islam will spread) and he
will rule for 9 years on earth.80

80 Masnad Ahmad, adth 6581.


228

Chapter 3

Misconception No 1:
Imam Mahdi X will remain as Kaliph
even after the arrival of Prophet Eisa X

Some people believe that only Imam Mahdi X will lead Muslims even
after the arrival of Prophet Eisa X. Some writers have gone far to this
extent that they wrote that purpose of Prophet Eisa X is only the killing
of the Dajjal. Astagfirullah. It is written in Asar-e- Qiyamat by Shah
Rafiuddin in page 31 (scan is given in Urdu language).

229

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Translation: It is written that: After the prayers Imam


Mahdi X will ask Prophet Eisa X: O Prophet, you may take
control of the army and lead them as you like. Prophet Eisa
X will reply, No you keep leading the army, I am here ONLY
to kill the Dajjal.
It is again claimed by the writer that this adth is taken from a
Muslim. You can check the original adth of a Muslim already
mentioned before that the adth is entirely different. There is not a
single word like this in the adth of a Muslim as the writer claims.
The statement that Imam Mahdi X will become the Leader of
Prophet Eisa X is totally wrong.
There is not a single adth that tells us that Prophet Eisa X will not
take the leadership of Muslims, or that he will work under Imam Mahdi
X!
The fact is that:
After the arrival of Prophet Eisa X, Imam Mahdi X will come
under the Kalifate of Prophet Eisa X as the following adth tells.
This adth clearly tells us that the rule of Quraish will be over.
We know that Imam Mahdi X is from Quraish and from Khurasan.




... It is a part of a Long adth...

230

Chapter 3 of Book II










It .......
...is a part of a Long adth



It is a part of a ...
... Long adth

(

)

231

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X




( )







)
(


()
)
: continued ...

(
958 :

Abu Umamah al-Bahili said: The Prophet U delivered a


speech to us, most of which dealt with the Dajjal and warned
us against him this a part of a Long adth then the
Prophet U said: Jesus X son of Mary will be a just
232

Chapter 3 of Book II

administrator and leader of my Ummah. He will break the


cross, kill the pigs, and abolish the Jizyah (tax on nonMuslims). He will not collect the Sadaqah, so he will not
collect sheep and camels. Mutual enmity and hatred will
disappear. Every harmful animal will be made harmless, so
that a small boy will be able to put his hand into a snakes
mouth without being harmed, a small girl will be able to make
a lion run away from her, and a wolf will go among sheep as
if he were a sheepdog. The earth will be filled with peace as a
container is filled with water. People will be in complete
agreement, and only Allah will be worshipped. Wars will
cease, and the authority ofQuraysh will be taken away. The
earth will be like a silver basin, and will produce fruits so
abundantly long adth continues.81
More adth telling us about the rule of Prophet Isa X
The following adth tells us about that Prophet Eisa X will be the
Imam (ruler) of Muslims:




.


81. Sunan Ibn Majah, adth 958.
233

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

393 : :
10 13
It is narrated on the authority of Abu Huraira \, that he heard
the Messenger of Allah U as saying: What would you do
when the son of Mary would descend and lead you?82
Another adth telling us about the Rule of Prophet Eisa X:

82. a Muslim,Vol. 3, adth 393.

234

Chapter 3 of Book II

390 : :
10 13
The same adth is transmitted from Zuhri with the same chain of
transmission. But in the tradition narrated by Ibn Uyaina the words
are: impartial leader and just judge and in the tradition narrated by
Yunus: the judge judging with justice and impartial leader are not
mentioned. And in the adth narrated by Salih like the one transmitted
by Laith the words are: impartial judge. And in the adth transmitted
by Ziyad the words are: Till one sajda is better than the world and what
it contains. Then Abu Huraira \ used to say: recite if you like: Not
one of the People of the Book will fail to believe in him before his death.83

83. a Muslim,Vol. 1, adth 390.


235

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Prophet Isa (Jesus X) will be the ruler who will distribute riches
among the people.





: .






391 : :
It is narrated on the authority of Abu Huraira \ that the
Messenger or Allah U observed: I swear by Allah , that the
son of Mary will certainly descend as a just judge and he
would definitely break the cross, and kill swine and abolish
Jizya, and would leave the young she-camel and no one would
endeavor to (collect Zakat on it). Spite, mutual hatred, and
jealousy against one another will certainly disappear, and
236

Chapter 3 of Book II

when he summons people to accept wealth, not even one


would come to take it.84




:
2332 :
Narrated Abu Huraira \: Allahs Apostle U said: The Hour
will not be established until the son of Mary (i.e.: Jesus X)
descends amongst you as a just ruler, he will break the cross,
kill the pigs, and abolish the Jizya tax. Money will be in
abundance so that nobody will accept it (as charitable gifts).85

84. a Muslim, Vol. 1, adth 391.


85. a Bkhari,Vol. 1, adth 2332.
237

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


)
: (

958 :

It was narrated from Abu Huraira \ that the Prophet said:


The Hour will not begin until Eisa bin Maryam comes down
as a just judge and a just ruler. He will break the cross, kill the
pigs and abolish the Jizyah, and wealth will become so
abundant that no one will accept it.86

86. Sunan Ibn Majah,Vol. 3, adth 958.


238

Chapter 3 of Book II




: . .

117 :

Sayyidina Abu Huraira \ reported that the Prophet said: By


Him in Whose hand is my soul, Ibn Maryam will soon
descend among you as a just judge. He will break the cross,
kill swine and abolish the jizyah, and wealth will flow to such
abundance that no one will take it.87

87. Ahmed 10944; Bkhari 2222; Muslim 155; Ibn Majah 4078.
239

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

10 13





)

(



679 : :

Narrated Abu Huraira \: Allahs Apostle said: By Him in


Whose Hands my soul is, surely (Jesus X) the son of Mary
will soon descend amongst you and will judge mankind justly
(i.e.: he will be a Just ruler); he will break the Cross and kill
the pigs and there will be no Jizya (i.e.: taxation taken from
non-Muslims). Money will be in abundance so that nobody
will accept it, and a single prostration to Allah (in prayer) will
be better than the whole world and whatever is in it. Abu
Huraira \ added If you wish, you can recite (this verse of the
Holy Book): And there is none of the people of the Scriptures
(Jews and Christians) But must believe in him (i.e.: Jesus X as
240

Chapter 3 of Book II

an Apostle of Allah and a human being) before his death. And


on the Day of Judgment He will be a witness against them. 88
What does the word leader amongst you means
as stated in some adth

88. a Bkhari,Vol. 2, adth 979.


241

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

394 : : (
10 13

It is narrated on the authority of Abu Huraira \ that the


Messenger of Allah U observed: What would you do when
the son of Mary would descend amongst you and would lead
you as one amongst you? Ibn Abi Dhib on the authority of
Abu Huraira \ narrated: Your leader amongst you. Ibn Abi
Dhib said: Do you know what the words:He would lead as
one amongst you mean? I said: Explain these to me. He
said: He would lead you according to the Book of your Lord
(hallowed be He and most exalted) and the Sunnah of your
Apostle U.89
There can never be two Caliphs of Islam
Also, the following adth tells us that there cannot be two Caliphs:

89. a Muslim,Vol. 3, adth 394.


242

Chapter 3 of Book II

302 : :
4
It has been narrated on the authority of Aba SaEid Al Khudri
\ that the Messenger of Allah U said: When oath of
allegiance has been taken for two caliphs, kill the one for
whom the oath was taken later (second).90
Prophet Isa will lead the first prayer of Muslims after arrival?

5161 : .

( )


:





:

:










90. adth 302, a Muslim, Vol. 3.
243

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X




.
http://www.iid-alraid.de.

244

Chapter 3 of Book II


2778 : :
Abu Huraira \ reported that Allahs Messenger U as saying:
The Last Hour would not come until the Romans would land
at al-Amaq or in Dabiq. An army consisting of the best
(soldiers) of the people of the earth at that time will come
from Medina (to counteract them). When they will arrange
themselves in ranks, the Romans would say: Do not stand
between us and those (Muslims) who took prisoners from
amongst us. Let us fight with them; and the Muslims would
say: Nay, by Allah, we would never get aside from you and
from our brethren that you may fight them. They will then
fight and a third (part) of the army would run away, whom
Allah will never forgive. A third (part of the army) which
would be constituted of excellent martyrs in Allahs eye,
would be killed and the third who would never be put to trial
would win and they would be conquerors of Constantinople.
And as they would be busy in distributing the spoils of war
(amongst themselves) after hanging their swords by the olive
trees, the Satan would cry: The Dajjal has taken your place
among your family. They would then come out, but it would
be of no avail. And when they would come to Syria, he would
245

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

come out while they would be still preparing themselves for


battle drawing up the ranks. Certainly, the time of prayer shall
come and then Jesus X son of Mary would descend and
would lead them in prayer. When the enemy of Allah would
see him, it would (disappear) just as the salt dissolves itself in
water and if he (Jesus X) were not to confront them at all,
even then it would dissolve completely, but Allah would kill
them by his hand and he would show them their blood on his
lance (the lance of Jesus X Christ).91
Meaning of some adth telling that Imam Mahdi X will lead
prayer?
We also have adth telling us that Imam Mahdi X will lead at least
one prayer at the time of Prophet Isas X arrival.
This discussion is given in detail in chapter 4 of this book. Briefly
it should be known that even our Dear Prophet Muammad U prayed
obligatory prayers while they were lead by two companions, i.e.:: Abu
Bakar Siddik, and Abdur Rehman bin Awf. But, it does not mean at all
that the companions became the Caliphs in the presence of the Prophet.
(Please check chapter 4 for detail)
Fabricated adth telling us about seven (7) years of rule
of Imam Mahdi X



91. a Muslim, adth 5161. http://www.iid-alraid.de.
246

Chapter 3 of Book II




892 : : .
Narrated Abu Saeid Al Khudri \: The Prophet said: The
Mahdi will be of my stock, and will have a broad forehead a
prominent nose. He will fill the earth will equity and justice
as it was filled with oppression and tyranny, and he will rule
for seven years.92
This adth is not authentic and can be checked at
http://library.islamweb.net/adth/display_hbook.php?bk_no=184an
dhid=3738andpid=116693
Authentic adth about the seven (7) years of rule
of Prophet Isa X
Prophet Isa will spend seven (7) years as Kalifah of Islam in this world
till he is 40 years as proved by the following two adth.
Note: At his arrival he will be 33 years old.

92. Sunan Abu Dawud, Vol. 3, adth 892.


247

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

( )
:

:
































.


( )


248

Chapter 3 of Book II

930 : : .
Narrated Abu Hurayrah \: The Prophet said: There is no
prophet between me and him, that is, Jesus X. He will
descent (to the earth). When you see him, recognise him: a
man of medium height, reddish fair, wearing two light yellow
garments, looking as if drops were falling down from his head
though it will not be wet. He will fight the people for the cause
of Islam. He will break the cross, kill swine, and abolish jizyah.
Allah will perish all religions except Islam. He will destroy the
Antichrist and will live on the earth for forty years and then
he will die. The Muslims will pray over him.93

93. Sunan Abu Dawud,Vol. 3, adth 930.


249

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X




















250

Chapter 3 of Book II

2881 : :

Abdullah b. Amr \ reported that a person came to him and


said: What is this adth that you narrate that the Last Hour
would come at such and such time? Thereupon he said:
Hallowed be Allah, there is no god but Allah (or the words to
the same effect). I have decided that I would not narrate
anything to anyone now. I had only said that you would see
after some time an important event that the (sacred) House
(Kaba) would be burnt and it would happen and definitely
happen. He then reported that Allahs Messenger U said: The
Dajjal would appear in my Ummah and he would stay (in the
world) for fortyI cannot say whether he meant forty days,
forty months or forty years. And Allah would then send Jesus
X son of Mary who would resemble Urwa b Masud \. He
(Jesus X Christ) would chase him and kill him. Then people
would live for seven years that there would be no rancour
between two persons. Then Allah would send cold wind from
the side of Syria that none would survive upon the earth
having a speck of good in him or faith in him but he would
die, so much so that even if some amongst you were to enter
251

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

the innermost part of the mountain, this wind would reach


that place also and that would cause his death. I heard Allahs
Messenger U as saying: Only the wicked people would survive
and they would be as careless as birds with the charactertistics
of beasts. They would never appreciate the good nor condemn
evil. Then the Satan would come to them in human form and
would say: Dont you respond? And they would say: What do
you order us? And he would command them to worship the
idols but, in spite of this, they would have abundance of
sustenance and lead comfortable lives. Then the trumpet
would be blown and no one would hear that but he would
bend his neck to one side and raise it from the other side and
the first one to hear that trumpet would be the person who
would be busy in setting right the tank meant for providing
water to the camels. He would swoon and the other people
would also swoon, then Allah would send or He would cause
to send rain which would be like dew and there would grow
out of it the bodies of the people. Then the second trumpet
would be blown and they would stand up and begin to look
(around). Then it would be said: O people, go to your Lord,
and make them stand there. And they would be questioned.
Then it would be said: Bring out a group (out of them) for the
Hell-Fire. And then it would be asked: How much? It would
be said: Nine hundred and ninty-nine out of one thousand for
the Hell-Fire and that would be the day which would make
the children old because of it is terror and that would be the
day about which it has been said: On the day when the shank
252

Chapter 3 of Book II

would be uncovered (lxviii. 42).94


Mahdi will rule only in the Arabian Peninsula

94. a Muslim,Vol. 3, adth 2881.


253

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X







: :
889
Narrated Abdullah Ibn Masud \: The Prophet U said: If
only one day of this world remained. Allah would lengthen
that day (according to the version of Zaeidah), till He raised
up in it a man who belongs to me or to my family whose
fathers name is the same as my fathers, who will fill the earth
with equity and justice as it has been filled with oppression
and tyranny (according to the version of Fitr). Sufyans
version says: The world will not pass away before the Arabs
are ruled by a man of my family whose name will be the same
as mine.95

95. Sunan Abu Dawud, Book 36, Number 4269


254

Chapter 3 of Book II

Conclusion
After the arrival of Prophet Isa X, the rule of Muslims will be handed
over to Prophet Isa X.
Imam Mahdi (AS) will lead the Muslims in the Arabian Peninsula
only before the arrival of Prophet Isa (AS).

255

Chapter 4

Misconception no 3:
The purpose of the arrival of Prophet Eisa X
is only to kill the dajjal

This is also taken from the book Asar-e-Qiyamat by Shah Rafiuddin,


in page 31 (scan is given in Urdu below).

Translation: Prophet Eisa X will say: No you (Imam Mahdi


X) keep leading the Muslim Army. I am here ONLY to kill
the Dajjal (a Muslim).
There not a single adth in a Muslim, or in any other books of
adth, that tell us that Prophet Eisa X will arrive ONLY to kill
the Dajjal
Prophet Eisa X will not arrive ONLY to kill the Dajjal but he will have
the following important tasks:

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

1. Become the Kalifah of Muslims and the whole world.


2. Lead the Muslims Army.
3. Do justice
4. Break the cross (for ever).
5. Kill swine
6. Remove all religions from the world except Islam.
7. Bring peace to the whole world.
8. Stop the Jyzia tax for ever.
9. Invite the world to Islam.
10. Kill the Dajjal.
11. Give charity in such an amount that no one will be left there to
accept it.
Here are some of the adth which tells us about the tasks of
Prophet Eisa X after his arrival.





: .



258

Chapter 4 of Book II






391 : :
It is narrated on the authority of Abu Huraira \ that the
Messenger or Allah U observed: I swear by Allah that the son
of Mary will certainly descend as a just judge and he would
definitely break the cross, and kill swine and abolish Jizya and
would leave the young she-camel and no one would endeavor
to (collect Zakat on it). Spite, mutual hatred and jealousy
against one another will certainly disappear and when he
summons people to accept wealth, not even one would do
so.96

96. a Muslim,Vol. 1, adth 391.


259

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

(




390 : :
10 13
The same adth is transmitted from Zuhri with the same
chain of transmission. But in the tradition narrated by Ibn
Uyaina the words are: impartial leader and just judge, and
in the tradition narrated by Yunus the words judge judging
with justice and impartial leader are not mentioned. And
in the adth narrated by Salih like the one transmitted by
Laith the words are: impartial judge. And in the adth
260

Chapter 4 of Book II

transmitted by Ziyad the words are: Till one sajda is better


than the world and what it contains. Then Abu Huraira \
used to say: recite if you like: Not one of the People of the
Book will fail to believe in him before his death.97










: .



!


97. a Muslim,Vol. 1, adth 390.


261

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X



4441 : :
Narrated by the mother of the faithful, Sayyida Ayesha
Siddiqah \ that once our Dear Prophet Muammad U came
to me and I was crying. Our Dear Prophet Muammad U
asked: Why are you crying?
I replied that: O Prophet of Allah U, I had a thought aboutthe
Dajjal (Anti-Christ) and that is why I was crying (out of fear).
Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: If he appears in my
life time, then I will protect you from him. And if he appears
after me, then remember that your Rabb (Allah Subhana hu)
is not squint.
He shall emerge from a Yahoodiya village of Isfahan
(Persia).
He will travel and reach Madinah Munnawara. He will be
stationed at once side of Madinah. At that time there will be
seven doors of Madina Munnawara and on each door, two
262

Chapter 4 of Book II

angels will be appointed (to stop the Dajjal). Then the bad
people of Madinah Munnawara will leave Madinah and join
him. Then he will go to Shaam (Syria. Not the modern Syria)
and when he reaches the entrance of Lood (city) in
Palestine, Prophet Isa (AS) will descend and after that he will
live for 40 years as a Just Imam (Leader) and a ruler of correct
Judgement.98










: .

)
(


98 Masnad Ahmad, Vol 9, adth 4441.
263

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

2081 : :

264

Chapter 4 of Book II

Abu Huraira \ narrated that our Dear Prophet Muammad


U said: All Prophets are like brothers of Lalat as they have
different mothers but same Deen (religion). I am close to
Prophet Isa X, then any other person in the world because
there is no Prophet between me and him (Jesus Christ X).
He shall descend so, recognize him when you see him. He is a
man of medium height, (his complexion) is between reddish
and white; he will be between (or dressed in) two slightly
yellowish garments; His head looks as if it is dripping water
even though it is not wet. He will:

Break the cross, and

Kill the swine (pig), and

Abolish Jizya (tax on Christians and Jews),

And invite people towards Islam.

Allah , will put an end to all religious sects except Islam


during his (Jesus X) time. He (Jesus X) will slay the
Antichrist (the Dajjal), and peace will be restored to earth.
(There will be so much peace that) Lions will graze with
camels, tigers with cattle, and wolves with sheep; children will
be able to play with snakes without coming to any harm. He
will stay in the world for 40 years. Then, he will die and the
Muslims will perform the funeral prayer for him.99

99. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 4, adth 2081.


265

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

::
533
Abu Huraira \ narrated that our Dear Prophet Muammad
U said: I swear by (the name of) the One who holds my life
in His control, soon Isa (Jesus Christ) X will descend as a
Just Imam (Leader or ruler) and he will break the Cross, kill
the swine and abolish Jizya (tax on non-Muslims), and will
spend so much money (for people) that no one will be left to
accept it.100
Now, decide for yourself if the arrival of Prophet Eisa X is
ONLY to kill the Dajjal and nothing else?

100. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 4, adth 533.


266

Chapter 5

Misconception no 4:
Only Imam Mahdi X will lead prayers after
the arrival of Prophet Eisa X

Many people think that in the End Time, only Imam Mahdi X will lead
prayers, even after the arrival of Prophet Eisa X, as written in some
books like in the famous book Asar-e-Qiyamat by Shah Rafiuddin,
in page 31. (Scan in Urdu language is given below.)

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Translation: The above adth is claimed to be taken from


a Muslim and it is written in the above Urdu translation
that there is one adth that tells us in a Muslim that
Prophet Eisa X will pray behind Imam Mahdi X.
But we also have the following adth of a Muslim stating that
Prophet Eisa X will lead the prayers himself.

















268

Chapter 5 of Book II


2778 : :

Abu Huraira \ reported Allahs Messenger U as saying: The


Last Hour would not come until the Romans would land at
al-Amaq or in Dabiq. An army consisting of the best
(soldiers) of the people of the earth at that time will come
from Medina (to counteract them). When they will arrange
themselves in ranks, the Romans would say: Do not stand
between us and those (Muslims) who took prisoners from
amongst us. Let us fight with them; and the Muslims would
say: Nay, by Allah, we would never get aside from you and
from our brethren that you may fight them. They will then
fight and a third (part) of the army would run away, whom
Allah will never forgive. A third (part of the army) which
would be constituted of excellent martyrs in Allahs eye,
would be killed and the third who would never be put to trial
would win and they would be conquerors of Constantinople.
And as they would be busy in distributing the spoils of war
269

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

(amongst themselves) after hanging their swords by the olive


trees, the Satan would cry: The Dajjal has taken your place
among your family. They would then come out, but it would
be of no avail. And when they would come to Syria, he would
come out while they would be still preparing themselves for
battle drawing up the ranks. Certainly, the time of prayer shall
come and then Jesus X son of Mary would descend and
would lead them in prayer. When the enemy of Allah would
see him, it would (disappear) just as the salt dissolves itself in
water and if he (Jesus X) were not to confront them at all,
even then it would dissolve completely, but Allah would kill
them by his hand and he would show them their blood on his
lance (the lance of Jesus X Christ).101
It written above that Prophet Eisa X will lead the prayers and not
Imam Mahdi X.
Note: Even if there are adth that Imam Mahdi X will lead
prayers, this does not mean at all that Prophet Eisa X will
not become the Islamic Khalifa. We know that our Dear
Prophet Muammad U also prayed behind Abdur Rehman
bin Auf \, and Abu Bakar Siddique \.
Our Dear Prophet Muammad U also prayed behind two Sahaba
(Companions).
It was reported that the Prophet U, prayed behind Abu Bakr, and
behind Abdur-Rahman Ibn Awf, may Allah be pleased with them.
101. a Muslim, Vol. 3, adth 2778.
270

Chapter 5 of Book II

Moreover, Imam Ahmad and Ibn Khuzaymah reported:


Al-Mugheerah Ibn Shubah, may Allah be pleased with him,
was asked whether anyone of this nation had led the Prophet,
U, in prayer other than Abu Bakr, and he replied: Yes. He
mentioned that the Prophet U, performed ablution and he
wiped over his socks and turban. Then Al-Mugheerah also
said: He [the Prophet] prayed behind Abdur-Rahman Ibn
Awf, and I was with him in one Rakah of Fajr, and then he
made up the Rakah that we had missed.
In the wording of Ahmad: Al-Mugheerah Ibn Shubah said:
There are two characteristics that I would never ask anyone
else about them as I saw the Prophet U, doing them: The
Imam praying behind a man among the people under his
guardianship and I saw the Prophet U, praying behind
Abdur-Rahman Ibn Awf one Rakah of Fajr [as he had missed
one Rakah] and I saw the Prophet U, wiping over his socks.
Narrated Sahl bin Sad As-Saeidi \: Allahs Apostle U went to
establish peace among Banu Amr bin Auf \. In the
meantime the time of prayer was due and the Muadh-dhin
went to Abu Bakr \ and said: Will you lead the prayer, so
that I may pronounce the Iqama? Abu Bakr \ replied in the
affirmative and led the prayer. Allahs Apostle U came while
the people were still praying and he entered the rows of the
praying people till he stood in the (first row). The people
clapped their hands. Abu Bakr \ never glanced sideways in
his prayer but when the people continued clapping, Abu Bakr
\ looked and saw Allahs Apostle U. Allahs Apostle U
271

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

beckoned him to stay at his place. Abu Bakr \ raised his


hands and thanked Allah for that order of Allahs Apostle U
and then he retreated till he reached the first row. Allahs
Apostle U went forward and led the prayer. When Allahs
Apostle U finished the prayer, he said: O Abu Bakr! What
prevented you from staying when I ordered you to do so?
Abu Bakr \ replied, How can Ibn Abi Quhafa (Abu Bakr)
dare to lead the prayer in the presence of Allahs Apostle U?
Then Allahs Apostle said: Why did you clap so much? If
something happens to anyone during his prayer he should say
Subhan Allah. If he says so he will be attended to, for clapping
is for women.102
Narrated Anas \: The Prophet did not come out for three
days. The people stood for the prayer and Abu Bakr \ went
ahead to lead the prayer. (In the meantime) the Prophet
caught hold of the curtain and lifted it. When the face of the
Prophet appeared we had never seen a scene more pleasing
than the face of the Prophet as it appeared then. The Prophet
beckoned to Abu Bakr \ to lead the people in the prayer and
then let the curtain fall. We did not see him (again) till he
died.103

102. a Bukhari, adth 647.


103. a Bukhari, adth 649.
272

Chapter 6

Misconception no 6:
Baseless explanations of the word Banu Isaac
(Children of Prophet Isaac X in adth about
conquest of Constantinople in a Muslim

The following adth mentions the Children of Prophet Isaac (Son of


Prophet Ibrahim X) as the being part of the army against the Dajjal.









-- -

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





!










)







274

Chapter 6 of Book II



)
()

Abu Huraira \ reported Allahs Apostle U as saying: You
have heard about a city, the one side of which is in the land
and the other is in the sea (Constantinople). They said:
Allahs Messenger, yes. Thereupon he said: The Last Hour
would not come unless seventy thousand persons from Banu
lsaac (Children of Prophet Isaac)104 would attack it. When
they would land there, they will neither fight with weapons
nor would shower arrows but would only say: There is no god
but Allah and Allah is the Greatest, that one side of it would
fall. Thaur (one of the narrators) said: I think that he said:
The part by the side of the ocean. Then they would say for
the second time: There is no god but Allah and Allah is the
Greatest, that the second side would also fall, and they would
say: There is no god but Allah and Allah is the Greatest, that
the gates would be opened for them, and they would enter

104. Some consider the Romans as the Children of Prophet Abraham X (from
his son Prophet Isaac) just as the Arabs who are Children of Prophet Abraham
X (from his son Prophet Ismael) but it is wrong as adth tells us that Arabs
comes from the different son of Prophet Noah called Saam and the Romans
are from the other son called Yaafith. We should know that Prophet Noah
X is the forefather of Prophet Ibrahim X.
275

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

therein and, they would be collecting the spoils of war and


distributing them amongst themselves that a noise would be
heard, and It would be said: Verily, the Dajjal has come. And
thus they would leave everything there and would turn to
him.105
There are 3 misconceptions of the word Banu Isaac
mention in the above adth
1. Romans are the Children of Isaac.
2. The word Children of Isaac actually means Children of
Ismael.
3. Banu Isaac is pointing towards a group of people in Bilad Ush
Sham (Syria, Lebanon, Israel, etc.).
Misconception No 1: Romans are the Children of Isaac
(in the adth about Constantinople)
Some consider the Romans as the Children of Prophet Abraham
X (from his younger son Prophet Isaac) just as the Arabs who are
Children of Prophet Abraham X (from his elder son Prophet
Ismael).For this reason they call Romans as the Children of Isaac.
This is totally baseless as the following adth clearly tells us that
the Romans are from a totally different lineage than the Arabs as the
following a adth proves.

105. a Muslim, Kitab al-Fitan, adth 2920.


276

Chapter 6 of Book II

Before reading these adth, remember that Prophet Ibrahim X


has two sons i.e. Prophet Ismail X and Prophet Isaac X. Also Prophet
Ibrahim X ancestor is one of the 3 sons of Prophet Nooh X whose
name is Saam.



.



1179 : :
Sayyidina Samurah \ reported from the Prophet that he said:
Saam was the father of the Arab, Haam the father of the
Ethiopians and Yaafith of the Romans.106




: .


329 : :

106. Jamia Tirmidhi, Vol. 2, adth 1179.


277

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Sayyidina Samurah \ reported from the Prophet U that he


said, Saam was the father of the Arab, Yafith the father of
the Romans and Haam the father of the Ethiopians. And the
narrater called Rooh said in the city of Baghdad that
Prophet Noah has 3 sons, namely, Saam, Haam and
Yafith.107
The following is another adth which only tells about the names
of the 3 sons of Prophet Nooh X.



187 . :
187 187 187
-
Sayyidina Samurah \ reported from the Prophet U that he
said, Prophet Nooh (Noah) sons are Saam, Yafith and
Haam108
The above adth proves that Romans have a different ancestor
than Prophet Ibrahim X and that proves son of Prophet Ibrahim X
i.e. Prophet Isaac X is not their ancestor.

107. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 9, adth 329.


108. Majam Al-Kabeer, adth 6872.
278

Chapter 6 of Book II

Proof from Quran


We shall check the following verses of the Quran regarding the children
of Prophet Ishaq X:









002:136
!




.

(02:136)-
Say (O Muslims), We believe inAllah and that which has been
sent down to us and that which has been sent down to Ibrhim
(Abraham), Ismil (Ishmael), Ishque (Isaac), Yaqb (Jacob),
and to Al-Asbt [the twelve sons of Yaqb (Jacob)], and that
which has been given to Msa (Moses) and Iesa (Jesus), and that
which has been given to the Prophets from their Lord. We make
no distinction between any of them, and to Him we have
submitted (in Islam). (02:136)

279

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

002:140





(02 :140) -
Or say you that Ibrhim (Abraham), Ismil (Ishmael), Ishque
(Isaac), Yaqb (Jacob) and Al-Asbt [the twelve sons of Yaqb
(Jacob)] were Jews or Christians? Say, Do you know better or
doesAllah (knows better...; that they all were Muslims)? And
who is more unjust than he who conceals the testimony [i.e. to
believe in Prophet Muammad Peace be upon him when he
comes, written in their Books. (See Verse 7:157)] he has
fromAllah? AndAllah is not unaware of what you do. (02:140)



003:084

, ,

280

Chapter 6 of Book II



.
(03:84)
Say (O Muammad ): We believe inAllah and in what has
been sent down to us, and what was sent down to Ibrhim
(Abraham), Ismil (Ishmael), Ishaque (Isaac), Yaqub (Jacob)
and Al-Asbt [the twelve sons of Yaqub (Jacob)] and what
was given to Msa (Moses), Iesa (Jesus) and the Prophets from
their Lord. We make no distinction between one another
among them and to Him (Allh) we have submitted (in Islm).
(03:84)









004:163


, , ,
,
, , ,
,
004:163
Verily, We have inspired you (O Muammad ) as We inspired
Nh (Noah) and the Prophets after him; We (also) inspired
Ibrhim (Abraham), Ismil (Ishmael), Ishaque (Isaac), Yaqb
281

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

(Jacob), and AlAsbt [the twelve sons of Yaqb (Jacob)], Iesa


(Jesus), Ayub (Job), Ynus (Jonah), Hrn (Aaron), and Sulaimn
(Solomon), and to Dawd (David) We gave the Zabr (Psalms).
(04:163)







006:084
()



006:084-
And We bestowed upon him Ishque (Isaac) and Yaqb
(Jacob), each of them We guided, and before him, We guided
Nh (Noah), and among his progeny Dawd (David), Sulaimn
(Solomon), Ayub (Job), Ysuf (Joseph), Msa (Moses), and Hrn
(Aaron). Thus do We reward the good doers. (06:84).





011:071

( )
011:071

282

Chapter 6 of Book II

And his wife was standing (there), and she laughed (either,
because the Messengers did not eat their food or for being glad
for the destruction of the people of Lout (Lot). But We gave her
glad tidings of Ishque (Isaac), and after him, of Yaqb
(Jacob). (11:71).

012:006
( ) ()


)
012:006- () (
Thus will your Lord choose you and teach you the
interpretation of dreams (and other things) and perfect His
Favour on you and on the offspring of Yaqb (Jacob), as He
perfected it on your fathers, Ibrahm (Abraham) and Ishque
(Isaac) aforetime! Verily, your Lord is All-Knowing, All-Wise.
(12:06)






019:049

()
283

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

019:049-
So when he had turned away from them and from those whom
they worshipped besidesAllah, We gave him Ishque (Isaac)
and Yaqb (Jacob), and each one of them We made a Prophet.
(19:49).

021:072



() 7 () 7 ( )
021:072 ( )

And We bestowed upon him Ishque (Isaac), and (a grandson)


Yaqb (Jacob). Each one We made righteous. (21:72)






029:027

()
029:027 .
And We bestowed on him [Ibrhim (Abraham)], Ishque (Isaac)
and Yaqb (Jacob), and ordained among his offspring
Prophethood and the Book [i.e. the Taurt (Torah) (to Msa
Moses), the Injeel (Gospel) (to Iesa Jesus), the Qurn (to
Muammad ), all from the offspring of Ibrhim (Abraham)],
and We granted him his reward in this world, and verily, in the
Hereafter he is indeed among the righteous. (29:27)
284

Chapter 6 of Book II

038:045






038:045.
And remember Our slaves, Ibrhim (Abraham), Ishque (Isaac),
and Yaqb (Jacob), (all) owners of strength (in worshipping Us)
and (also) of religious understanding. (38:45)
Only one son of Prophet Ishaq X is mentioned i.e.: Prophet
Yaqb (Israel) X in the Quran.
If the twelfth sons of Prophet Yaqb can be mentioned by the Quran,
then why is not mentioned the so called second twin son of Prophet
Isaac?
Even then, if for a moment we consider the Romans as Banu Isaac then
again it does not make sense as:
The Mahdi Army will come from the EAST while Romans are in
the West.
Abdullah bin Haris \ reported that our Dear Prophet U said:
Some people will come out from the EAST who will make
the Kalifate (Islamic rule) easy for Imam Mahdi X.109
The Army of the Mahdi will come from the Khurasan where there
are no Romans.

109. Sunan Ibn Majah, Kitab-al-Fitan, adth No 4088.


285

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Narrated by Thoban, that our Dear Prophet Muammad U


said that: When you hear the news of black flags coming
from the east, then, you must join them even if you have to
crawl over ice (to reach them).110
The Mahdi (X will be wearing clothes of Banu Israel, and not the
clothes of the Romans.
Narrated Hazrat Umama \ who reported that Rasulullah U
said (I am not mentioning the beginning part of the
adth) Rasulullah U was asked who would be the Imam of
the Muslims at that time. Rasulullah U said: That person
would be from my family, his age would be 40 years, his face
would be bright as a star, and a black spot would be on his
right cheek. He would be wearing two Qutwani Shawls. He
will appear exactly as a person from Banu Israel. He will rule
for 10 years and will conquer the cities of the Mushrikeen
(Idolaters).111
So, in summary I ask:
Are the Romans for the east?
Are the Romans from Khurasan?
Are the Romans from Banu Israel? (they are BANU ESU
according the base less claim described above)
Do the Romans wear the Banu Israeli dress of Qutwan?

110 Masnad Ahmad 5:277.Also in Sunan Ibn Majah


111 Kanz-ul-Aamal, Page 268, adth No 3868.Also Tabarani
286

Chapter 6 of Book II

So it is proven that Banu Ishaq never stands for the Romans


of the West.
Baseless Explanation No 2: The word Children of Isaac actually
means Children of Ismael (in the adth about Constantinople)
According to some Scholars the word Banu Isaac (Children of Prophet
Isaac) actually means Banu Ismael (Children of Prophet Ismael). This
is totally wrong because of the following reasons:
There is no adth in any of the original copies of a
Muslims that uses the word Banu Ismael in the adth.
The majority of the non-Arabs will fight the great wars
of End of Times for Islam.

. .
:
:
))
.((
Narrated Hazrat Abu Huraira \: When great wars will
occur, then Allah , will rise an Army from the non-Arabs
who will be greater riders, and will have better weapons than
the Arabs. Allah , will support His Deen (Islam) by them.112

112. Sunan Ibn Majah, Kitab-al-Fitan, adth No. 4090.


287

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

70,000 means the majority while the adth tells us that the Arabs
will be very small in number of those who fight the Dajjal.

: : .
:

! : .
.





: --

Umm Sharik \ reported: I heard Allahs Messenger U as


saying: The people would run away from the Dajjal seeking
shelter in the mountains. She said: Where would be the
Arabs then in that day? He said: They would be very few.113
You see, for the term very few Arabs, the word seventy
thousand can never be used. This in turn means that Banu Isaac can
never point out towards the Arabs.

113. a Muslim, Kitab-al-Fitan, adth No. 125.


288

Chapter 6 of Book II

The Mahdi Army will come from Khurasan, while Banu


Ismael (Arabs) are not in Khurasan.

Imam Mahdi (AS) will appear from a place with ICE while
the Arab areas have deserts.

The following adth tells us that Army of Mahdi will be


from a place with ice (cold climate)
Thawban \ reported that our Dear Prophet U said: Three
people will fight for your treasure (and get killed). All three of
them will be sons of a ruler, but none of them will get the
treasure. Then black flags will appear from the east and will
kill you as no one (in history) has killed you before. Then our
Dear Prophet said something that I didnt remember. Then
again our Dear Prophet said: If you see him then give him
your allegiance, even if you have to crawl over ice, because he
is the Khalifa of Allah, the Mahdi.114
Baseless Explanation No 3: Banu Isaac (in the adth about
Constantinople) is pointing towards a group of people in
Bilad Ush Sham (Syria, Lebanon, Israel, etc.)
Some Scholars said that the Banu Isaac is pointing towards a group of
people in Bilad Ush Sham (Syria, Lebanon, Israel, etc.) who claim to
be from Banu Isaac. This is contradictory to the following points of
adth:

The Mahdi Army will come from the east, while Syria is in

114. Hakim Mustadrak, adth 4084, Kitab-al-Fitan.


289

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

the West (according to adth).

The Mahdi Army will come from Khurasan and not Syria.

The Lost tribes of Israel do not live in Syria.

Which Muslims belong to the Lost Tribes of Israel?


According to the reference of the Encyclopedia Britannica 1997, the
following groups of people are said to be from the Lost Tribes of Israel:
People who at various times were said to be descendants
of the Lost Tribes (of Israel) include the:

Nestorians

Mormons

Afghans

Falashas of Ethiopia

American Indians

Japanese

Note: To be brief, I quoted this reference of Encyclopedia


Britannica, otherwise solid proof about the Israeli origin of
Pashtuns can be found from adth. For further reading, read
the book Lost Tribes of Israel with Prophet Isa X, and Imam
Mahdi X.
Now, among all the above, the only Muslims told to be from Banu
Israel are the Afghans (The Pathans) and also, at the same time, from
the same area where the Army of Mahdi will rise. Since the Army of
Madhi will be from the Muslims from Banu Israel, hence the Pathans
290

Chapter 6 of Book II

are the lucky ones to make the majority of that sacred Army.
InshahAllah.
Hiding the truth
Some of the so called modern Western historians are trying to change
history by telling that the Pathans are not Banu Israel. The reasons
behind this is simple as the Quran tells us:






002:146
)
(

002:146
Those to whom We gave the Scripture (Jews and Christians)
recognize him (Muammad U or the Kaba at Makkah) as they
recognize their sons. But verily, a party of them conceals the
truth while they know it. (2:146)
By changing the identification of Muslim Banu Israel, the
People of the Book try to hide the real intention behind the
genocide of Pathans, which started in 1979, and they still
continue using different fake reasons like the so called
Taliban, Al-Qaeda, War on Terror, etc., etc. Different
reasons, but the same purpose.
Just one example of the Western Hypocrisy is the so called
291

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Historian Mr. Olaf Caroe 115 who openly lies by saying that he does not
know exactly the origin of the word PATHAN. In fact the word is
clearly mentioned in The Book of the Chronicles116 (i.e.: Chronicles1) and there is no way Mr. Olaf Caroe was unaware of this.
PATHAN or PITHON is the name of the great-grandson of King
117

Saul , mentioned among a list of hundreds of names chronicling the


descendants of the Twelve Tribes of Israel. (Ref: Chronicles I, 8:35, 36)
8:34 The son of Jonathan: Meribbaal. Meribbaal was the
father of Micah.118
8:35 The sons of Micah: Pithon, Melech, Tarea, and Ahaz.119
All Pathan areas of Pakistan and Afghanistan are full of places by
the name PATHAN. Also in Israel, at the Gaza Strip near Nablus there
is a famous Israeli check post by the name of AL-PATHAN.120
The detailed proof about the Israeli origin of Pathans can
be found in my other book called: Lost Tribes of Israel
with Prophet Isa X, and Imam Mahdi X.

B
115. British Governor and writer of The Pathans.
116. A Section of Hebrew Bible with 2 parts.
117. Known as Taloot in Al-the Quran.
118. Chronicles I, 8:34.
119. Chronicles I, 8:35.
120. http://www.imemc.org/article/17284
292

Chapter 7

Misconception no 7:
An army lead by Mansoor from Tranxonia
will come to help Imam Mahdi X

As reference the following weak adth is given:

:
:
:








. .






( )

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


:
897 :
A man called al-Harith ibn Harrath will come forth from Ma
Wara an-Nahr. His army will be led by a man called Mansur
who will establish or consolidate things for Muammads
family as Quraysh consolidated them for the Apostle of Allah
U. Every believer must help him, or he said: respond to his
sermons.121
This adth is considered Daif (Not Authentic) according
to Jamia Sagheer.122
This is a weak adth, and also it is proved wrong by the following
adth which clearly tells us that many people from those Turks of
Khurasan who have Mogol like features(because of having Mongol
origin), will join the army of the Dajjal.
Mongol origin people of Khurasan (who have adopted Turkish
culture) will join the Dajjal (and not Mahdi).

:
.
:
)):

121. Sunan Abu Daud.


122. Daif, al-Jami al-Saghir, 6418.
294

Chapter 7 of Book II

(( .
4072





( )
952 : :
Narrated by Amr ibn Hurayth \ who quoted Abu Bakr Al
Siddiq \ as saying that Allahs Messenger U told them that
the Dajjal would come forth from a land in the east called
Khurasan, followed by people whose faces resembled shields
covered with skin.123
Also the following adth tells us that these shield like faces
belong to the Turks. (Note: The word Turk in this adth points
out toward the Mongol origin Turkic people of Central Asia and
Khurasan who adopted Turkish culture. We know that people in
Modern day Turkey dont have flat faced, small eyed people.):

123. Sunan Ibn Majah, Chapter Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 4078 at http://www.iidalraid.de/Hadeethlib/. Also in a Tirmidhi and Mishkat, adth 5251.
295

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X








911 : :
Hazrat Buraidah \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet
Muammad U) reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad
U said: A nation will wage war with you who will have small
eyes, meaning the Turks. You will drive them three times until
you will drive them to the Arabian Peninsula. The 1st time
you push them back, those who will run away among them
will get salvation, and in the 2nd time some will get salvation
and some will be killed, and the 3rd time you drive them back,

296

Chapter 7 of Book II

they will be up rooted or the way you said it.124


For further discussion about the Turks of Khurasan with
Mongol like faces of the Dajjals army please refer to the other book
called Signs of the Army of the Dajjal Part 2 which is included in
this same collection.

124. Sunan Abu Daud, Awwal Kitab-al-Malahim, adth 4305.


297

Chapter 8

Misconception no 8:
The dajjal will come among the non arabs

The location of the first appearance of the Dajjal is in Arabian


Peninsula. The Dajjal will first appear among the Arabs of the Najd.

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





!






( )



!

!





300

Chapter 8 of Book II





. .
44 : : .

It was narrated that Sharik bin Shihab \ who said: I used to
wish that I could meet a man among the Companions of The
Prophetand ask him about the Khawarij. Then I met Abu
Barzah \ on the day of Eid, with a number of his companions.
I said to him: Did you hear the Messenger of Allah U mention
the Khawarij? He said: Yes. I heard the Messenger of Allah
U with my own ears, and saw him with my own eyes. Some
wealth was brought to the Messenger of Allah U and he
distributed it to those on his right and on his left, but he did
not give anything to those who were behind him. Then a man
stood behind him and said: Muammad! You have not been
just in your division! He was a black man with patchy
(shaved) hair, wearing two white garments and sign of
prostration on the forehead. So Allahs Messenger U became
very angry and said: By Allah! You will not find a man after
me who is more just than me. He U repeated these words
three times. Then he said: A people will come at the end of
time from the east, as if he is one of them, and their
appearance will also be like this man. They will be reciting the
301

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Quran without it passing beyond their throats. They will go


through Islam just as the arrow goes through the target. Their
distinction will be shaving. They will not cease to appear
until the last of them comes with Al-Masih Al the Dajjal. So
when you meet them, then kill them, they are the worst of
created beings.125
The above adth is not just for the Khawarij126 but for all times
since it is clearly told that such people will appear constantly till the end
time and will join the Dajjal.
adth about the incident of the hypocrite Zul-Khuwaisara of the
Banu Tamim tribe from Najd.
Most of the following adth are related to the incident related to a
person named Zul-Khuwaisara from the Banu Tamim tribe who
behaved foolishly in front of our Dear Prophet Muammad U. In all
these adth you will find that Muslims are warned of an affliction that
will have the following characteristics:

It will appear from the offspring of Zul-Khuwaisara of the Banu


Tamim tribe.

It will appear from Najd as Zul-Khuwaisara was also from Najd.

125. Masnad Ahmad,Vol. 9, adth 44.


126. Kharijites (Arabic: ( Khawrij, literally those who went out;
(singular, Khriji) is a general term embracing various Muslims who, while
initially supporting the authority of the final Rashidun Khalifa Ali ibn Abi
Talib, then later rejected his leadership. They first emerged in the late 7th
century AD.
302

Chapter 8 of Book II

The people related to this affliction will read the Quran


beautifully but hypocritically.

The people related to this affliction will pass through Islam


unaffected just like an arrow passes through the flesh.

They will respect the non-Muslims but kill the Muslims.

They will deny many adth.

They will have shaved heads.

They will have long beards.

Their appearance will be just like pious Muslims.

They will appear in all times.

They will join the Dajjal in the End of Times.

The Dajjal will be among these people.

The two common sentences in all these adth.


Most of these adth have two common sentences about these people,
i.e.:
1. The people related to this affliction will read the Quran but
it will not pass through their throats.
2. They will pass through Islam (unaffected) just as an arrow
passes through the preys body.
This also shows that all the adth are describing the same group
of people who are from Najad.
The main the adth about this affliction is in relation to the
303

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Arab tribe of Banu Tamim.




304

Chapter 8 of Book II














(58 : 9

1839 : :
17 24
Narrated Abu Saeed \: While the Prophet U was distributing
(something) Abdullah bin Dhil Khawaisira Al Tamimi came
and said: Be just, O Allahs Apostle! The Prophet U said:
Woe to you!, Who would be just if I were not?, Umar \ bin
Al-Khattab said: Allow me to cut off his neck!, The Prophet
U said: Leave him, for he has companions, and if you
compare your prayers with their prayers, and your fasting
with theirs, you will look down upon your prayers and
fasting, in comparison to theirs. Yet they will go out of the
religion as an arrow darts through the games body in which
305

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

case, if the Qudhadh of the arrow is examined, nothing will


be found on it, and when it is Nasl is examined, nothing will
be found on it; and then it is Nadiyi is examined, nothing will
be found on it. The arrow has been too fast to be smeared by
dung and blood. The sign by which these people will be
recognized will be a man whose one hand (or breast) will be
like the breast of a woman (or like a moving piece of flesh).
These people will appear when there will be differences
among the people (Muslims). Abu Saeed added: I testify
that I heard this from the Prophet, and also testify that Ali \
killed those people while I was with him. The man with the
description given by the Prophet U was brought to Ali \. The
following Verses were revealed in connection with that very
person (i.e.: Abdullah bin Dhil-Khawaisira At-Tamimi):
and among them are men who accuse you (O Muammad)
in the matter of (the distribution of) the alms. (9.58).127
Further discussion about this can be found in the book III
i.e Army of Dajjal Part-1 which is the next book here in
this collection.

127 a Bokhari Vol 3, adth 1839


306




.
.


B
BOOK III

SIGNS OF THE ARMY OF THE DAJJAL


PART I





.
.

Chapter 1

The location of the


first appearance of the Dajjal

The main adth showing the afflictions from the Tribe of Banu
Tamim.

313

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X
















(58 : 9

1839 : :
17 24
314

Chapter 1 of Book III

17 24
Narrated Abu Saeed \: While the Prophet U was distributing
something, Abdullah bin Dhil Khawaisira At-Tamimi came
and said: Be just, O Allahs Apostle! The Prophet U said:
Woe to you! Who would be just if I were not? Umar \ bin
Al-Khattab said: Allow me to cut off his neck!. The Prophet
said: Leave him, for he has companions, and if you
compare your prayers with their prayers and your fasting
with theirs, you will look down upon your prayers and
fasting, in comparison to theirs. Yet they will go out of the
religion as an arrow darts through the games body in which
case, if the Qudhadh of the arrow is examined, nothing will
be found on it, and when it is Nasl is examined, nothing will
be found on it; and then it is Nadiyi is examined, nothing will
be found on it. The arrow has been too fast to be smeared by
dung and blood. The sign by which these people will be
recognized will be a man whose one hand (or breast) will be
like the breast of a woman (or like a moving piece of flesh).
These people will appear when there will be differences
among the people (Muslims). Abu Saeed added: I testify
that I heard this from the Prophet, and also testify that Ali \
killed those people while I was with him. The man with the
description given by the Prophet U was brought to Ali \. The
following verses were revealed in connection with that very
person (i.e.: Abdullah bin Dhil-Khawaisira At-Tamimi):
and among them are men who accuse you (O Muammad)

315

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

in the matter of (the distribution of) the alms. (9.58). 128


The following verses describes the above incident





[:]
()
( )
( )

And among them are men who accuse you (O Muammad) in


the matter of (the distribution of) the alms. (9.58)129
The 2nd adth tells us that the family of
Zul-Khuwaisara Al Tamimi will start afflictions.
Following adth are also tells of the same event mentioned before in
the adth, and tells us that the afflictions will start from the offspring
of Zul-Khuwaisara of Banu Tamim, and it is location is the Najd.

128. a Bukhari, Vol. 3, adth 1839.


129. a Bukhari, Vol. 3, adth 1839.
316

Chapter 1 of Book III











.




( )






317

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

2300 :

17 24
Narrated Abu Said Al Khudri \: When Ali \ was in Yemen,
he sent some gold in it is ore to the Prophet. Our Dear
Prophet distributed it among Al-Aqra bin Habis Al-Hanzali
who belonged to Banu Mujashi, Uyaina bin Badr Al-Fazari,
Alqamah bin Ulathah Al-Amiri, who belonged to the Banu
318

Chapter 1 of Book III

Kilab tribe and Zaid AI-Khail At-Tai who belonged to Banu


Nabhan. So the Quraish and the Ansar became angry and
said: He gives to the chiefs of Najd and leaves us! The
Prophet said: I just wanted to attract and unite their hearts
(make them firm in Islam). Then there came a man with
sunken eyes, bulging forehead, thick beard, fat raised cheeks,
and clean-shaven head, and said: O Muammad! Be afraid
of Allah! The Prophet U said: Who would obey Allah if I
disobeyed Him? (Allah). He trusts me over the people of the
earth, but you do not trust me? A man from the people
(present then), who, I think, was Khalid bin Al-Walid \,
asked for permission to kill him, but the Prophet prevented
him. When the man went away, the Prophet said: Out of the
offspring of this man, there will be people who will recite the
Quran but it will not go beyond their throats, and they will
go out of Islam as an arrow goes out through the game, and
they will kill the Muslims and leave the idolaters. Should I live
till they appear, I would kill them as the Killing of the nation
of Ad.130
The 3rd adth telling us that family of Zul-Khuwaisara Al Tamimi
will start afflictions.

130. a Bkhari,Volume 9, Book 93, Number 527.


319

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X









:











!
!

320

Chapter 1 of Book III


!






!



710 : :

When Ali \ was in Yemen, he sent some gold in it is ore to


the Prophet. The Prophet distributed it among Al-Aqra bin
Habis Al-Hanzali who belonged to Banu Mujashi, Uyaina bin
Badr Al-Fazari, Alqamah bin Ulathah Al-Amiri, who
belonged to the Banu Kilab tribe and Zaid AI-Khail At-Tai
who belonged to Banu Nabhan. So the Quraish and the Ansar
became angry and said: He gives to the chiefs of Najd and
leaves us! The Prophet said: I just wanted to attract and
unite their hearts (make them firm in Islam). Then there
321

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

came a man with sunken eyes, bulging forehead, thick beard,


fat raised cheeks, and clean-shaven head, and said: O
Muammad! Be afraid of Allah! The Prophet said: Who
would obey Allah if I disobeyed Him? (Allah). He trusts me
over the people of the earth, but you do not trust me? A man
from the people (present then), who, I think, was Khalid bin
Al-Walid \, asked for permission to kill him, but the Prophet
prevented him. When the man went away, the Prophet said:
Out of the offspring of this man, there will be people who
will recite the Quran but it will not go beyond their throats,
and they will go out of Islam as an arrow goes out through the
game, and they will kill the Muslims and leave the idolaters.
Should I live till they appear, I would kill them as the Killing
of the nation of Ad. 131
The 4th adth telling us that the group of Zul-Khuwaisara Al
Tamimi will start afflictions.

131. a Bukhari 93/527.


322

Chapter 1 of Book III









.








!



!

323

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

!






: :
2526
The 5th adth tells us that location Zul-Khuwaisara Al Tamimi is
Najd.






(3) (2) (1)




()
324

Chapter 1 of Book III
















)
(

:.
24 489 :
It was narrated that Abu Saeed Al Khudri \ said: When he
325

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

was in Yemen, Ali \ sent a piece of gold that was still mixed
with sediment to the Messenger of Allah U and the Messenger
of Allah U distributed it among four people: Al-Aqra bin
Habis Al-Hanzali, Uyaynah bin Badr Al- Fazari, Alqamah
bin Ulathah Al Amiri, who was from Banu Kilab and Zaid
At-Tai who was from Banu Nabhan. The Quraish - he said
one time the chiefs of the Quraish - became angry and said:
You give to the chiefs of Najd and not to us? He said: I only
did that, so as to soften their hearts toward Islam. Then a man
with a thick beard, prominent cheeks, sunken eyes, a high
forehead, and a shaven head came and said: Fear Allah,
Muammad! He (Prophet Muammad U said: Who would
obey Allah if I disobeyed Him? (Is it fair that) He has
entrusted me with all the people of the Earth but you do not
trust me? Then the man went away, and a man from among
the people, whom they (the narrators) think was Khalid bin
Al Walid, asked for permission to kill him. The Messenger of
Allah U said: Among the offspring of this man will be some
people who will recite the Quran but it will not go any
further than their throats. They will kill the Muslims but
leave the idol worshippers alone, and they will pass through
Islam as an arrow passes through the body of the target. If I
live to see them, I will kill them all, as the people of Ad were
killed.132

132. Sunan Nisai, Vol. 2, adth 489.


326

Chapter 1 of Book III

The 6th adth telling us that the Dajjal will join the followers of ZulKhuwaisara Al Tamimi of the east and will have shaved heads.

: ,






:

:



,

,


,


:
:

:
,












,

:




:









.,





!

327

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X






)
(


!

!









. .
44 : : .
328

Chapter 1 of Book III


It was narrated that Sharik bin Shihab \ said: I used to wish
that I could meet a man among the Companions of The
Prophet and ask him about the Khawarij. Then I met Abu
Barzah \ on the day of Eid, with a number of his companions.
I said to him: Did you hear the Messenger of Allah U mention
the Khawarij? He said: Yes. I heard the Messenger of Allah
U with my own ears, and saw him with my own eyes. Some
wealth was brought to the Messenger of Allah U and he
distributed it to those on his right and on his left, but he did
not give anything to those who were behind him. Then a man
stood behind him and said: Muammad! You have not been
just in your division! He was a black man with patchy
(shaved) hair, wearing two white garments and sign of
prostration on the forehead. So Allahs Messenger U became
very angry and said: By Allah! You will not find a man after
me who is more just than me. He U repeated these words
three times. Then he said: A people will come at the end of
time from the east; as if he is one of them and their appearance
will also be like this man. They will be reciting the Quran
without it passing beyond their throats. They will go through
Islam just as the arrow goes through the target. Their
distinction will be shaving. They will not cease to appear
until the last of them comes with Al-Masih Al the Dajjal. So
when you meet them, then kill them, they are the worst of

329

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

created beings. 133


It was narrated that Sharik bin Shihab \ said: I used to wish
that I could meet a man among the Companions of The
Prophet U and ask him about the Khawarij. Then I met Abu
Barzah \ on the day of Eid, with a number of his companions.
I said to him: Did you hear the Messenger of Allah U mention
the Khawarij? He said: Yes. I heard the Messenger of Allah
U with my own ears, and saw him with my own eyes. Some
wealth was brought to the Messenger of Allah U and he
distributed it to those on his right and on his left, but he did
not give anything to those who were behind him. Then a man
stood behind him and said: Muammad! You have not been
just in your division! He was a black man with patchy
(shaved) hair, wearing two white garments and sign of
prostration on the forehead. So Allahs Messenger U became
very angry and said: By Allah! You will not find a man after
me who is more just than me. He U repeated these words
three times. Then he said: A people will come at the end of
time from the east, as if he is one of them and their appearance
will also be like this man. They will be reciting the Quran
without it passing beyond their throats. They will go through
Islam just as the arrow goes through the target. Their
distinction will be shaving. They will not cease to appear
until the last of them comes with Al-Masih Al the Dajjal. So
when you meet them, then kill them, they are the worst of

133. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 9, adth 44.


330

Chapter 1 of Book III

created beings. 134


The above adth is not just for the Khawarij135 but for all times,
since it is clearly told that such people will appear constantly till the end
time and will join the Dajjal.
The following adth tells us about the same incident, and this
further tells us that the Dajjal will come among the offspring of the
Banu Tamim tribe from the Najd.

134. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 9, adth 44.


135. Kharijites (Arabic: ( Khawrij, literally those who went out;
(singular, Khriji) is a general term embracing various Muslims who, while
initially supporting the authority of the final Rashidun Khalifa Ali ibn Abi
Talib, then later rejected his leadership. They first emerged in the late 7th
century A.D.
331

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X




407 : : .















( )

!
( )
332

Chapter 1 of Book III









407 : :
10
It was narrated that Sharik bin Shihab \ said: I used to wish
that I could meet a man among the Companions of The
Prophet and ask him about the Khawarij. Then I met Abu
Barzah \ on the day of Eid, with a number of his companions.
I said to him: Did you hear the Messenger of Allah U

mention the Khawarij? He said: Yes. I heard the


Messenger of Allah U with my own ears,
and saw him with my own eyes. Some wealth was brought to
the Messenger of Allah U and he
distributed it to those on his right and on his left, but he did
not give anything to those who were behind him. Then a man
stood behind him and said: Muammad! You have not been
just in your division! He was a man with black patchy
(shaved) hair, wearing two white garments. So Allahs
Messenger U , became very angry and said:
333

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

By Allah! You will not find a man after me who is more just
than me. Then he said: A people will come at the end of
time; as if he is one of them, reciting the Quran without it
passing beyond their throats. They will go through Islam just
as the arrow goes through the target. Their distinction will be
shaving. They will not cease to appear until the last of them
comes with Al-Masih Al the Dajjal. So when you meet them,
then kill them, they are the worst of created beings.136
We see that in the above adth the same person Zul-Khuwaisara
of Banu Tamim is mentioned in the same incident. So it proves that the
Dajjal will join the Banu Tamim from the Najd.

136. Sunan Nisai, Vol. 3, adth 407, adth Matwatar Marfu.


334

Chapter 2

Analysis of the adth about Zul Khuwaisara


of Banu Tamim tribe of the Najad

Most of the adth about the followers of the Dajjal from the Najd are
related to the incident to a person named Zul-Khuwaisara from the
Banu Tamim tribe who behaved foolishly in front of our Dear Prophet
Muammad U. In all these adth you will find that the Muslims are
warned of an affliction that will have the following characteristics:

It will appear from the offspring of Zul-Khuwaisara of the Banu


Tamim tribe.

It will appear from the Najd as Zul-Khuwaisara was also from


the Najd.

The people related to this affliction will read the Quran


beautifully but hypocritically.

The people related to this affliction will pass through Islam


unaffected just like an arrow passes through the flesh.

They will respect the non-Muslims but kill the Muslims.

They will deny many adth.

They will have shaved heads.


335

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

They will have long beards.

Their appearance will be just like pious Muslims.

They will appear in all times.

They will join the Dajjal in the End of Times.

The Dajjal will be among these people.

Two common sentences in all these adth.


Most of the adth have two common sentences about these people:
1. The people related to this affliction will read the Quran but it
will not pass through their throats.
2. They will pass through Islam (unaffected) just as an arrow
passes through the preys body.
The Quran comments about Banu Tamim.
The following verse of Srah Hujurat of the Quran clearly tells us that
Banu Tamim has no sense:




(40:4)

(40:4)
Lo! Those who call thee from behind the private apartments,
most of them have no sense. (40:4)
336

Chapter 2 of Book III

The chambers (Hujurat) were spaces enclosed by walls. Each of


the wives of Allahs Messenger U had one of them. The ayat was
revealed in connection with the delegation of the Banu Tamim who
came to the Prophet U. They entered the mosque, and approached the
chambers of his wives. They stood outside them and called:
Muammad! Come out to us! an action which expressed a good deal
of harshness, crudeness and disrespect. Allahs Messenger U waited a
while, and then came out to them. One of them, known as al-Aqraibn
Habis, said: Muammad! My praise is an ornament, and my
denunciation brings shame!, and the Messenger U replied: Woe
betide you! That is the due of Allah. (Imam Muammad ibn Ahmad
ibn Juzayy, al-Tashil [Beirut, 1403], p.702. See also the other tafsir
works; also Ibn Hazm, Jamharat Ansab al Arab [Cairo, 1382], 208, in
the chapter on Tamim.)
The following Verses were revealed in connection with that very
person (i.e.: Abdullah bin Zul-Khuwaisara Al Tamimi): who was from
Banu Tamim and who misbehaved with our Dear Prophet Muammad
U.





[:]
()
( ) ( )

337

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

And among them are men who accuse you (O Muammad) in


the matter of (the distribution of) the alms. (9:58) 137
More adth telling us that these people will join the Dajjal.
The following adth is also related to Zul-Khuwaisara since it also tells
us about the hypocrites who reading the Quran but it will not pass their
thoughts.




.





:
2361 :
It was narrated by Abdullah bin Umar \ that I heard, the
Messenger of Allah U saying that: Soon among my nation
(Muslim Ummah) there will appear people from the east
who will recite Quran but it will not go any deeper than their
137. a Bukhari, Vol. 3, adth 1839.
338

Chapter 2 of Book III

collarbones or their throats. Whenever any of their offspring


will appear, they will be eliminated. He U repeated this 10
times and then said until in the last of them will appear with
the Dajjal (Anti-Christ).138





.








2443 : :
It was narrated by Abdullah bin Umar \ that I heard, the
Messenger of Allah U saying that: There will appear a nation
from the east who will recite the Quran but it will not go
any deeper than their collarbones or their throats.
138. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 2361.
339

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Whenever any of their offspring gets eliminated another


will appear until the last of them will appear with the Dajjal
(Anti-Christ). 139
Please note that the same two characteristics are described about
the above people:
1. They will read the Quran but will not pass their throats.
2. They will apparently worship Allah , much more than the
Muslims.
This exactly matches with the adth of Zul-Khuwaisara and
therefore these adth also point towards the fitnah of Banu Tamim of
Najd (the east of Arabia). It proves that the Dajjal will appear among
them.
The previous two adth; adth 489, Sunan Nisai, Vol. 2, and
adth 407, Sunan Nisai, Vol. 3, are adth Matwatar Marfu. Already
have proven that the word east in above adth means Najd.
They will appear again and again throughout history

139. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 2361.


340

Chapter 2 of Book III

.










1091 : :
It was narrated by Abdullah bin Umar \ that I heard, the
Messenger of Allah U saying that: A nation will be born from
my Ummah (Muslims), who will be of bad character. They
will recite Quran but it will not go any deeper than their
collarbones or their throats. Apparently, you will consider
your deeds much less than their deed. They will kill Muslims.
If they appear, you must kill them, and you should keep on
killing them whenever they rise. Glad tidings are for the
person who will kill them. Glad tidings are for the person who
will kill them. Whenever any of their offspring appear,
Allah , will eliminate them. The Prophet said this 20 times

341

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

or more and I was listening to it.140


Banu Tamim had the same rude behavior with the Sahaba also.







416 : :










140. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 2361.


342

Chapter 2 of Book III

416 : :

Ibn Abbas \ once preached to us after the Asr prayer, until


the sun set and the stars appeared, and people began to say:
The prayer! The prayer! A man of the Banu Tamim came
up to him and said: loudly and constantly: The prayer! The
prayer!, and Ibn Abbas \ got angry and replied: Are you
teaching me the Sunnah, you wretch? We have seen the
Prophet that he combined two prayer (timings). The
narrator Abdullah says that there was some doubt in my heart
about this, so, I met Hazrat Abu Huraira \ and asked about
this and he agreed (on the problem of combining two
prayers).141





: .

1383 :




141. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 2, adth 416.
343

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X






1383 : :
Ibn Abbas \ once preached to us after the Asr prayer, until
the sun set and the stars appeared, and people began to say:
The prayer! The prayer! A man of the Banu Tamim came
up to him and said: loudly and constantly: The prayer! The
prayer! And Ibn Abbas \ got angry and replied: Are you
teaching me the Sunnah, you wretch? We have seen Prophet
that he combined two prayer (timings)142
They will be proud of themselves.
Note: That again the word arrow is used in this adth.



142. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 2, adth 1383.
344

Chapter 2 of Book III





1861 : :
Narrated Hazrat Anas b. Malik \ that: our Dear Prophet
Muammad U said that a nation will come amongst you who
will worship and follow religion (Islam) so much that people
will be amazed by the excess of their worshipping (Allah) and
they themselves will be feeling proud of themselves. These
people will go out of religion like an arrow passes through the
game.143

143. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 5, adth 1861


345

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





: :
1170
Hazrat Muaz ibn Jabal \ said that the Quran will become
aged in the hearts of the people just like a piece of cloth
becomes aged and is thrown away. People will read the
Quran but they will neither have joy nor interest in it. These
people will be wearing the skins of lamb and they will have
hearts of wolves. Their actions will consist of greed. They will
have no fear (of Allah) and if they have some short coming in
some good deed (virtue), then they will say that we will fulfil
the shortcoming, and if they commit some sin (mistake), then
they will say that we will be forgiven because we are not
making partners with Allah.144
Banu Tamim did not accept the good news from the Prophet.





144. Sunan Darimi, Vol. 2, adth 1170.
346

Chapter 2 of Book III


!





( ) ( )





!
:
2288 :
347

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Narrated Imran bin Hussain \: While I was with The


Prophet, some people from Banu Tamim came to him. The
Prophet said: O Banu Tamim! Accept the good news! They
said: You have given us the good news; now give us
(something). (After a while) some Yemenites entered, and he
said to them, O the people of Yemen! Accept the good news,
as Banu Tamim have refused it. They said: We accept it, for
we have come to you to learn the Religion. So we ask you what
the beginning of this universe was. The Prophet U said:
There was Allah, and nothing else before Him and His
Throne was over the water, and He then created the Heavens
and the Earth and wrote everything in the Book. Then a man
came to me and said: O Imran! Follow your she camel for it
has run away! So I set out seeking it, and behold, it was
beyond the mirage! By Allah, I wished that it (my she-camel)
had gone but that I had not left (the gathering).145
Another adth telling us that Banu Tamim did not accept
good news from our Prophet

145. a Bukhari, Vol. 3, adth 2888.


348

Chapter 2 of Book III

.



!




1540 : : !
Narrated by Imran bin Husain: The people of Banu Tamim
came to Allahs Apostle, and he said: Be glad (i.e.: have good
tidings), O Banu Tamim! They said: As you have given us
good tidings, then give us (some material things): On that the
features of Allahs Apostle changed (i.e.: he took it ill). Then
some people from Yemen came, and the Prophet said (to
them): Accept good tidings as Banu Tamim have not
accepted them. They said: We accept them, O Allahs
Apostle!146

146 a Bokhari, Vol 2, adth 1540.


349

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Banu Tamim is the worst among the Arabs.


( )


:
7 8

1556 :

Narrated Abu Bakra \: The Prophet U said: Do you think if


the tribes of Aslam, Ghifar, Muzaina, and Juhaina are better
than the tribes of Tamim, Amir bin Sasaa, Ghatfan and
Asad, they (the second group) are despairing and losing?
They the Prophets companions said: Yes, (they are). He
said: By Him in Whose Hand my soul is, they (the first
group) are better than them (the second group).



350

Chapter 2 of Book III





.







!

742 : :
7 8
Narrated Abu Bakra: Al-Aqra bin Habis said to the Prophet:
Nobody gave you the pledge of allegiance but the robbers of
the pilgrims (i.e.: those who used to rob the pilgrims) from
the tribes of Aslam, Ghifar, and Muzaina. (Ibn Abi Yaqub is
in doubt whether Al-Aqra added and Juhaina.) The Prophet
U said: Dont you think that the tribes of Aslam, Ghifar, and
Muzaina (and also perhaps) Juhaina are better than the tribes
351

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

of Banu Tamim, Banu Amir, Asad, and Ghatfan? Somebody


said: They were unsuccessful and losers! The Prophet U
said: Yes, by Him in Whose Hands is my life, they (i.e.: the
former) are better than they (i.e.: the latter).

352

Chapter 3

Solid proof that the The Eastern area of


Affliction and Najad are both the same,
and that the Dajjal will appear from the Najad

Combining the following two pairs of adth (i.e.: total of four adth)
also proves that the east of Afflictions and Najd are both the same.
First pair of adth
This first adth mentions the word Najd where the horn of Satan will
appear.





.



353

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





1986 : :

Narrated Ibn Umar \: our Dear Prophet Muammad U said:
O Allah! Bless our Sham (Syria and some other countries),
and our Yemen. People said: our Najd as well. The Prophet
again said: O Allah! Bless our Sham and Yemen. They said
again: our Najd as well On that the Prophet said: There will
appear earthquakes and afflictions, and from there will come
out the side of the head of Satan. 147
This second adth mentions the same place where the horn of Satan
will appear but uses the word east instead of Najd.

147. a Bukhari, Vol. 3, adth 1986.


354

Chapter 3 of Book III






: :
1169
Narrated Ibn Umar \: Once our Dear Prophet Muammad
U prayed two times, O Allah! Bless our Shaam (Syria and
some other countries) and our Yemen. People said: Pray for
our east as well. The Prophet said: From there will come out
the side of the horn of Satan, and nine out of ten shar(evils)
appears from there.148
Second pair of adth
Proof by this third adth that the Dajjal will come out from the Najd.
This adth tells us that the Dajjal will come from the east
wherepeople will read the Quran but it will not pass through their
throats.

( )

148. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 1169.


355

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


.





: :
2361
It was narrated by Abdullah bin Umar \ that I heard, the
Messenger of Allah U saying that: Soon among my nation
(Muslim Ummah) there will appear people from the east who
will recite Quran but it will not go any deeper than their
collarbones or their throats. Whenever any of their offspring
will appear, they will be eliminated. He U repeated this 10
times, and then said until in the last of them will appear with
the Dajjal (Anti-Christ).149
This fourth adth tells us that about people who will recite the
Quran but it will not go deeper than their throats, and the Dajjal will
appear amongst them.

149. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 2361.


356

Chapter 3 of Book III

Here the word east is used instead of Najd, as in the previous


third adth, which again proves that that Najd and the east of
Affliction are the same, and that the Dajjal will appear from the
Najd.

( )
: ,






:

:


,




,

: ,




:







:


:









,






357

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

!






( )



!

!









358

Chapter 3 of Book III

. .
44 : : .

It was narrated that Sharik bin Shihab \ said: I used to wish
that I could meet a man among the Companions of The
Prophet and ask him about the Khawarij. Then I met Abu
Barzah \ on the day of Eid, with a number of his companions.
I said to him: Did you hear the Messenger of Allah U

mention the Khawarij? He said: Yes. I heard


the Messenger of Allah U with my own ears,
and saw him with my own eyes. Some wealth was brought to
the Messenger of Allah U and he distributed
it to those on his right and on his left, but he did not give
anything to those who were behind him. Then a man stood
behind him and said: Muammad! You have not been just
in your division! He was a black man with patchy (shaved)
hair, wearing two white garments and sign of prostration on
the forehead. So Allahs Messenger U became
very angry and said: By Allah! You will not find a man after
me who is more just than me.He U repeated these words
three times. Then he said: A people will come at the end of
time from the east; as if he is one of them and their appearance
will also be like this man. They will be reciting the Quran
without it passing beyond their throats. They will go through
Islam just as the arrow goes through the target. Their
distinction will be shaving. They will not cease to appear
until the last of them comes with Al-Masih Al the Dajjal. So
359

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

when you meet them, then kill them, they are the worst of
created beings. 150

150. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 9, adth 44.


360

Chapter 4

Banu Tamims attack on Imam Mahdi X

Banu Tamim Tribe will attack Imam Mahdi X.






361

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X




( )







6581 : :
Narrated by Umm Salma \ that our Dearest Prophet
Muammad U said that: Disagreement will occur after the
death of a Khalifa (note here Khalifa does not necessarily
mean a just Khalifa of Islam, it can mean a king), then a
person will flee from Madinah to Makkah. Some of the people
in Makkah will come to him and take him out against his will
and will give allegiance (Bayah) to him between Hajar Aswad
(black stone) and Maqam Ibrahim X. Then an army from
Sham (Syria) will come to attack him but will be devoured by
the earth at the place of BAIDAH. When people will see this,
then the Abdal of Sham (Syria), and the Asaeb of Iraq (Abdal
and Asaeb is a level of pious people from Shaam and Iraq
respectively, and their number is 40 according to other
362

Chapter 4 of Book III

narrations) will come and give allegiance (bayah) to him.


Then a person from Quraish will come forward, whose
maternal family will be from Banu Kulaib (a branch of
Banu Tamim). That personin Makkah (Imam Mahdi X)
will send an army towards that Qureshi and will overcome
him. This battle will be called the BATH KULAIB, and a
person is at great loss if he is not present at the distribution of
the booty of that ghazwa (battle). He will distribute the riches
and act upon the Sunnah of the Prophet, and Islam will put it
is neck on the earth (i.e.: Islam will start spreading again) and
he will rule for nine years on earth. 151
Banu Kulaib are the direct descendants of Banu Tamim.
Ibn Jarir is one of the greatest and most celebrated Muslim poets. It is a
well-known fact that Ibn Jarir is from the Banu Kulaib tribe.
If we check his family tree, we find that Banu Kulaib are the direct
descendants of Banu Tamim. Two important books show his family
tree:

151 Masnad Ahmad, adth 6581.


363

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Ibn Khallikans Biographical Dictionaryby Ibn Khallikan.


This book tells the family tree of Jarir as:
Abu Hazra Jarir son of
Ibn Atiya

son of

Ibn Khudaifa (surnamed al-Khatafa) son of


Ibn Badr

son of

Ibn Salma

son of

Ibn Yarbu

son of

Ibn Hanzla

son of

Ibn Malik

son of

Ibn Zaid Manat

son of

Ibn Tamim

son of

Ibn Murr at-Tamimi (descended from Tamim).152


Asiatic Journal.
Jarir, son of Ahtiyeh ben Khatfi, was born in the reign of Imam Ali \.
His family, the Banu Kolayb, was a branch of the great tribe of
Tamim.153

152. Page 294, Chapter: Jarir the Poet, Book: Ibn Khallikan's Biographical
Dictionary, Writer: Ibn Khallikan.
153. Asiatic Journal, Volume 16, page 73. 1835 (Google eBook)
364

Chapter 4 of Book III

Banu Tamim (Banu Kulaib) will be made slaves by Imam Mahdi X






)
(

( )
( )
)
( 8329
Narrated by Abu Huraira \ that our Dear Prophet
Muammad U said that: Disappointed will be the one who
does not receive the booty of Kalb, even if it is a single Aqal (a
small unit). I swear by the Name of the One who holds my
life, no doubt the women of Kulaib will be sold (as slaves) on
the way to Damascus until one of the women will be returned
back because of a broken ankle.154

154. Mustadrak Hakim, Chapter of Fitan wa Malahim, adth 8329.


365

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

The Arabs are made Slaves by Muslims


Previously in a adth it has been stated that the Arabs are not to be
made as slaves but in the above authentic adth, permission is given to
Muslims to make slaves of the Arabs. This permission is given in the
End of Times.

366

Chapter 5

The Horns of Satan And Its Meaning

We already mentioned many adth, telling us about the Horn of


Satan appearing from Najd, e.g.: the following adth. Read this adth,
and then we will further discuss the meaning of the Horn of Satan.
Najd is the land of the Horn of Satan.





.







367

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

1986 : :
14 16
Narrated Ibn Umar \: our Dear Prophet Muammad U said:
O Allah! Bless our Sham (Syria and some other countries)
and our Yemen. People said: our Najd as well. The Prophet
again said: O Allah! Bless our Sham and Yemen. They said
again, our Najd as well. On that the Prophet said: There
will appear earthquakes and afflictions, and from there will
come out the side of the head of Satan.155
Which two Arab tribes make the Horns of Satan?
The following adth tells us that the Horns of Satan means the cruel
Arabs tribes of Mudar and Rabiah from the east of Madinah.










155. a Bkhari, Vol. 3, adth 1986.
368

Chapter 5 of Book III

725 : :
Narrated Abi Masud \: The Prophet U said: From this side
from the east, afflictions will appear. Rudeness and lack of
mercy are characteristics of the rural bedouins who are busy
with their camels and cows (and pay no attention to religion).
Such are the tribes of Rabia and Mudar.156











:
1541 :
Narrated Abu Masood \: The Prophet U beckoned with his
hand towards Yemen and said: Belief is there. The
harshness and mercilessness are the qualities of the tribes of

156. a Bkhari, Vol. 2, adth 725.


369

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Rabia (the tribe of Al-e-Saud) and Mudar (The Banu Tamim)


who are shouting near the tails of camels in the direction of
the rising sun (i.e.: in the east ).157







183 : : .








It is narrated on the authority of Ibn Masud \ that the
Apostle of Allah U pointed towards Yemen with his hand and
said: Verily Iman is towards this side, and harshness and

157. a Bkhari, Vol. 2, adth 1541.


370

Chapter 5 of Book III

callousness of the hearts is found amongst the rude owners of


the camels who drive them behind their tails (to the direction)
where emerge the two horns of Satan, they are the tribes of
Rabia and Mudar.158
A very important adth which tells us that Banu Tamim are
the ones with camels and horses, as mentioned in the previous
adth (about the owners of camels and horses).

9601 :
, ( )


, :

:
, ,
.
,



2616 : :
Narrated by Abu Huraira \: our Dear Prophet of Allah U said
that the tribe of Ghifar, Aslam, Muzaina, and some of the part
of the tribe of Jahina is better than the tribe of Asad,
Ghatfan, Hawazan, and Tamim because they are people of

158. a Muslim, Vol. 1, adth 183.


371

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

camels and horses (or owner of camels and horses).159


The above adth mentioned that Banu Tamim owns Horses and
Camels and the following adth tells us that the owners of Horses
and Camels have pride and arrogance. This proves that Banu Tamim
has pride and arrogance:

79 :


( )
: :



:



.
Narrated by Abu Huraira \: our Dear Prophet of Allah U
said that faith is in the right, disbelief lies towards the
east (of Madinah), tranquility lies in people who
possess sheep, and the pride and arrogance lie in people
who possess horses and camels, who are also coarse.160

159. Masnad Ahmad bin Hambal, adth 9601.


160. a Muslim, adth 79.
372

Chapter 6

The great affliction of the Mudar tribe




.





3301 : : .
It is narrated on the authority of Hazrat Huzafa y that the
Apostle of Allah r said: The tribe of Mudar (i.e.: Banu
Tamim) will not leave a pious person on Earth, and it will put
in affliction and get them killed (or destroyed) until Allah I
will overpower them with His army, who will humiliate them

373

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

and they will find no place to hide.161


The Noble Quran is also warning about the same kind of
affliction in Srah Anfal





(8:25)



(8:25)
And fear the Fitnah (affliction and trial) which affects not in
particular (only) those of you who do wrong (but it may afflict
all the good and the bad people), and know that Allh is Severe
in punishment. (25:8)
If we combine the meaning of this verse and the previous hadith,
then it can be clearly said that this verse is also pointing out towards the
affliction of Mudar tribe from where Dajjal will first rise. Furhter
ahadith in the next pages will prove that the tribe of Mudar
mentioned in the previous hadith is just another name for the tribe of
Banu Tamim. Mudar or Banu Tamim is the tribe from where the
affliction of Khawarij rose.

161. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 9, adth 3301.


374

Chapter 6 of Book III

Mudar will Kill Innocent Muslims.




.




834 : : -
Hazrat Abu Saeed Khadri \ narrated that the Apostle of Allah
U said that, The tribe of Mudar (i.e.: Banu Tamim) will be
killing (innocent) creatures (people) of Allah , so that no one
is left to worship Allah , on earth. And when the faithful
(Muslims) will start killing them, then they (Mudar Tribe)
will find no place to hide.162
Who is Mudar and Rabia?
Rabia is the Ancestor tribe of the resent Saudi (Banu Saud) rulers.
Mudar is the tribe of Banu Tamim. Muammad ibn Abdul Wahhab is
also from Mudar or Banu Tamim.

162. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 5, adth 834.


375

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

These horns of Satan are related to the Ibn Saud family of Arabia.
The present Saudi royal family belong to the tribe of Anizzah, which
is directly descended from Rabia.
Rabiah (Arabic: Is the purported patriarch of (( one of the
two main branches of the so-called North Arabian (Adnanite) tribes,
the other branch being known as Mudar.
According to the classical Arab genealogists, the following were
the most important branches of Rabiah:

Abdul Qays

Anizzah

Bakr ibn Wail, which also included the following sub-tribes


Banu Hanifa
Banu Shayban
Banu Qays ibn Thalabah
Banu Yashkur

376

Chapter 7

Proof that the name Mudar and


Banu Tamim stands for the same tribe

Proof that the tribe of Quraish is distinct from the


tribe of Mudar.
Note: Banu Tamim of Najd were commonly known as the
Mudar tribe at the time of our Dear Prophet Muammad
U. The following family tree will clear these relations.

Figure: The Adnani Arab tribes.


377

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Mudar is one of the forefathers of Quraish, and Banu Tamim.


Mudar had a son called Rabiah who is the father of Anizzah.
Anizzah is the tribe of the present Saudi rulers. It means that the Saudi
rulers are from the Rabiah Tribe. 163
Now, the question is that if Mudar is the father of the Quraish
(i.e.: the tribe of Prophet Muammad U) then, how can our Dear
Prophet Muammad U be against his own family.
The reason is simple. At the time of our Dear Prophet Muammad
U, the tribe of Banu Tamim was known as the Tribe of Mudar as the
following adth clearly tells us.
Mudar Tribe are Banu Tamim
Proof No 1: From the following adth we learn that Mudar and
Banu Tamim are same tribe.

( )< >15634 :

:
:








:
,
: :
:

:


,



:
:

163. https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/%60Anizzah
378

Chapter 7 of Book III


:
,


:


:


.

:



:


: ,





,
:

:
: , :


:


, :



:
,



:




.
:







379

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X




.


















380

Chapter 7 of Book III




: :
Narrated by Harith bin Hassaan that near a place called
Rabza, he passed by an old lady (from Banu Tamim) who
was seperated from Banu Tamim.The old lady asked, Where
are you going?
I replied that I am going to Prophet Muammad U. She said
to take her also to Prophet Muammad U as she had
something to ask.
When I reached Madinah city, then I found Prophet
Muammad U surrounded by people and a black flag at that
place. I asked the people about what the matter was and they
told me that Prophet Muammad U is sending an army under
the command of Amr bin Aaas. I moved forward and said,
O prophet of Allah U, if you consider it suitable, then
declare the area of Hijaz (Makkah and Madinah) as a seperate
buffer between us and Banu Tamim.
When I said this, the old lady got angry and she came out with
anger and said, O Prophet of Allah, till what extent you will
compell our Mudar Tribe.
I said, O Prophet of Allah U, I brought this old lady but I
didnt know that she will start arguing with me. I take refuge

381

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

of Allah (The adth continues further ).164


Note: The old lady is from Banu Tamim and she is saying
Mudar as her tribe which means that Banu Tamim and
Mudar are the same. Also the sahabi only mentioned Banu
Tamim but the old lady is mentioning Mudar tribe which is
also the proof that both means the same.
Proof No 2: From the following adth also, we again learn that the
tribe of Mudar and the tribe of Banu Tamim are both the same.
The following adth mentions Mudar and Banu Tamim in the same
context and meaning, proving that both names are the same.
The first adth is mentioning Banu Tamim:

164. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 6.


382

Chapter 7 of Book III



: :
1197
It was narrated from Abdullah bin Abu Jada \ that he heard
the Prophet U say: More than the members of thetribe of
Banu Tamim will enter Paradise through the intercession
of a man from among my nation. They said: Oh Messenger
of Allah U, besides you? He said: Besides me. (a) I (the
narrator) said: Did you hear that from the Messenger of
Allah U? He said: I heard it.165
Now the following second adth is mentioning the Mudar Tribe
in the same context and same meaning as the first adth:

165. Sunan Ibn Majah, Vol. 3, adth 1197.


383

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





:
1204 :
Abdullah bin Qais \ said: I was with Abu Burdah one night,
and Harith bin Uqaish entered upon us. Harith told us that
night that the Messenger of Allah U said: Among my nation
are some by whose intercession more than the members of
the tribe of Mudar will enter Paradise, and among my nation
are some who will be made huge for the Fire until they fill one
of it is comers.166
We see that both the adth mentions Mudar and Banu Tamim
within the same context of meaning, proving that both names of
Mudar and Banu Tamim are used for the same tribe.
Proof No 3: The following adith tells us about the tribes of Mudar
and Rabia who possess camels, and who will make the horn of Satan
from Najd.
First check this first adth which tells us that these camel owners are
people of the tribe of Rabia and Mudar.


166. Sunan Ibn Majah, Vol. 3, adth 1204.
384

Chapter 7 of Book III






183 : : .








It is narrated on the authority of Ibn Masud \ that the
Apostle of Allah U pointed towards Yemen with his hand and
said: Verily Iman is towards this side, and harshness and
callousness of the hearts is found amongst the rude owners of
the camels who drive them behind their tails (to the direction)
where emerge the two horns of Satan, they are the tribes of
Rabia and Mudar.167

167. a Muslim, Vol. 1, adth 183.


385

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Now check this important adth which tells us that Banu Tamim are
the ones famous as owners of camels as mentioned in the previous
adth.

, ( ) 9601 :
:



, , , :


,

.


9601 : :
Narrated by Abu Huraira \: our Dear Prophet of Allah U said
that the tribe of Ghifar, Aslam, Muzaina and some of the part
of the tribe of Jahina is better than the tribe of Asad,
Ghatfan, Hawazan, and Tamim because they (the latter) are
people of camels and horses (or owner of camels and
horses).168
The above adth mentions that Banu Tamim owns horses and
camels and the following adth tells us that the owners of horses and
camels have pride and arrogance. This proves that Banu Tamim has
pride and arrogance.
168. Masnad Ahmad bin Hambal, adth 9601.
386

Chapter 7 of Book III


( ( 79 :
:


:



:


Narrated by Abu Huraira \: our Dear Prophet of Allah U said
that faith is in the right, disbelief lies towards the east and
tranquility lies in people who possess sheep, and the pride and
arrogance lie in people who possess horses and camels who
are also coarse.169
Proof No 4: adth mentioning the tribe of Mudar and the tribe of
Quraish as two different tribes.
If the word Mudar tribe meant the common ancestor of Quraish and
Banu Tamim, then the adth would never mention the two tribes
separately, and just mention the tribe of Mudar, as it would include
both of their children tribes (i.e.: Quraish and Banu Tamim).
But this is not the case. The word Mudar tribe in the adth never
points towards the common forefather of the Quraish. We always see
that Banu Tamim and Rabiah are mentioned separately proving that
this Mudar tribe never meant the son Mudar of ADNAN as the
following adth clearly tells:

169. a Muslim, adth 79.


387

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X






.




!


:
2262 :
Narrated by Abu Umama: I heard our Dear Prophet
Muammad U saying that with the Shifaa (prayer) of one
person, who will not be a prophet, people equal to the number
of the Rabia and Mudar tribe will enter paradise.
One person asked: O Prophet of Allah U, Is the tribe of
Rabia part of the Mudar tribe?

388

Chapter 7 of Book III

Our Dear Prophet Muammad U replied, I say only what I


have to say. 170
Here we have a second adth which proves that the word Mudar
Tribe never meant the son Mudar of ADNAN.



!

!

141 : :
Narrated by Abu Huraira \: I heard our Dear Prophet
Muammad U saying this prayer after raising from ruku
(bending in the obligatory prayer),

170. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 9, adth 2262.


389

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

O Allah, save Waleed son of Waleed, Ayyash son of Abi


Rabia, and other weak people of Makkah from the
oppression of the Quraish tribe. O Allah catch the tribe of
Mudar tightly, and send drought upon them just like the
drought at the time of Prophet Yusuf X.171
We already described that this separate tribe is the tribe of
Mudar is actually the Banu Tamim as the previous adth proves.
So it proves that the tribe of Quraish and the tribe of Mudar
were both separate and that the tribe of Banu Tamim was normally
known as the tribe of Mudar.

171. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 4, adth 141.


390

Chapter 8

The Heartless Tribe of Rabia and


Banu Tamim having Camels

The Harsh people of the east having camels.





.









391

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

371 : :

Narrated Abi Masud \: The Prophet said: From this side


from the east, afflictions will appear. Rudeness and lack of
mercy are characteristics of the rural bedouins who are busy
with their camels and cows (and pay no attention to religion).
Such are the tribes of Rabia and Mudar.172
adth No 1: Proves that these camel owners (of the above adth)
are the Rabiah and Banu Tamim tribes.




.


!


2385 : :

172. a Bukhari, Book #56, adth #702.


392

Chapter 8 of Book III

It is narrated on the authority of Ibn Masud \ that the


Apostle of Allah U pointed towards Yemen with his hand and
said: Verily Iman is towards this side, and harshness and
callousness of the hearts is found amongst the rude owners of
the camels who drive them behind their tails (to the direction)
where emerge the two horns of Satan, they are the tribes of
Rabia and Mudar.173
adth No 2: Proof that these cruel camel owners (mentioned in the
first adth) are Banu Tamim.
Here we have another adth which clearly tells us that Banu Tamim
tribe is famous for having camels and horses.

, ( ) 2616 :

:



, , , :


,




2616 : :

173. adth 083 found in The Book of Faith (Kitab Al-Iman) of a Muslim.
393

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Narrated by Abu Huraira \: our Dear Prophet of Allah U said


that the tribe of Ghifar, Aslam, Muzaina, and some part of the
tribe of Jahina is better than the tribe of Asad, Ghatfan,
Hawazan, and Tamim, because they are people of camels
and horses (or owner of camels and horses).174
The above adth mentioned that Banu Tamim owns horses and
camels, and the following adth tells us that the owners of horses and
camels have pride and arrogance. This proves that Banu Tamim has
pride and arrogance.

79 :

( (
: :





:



.
Narrated by Abu Huraira \: our Dear Prophet of Allah U said
that faith is in the right, disbelief lies towards the east and
tranquility lies in people who possess sheep, and that pride
and arrogance lie in people who possess horses and camels
who are also coarse.175

B
174. Masnad Ahmad bin Hambal, adth 9601.
175. a Muslim, adth 79.
394

Chapter 9

The End of Banu Tamim Tribe


by Imam Mahdi X

The great Affliction of Mudar Tribe.




.





3301 : : .
It is narrated on the authority of Hazrat Huzafa \ that the
Apostle of Allah U said that the tribe of Mudar (i.e.: Banu
Tamim) will not leave a pious person on Earth, that it will put
in affliction and get him killed (or destroyed) until Allah will
395

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

overpower them by His army, who will humiliate them and


they will find no place to hide.176
Mudar will Kill Innocent Muslims




.




834 : : -
Hazrat Abu Saeed Khadri \ narrated that the Apostle of Allah
U said that, The tribe of Mudar (i.e.: Banu Tamim) will be
killing (innocent) creatures (people) of Allah so that no one is
left to worship Allah on earth. And when the faithful
(Muslims) will start killing them, then they (Mudar Tribe)
will find no place to hide.177

176. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 9, adth 3301.


177. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 5, adth 834.
396

Chapter 9 of Book III

Our Dear Prophets U Dua against Banu Tamim (The Mudar Tribe).




.
141 : :


!

!

141 : :
Narrated by Abu Huraira \: I heard our Dear Prophet
Muammad U saying this prayer after raising from ruku
(bending in the obligatory prayer) of morning obligatory
prayer: O Allah, save Waleed son of Waleed, Ayyash son
of Abi Rabia, and other weak people of Makkah from the
oppression of the Quraish tribe. O Allah catch the tribe of
Mudar tightly and send drought upon them just like the
drought at the time of Prophet Yusuf X.178

178. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 4, adth 141.


397

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

The attack of Banu Tamim of Najd on Imam Mahdi X.


We have two important adth below.
1. The first adth tells us that Banu Tamim will attack Imam
Mahdi X.
2. The second adth tells us that the tribe of Banu Tamim will
be from the Najd.
adth No 1






398

Chapter 9 of Book III




( )







6581 : :
Narrated by Umm Salma \ that our Dearest Prophet
Muammad U said that: Disagreement will occur after the
death of a Khalifa (note here Khalifa does not necessarily
mean a just Khalifa of Islam. It can mean a king), then a
person will flee from Madinah to Makkah. Some of the people
in Makkah will come to him and take him out against his will
and will do allegiance (Bayah) to him between Hajar Aswad
(black stone) and Maqam Ibrahim. Then an army from Sham
(Syria) will come to attack to him but will be devoured by
earth at the place of BAIDAH. When people will see this, then
Abdal of Sham (Syria) and Asaeb of Iraq (Abdal and Asaeb is
a level of pious people from Shaam and Iraq respectively and
their number is 40 according to other narrations) will come
399

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

and take allegiance (bayah) of him. Then a person from


Quraish will come forward, whose maternal family will be
from Banu Kulaib (a branch of Banu Tamim). That person in
Makkah will send an army towards that Qureshi, and will
overcome him. This battle will be called the BATH KULAIB
and a person is at great loss if he is not present at the
distribution of the booty of that Ghazwa (battle). He will
distribute the riches and act upon the Sunnah of Prophet and
Islam will put it is neck on the earth (i.e.: Islam will spread)
and he will rule for nine years on earth.179
adth No 2
The following adth uses the word east for the same army described
in the previous adth. We already have mentioned that the east of
afflictions is Najd. So here the east meansNajd (eastern side of Arabia).

179. Masnad Ahmad, adth 6581.


400

Chapter 9 of Book III

: :
6367
Narrated by Hafsa \: I heard our Dear Prophet Muammad
U saying that: An army will rise from the east (Najd), to
attack Baitullah (the Holy Kaba in Makkah). When they
will reach a place called Baidaa, then the central part of that
army will be devoured by the earth and the people in the front
part of the army and in the back part of the army will be crying
to one another. Only one person will be saved who will tell
people about this news. I asked: O Prophet of Allah U, what
will happen to the person who will be forced to join this
army? our Dear Prophet of Allah U said that: This disaster
will fall upon everyone (in that army) but Allah , will raise
people (on the Judgement day) according to their

401

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

intentions.180

180. Masnad Ahmad, Volume 9, adth 6367.


402

Chapter 10

The Punishment of Banu Tamim

8402 :

( )




: :




.





)
(

( )
( )
)
( 8402

403

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Narrated by Abu Huraira \ that our Dear Prophet


Muammad U said that: Disappointed will be the one who
does not receive the booty of Kalb even if it a single Aqal (a
small unit). I swear by the Name of the One who holds my
life, no doubt the women of Kulaib will be sold (as slaves) in
the way to Damascus until one of the women will be returned
back because of a broken ankle.181

181. Mustadrak Hakim, Chapter of Fitan wa Malahim, adth 8329.


404

Chapter 11

The Difference between the East of


Imam Mahdi X and the East of affliction

Two types of east mentioned in the adth.


There are two types of east mentioned in the adth:
1. The first type of east is that of afflictions and turmoil from
where the Dajjal will appear. We already proved that this is the
Najd.
2. The second type of East is from where Imam Mahdi X and his
followers will appear. Also the Mongols (who have adopted
Turkish culture) will follow the Dajjal will come from the same
east (Khurasan) as that of Imam Mahdi X.
The difference between both is that the east of Imam Mahdis Army is
an area with cold climate and with ice.

:

)): :
. .
405

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

)) . .(( .
--.(( .
. . :
.


( )






( )
Thawban \ reported that our Dear Prophet U said: Three
people will fight for your treasure (and get killed). All three of
them will be sons of a ruler but none of them will get the
treasure. Then black flags will appear from the east and will
kill you as no one (in history) has killed you before. Then our
Dear Prophet U said something that I didnt remember. Then
again our Dear Prophet U said: If you see him then give him
your allegiance, even if you have to crawl over ice, because
he is the Khalifa of Allah, the Mahdi. (The given adth is
Most Authentic (a) according to conditions of a
406

Chapter 11 of Book III

Muslim and a Bukhari).182


The east of Affliction is a desert, as camels are mentioned in the
adth.















.
371 : :

182. Hakim Mustadrak, adth 4084, Kitab-al-Fitan.


407

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

The east of Imam Mahdis X Army is the Khurasan.


We must know that Khurasan also means The land of the rising sun
or the east .

1599 : :

Abu Huraira \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet


Muammad U reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad
U said: Black flags will appear from the Khurasan. Nothing
will stop them until they will be placed at Elya (The Holy Land
of Jerusalem).183
The following adth tells us that the above adth that speaks of
camel owners is related to the Mudar and Rabia tribes.

183. Masnad Ahmad, Volume 4, adth 1599.


408

Chapter 11 of Book III



.


!


2385 : :
It is narrated on the authority of Ibn Masud \ that the
Apostle of Allah U pointed towards Yemen with his hand and
said: Verily Iman (faith) is towards this side, and harshness
and callousness of the hearts is found amongst the rude
owners of the camels who drive them behind their tails (to the
direction) where emerge the two horns of Satan, they are the
tribes of Rabia and Mudar.184

184. adth 083 found in The Book of Faith (Kitab Al-Iman) of a Muslim.
409

Chapter 12

Proof that the East of Affliction


is from the Najad

In many adth we are told about the following points:

The horns of Satan are from the east and the Najd.

People who read the Quran but it will not pass from their
throats are from the east, and the Najd.

You see the same incident or the same points described against
both in the Najd and the east , which means that in these hadth
the word east means the Najd, and vice versa.

We shall check some of the hadth:


Proof No 1: The east of Afflictions means the Najd.
The following adth is related to the previous hadth of ZulKhuwaisara Tamimi as it tells us about the same hypocrites who will
be reading the Quran but it will not pass through their throats. Here we
see the word east is used.

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

( )



.





: :
2361
It was narrated by Abdullah bin Umar \ that he heard the
Messenger of Allah U saying that: Soon among my nation
(Muslim Ummah) there will appear people from the east who
will recite the Quran but it will not go any deeper than their
collarbones or their throats. Whenever any of their offspring
will appear, they will be eliminated. He U repeated this ten
times, and then said: Until the last of them will appear with
the Dajjal (Anti-Christ).185
Now we have another adth about the same incident. It is further
explained in this adth that these people will be among the tribes of
185. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 2361.
412

Chapter 12 of Book III

Najd in the east.















.
.





(3) (2) (1)
413

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





()















)
(

414

Chapter 12 of Book III

489 : : .
24

It was narrated that Abu Saeed Al Khudri \ said: When he


was in Yemen, Ali \ sent a piece of gold that was still mixed
with sediment to the Messenger of Allah U and the Messenger
of Allah U distributed it among four people: Al-Aqra bin
Habis Al-Hanzali, Uyaynah bin Badr Al- Fazari, Alqamah
bin Ulathah Al Amiri, who was from Banu Kilab and Zaid
At-Tai who was from Banu Nabhan. The Quraish - he said
one time the chiefs of the Quraishbecame angry and
said: You give to the chiefs of Najd and not to us? He said: I
only did that, so as to soften their hearts towards Islam. Then
a man with a thick beard, prominent cheeks, sunken eyes, a
high forehead, and a shaven head came and said: Fear Allah,
Muammad! He said: Who would obey Allah if I disobeyed
Him? (Is it fair that) He has entrusted me with all the people
of the Earth but you do not trust me? Then the man went
away, and a man from among the people, whom they (the
narrators) think was Khalid bin Al Walid \, asked for
permission to kill him. The Messenger of Allah U said:
Among the offspring of this man will be some people who
will recite the Quran but it will not go any further than
their throats.They will kill the Muslims but leave the idol
worshippers alone, and they will pass through Islam as an
arrow passes through the body of the target. If I live to see
415

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

them, I will kill them all, as the people of Ad were killed.186


So we see, that in both the adth we have the common word
people who recite the Quran but it will will not go any further than
their throats connected the word east and Najd, which means that
both these words have the same meaning.
The east of Afflictions (Fitnah) = Najd
Proof No 2: The east of Afflictions means the Najd
The following two adth gives us a solid proof that the east of Affliction
(Fitnah) always means Najd in the adth.
The first adth tells us that Horns of Satan are from the east.

186. Sunan Nisai, Vol. 2, adth 489.


416

Chapter 12 of Book III

: :
1169
Narrated by Hazrat Abdullah Bin Umar \ that once our Dear
Prophet Muammad U prayed two times that O Allah!
Bestow Your blessings on our Yemen O Allah! Bestow Your
blessings on our Shaam (Syria). A person said: O Allahs
Apostle! And also on our east. The Prophet said: There (in
the east) comes out the side of the head of Satan and nine out
of ten (parts) of evil is from there.187





.

!

!

: :
1500

187. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 1169.


417

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Narrated by Hazrat Abdullah Bin Umar \ that once our Dear


Prophet Muammad U prayed three times that O Allah!
Bestow Your blessings on our Yemen O Allah! Bestow Your
blessings on our Shaam (Syria). A person said: O Allahs
Apostle! And also on our Najd. The Prophet said: There (in
Najd) comes out the side of the head of Satan and nine out of
ten (parts) of evil is from there.188
Conclusion
We see that both adth are pointing towards the same incident with
the mention of the Horns of Satan. In one adth the Horns of Satan
is told to be coming from the east, and in the second adth it is told to
be coming from the Najd, and this proves that:
East of Afflictions = Najd = The Horns of Satan
We also have another adth about the same incident and again we see
that the word Najd is used instead of east.
The Prophet said: O Allah! Bestow Your blessings on our Sham! O
Allah! Bestow Your blessings on our Yemen. The People said: And
also on our Najd. He said: O Allah! Bestow Your blessings on our
Sham (north)! O Allah! Bestow Your blessings on our Yemen. The
people said: O Allahs Apostle! And also on our Najd. I think the third
time the Prophet said: There (in Najd) is the place of earthquakes and

188. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 1500.


418

Chapter 12 of Book III

afflictions, and from there comes out the side of the head of Satan. 189

189. a Al-Bukhari, Book of Tribulations and the End of the World, adth
No. 6641.
419

Chapter 13

Confusion between Iraq and Najad

Is the land of afflictions in the east Iraq, but not Najd?


There is a single adth of Sahal bin Hanif mentioning the name of Iraq
where evil people will rise who read the Quran but it will will not pass
through their throats.

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

1863 : :

Narrated Yusair bin Amr \: I asked Sahl bin Hunaif \, Did


you hear the Prophet saying anything about Al-Khawarij?
He said: I heard him saying while pointing his hand towards
Iraq. There will appear in it (i.e.:, Iraq) some people who will
recite the Quran but it will not go beyond their throats, and
they will go out from (leave) Islam as an arrow darts through
the games body.
But Sahal Bin Hanif was telling the same about east.





2463 : :
422

Chapter 13 of Book III

Yusair b. Amr \ reported that he inquired of Sahl b. Hunaif


\: Did you hear the Apostle of Allah U making a mention the
Khawarij? He said: I heard him say (and he pointed with his
hand towards the east) that There would be a people who
would recite the Quran with their tongues and it would not
go beyond their collar bones. They would pass clean through
their religion just as the arrow passes through the prey.


:






.

:




2465 : :
Sahl b. Hunaif \ reported Allahs Apostle U as saying: There
would arise from the east a people with shaven heads.
Objection No 1: Why did Sahal bin Hanif mentions Iraq once, and
then he mentions the east (while Iraq is not located at the east of
Madinah city)?
The reason is simple. The founder of the Khriji (i.e.: Zul-Khuwaisara
Tamimi) was from Najd (please check the adth at the beginning of the
423

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

book), but the movement spread too many parts including Iraq.
The spreading and wandering of Khriji is beautifully depicted in
the following adth:




.




1814 : :
Sahl b. Hunaif \ reported Allahs Apostle U as saying: From
the east a nation will come who will be wandering (here and
there), and they will have shaved heads. Someone asked
about Madinah city, and our Dear Prophet replied that:
Madinah is Haram, and a land of peace.190
I already wrote the adth telling us that the Khriji will have
shaved heads, so the above adth is pointing towards the Khriji.

190. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 6, adth 1814.


424

Chapter 13 of Book III

Another answer to Objection No 1.


The Khawarij came from the NAJD (Central part of Arabia which lies
to the east of the Hejaz, the region where city of Riyadh is located), but
later they made Iraq their home base to wage their evil war against
Hazrat Ali \, and Hazrat Ameer Muawiyah \, and so they brought
their fitnah from the Najd in Arabia to Iraq as well.
People of Iraq killed the Khriji of Najd.
Here is the undeniable proof that the Khriji shifted towards Iraq and
were killed by the people of Iraq:







.






425

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

: :

2450

Abu Said al-Khudri said that the Apostle of Allah U made a


mention of a sect that would be among his Ummah which
would emerge out of the dissension of the people. Their
distinctive mark would be shaven heads. They would be the
worst creatures or the worst of the creatures. The group who
would be nearer to the truth out of the two would kill them.
The Apostle of Allah U gave an example (to give their
description) or he said: A man throws an arrow at the prey (or
he said at the target), and sees at its iron head, but finds no
sign (of blood there), or he sees at the lowest end, but would
not see or find any sign (of blood there). He would then see
into the grip but would not find (anything) sticking to it. Abu
Said then said: People of Iraq, it is you who have killed
them.191

B
191. a Muslim, Vol. 1, adth 2450
426

Chapter 14

Further discsussion regarding the Horns of


Satan appearing from Najd (and not Iraq)

Our Dear Prophet Muammad U prayed for Iraq and prayed against
the Najd.
adth telling about our dear Prophets U prayer for Iraq to turn their
hearts towards the right path




.





: :
567

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Narrated by Sayyidna Jabir \ that one day,The Prophet of


Allah U turned towards the Shaam(Syria and adjacant area)
and I heard him U saying that,O Allah, turn their hearts(to
the right path) and then turned towards Iraq and said the
same prayer and then turn towards the sky(i.e turning face
towards the sky) and said, O Allah, grant us fruit of the earth
and grant barakah (i.e. blessing of abundance) in our
Mudd and Saa (both are measuring units for
weighing).192
In the following two adth, we see that our Dear Prophet
Muammad U is praying against the Najd. (Also the combination of
these two adth proves that the east of affliction is always the Najd).





.

!

!

192. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 8, adth 567.


428

Chapter 14 of Book III

: :
1500
Ibn Umar said: The Prophet U mentioned: O Allah, give us
Baraka (i.e. blessing of abundance) in our Shaam ( Syria
and adjacent area), and in our Yemen.
One person asked: O Prophet of Allah U pray for our Najd
also. Prophet of Allah U said: In that place are earthquakes,
and seditions, and in that place shall rise the devils horn
[qarn al-shaytan].193

In the above adth, how can the Najd and Iraq be the same
area of affliction, when the Prophet U is making the same
Dua (prayer) in favour of Iraq, and also praying against the
Najd?

How can the Horn of Satan come from Iraq when Prophet
Muammad U prayed for Iraq?

Confusion between Iraq and Najd.


The single adth of Sahal bin Hanif mentioning the name of Iraq as
the land of affliction.

193. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 15000.


429

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

1863 : :

Narrated Yusair bin Amr \: I asked Sahl bin Hunaif \: Did


you hear the Prophet saying anything about Al-Khawarij?
He said: I heard him saying while pointing his hand towards
Iraq. There will appear in it (i.e.:, Iraq) some people who will
recite the Quran but it will not go beyond their throats, and
they will go out from (leave) Islam as an arrow darts through
the games body.194
Why Iraq is mentioned in the above adth?
The reason is simple. The founder of the Khriji (i.e.: Zul-Khuwaisara
Tamimi) was from Najd (please check the adth in the beginning of

194. a Bkhari, Vol. 3, adth 1863.


430

Chapter 14 of Book III

the book) but the movement spread too many parts including Iraq. In
fact Iraq became their center after they were driven out of the Arabian
Peninsula.
The next adth (narrated by the same Sahal bin Hanif) also tells
us that the Khawarij will be wandering and moving from one place to
another. That is why they moved from Najd to Iraq.
The wandering nature of the Khriji.
This displacement of the Khriji and their wandering nature is
beautifully depicted in the following adth:




.




1814 : :
Sahl b. Hunaif \ reported that Allahs Apostle U as saying:
From the east a nation will come who will be wandering
(here and there), and they will have shaved heads. Someone
asked about Madinah city, and our Dear Prophet replied that:
431

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Madinah is Haram, and a land of peace.195


That is why Sahal Bin Hanif (narrator of the previous adth
which mentions Iraq as the land of affliction) is again mentioning
the east for afflictions in the following adth. We all know that Iraq
is not in the east of Madina.





2463 : :
Yusair b. Amr \ reported that he inquired of Sahl b. Hunaif
\: Did you hear the Apostle of Allah U making a mention of
the Khawarij? He said: I heard him say (and he pointed with
his hand towards the east) that these would be a people who
would recite the Quran with their tongues and it would not
195. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 6, adth 1814.
432

Chapter 14 of Book III

go beyond their collar bones. They would pass clean through


their religion just as the arrow passes through the prey.196
Another adth in which Sahal Bin Hanif is mentioning the east
as the land of afflictions and not Iraq (which is in the North of Madinah
city).


:






.

:




2465 : :
Sahl b. Hunaif \ reported Allahs Apostle U as saying: There
would arise from the east a people with shaven heads.197
adth of Abdullah Bin Umar (RA) about Iraq.

196. a Muslim, Vol. 1, adth 2463.


197. a Muslim, Vol. 1, adth 2465.
433

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X



2797 : :
Ibn Fudail \ reported on the authority of his father that he
heard Salim b. Abdullah b. Umar \ as saying: O people of
Iraq, how strange it is that you ask about the minor sins but
commit major sins? I heard from my father Abdullah b.
434

Chapter 14 of Book III

Umar \, narrating that he heard Allahs Messenger U as


saying while pointing his hand towards the east: Verily the
turmoil would come from this side, from where appear the
horns of Satan, and you would strike the necks of one another;
and Moses X killed a person from among the people of
Pharaoh unintentionally and Allah, the Exalted and Glorious,
said: You killed a person but We relieved you from the grief
and tried you with (many a) trials (20:40). Ahmad b. Umar
\ reported this adth from Salim, but he did not make a
mention of the words: I heard. 198
Here, Hazrat Abdullah is telling the people of Kufah from Iraq that
every fitnah will come from the east. This is because the town of Kufah
was inhabited by the Banu Hanifa tribe who were originally from Najd.
Banu Hanifa also joined the Banu Tamim tribe in their evil movement
of Khawarij.
Also we see that he is talking about the east (of Madinah) where
the Najd lies, and not Iraq.
We know that Yamamah is an area around Riyadh in Najd.
The following adth tells us that Yamamah and the east have the
same meaning which proves that east in the hadth normally means
the Najd.

198. a Muslim, Vol. 3, adth 2797.


435

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X








: : .
1454














436

Chapter 14 of Book III




!
!

1454 : :
(Translation of only the part which describes that the
Yamamah (Najd) and the has the same meaning)
Narrated by Abdullah bin Badar: A companion of our Dear
Prophet Muammad U Abdullah Bin Umar \ called us
(during the time of Hajj). When we went close to him
Abdullah Bin Umar \ asked us: Who are you people? We
replied: We are the people of the east. Then again replied:
We are the people of Yamamah (city of Najd) the adth
continues further.199
We see in the above adth, that the same person calls the east,
and the Yamamah city the same, which proves that the Najd was well
known as the east at that time.

199

Masnad Ahmad, Volume 3, adth 1454.


437

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Another adth telling us that Yamamah and Najd are the same.
Also the following adth tells us the same thing, that Najd and
Yamamah are both same.




.




()

716 : :
10

It was narrated from Saeed bin Abi Saeed that he heard Abu
Hurairah \ say: The Messenger of Allah U
sent some horsemen toward Najd, and they brought back a
man from Banu Hanifa who was called Thumamah bin Uthal,
the chief of the people of Al-Yamamah. The he was tied to
one of the pillars of the Masjid. (This adth continues
further and I have translated it till here.) 200

200. Sunan Nisai, Vol. 1, adth 716.


438

Chapter 14 of Book III

adth of Meqat-e-Hajj differentiating between Iraq and Najd.




.





567 : :
3
It was narrated that Aishah \ said: The Messenger of Allah
U designated Dhul-Hulaifah as the Miqat
for the people of Al-Madinah, Al-Juhfah for the people of Ash
Sham and Egypt, Dhat Irq for the people of Al-Iraq, Qarn for
the people of Najd and Yalamlam for the people of Yemen.201

201. Sunan Nisai, Vol. 2, adth 567.


439

Chapter 15

The meaning of Reading the Quran but


not passing through their throats.

In almost all of the adth that deal with this subject, both the reading
of the Quran, and not passing through their throats, is mentioned. The
meaning is explained in the following two adth:

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





462 : :
Narrated by Abdul Malik bin Malil: I was sitting on the
occasion of the Friday prayer near the pulpit with Uqba (who
is was a companion of our Dear Prophet Muammad U.
Muammad bin Abi Hanifa came and started giving sermon
at the pulpit. He recited a srah of the Quran. He was one of
the best reciters. Then Uqba \ said: Allah Subhana hu and
His Messenger U said the truth. I have heard our Dear
Prophet saying that many people will read the Quran but it
will not pass through their throats, and they will leave the
Deen (Islam) just like an arrow passes quickly through it is
prey.202

202. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 7, adth 462.


442

Chapter 15 of Book 3

2869 :

So it means that they will be reading the Quran very beautifully,


but they will not act upon it, and also their objective will be to gain
worldly benefits by the beautiful recitation of the Quran.
Can the reader tell which people, and from which geographical area
today are known to be the best reciters of the Quran?
The reader knows the answer, and this is the proof of the truth of the
above adth.
Also the following adth tells us that offspring of Zul-Khuwaisara
Tamimi will be reading the Quran continuously and elegantly. We
already know that Zul-Khuwaisara is from the Najd and from the Banu
Tamim tribe.






443

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


( )







444

Chapter 15 of Book 3



! !

!
)

(


( )

( )








: :
17 24

1509

Narrated Abu Said Al Khudri \: Ali bin Abi Talib \ sent a


piece of gold not yet taken out of it is ore, in a tanned leather
container to Allahs Apostle. Allahs Apostle distributed that
445

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

amongst four Persons: Uyaina bin Badr, Aqra bin Habis, Zaid
Al-Khail and the fourth was either Alqamah or Amir Binat
Tufail. On that, one of his companions said: We are more
deserving of this (gold) than these (persons). When that
news reached the Prophet, he said: Dont you trust me
though I am the truth worthy man of the One in the Heavens,
and I receive the news of Heaven (i.e.: Divine Inspiration)
both in the morning and in the evening? There got up a man
with sunken eyes, raised cheek bones, raised forehead, a thick
beard, a shaven head and a waist sheet that was tucked up and
he said: O Allahs Apostle! Be afraid of Allah. The Prophet
said: Woe to you! Am I not of all the people of the earth the
most entitled to fear Allah? Then that man went away.
Khalid bin Al-Walid \ said: O Allahs Apostle! Shall I chop
his neck off? The Prophet said: No, for he may offer
prayers. Khalid said: Numerous are those who offer prayers
and say by their tongues (i.e.: mouths) what is not in their
hearts. Allahs Apostle U said: I have not been ordered (by
Allah) to search the hearts of the people or cut open their
bellies. Then the Prophet looked at him (i.e.: that man) while
the latter was going away and said: From the offspring of
this (man there will come out (people) who will recite the
Quran continuously and elegantly but it will not exceed
their throats. (They will neither understand it nor act upon
it). They would go out of the religion (i.e.: Islam) as an arrow
goes through a games body. I think he also said: If I should
be present at their time I would kill them as the nations a
446

Chapter 15 of Book 3

Thamud were killed. 203

203. a Bukhari, Vol. 2, adth1509.


447

Chapter 16

Two Very Important adth telling


about the Eastern location of Najad

Najd lies in the direction of the rising of the Sun (i.e. The East)
The following adth tells us that the word east means the direction
of the rising of the sun and not towards Iraq.










1603 : :

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Narrated by Abdullah bin Omar that he heard Dear Prophet


Muammad U saying that: O Allah bring barakah
(blessings) in our city of Madinah, our Shaam and our
Yemen. Then he U turned towards the direction of the
rising Sun (i.e. the East) and said that Horn of Satan will
appear from here and earthquakes and afflictions will be from
there.204
In the following adth it is clearly told that our Dear Prophet
Muammad U is pointing towards the east.




.




:

938 :

Narrated by Abdullah bin Omar: Once Dear Prophet


Muammad U lead the obligatory prayer of Fajar
(morning) and then after salam stood in the direction of the
204 Masnad Ahmad,Vol 3,adth 1603
450

Chapter 16 of Book III

rising sun and pointed towards the East with his hand and two
times said that Affliction will be from here where the horn of
the Satan will rise. 205
Geographically, Iraq is not in the east of Madina.

Figure: Even a primary grade student can tell


that the Najd is at the east of Al-Madinah city.

205. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 938.


451

Chapter 17

Resemblance between the afflictions of


the Najad and the Wahhabi Movement

The origin of the Khawarij and the Wahhabi movement is the same.
The Wahhbiya (h) or Wahhabi movement originated from the Najd.
The founder of this movement is Muammad ibn Abd al-Wahhab
(Arabic: ; 1703 - 22 June 1792) who was from Uyayna
in Najd. Uyayna is close to Riyadh. The Khawarij were also from the
same area.
In fact they are called Khawarij because they first
came from Al-Kharj.
Few people know that Khawarij are called Khawarij because they first
came from Al-Kharj, which was the area where Al-Yamamah was
situated. Al-Yamamah was known as Najd as described in the following
adth.
The following adth also describes Yamamah as part of Najd.

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


716 : : --




()
716 : :
It was narrated from Saeed bin Abi Saeed that he heard Abu
Hurairah \ say: The Messenger of Allah U sent some
horsemen toward Najd, and they brought back a man from
Banu Hanifa who was called Thumamah bin Uthal, the chief
of the people of Al-Yamamah. Then he was tied to one of the
pillars of the Masjid.
It can be easily confirmed by these words of Wikipedia (I hope they
do not change it to hide the truth):
Al-Yamamah (Arabic: al-Yamamah) is an ancient
district lying to the east of the plateau of Najd, in modern-day
Saudi Arabia, or sometimes more specifically, the nowextinct ancient village of Jaww Al-Yamamah, near Al-Kharj,
after which the rest of the region was named. The region was
gradually subsumed in recent centuries under the term
Najd, which encompasses a larger area. However, the term
Al-Yamamah still lives on as a nostalgic historical term that
454

Chapter 17 of Book 3

is invoked to emphasize the regions ties with it is ancient past.


The current headquarters of the Saudi government in Riyadh,
for example, is known as the Palace of Yamamah. 206
The Tribe of Ibn Saud is described in the adth
Ibn Saud belongs to the Anizzah tribe. The tribe of Aniza is the direct
descendant of Rabiah tribe, as told in the following reference.
Rabiah (Arabic: purported (patriarch of one of the two
main branches of the so-called North Arabian (Adnanite) tribes, the
other branch being known as Mudar.
According to the classical Arab genealogists, the following were
the most important branches of Rabiah:

Abdul Qays

Anizzah

Bakr ibn Wail, which also included the following sub-tribes:


o

Banu Hanifa

Banu Shayban

Banu Qays ibn Thalabah

Banu Yashkur.207

We already mentioned the adth about the tribe of Rabiah. We


shall once again reproduce it here.
206. https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Al-Yamama
207. Wikipedia.
455

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X




.


!


2385 : :
It is narrated on the authority of Ibn Masud \ that the
Apostle of Allah U pointed towards Yemen with his hand and
said: Verily Iman is towards this side, and harshness and
callousness of the hearts is found amongst the rude owners of
the camels who drive them behind their tails (to the direction)
where emerge the two horns of Satan, they are the tribes of
Rabia and Mudar.208
We know that the Aniza tribe appeared from the Najd, and so the
following adth points towards Najd, and clearly tells us that the tribe
of Rabiah is associated with the Horns of Satan.
Note: The present rulers of ArabiaBanu Saudbelong to
the Anizzah tribe, which are the direct descendants the Rabia
208. adth 083 found in The Book of Faith (Kitab Al-Iman), of a Muslim.
456

Chapter 17 of Book 3

tribe.209
One of Rabias son is called Anizzah, from which the tribe of
Anizzah descends.210 Ibn Saud is from the tribe of Anizzah.
Both the families of Ibn Saud (i.e.: Anizzah), and Ibn Abdul
Wahhab (i.e.: Banu Tamim) are ruling Arabia today.

Figure: Yamamah and Riyadh are part of Najd.


Yamamah is located inside the Najd. Riyadh is located in Wadi
209. Check Wikipedia.com for Rabiah and Anizzah tribes.
210. Hamad Al-Jassir, Hizzan, Compendium of the Lineages of the Settled
Families of Najd, Part. II, p. 889 (Arabic).
457

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Hanifa of Yamamah. Riyadh is exactly at the east of Madinah


Boundaries of Najd.
The Arabic word Najd literally means upland. Najd is the central
region of the Arabian Peninsula, roughly bounded on the west by the
mountains of the Hejaz and Yemen, and to the east by the historical
region of Bahrain, and the north by Iraq and Syria.
The following adth also describes Yamamah as part of Najd.




716 : : --




()
716 : :
It was narrated from Saeed bin Abi Saeed that he heard Abu
Hurairah \ say: The Messenger of Allah U
sent some horsemen toward Najd, and they brought back a
man from Banu Hanifa who was called Thumamah bin Uthal,
the chief of the people of Al-Yamamah. The he was tied to
458

Chapter 17 of Book 3

one of the pillars of the Masjid. (The adth continues


further but I only translated up to here).211

Figure: Yamamah is part of Najd and at the heart of the Najd. 212

211. Sunan Nisai, Vol. 1, adth 716.


212. http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/File:Yamama_english.jpg
459

Chapter 18

The Dress of the Army of the Dajjal



)
( .





2892 : :
1 6
Anas b. Malik \ reported that Allahs Messenger U said: The
Dajjal would be followed by seventy thousand Jews of Isfahan
wearing Tayalisi hoods on their heads. 213

213. a Muslim, Vol. 3, adth 2892.

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


:
( )
"
"

45 : : ( )
Narrated by Anas b. Malik \ that our Dear Prophet
Muammad U said that: Seventy thousand Jews from
Esfahan will obey the Dajjal (Anti-Christ), and they will have
Tayalisi Hoods (over their heads).214
TAYALISAH is the Dress of Jews



.

( )

214. a Muslim. Also Mishkat-al-Masabeeh, Vol. 5, adth 45.


462

Chapter 18 of Book III

1388 : :
Narrated Abu Imran: Anas \ looked at the people (in Basra),
on Friday, wearing Tailsans (i.e.: a special kind of head
covering worn by Jews in old days) like the Jews of Khyber.
On that Anas \ said: At this moment they (i.e.: those people)
look like the Jews of Khaibar. 215
The green Tayalisah is called Saijan.



.



2306 : : .
Narrated Anas b. Malik \: our Dear Prophet said that the
Dajjal will appear from the Yahudia city of Isphahan (Iran),
and there will be seventy thousand Jews with him with
Saijan sheets over them.216

215 a Bokhari, Vol 2, adth 1388.


216 Masnad Ahmad,Vol 5, adth 2306.
463

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

:

4198
( )





:



" :

"

"

) "
(
Narrated by Abu Saeed Khudri \: The Prophet of Allah U
said that seventy thousand people from my Ummah
(nation) having Saijan sheets over them.217
Also, a long adth from the adth book of Sunan Ibn Majah
telling us about the Saijan sheets being worn by the army of the Dajjal:



...

217 Sharah As-Sunnah, Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 419.


464

Chapter 18 of Book III



...

( )
( )

( )

( )


()

957 : : ...
10

Part of a long adth narrated by Abu Umamah: and


afterwards Jesus X will say: Open the gate. The gate will be
opened, and behind it will be the Dajjal and a thousand Jews,
each of them bearing a sword, jewelry, and a saijan (green
head cover). When the Dajjal sees Jesus X, he will begin to
dissolve like salt in water, and will run away. Jesus X will say:
You will remain alive until I strike you with my sword. He
465

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

will catch up with him at the eastern gate of Ludd [1] and will
kill him. The Jews will be deflated with the help of Allah
(The adth continues further). 218
The explanation of the saijan in Mishkat


) :
(
"
"

45 : : ( )
Saijan is the plural of saj, just like taijanis the plural of taj. Now Saj
or saijan is just like taylasan but it iscolor is green. 219

218 Sunan Ibn Majah,Vol 3, adth 957.


219 Sharah Mishkat-al-Masabeeh, Vol 5,explanation of adth 25.
466

Chapter 18 of Book III

The Meaning of Tayalisah or Taylasan


The following references will clear the meaning of a tayalisah.
M.T. Houtsma writes that: Al tayalisah, is the plural of
taylasan, a piece of clothing that covers the head-dress and
sometimes also the shoulders (see Dozy, Dictionnaire
detaille des noms des vetements chez les arabes, p 278 sqq).220
Also, Yedida Kalfon Stillman, Norman A. Stillman writes:
The taylasan was a shawl-like head cloth which was
considered a typically Khaybari Jewish garment. 221
So, we see that the tayalisah is a piece of cloth, or small shawl that
covers the head, and sometimes shoulders. It is shown in the given
figure:

220. First Encyclopaedia of Islam by M. T. Houtsma.


221. Arab Dress: A Short History from the Dawn of Islam to Modern Times, By
Yedida Kalfon Stillman, Norman A. Stillman, page 18.

467

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Tayalisah sheets covering the head and the shoulders.

468

Chapter 18 of Book III

Saijan - a green tayalisah is called Saijan

Yemenite Jew wearing a tayalisah. Yahya Joseph Mossa,


Rabbi of al-Salem Jews wearing a tayalisah.

469

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

The head dress of the Prophet is the turban.


Some scholars say that it is allowed to wear this dress (i.e.: tayalisah),
but it should be noted that our Dear Prophet Muammad U mostly
wore a turban, and not the tayalisah as the following adth tells us:




: :
816
Jabir b. Abdullah al-Ansari \ reported that Allahs
Messenger U entered Mecca and Qutaiba (another narrator)
stated that he entered Mecca in the Year of Victory, wearing
a black turban, but not wearing the Ihram.222

222. a Muslim, Vol. 2, adth 816.


470

Chapter 18 of Book III




: :
816
Jafar b. Amr b. Huraith \ reported his father as saying: As
if I am seeing Allahs Messenger U on the pulpit with a black
turban on his head, and it is two ends hanging between his
shoulders. Abu Bakr (another narrator) did not make
mention of: Upon the pulpit. 223

223. a Muslim, Vol. 2, adth 819.


471

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X




)
(

: :
146
Narrated Anas ibn Malik \: I saw the Messenger of Allah U
perform ablution. He had a Qatari turban. He inserted his
hand beneath the turban and wiped over the forelock, and
did not untie the turban. 224

( )
::

224. a Abu Dawud, Vol. 1, adth 146.


472

Chapter 18 of Book III

1 688
Narrated Abdur Rahman ibn Awf \: The Apostle of Allah U
put a turban on me and let the ends hang in front and behind
me. 225

687 : :
2

Narrated Ali ibn Rukanah: Ali quoting his father said:


Rukanah wrestled with the Prophet and the Prophet threw
him on the ground. Rukanah said: I heard the Prophet say:
The difference between us and the polytheists is that we wear
225 a Abu Dawud,Vol 3, adth 688.
473

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

turbans over caps. 226


.



230 : :
Narrated Ibn Abbas \: Once our Dear Prophet addressed the
people and he U was wearing a black turban which was all
wet with hair oil.227
The companions (Sahaba) also used to wear turbans and not
Tayalisah.

226. Sunan Abu Dawud, Vol. 3, adth 687.


227. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 2, adth 230.
474

Chapter 18 of Book III

110 : :
Hazrat Ibn Umar \ reports, When Rasulullah U fastened an
amaamah (turban), he used to put the shamlah between his
shoulders (i.e.: he used to put the ends on the back). Nafi
says, I had seen Abdullah bin Umar \ do it in the same
manner.
Ubaidullah, who is the student of Nafi, says: In my time the
grandson of Abu Bakr \, Qasim bin Muammad, and the
grandson of Umar \, Salim bin Abdullah \ did the same. 228
Near the End of Times, the majority of the Arabs
will wear the tayalisah.

( )










228. Shimayel Tirmidi, Vol. 1, adth 110.


475

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X










:









.




. 5432 : .


Narrated by Jaddah \: our Dear Prophet Muammad U said


that that near the End of Times, the majority will wear
tayalisah, there will be vast business, and there will be so
much wealth The adth continues further. 229
Note: The adth does not mention the word Arabs when
discussing the tayalisah, but it is clear to us that today
majority of the Arabs wear the Tayalisah, and this also proves
that this adth points towards the Arabs.

229. Mustadrak-al-Saheheen, adth 5432.


476

Chapter 18 of Book III

Is it allowed to wear Tayalisah?


Some scholars have declared that wearing the tayalisah cloth that covers
head and shoulders is not forbidden in Islam. However, there is not a
single adth which tells us that our Dear Prophet Muammad U wore
the tayalisah cloth that covered the head and shoulders.
We have one adth that tells us that our Dear Prophet wore a
Persian tayalisah garment which was like a long shirt, and had
sleeves, necklines and openings (at front and back), and not like the
common tayalisah which is just a piece of cloth covering only head
and shoulders.



477

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X



478

Chapter 18 of Book III



912 : :
Abdullah \, the freed slave of Asma \ (the daughter of Abu
Bakr), the maternal uncle of the son of Ata, reported: Asma
\ sent me to Abdullah b. Umar \ saying: The news has
reached me that you prohibit the use of three things: the
striped robe, saddle cloth made of red silk, and the fasting in
the holy month of Rajab. Abdullah said to me: So far as
what you say about fasting in the month of Rajab, how about
one who observes continuous fasting?, and so far as what you
say about the striped garment, I heard Umar b. Khattab \ say
that he had heard from Allahs Messenger U: He who wears
silk garment has no share for him (in the Hereafter), and I
am afraid it may not be that striped garment; and so far as the
red saddle cloth is concerned that is the saddle cloth of
Abdullah and it is red. I went back to Asma \ and informed
her. whereupon she said: Here is the cloak of Allahs
479

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Messenger U, and she brought out to me that tayalisah


Persian cloth with a hem of brocade, and it is sleeves
bordered with brocade, and said: This was Allahs
Messengers cloak in possession of Aisha \ until she died,
and when she died, I got possession of it. The Apostle of Allah
U used to wear that, and we used it for the sick and sought
cure thereby.230
We see that the above Persian tayalisah is much different than the
ordinary tayalisah which is just a simple sheet of cloth that covers head
and shoulders only. This Persian tayalisah had sleeves and a neck
opening.
Another adth explains the detail of this dress.
The following adth is exactly related to the previous adth of Hazrat
Asma \.
This adth again tells us of this tayalisah which is much different
from the tayalisah worn on the head. Check that the adth tells us that
this garment had sleeves, necklines, and openings (at front and back),
and not like the common tayalisah which is just a piece of cloth covering
only head and shoulders.
It should be noted that this is same garment which Hazrat Asma
(RA) has mentioned in the previous adth.



230. a Muslim, Vol. 3, adth 912.
480

Chapter 18 of Book III

()


:
3

474 :

It was narrated that Abu Umar \, the freed slave of Asma


\, said: I saw Ibn Umar \ buying a turban that had some
markings, then he called for a pair of scissors and cut that off.
I entered upon Asma \ and mentioned that to her, and she
said: May Abdullh perish, Oh girl, give me the garment of
the Messenger of Allah U A garment was brought that was
hemmed with brocade on the sleeves, necklines and openings
(at the front and back). 231
So we see that the tayalisah with Hazrat Asma \ is much more
different than the common tayalisah which only covered head and
231. Sunan Ibn Majah, Vol. 3, adth 474.
481

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

shoulders like a simple piece of cloth.


Also notice that in this adth the word tayalisah is NOT used but
only the word of Garment is used which clearly shows that this is much
different than the common Tayalisah hoods.
In fact, there is not a single adth that tells us that someone
saw our Dear Prophet Muammad U wearing tayalisah
hood that covered only the head and shoulders.
Conclusion
Some scholars have declared that wearing tayalisah is allowed in Islam.
No matter whether the wearing of the tayalisah is allowed or forbidden,
one thing is clear that:
In the End of Times, the tayalisah will be the dress of the
Army of the Dajjal, which is the same dress of Banu Saud,
and it is Saudi Government.

482

Chapter 19

Very Important Information

Where the word Khriji did came from?


Khriji came from the Najd, and especially from the city of Al-Kharj
that is situated in the heart of the Najd.

Figure: Al Kharaj city in Najd (close to Riyadh) in Saudi Arabia.

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

From the Saudi Government website: Al Kharj (Arabic: ) is a


city in theAl Kharj Governorate in central Saudi Arabia. Al Kharj is
located at a distance of 77 km south of Riyadh. The city is located at
around 24854N 471818E and connected by rail to both Riyadh and
Dammam. The citys main landmarks includes the historical water
wells, and King Abdul Aziz palace and Mosque.
One of the main RSAF bases, Prince Sultan Air Base with
coordinates of 240348N 473450E, is located in Al Kharj, which is
home for several fleets of F-15s. Al Kharj was home to about 60,000
coalition forces during the 1991 Gulf War.

Figure: Al Kharaj city in Najd (close to Riyadh) in Saudi Arabia.


484

Chapter 19 of Book III

Figure: Al Kharaj city in Najd (close to Riyadh) in Saudi Arabia.

485

Chapter 20

A Beautiful Essay

Where is Najd, by Aamir Ibrahim (AS) (Summarized)


I am copying a part of a very beautiful article by Mr. Aamir Ibrahim to
further remove confusion between Najd and Iraq.

Figure: Map showing that only Najd is in the east


of Madinah but Iraq is in the North.

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

adth #1 Afflictions in the east


Book 4, Volume 56, adth 714: a Bukhari
Narrated by Abdullah bin Umar \: I heard Allahs Apostle
U on the pulpit saying, Verily, afflictions (will start) from
there, pointing towards the east,where the side of the head
of Satan comes out.
adth # 2
(adth with variation of wording and deserves separate
reference.)
Narrated by Abdullah: The Prophet stood up and delivered a
sermon, and pointing to Aishas \ house (i.e.: eastwards), he
said thrice: Affliction (will appear from) there, and from
there the side of the Satans head comes out (i.e.: from the
east).
This adth is very important to understand the knowledge that
Prophet Muammad U had in regards to cardinal points (i.e.: east,
West, North, and South). The Wahhabis, with their utter propaganda,
say that Prophet Muammad U was clueless of cardinal points, such as
North and South, which is why he considered Iraq to be east although
on map it is towards northern side, Astagfirullah! They also misuse a
verse of the Quran which mentions that Allah , is the Lord of the two
Easts and two Wests.
This is disrespect for Islam and its Prophet. Due to such pathetic
viewpoints

of

Wahhbiya,

the

disbelievers

and

anti-Islamic

propagandists laugh at Islam and mock our Prophet by saying, look


488

Chapter 20 of Book III

their Prophet did not even know of cardinal points properly. However
here is a shock to anti-Islamic propagandists, and their allies i.e.:
Wahhabis. Our Beloved Prophet Muammad U who is the source of
knowledge did indeed know of cardinal points called North and
South, as we know today. Proof that Prophet Muammad U indeed
knew:
Book 40, Number 6792: a Muslim.
Allahs Messenger U said: In Paradise there is a street to
which they would come every Friday. The North windwill
blow and would scatter fragrance on their faces
As this part is clear, let us come back to adth # 3 mentioned
above. Unfortunately this adth is misused by the Rawafidh who
literally point towards Sayyidah Aishas \ house and claim: Look the
Prophet called it the house of Fitnah. Naudhobillah! On the other
hand, Wahhabis hide this adth, and never show it when they are
grabbed in regards to location of Najd.
Lets prove this from Google Earth maps. The white pure mosque
in the middle is Masjid Al Nabawi, and the red arrow is pointing
towards east from the Pulpit of Prophet Muammad U.

489

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Figure: Masjid Al Nabawi, Madinah Munnawara.


Also see this map of Masjid an-Nabawi (I have practically
confirmed that the Hujra of Sayyidah Aisha \ is towards east
of the pulpit. Also Bab al-Baqi and Bab Jibril are towards
eastern side of the Masjid. I have had the privilege of entering
through Bab e Jibril Alhamdulillah although it remains
mostly closed).
Written by Mr. Aamir Ibrahim.

490

Chapter 20 of Book III

Figure: Internal layout of the Masjid Al Nabawi,


Madinah Munnawara.
Also see the following adth in Sahih Muslim:
Book 41, adth 6941: a Muslim
Ibn Umar \ reported that Allahs Messenger U came out
from the house of Aisha \ and said: It would be from this
side that there would appear the height of unbelief, (Where
appears the horns of Satan, i.e.: the east.)
This adth has clarification i.e.: east , and by no means it refers
to the literal house of Ayesha \ unlike what the Rawafidh try to assert.
These adths, combined together refer to NAJD, EAST, FROM
WHERE SUN RISES and that is only Najd within Saudi Arabia.

B
491

Chapter 21

Comments by famous scholars about


Muammad Ibn Abdul Wahhab

Imam Ibn Abidin al- Shami (1198-1252 A.H. / 1783-1836A.D.)


The great Hanafi scholar Ibn Abidin al-Shami gives specific
explanations Wahhbiya sect (followers of the teachings of Muhammed
ibn Abdul Wahhab an-Najdi) decanted in the book of his works
entitled: Radd al-Muhtar Hasyiyah Ala ad-Durr al-Mukhtar (p, 413).

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

494

Chapter 21 of Book III

Translation:
His words and who consider the Companions of our
Prophet U to be disbelievers, are not a condition for someone
to be a kharijite, but rather are a mere clarification of what
those who revolted against Ali \ in fact did. Otherwise, it is
enough to be convinced of the unbelief of those they fight
against, as happened in our own times with the followers of
[Muammad ibn] Abd al-Wahhab, who came out of the Najd
in revolt, and took over the sanctuaries of Mecca and Medina.
They followed the Hanbali madhhab, but believed that they
were the Muslims, and that those who believed differently
than they did were polytheists (mushrikin). On this basis, they
held it lawful to kill Sunni Muslims (Ahl al-Sunna) and their
religious scholars, until Allah Most High dispelled their
forces, and the armies of the Muslims attacked their
strongholds and subdued them in 1233 A.H. [1818 C.E.]
(Hashiya Radd al-Muhtar, 4.262).
Biography of Ibn Abidin al-Shami.
This biography of Ibn Abidin al-Shami is based on the biographical
note in the preface of Radd al-Mutr, the Dr Iy at-Turth edition.
The original Arabic version is by Shaykh Abd al-Jall  of Damascus.
Sayyid Muammad Amn ibn Sayyid Umar ibn Sayyid Abd alAzz ibn Sayyid Amed ibn Sayyid Abd ar-Ram ibn Sayyid
Najmuddn ibn Sayyid Muammad aluddn better known as Ibn
Abidin is praised in these words: the prominent, praiseworthy and
noble scholar; an ocean of knowledge; the master scholar [jahbadh]; the
495

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

great jurist [faqh]; the genius; the finest among the later scholars and
the seal of the research scholars; one with an exalted ancestry [hasb,
nasb]; the erudite Imam; the litterateur.
The Imam was bornraimahullhin Damascus (Syria), in a
family of scholars and high ancestry in the year 1198 A.H.
His lineage reaches Sayyid Sharf Zayn al-Abidn and from him
to Sayyidah Fimah, the daughter of the Master of all creation, U.
Ibn Abidns father Sayyid Umar and his mother were both
famous for their righteousness and being fearful of Allh. May Allh
have mercy on them.
Ibn bidn has left behind numerous books and monographs that
are a monument to his research; the most famous and the biggest of
them all being his marginalia on Durr al-Mukhtr named: Radd alMutr la Ad-Durr al-Mukhtr [Answer to the Perplexed: An Exegesis
of The Choicest Gems]
This is the most comprehensive and the most authoritative book
on Hanafi fiqh in the world today. I have also worked in crossreferencing and preparing a detailed index of the book [Shaykh Abd alJall  means himself]. It has been published many times: the Bulaq
edition of 1272 A.H. in five volumes and later in 1276 A.H.
and 1299 A.H.; the Maymaniyyah edition in 1307 A.H.; the Istanbul
edition of 1307 A.H. Once again in 1323 A.H., there was a
Maymaniyyah edition; and later in 1323A.H., the Bbi al-alab edition
and Istanbul edition in eight volumes along with the Takmalah, which
has been photo-offset a number of times hence.

496

Chapter 21 of Book III

Ahmed Saadi Ali Bari


Ahmdad Saadi Ali Bari is one of the greatest Mufassir of the Quran. He
writes in his book Al-Sadi Al-Jalaeen.

Translation:
He is describing the explanation of the verse 6 of Srah Fatir
i.e.:
497

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


()



Lo! The devil is an enemy to you, so treat him as an enemy. He
only summoneth his faction to be owners of the flaming Fire.
(35:6)
And then saying that, Scholars of Islam have said that these verses
point out towards the Khawarij. These people change the meaning of
the Quran and adth while explaining it, and then they use this
changed meaning as a proof to justify the killing of Muslims and
snatching their property from them.
We have observed this in this time also in the form of the sect that
is called Wahhabi (followers of Muammad ibn Abdul Wahhab) in
the Arabian Peninsula. This sect thinks that they are right but in reality
they are liars. Satan has mislead them and turned them away from
remembrance of Allah Azza wajal. In reality they are the faction of Satan
(as this verse tells) and indeed the faction of Satan will always be at a
loss. We pray to Allah Azza wajal that He cut the roots of this faction.
Ahmed Bin Zainee
He was Mufti of Makkah and also Imam of Masjid al Haram. He wrote
about the wrong interpretation of the Quran by the Wahhabis.
498

Chapter 21 of Book III

Translation:
He (Muhammad bin Abdul Wahhab) used to stop his
followers from reading books of Islamic Fiqh, Tafseer of
the Quran, and the books of adth. They even burnt many
Islamic books. He allowed his followers to explain the Quran
according to their own understanding. This mislead his
followers. Every one of his followers was doing this. (For
example) one of them who did not even know or memorized
any part of the Quran, and used to tell the other follower to
read the Quran for him, and he will tell the tafseer of the
499

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Quran. After listening to the Quran, that follower used to


explain the Quran according to his own understanding. 232
Allam Afandi
He also writes about the wrong interpretation of the Quran by the
Wahhabis in his famous book Al-Fajar As-Sadiq.

Translation:
Muammad-bin-Abdul Waha Najdi and his followers
explain the meaning of Quran according to their own desires.
They do not explain the meaning of Quran correctly as
according to the explanations told by the Companions of
Dear Prophet Muammad U, the Salaf Saliheen (Pious
Muslims ) and the Ayemma. Narrator (the leaders in

232. Ad Dar Asanniah, page 41.


500

Chapter 21 of Book III

Tafseer of Quran).233
Ashraf Ali Thanvi and 40 other Scholars of famous Islamic
school of Deoband in India signed and verified a book called AlMuhannad, the book of beliefs of the Ulama of Deoband.
At the time, Makkah and Madinah were not under the rule of
Wahhabi movement. The scholars of Madinah asked some questions
from the Muslim scholars of India. Al-Muhannad is actually the
book that contains these questions and answers.On page 12, contains
the following question and answer:
Question Number 12: Muammad Ibn Abdul Wahhab held
the view that shedding the blood of Musalmaans and taking
away their property, and defiling their honor, all these things
were lawful. He also termed them idolaters. He was insolent
towards the elders. What is your view of him? And do you
think calling the Ahle Qiblah as infidels is a lawful act? Or do
you think that he who does these things belongs to a
legitimate sect?
Answer: In our view (please note: OUR VIEWnot my
view and Al Muhanned was signed by forty leading scholars
of the Deoband school of thought) the same verdict applies
to them as has been given by the writer of Durr-e-Mukhtaar.
And Khawarij are a band of people who waged war against
the Imam because they thought him to be guilty of falsehood,
that is, idolatry, which justified waging war. For this reason

233. Al-Fajar As-Sadiq, page 19.


501

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

they take the taking of our lives and our property and making
our women captives to be lawful. He further held that they
were rebels. He also held that they did not describe them as
infidels because this was a matter of interpretation, though a
faulty one. And Allamah Shaami, in his marginal notes on the
book, has said: Like it happened in our times when the
followers of Ibne Abdul Wahhab sallying forth from Najd
overwhelmed the Haramain Shareefain. They described
themselves as belonging to Hambali creed, but it was their
belief that only they were Musalmaans and whoever was
against their belief was an idolater and, so, they justified the
killing of the Ahle Sunnat and the Ulama of the Ahle Sunnat
until Almighty Allah deprived them of their ascendancy.234
Syed Hussain Ahmed Madni
Syed Hussein Ahmad Sahib Madni says: Gentlemen, Muammad
Ibne Abdul Wahhab appeared in the Najd in the 13th century A.H., and,
because he harboured evil thoughts and held wrong beliefs, he waged
war on the Ahl-e-Sunnat Wa Al Jamaat, sought to force his evil
thoughts upon them, and considered lawful seizing of their properties
as the spoils of war, and killing them, and considered all these acts to
bring blessings. He was harsh on the people of the Haramain (Makkah
and Madinah), in particular, and on the people of the Hijaaz in general.
He used the most foul language against the pious men of the earlier
generations. Because of the atrocities committed by him on them,
countless people had to flee the holy cities of Makkah and Madinah, and
234. Al-Muhannad Book, Answer to Question 12 in this book.
502

Chapter 21 of Book III

many of them were martyred by his troops. In short, he was a tyrant, a


rebel and an altogether evil person. 235
Muammad Ibn Abdul Wahhab believed that people all over the
world, and all Muslims were polytheists and infidels. 236
The Najadis believed, and his followers still believe, that the lives
of the Prophets X were limited to the times during which they lived
upon this earth. Thereafter, in death, they and other faithfuls are
equal.237
The End of Times affliction of people narrating false adths
and reading the Quran.

235. Ash Shahaubus Saaqib, page 42.


236. Ash-Shahaubus Saaqib, page 44.
237. Ash-Shahaubus Saaqib, page 45.
503

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

( )




1899 : :
Narrated by Hazrat Abdullah bin Masood \, that dear
Prophet of Allah U said, Near the end of times,a nation will
rise who will be foolish and young.They will tell the sayings of
the best human beings (i.e. Dear Prophet Muammad U) of
all human beings.They will recite Quran with their tongues
but this Quran will not pass further than their throats(means
that they will just recite Quran but their hearts will not follow
Quran).
They will come out of Islam just like an arrow passes out of its
prey.Whoever finds them, should kill them as killing them will be a
great virtue from Allah.238
Narrating false adths.
The fitnah of the Najd has the characteristic of distorting the adths in
certain ways:
1. Changing the translations of adth.

238. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 2, adth 1899.


504

Chapter 21 of Book III

2. Changing the meaning of certain words in the adth.


3. Denying authentic adth, and considering them weak if these
adth speak against them.
4. Taking references of the Jews, and leaving aside any adth that
speaks against the Jews.
This is told in the following adth.




.




:
1098 :
Narrated by Abu Huraira \ that Dear Prophet Muammad
U said that: Soon in the end of times, some people from my
Ummah (nation) will come who will present such adth
infront of you which you or your ancestors have never heard
of these adth. Protect yourself from these people and keep

505

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

distance from them.239


Note: Please note that the above adth uses the words of
Soon and The end of Times together. Which shows that
this affliction will continue from the beginning of Islam till
near the end of times.




.





1420 : : .
Narrated by Abu Huraira \ that Dear Prophet Muammad
U said that: Soon, some Dajjal like people and Liars will come
who will present such adth infront of you which you or your
ancestors have never heard of these adth. Protect yourself
from these people and keep distance from them so that you

239. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 4, adth 1098.


506

Chapter 21 of Book III

do not get into affliction.240


Example 1: Distortion of adth by the Najdis.
Please check the following adth

1193 ::
Narrated by Abu Huraira \ that our Dear Prophet
Muammad U said that, The cycle of day and night will not
be over until a person from the Mawali (non-Arabs) called
JHEH-JAH will become the ruler (of the world).241
Very Important: The word Mawali or mawla (Arabic:

) is a term in classical Arabic used to address non-Arab


Muslims.242
Now the followers of Muammad bin Abdul Wahhab have
240. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 4, adth 1420.
241. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 4, adth 1193.
242 Princeton University webpage
http://www.princeton.edu/~batke/itl/denise/mawali.htm, and also
http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mawali
507

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

changed the translation of the meaning of the word mawali and they
say it means the newly converted Muslims, and say that this adth
represent the Romans who will become Muslims. Astagfirullah.
Some have even denied this adth, and considered it Daif, which
is also wrong, as this adth is Hassan a which can be taken as a
strong reference.
Proof of the true meaning of the word Mawali
What does the word Mawali means?
Mawali or mawla (Arabic: ) is a term in classical Arabic used to
address non-Arab Muslims. It is a pity that the recent books published
by the Saudi government funded publishers, the meaning of the word
Mawali is deliberately changed to new Muslim converts instead of
the non-Arabs. We shall study the true meaning of Mawali using
different references.
Reference 1
In the book Nature, man and God in medieval Islam by Mahmud ibn
Abd al-Rahman Al-Isfahani, Edwin Elliott Calverley he writes:
Quoting form the article, Mawla by A.J Wensinck, and
Patricia Crone, The meaning of [mawla], is a person linked
by [wala] (proximity) to another person, similarly known as
[mawla]. The relation maybe one of equality or of inequality.
The root meaning of [wali] thus includes proximity, and by
derivation, power and protection. In the Quran and
Traditions (adth), there are two senses of the term
508

Chapter 21 of Book III

[mawla=wali], referring to the superior of two parties in a


relationship: as tutor-trustee-helper, and as Lord. We may
supply synonyms for the trustee that would include warden,
executor, guardian, etc., and for helper that would include
kinsman, friend, ally, etc. In the relationship of inequality, the
lesser party would be a client of some sort to the superior
party.
Quoting the same article further
Since the non-Arabs could only enter this society as client,
[mawla] came to be synonymous with non-Arab Muslims.
Reference 2
The Princeton University website describes mawali as the non-Arab
converts to Islam.
Originally the term mawla (singular of mawali) referred to a
party with whom one had an egalitarian relationship, such as
a relative, ally, or friend, but the term eventually came to
designate a party with whom one had an unequal
relationship, such as master, manumitter, and patron, and
slave, freedman, and client. Under the first four Caliphs and
the Umayyads, the influx of non-Arab converts to Islam
created a new difficulty: how were they to be incorporated
into tribal Arab society? The solution was the contract
of wala, through which the non-Arab Muslim acquired an
Arab patron. In principle, the mawali were to enjoy the same
privileges as Arab Muslims. The mawali rapidly rose to
509

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

prominence in Muslim society in administration, military,


and scholarship.
Bibliography
1. Conversion and Poll-Tax in Early Islam, D.C. Dennett,
Cambridge 1950.
2. The Encyclopedia of Islam, Second Edition
3. Slaves on Horses, P. Crone, Cambridge 1980.
Reference 3
In the book: Orphans of Islam: Family, abandonment, and Secret
Adoptions in Morocco, by Jamila Bargach it iswritten:
The meaning of mawali has historically shifted. In the preIslamic period, the Mawali were the clients of Arab tribe,
while with Islam it came to denote simply non-Arab Muslims
who allied themselves with the Muslim community as
clients.
Reference 4
In the book Islam in history: Ideas, People, and Events in the Middle
East, By Bernard Lewis it is written:
The mawali (mawla is the singular) were those Muslims who
were not full members by birth of an Arab tribe. The greater
part of these were the non-Arabs converts to Islam.

510

Chapter 21 of Book III

Reference 5
In the book Discovering Islam: Making Sense of Muslim history and
Society, by Akbar S. Ahmed, it is written that:
A mawla was a Muslim who was not a member of an Arab
tribe by descent, a Persian, or an Egyptian for example. The
term did not include non-Muslims, dhimmis.
Conclusion: Meaning of the term Mawali.
In short, the word mawali means the non-Arabs only in the adth
given above.
Note: As an example, you can find this clear distortion of
adth at the following website of the Najdis:
i.e.: www.discoveringislam.org. I request you to email
info@discoveringislam.org and protest against this distortion
Example 2: Distortion of adth by the Najdis.

5161 : .

( )


:





:

:


511

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X














.
TRUE TRANSLATION

CHANGED TRANSLATION

Abu Huraira \ narrates that Abu Huraira \ narrates that


Prophet Muammad U said:

Prophet Muammad U said:

The Last Hour would not come

The Hour (of Resurrection)

until the Romans would land at will not come until the ()
al-Amaq or in Dabiq. An army Romans

land

in

Al-Amaq

consisting of the best (soldiers) (valleys in Antioch, southern


of the people of the earth at that Turkey) or in Dabiq (a plain near
time will come from a City Aleppo,

Syria).

An

army

(Madinah word means a City) consisting of the best of the


(to counteract them).
When

they

people

will

arrange

themselves in ranks, the Romans


would

say:

Do

not

stand

between us and those (Muslims)

of

the

Earth

(an

international Muslim army) at


that time will come out of
Medina (in Saudi Arabia) to face
them.

who took prisoners from amongst When

they

will

arrange

us. Let us fight with them; and themselves in ranks, the Romans
the Muslims would say: Nay, by will say: Do not stand between
512

Chapter 21 of Book III

Allah, we would never get aside us and those (Christian Converts


from you and from our brethren to Islam) who were taken away
that you may fight them.

from amongst us. Let us fight

They will then fight and a third


(part) of the army would run
away, whom Allah will never
forgive. A third (part of the
army),

which

would

with them ; and the Muslims will


say: No! By Allah, we will not
stand aside and let you fight our
brothers.

be

They will then fight. A third (of

constituted of excellent martyrs the Muslim army) will be


in Allahs eye, would be killed defeated (and run away), and
and the third who would never Allah will never forgive them. A
be put to trial would win and third (of the Muslim army) will
they would be conquerors of be killed and they will be
Constantinople.

regarded as the best martyrs in

And as they would be busy in


distributing the spoils of war
(amongst

themselves)

after

hanging their swords by the olive


trees, the Satan would cry: The

the eyes of Allah. A third (of the


Muslim army) will conquer and
they do not get affected by Fitnah
(tribulations). They will conquer
Constantinople.

Dajjal has taken your place While the Muslims are busy
among your family. They would distributing the spoils (booty) of
then come out, but it would be of war, after hanging their swords
no avail. And when they would by the olive trees, Satan will
come to Syria, he would come shout: The Anti-Christ has
out while they would be still taken your place among your
preparing themselves for battle family (or in your land). The
drawing up the ranks. Certainly, Muslims will then come out, but
513

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

the time of prayer shall come and will find out that it is not true.
then Jesus X son of Mary would And when they arrive to Aldescend and would lead them in Sham (Damascus or Syria), he
prayer. When the enemy of Allah (Anti-Christ) will come out.
would

see

him,

it

would While

they

(Muslims)

are

(disappear) just as the salt preparing to fight him, and


dissolves itself in water and if he drawing up their ranks, prayer
(Jesus X) were not to confront time will come and then, Jesus
them at all, even then it would X the son of Mary will descend
dissolve completely, but Allah and lead (or join) them in prayer.
would kill them by his hand and When Allahs enemy (Antihe would show them their blood Christ) sees him (Jesus X), it
on his lance (the lance of Jesus will dissolve just as the salt
X Christ). a Muslim, Book dissolves in water. If Jesus X
of Turmoils, adth 5161.

were to leave him (Anti-Christ)


alone, he (Anti-Christ) would
melt to death anyway, but Allah
will have him (Anti-Christ)
killed by his (Jesus X) hand, and
he (Jesus X) will show the
Muslims

his

(Anti-Christs)

blood on his (Jesus X) spear.


The only words mentioned in the adth are that
The Romans would say: Do not stand between us and
those (Muslims) who took prisoners from amongst us. Let
us fight with them

514

Chapter 21 of Book III

Please decide:

Is there anywhere in the original adth mention that the nonMuslims have become Muslims, and joined the Muslims?

Is there anywhere in the original adth mention thatthe


Romans/Christians have been captured and made prisoners?

Do the words written in the quote marks match the wordings


of the original adth?

Of course your answer will be NO. There is no such thing in the


original adth.
Note: Also they changed the words that Prophet Isa X will
lead the prayers.
One example of publishers who are spreading such mistranslations
is the Saudi-funded Dar us Salam (www.dar-us-salam.com).
Warning against those who distort adth.

:






:




:



:

: :

:
:







515

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





:














:


.
,
















868 : :

Sayyidna Ali ibn Talib \ said: When I say something related


to our Dear Prophet Muammad U, then it is preferable for
516

Chapter 21 of Book III

me to drop down from the sky (and die) instead of telling


words that are not said by him U, and I relate these words of
him U.
If I say something related to someone else, then I am a warrior and
war is a game of tactics.
I heard our Dear Prophet Muammad U saying that near the
End of Times, such Nations will appear who will be young in
age and will have no wisdom. They will speak the adth of
our Dear Prophet Muammad U but Faith will not pass
through their throats (to reach their hearts). Wherever you
find them, kill them. Killing them will be (greatly) rewarded
on the day Judgement (Qiyamah).243
We see that the above adth describes the Khriji and the sin of
changing the adth together as these people will change the adth.

243 Masnad Ahmad, Vol 1, adth 868.


517

B
BOOK IV

SIGNS OF THE ARMY OF THE DAJJAL


PART II










.

.

The adth which we shall read in this book mentions the


Turks (or Turkic) people of Khurasan and Iran.They
have strong relation with the Mongols.These people have
Turkish culture but they are different from the Turks of
Turkey.
Please note that not all of these Turkic/Mongol nations will
follow dajjal. Of course, only the disobedient among them
will follow the Dajjal (the Anti-Christ). The pious among
them will join the Army of Mahdi and Prophet Isa X.
InshahAllah.

Chapter 1

Faces like a Shield

People with faces like shields (or flat faces) helping the Dajjal.
Please check the following adth telling us about the army of the Dajjal
with faces like shields.

( )2725 :

:






:

Allahs Messenger U said: The Hour will not be established


until you fight with the Turks; people with small eyes, red
faces, and flat noses. Their faces will look like shields coated
with leather. The Hour will not be established till you fight
with people whose shoes are made of hair.244

244. a al-Bukhari, Vol. 4, Book 52, adth 179.


523

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


( )3347 :
:

:





:


.




Narrated Amr bin Taghlib \: The Prophet said: One of the
portents of the Hour is that you will fight with people wearing
shoes made of hair; and one of the portents of the Hour is that
you will fight with broad-faced people whose faces will look
like shields coated with leather.245
These broad face people will join the Dajjal
The following adth further tells us that these people with faces like
shields will be in the Dajjals Army.

:
.
:
)):
(( .

245. a Bukhari, Volume 4, Book 52, Number 178.


524

Chapter 1 of Book IV



( )
952 : :
Narrated by Amr ibn Hurayth \ quoted Abu Bakr Al Siddiq
\ as saying that Allahs Messenger U told them the Dajjal
would come forth from a land in the east called Khurasan,
followed by people whose faces resembled shields covered
with skin. 246

246. Sunan Ibn Majah, Chapter Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 4078 at www.iidalraid.de/Hadeethlib/. Also in a Tirmidhi. and Mishkat adth 5251.
525

526

Chapter 2

Location of the people


who have faces like Shields?

We have two locations as given by the adth.


1. Location No 1 = Khurasan
2. Location No 2 = Iran
Location No 1: Khurasan
The people with round and fat faces from Khurasan

:
.
:
)):
(( .
4072



527

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X



( )
4072 : :
Narrated by Amr ibn Hurayth \ quoted Abu Bakr As-Siddiq
as saying that Allahs Messenger U told them that the Dajjal
would come forth from a land in the east called Khurasan,
followed by people whose faces resembled shields covered
with skin (round and fat faces like shields).247

247. Sunan Ibn Majah, Chapter Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 4072 at www.iidalraid.de/Hadeethlib/. Also in a Tirmidhi.
528

Chapter 2 of Book IV

)
33 : : (
Narrated by Amr ibn Hurayth \ quoted Abu Bakr As-Siddiq
as saying that Allahs Messenger (SAWS) told them that the
Dajjal would come forth from a land in the east called
Khurasan, followed by people whose faces resembled shields
covered with skin (round and fat fleshy faces like shields).248
And also the following adth telling us the location as Khurasan:




: .



)
12 : : (
Narrated by Amr ibn Hurayth \ quoted Abu Bakr As-Siddiq
as saying that Allahs Messenger U told them the Dajjal would
come forth from a land in the east called Khurasan, followed
by people whose faces resembled shields covered with skin

248. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 1, adth 33.


529

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

(round and fat faces like shields). 249


The Turkic people (who have strong relation with Mongols)
having broad, fat faces will fight against Muslims
And also the following adth tells us that Turkic people of this area
have faces like shields.

( )2725 :

:






:

Allahs Messenger U said: The Hour will not be established


until you fight with the Turks; people with small eyes, red
faces, and flat noses. Their faces will look like shields coated
with leather. The Hour will not be established till you fight
with people whose shoes are made of hair. 250
Conclusion
In the above adth two points have been mentioned about Army of the
Dajjal

249Masnad Ahmad, Vol1 adth12.


250Sahih al-Bukhari: Vol. 4, Book 52, adth 179.
530

Chapter 2 of Book IV

1. People with broad/round faces like shields from Khurasan.


2. The Turkic(and Mongols)of Central Asia have broad/round
faces like shields
Important Note: The Turks of Khurasan are different from
the Turkish people of Turkey.The adth points out the broad
faced central Asian people who have strong relation with the
Mongols but are Muslims and have adopted Turkish culture.
Who in the region of Khurasan have faces like shields or flat faces?
In Central Asia and Khurasan, the Turkic people who are originally
Mongols but have adopted Turkish culture have round faces as
described in the above adth.
These include
1. Tajik
2. Uzbek
3. Hazara
4. Turkeman
5. Kazakh, etc.
In fact most of the Central Asian states are related to Mongols and
have broad faces.
Tajiks claim to be Persian and have Caucasian features but more
than a 1000 years of Turk-Mongol rule over them, and the intermixing
have Turkicised them. As told in the words of Encyclopedia Britannica
1997:
531

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Tajik people have been turkicised in the past centuries


Most of the Tajiks even have faces like the Mongol people i.e.:
round faces like shields as told in the adth.

Figure: Turkmen President Mr. Gurbanguly and


Tajik President Mr. Emomali with same broad, fleshy faces.
Mongol connection of Tajiks
H.G Keene says:
The distinction between Turk and Mongol is not altogether
a natural distinction, but one preceding from comparatively
recent, and artificial causes cause arising out of a fusion,
more or less complete, of Tajik and Tartar. 251

251. The Turks in India: Critical Chapters on the Administration of that


Country, By Henry George Keene, page 1.
532

Chapter 2 of Book IV

Mongol like features and DNA of Tajiks


I personally dont want to quote DNA research here as this research is
in control of the people of the book and they can fasly present any
results they want to misguide the word. I am only mentioning it here to
satisy those who believe in these findings.
Ethnic Tajiks, particularly those from Tajikistan, show clear
Mongoloid admixture possibly originating from their Kyrgyz and
Uzbek neighbors.
DNA type of R1a1 is found among the Khotons of Uvs Province in
Western Mongolia (82.5%)
High frequencies of R1a1 between 50 and 70 percent are found
among the Tajiks especially the Panjakent and Dushanbe Tajiks,

533

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Figure: Turkmen, Tajiks, Uzbeks and Hazara


having round, fleshy faces as the adth described
534

Chapter 2 of Book IV

Tajiks claim to be Persian, and have Caucasian features but that


claim dates backs to the short lived Samani Empire (819 A.D.-999 A.D.)
which was defeated by the Arabs in 999.
Since then Tajiks were ruled by Arabs, Turks, and Mongols. Even
now at the cultural center of the so called Tajik empire, i.e.: Bokhara,
there is no Persian speaking people left, and only Turkmen live there.
Today their culture resembles the Turkic Culture of their
neighborhood Turkic state of Uzbekistan. The appearance is also the
same as the Central Asian Turkic i.e.: having round/broad faces.
The fact is that Uzbeks and Tajiks have been considered the same
as told below:
Until the twentieth century, people in the region used two
types of distinction to identify themselves: way of lifeeither
nomadic or sedentaryand place of residence. By the late
nineteenth century, the Tajik and Uzbek peoples, who had
lived in proximity for centuries and often used each others
languages, did not perceive themselves as two distinct
nationalities. Consequently, such labels were imposed
artificially when Central Asia was divided into five Soviet
republics in the 1920s.252
So, in conclusion, Uzbeks and Tajiks have more or less the same
Turkic culture, and majority of them have round faces like mongoloid
admixture.

252. Library of Congress Country StudiesTajikistanHistorical and Ethnic


Background, 1996.
535

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Over 1000 year of Mongoloid Turkic rule over the Tajiks.


The Turkic people of central Asia have Mongol-like round faces and
these Turkmen influences greatly affected the Tajiks. The first Turkic
invaders (from the northeast) seized this area of Transoxiana in 999,
and, because both conquered and conquerors were Muslim, in time
many Tajiksespecially those in the valleys of the Syr Darya and Amu
Daryabecame Turkicised. This resulted in the transformation of a
formerly purely Iranian land into Turkistan. (Encyclopedia
Britannica) 253
In the 13th century, Genghis Khan and his Mongol army settled in
many of the popular Persian cities after whiping out the Persian
population. These Mongols later adopted the Persian language and the
religion of Islam.
Its funny that Tajiks usually reject Mongol origin and claim to be
ancient Persians but this is difficult to prove.

253 Britannic 2011


536

Chapter 2 of Book IV

Figure: The region between Amu and Syr Drya


has been Turkicised (Encyclopedia Britannica 2012).
The genetic pool of Tajikistan has been greatly diversified and
diluted by these invaders. In some cases the Turkic contribution is so
extensive that there is almost no difference between Turkic people and
Tajiki phenotypes. Thus eliminating all the Caucasoid features. Please
check the figures below and decide for yourself.
The round faces of Tajiks (mongoloid admixture).
Check the round faces of Tajik people as told in the adth about the
people of Khurasan.

537

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Figure: Tajik opposition leader Mr.Dodojon.

Figure: Tajik boy.


538

Chapter 2 of Book IV

Figure: Tajik politician Mr.Kabiri.

Figure: Turkmen President Mr.Gurbanguly,


and Tajik President Mr. Emomali with same flat and fleshy faces.
539

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Figure: Tajik youth wearing hairy caps as told in the adth.

Figure: Tajiks from China also look like Mongols

540

Chapter 2 of Book IV

Figure: Even ancient TajiksSoghdianslooked like Mongols. In


this this ancient wall fresco these men resembles officials of the
Tang Dynasty, China, which was the contemporary of Bunjikath.
The braod, fleshy Faces of Tajiks of a modern Book.

Mongoloid features of Tajiks, just as told in the adth.

B
541

542

Chapter 3

The Second Location of


People with Faces like Shields

Location No 2: Iran




.

( )


:












. 3345 : . .





543

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


: : .
10 17 812
Narrated Abu Huraira \: The Prophet said: The Hour will
not be established till you fight with the Khudh and the
Kirman from among the non-Arabs. They will be of red faces,
flat noses and small eyes; their faces will look like flat shields,
and their shoes will be of hair.254


( )




:
: ,



8250 : . .



: .
:
Narrated Abu Huraira \: our Dear Prophet said: the Dajjal
(Anti-Christ) will descend in Khuz and Karman with seventy

254. a Bukhari, adth 812, Vol. 2, (adth 3375).


544

Chapter 3 of Book IV

thousand people having faces like hammered shields. 255

( )

. -

( )



:
1071 :
(Sahifa Hamam bin Manbah) our Dear Prophet of Allah U
said that the judgement day will not occur until you fight with
the people of Khuz and Karman who are from the non-Arab
nations, who have red faces, flat noses, small eyes, and their
faces are (flat) like hammered shields.256
You can see that again faces like shields is used to show that it
means the same as Turks. Check the following adth also about the
same area, and using the same words faces like shields.
Narrated Abu Huraira \: The Prophet said: The Hour will
not be established till you fight with the Khudh and the
255. Musnad Ahmad, adth 1278, Vol. 4.
256. Masnad Ahmad, Sahifa Hamam bin Manbah, Vol. 4, adth 1071.
545

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Kirman from among the non-Arabs. They will be of red faces,


flat noses and small eyes; their faces will look like flat shields,
and their shoes will be of hair.257
Which Iranis have faces like shields (or Mongol like faces)?
As the above adth clearly mentions that the faces of these followers of
the Dajjal will be like flat shields, it is obvious that this means the
Turkic people.
Now, do the Turkic people live in Iran?
Iran also has considerable Turkic population and they are known as
Azeri Turks, or the Turks from Azerbaijan.
According to Olivier Roy:
The mass of the Oghuz Turkic tribes who crossed the Amu
Darya towards the west left the Iranian plateau, which
remained Persian, and established themselves more to the
west, in Anatolia. Here they divided into Ottomans, who were
Sunni and settled, and Turkmens, who were nomads and in
part Shiite (or, rather Alevi). The latter were to keep the name
Turkmen for a long time: from the 13th century onwards
they Turkicised the Iranian populations of Azerbaijan (who
spoke west Iranian languages such as Tat, which is still found
in residual forms), thus creating a new identity based on
Shiism and the use of Turkic. These are the people today

257. Bukhari, Volume 4, Book 56, Number 788.


546

Chapter 3 of Book IV

known as Azeris. 258


Richard Thomas, Roger east, and Alan John Day state:
The 1520 million Azeri Turks living in northern Iran,
ethnically identical to Azeris, have embraced Shia Islam and
are well integrated into Iranian society. 259
Common points about both the above locations.
In both locations people with Turk culture are common and for them
the word faces like shields is commonly used because they have round
and fleshy faces (like Mongols)
Also the following adth clearly tells us that the people with faces
like flat shields are the Turks (or Turkic / Mongols).
Narrated Abu Huraira \: The Prophet U said: The Hour will
not be established till you fight a nation wearing hairy shoes,
and till you fight the Turks, who will have small eyes, red faces
and flat noses; and their faces will be like flat shields.260
And in the following adth, the Turks are mentioned
to have flat faces like shields.
Narrated Abu Huraira \: The Prophet U said: The Hour
258. Olivier Roy. The new Central Asia, I.B. Tauris, 2007, pg 7.
259. Richard Thomas, Roger East, Alan John Day, Political and Economic
Dictionary of Eastern Europe, Routledge, 2002, pg 41.
260. Bukhari, Volume No: 4, Book No: 56, No: 787.

547

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

will not be established till you fight a nation wearing hairy


shoes, and till you fight the Turks, who will have small eyes,
red faces and flat noses; and their faces will be like flat shields.
And you will find that the best people are those who hate the
responsibility of ruling most of all, till they are chosen to be
the rulers. And the people are of different natures: The best in
the pre-Islamic period are the best in Islam. A time will come
when any of you will love to see me rather than to have his
family and property doubled.261
The above two adth have the common words faces like shields,
and it is also told that these will be Turks (or the Turkic people). So, it
means that the round faced people (mainly the Turkic people) of Iran
and Khurasan will be among the Army of the Dajjal.

261. Al-Tirmidhi, adth 5487.


548

Chapter 4

Does the above adth points towards the


Mongols of the past?
(Genghis Khan and Hulugu)

In those adth that do not point towards the location of the Mongols,
it is possible that the Mongols and Turks are mentioned in separate
adth?
We cannot combine them together as the adth tells us about the
two distinct groups, at two distinct times, as you can see in the following
adth.

.
:
.
. .
Abu Huraira \ reported Allahs Messenger U as saying: You
shall fight in the hours to come against a nation wearing shoes
made of hair and faces like hammered shields, with red

549

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

complexion and small eyes.262


The following adth clearly tells us about two different groups.
Also, it tells us that the Mongols wear shoes made of hair, and the Turks
are those who have faces like shields:
Narrated Amr \ bin Taghlib: The Prophet said: One of the
portents of the Hour is that you will fight with people wearing
shoes made of hair, and one of the portents of the Hour is that
you will fight with broad-faced people whose faces will look
like shields coated with leather.263
Also the following adth again points out towards the faces like
shields of the Turks and differentiates them from the other groups. i.e.:
the Mongols.

( )2725 :

:






:

262. a Muslim, Bab-al-Fitan, adth 2291-66


http://www.iid-alraid.de/Hadeethlib/hadethb.htm.
263. a Bukhari, Volume 4, Book 52, Number 178.
550

Chapter 4 of Book IV





190 : :
Allahs Messenger U said: The Hour will not be established
until you fight with the Turks, people with small eyes, red
faces, and flat noses. Their faces will look like shields coated
with leather. And the Hour will not be established till you
fight with people whose shoes are made of hair.264
Also the following adth tells us that the small eyed people (like
Mongols) are the Turkic people.



( )






:






3753 :



264. a al-Bukhari, Vol. 4, Book 52, adth 179.


551

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X







911 : :
Hazrat Buraidah \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet
Muammad U) reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad
U) said: A nation will wage war with you who will have small
eyes, meaning the Turks. You will drive them three times until
you will drive them to the Arabian Peninsula. The first time
you push them back, those who will run away among them
will get salvation, and in the second time some will get
salvation and some will be killed, and the third time you drive
them back, they will be uprooted or the way you said it.265

265. Sunan Abu Daud, Awwal Kitab-al-Malahim, adth 4305 at


http://www.iid-alraid.de/Hadeethlib/Books/05/book291.htm
552

Chapter 5

The Children of Qantura

The adth tells us that the Children of Qantura are Turks (meaning
mixture of Turks and Mongols).
Khurasan (part of Central Asia) has different nations sharing the same
Turkic culture. For example Uzbekistan, Turkmenistan, Hazara people,
Azerbaijan, etc. These are different people, but all of them share the
same Turkic culture.
Now, the word used in the first adth is Turkic nations of
Khurasan, which clearly tells us that in the Khurasan there are
different races with different names but are all known as Turkic, which
clearly points out towards these nations.
On the other hand we do not know of different countries for the
Mongols as they are known to have a single nation, unlike the Turks of
Central Asia, who have different flavors. We see that we have only one
country for the Mongols, i.e.: Mongolia. On the other hand, Turks have
different

countries

like

Uzbekistan,

Kazakhstan,

Tajikistan,

Turkmenistan, etc. This also proves that the first adth points towards
the Turks of Central Asia and not the Mongols.
The first adth tells us that Muslims will fight the Children of
553

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Qantura who will have


1. Broad faces, and
2. Small eyes
Very important adth telling us about Children of Qantura fighting
with the non-Arab in the Arab region of the city of Basra.

( -)(3754 : )







:




:

:


:




..


Narrated Abu Bakrah \: The Apostle of Allah U said: Some
of my people will alight on low lying ground, which they will
call al-Basrah, beside a river called the Dajjal (the Tigris) over
which there is a bridge. It is people will be numerous, and it
will be one of the cities of immigrants. At the end of time the
descendants of Qantura will come with broad faces and small
eyes and alight on the bank of the river. The towns
inhabitants will then separate into three sections, one of
which will follow cattle and (live in) the desert and perish,
554

Chapter 5 of Book IV

another of which will seek security for themselves and perish,


but a third will put their children behind their backs and fight
the invaders, and they will be the martyrs. 266
The following adth further tells us that these Banu Qantura are
the Turkic people. (Turk-Mongol mixture)

( )


:
:








:



:
: :

: . . .


19932 : .



()

266. Sunan Abu Dawud, adth 903.
555

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





592 : :
Narrated Abu Bakrah \: The Apostle of Allah U said: Some
of my people will alight on a ground, which they will call alBasirah, beside a river called Dajjal (the Tigris). It will be a city
of many orchards. The descendants of Qantura will come.
The towns inhabitants will then separate into three sections,
one of which will follow cattle (or their belongings and
property) and perish, another of which will seek security for
themselves and will leave Islam (become kafir) and they will
(also) perish. But a third will put their children behind their
backs and fight the invaders, and they will be the martyrs, and
this will bring victory to the people. The Companion (Sahabi)
Al-Awam (narrator) said that: The descendants of Qantura
means the Turks.267
Who is Qantura?
Qantura was one of Sayyidina Ibrahims X Canaanite wives whom he
married after the deaths of Sarah and Hajar, or a concubine, who came
from Central Asia. She bore him three sons whom Sayyidina Ibrahim

267. Masnad Ahmad, Vol 9, adth 592.


556

Chapter 5 of Book IV

X sent to Khurasan. They complained of this saying that Ismail had


been sent to a holy place, and Isaac was kept beside him, but they were
sent to Khurasan. Sayyidna Ibrahim X taught them an invocation.
When they experienced drought in Khurasan, these three sons were
sought by the people of the area to relieve them of drought, for that
invocation was always accepted. They prayed and it began to rain, and
the drought ended. Their descendants were addressed as Khana
title of importance to the Turks (who inhabited the Khurasan at that
time). The people would not touch the tribe out of respect and
reverence, even for the point of avoiding one drop blood to fall on the
earth, in fear it would bring about Allahs , revenge. Because of this
tremendous respect, if a descendant of Qanturacommitted a capital
crime he could not be punished by the sword, which is the tradition of
the Turks. Instead a bowstring would be used to throttle the guilty, in
order to prevent his blood from falling on the ground, and this was a
tradition of the descendants of Ibrahim X. This practice spread among
all the Turks.
The following famous Islamic historians have clearly told us that
the Turkic people belong to the sons of Qantura, and they settled in the
east and Khurasan, and beyond the Oxus River (Mawaraan Nahar).
1. Ibn Katheer Al-Dimashqi
2. Ibn-Sad
3. Al-Tabari
4. Al-Jahiz
The famous scholar Ibn Katheer Al-Dimashqi writes:
557

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

The Turks are from the progeny of Qantura who was the
female slave of Sayyidna Ibrahim X. 268
Al-Dimashqi also says that according to one tradition, the
Turks were the children of Ibrahim X by Qantura, whose
father belonged to the original Arab stock (al-Arab alAribah). The descendants of the other sons of Ibrahim X,
namely the Soghdians and the Kirgiz, were also said to live
beyond the Oxus.
Al-Jahiz similarly refers to the legend of the sons of Ibrahim X
and Qantura settling in Khurasan but does not mention the Khazars.269
The tale of a meeting in Khurasan between the sons of Qantura
(Gen. 25:1; 25:4; 1 Chr. 1:32-33) and the Khazars (Ashkenaz Gen. 10:3)
where the Khaqan is mentioned is quoted from the Sad and al-Tabari
by Poliak. (loc. cit.; Khazaria, 23,142, 148; Cf. ibn-Sad, I, i, 22; Tabari I,
i, 347ff).
Some other references telling us about the Turkic origin of
Qantura can be found in the following books also:
1. The Middle East Remembered: Forged Identities, Competing
Narratives, by Jacob Lassner, page 194.
2. Tracing our Ancestors, by Frederick Haberman, page 14, 15.
3. Risala, by Al-Jahiz, page 12-15.

B
2680 Book of the End, by Ibn Katheer, page 88.
269. Fada'il al-Atrak, transl. C. T. Harley Walker, J. (RA) S., 1915, page 687.
558

Chapter 6

Mongol and Central Asian Turks are related

Henry George Keene (18251915)270 writes:


A Mongol is merely a Turk in embryoa Turk little more
than a civilized and circumcised Mongol or Tartar.271
The Turks of central Asia have Mongol-like round faces, and these
Turkmen influences greatly affected the Tajiks. The first Turkic
invaders (from the northeast) seized this area of Transoxiana in the year
999 C.E., and because both conquered and conquerors were Muslim, in
time many Tajiks, especially those in the valleys of the Syr Darya and
Amu Darya,became Turkicised. This resulted in the transformation of
a formerly purely Iranian land into Turkistan. (Encyclopedia
Britannica).272

270. Fellow of the University of Calcutta; grandson of Henry George Keene


(17811864), orientalist (the brother-in-law of George Harris, first baron of
Seringapatam).
271. TheTurks in India: Critical Chapters on the Administration of That
Country, by Henry George Keene, page 1-2.
272. Encyclopedia Britannica, 2011.
559

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Fusion of the Mongols and Tajiks.


H.G Keene says:
The distinction between Turk and Mongol is not altogether
a natural distinction, but one preceding from comparatively
recent, and artificial causes cause arising out of a fusion,
more or less complete, of Tajik and Tartar. 273
The living proof of the fusion of the Tajiks with the Uzbeks.
The cultural centers of the Tajiks are claimed to be the cities
of Samarkand and Bukhara, more than a 1000 years ago during
the Samanid Empire. Today we see that both of these cities are now in
Uzbekistan.
The fact is that Uzbek and Tajiks have been considered the same
as told below.
Until the twentieth century, people in the region used two
types of distinction to identify themselves: way of life - either
nomadic or sedentary - and place of residence. By the late
nineteenth century, the Tajik and Uzbek peoples, who had
lived in proximity for centuries and often used each others
languages, did not perceive themselves as two distinct
nationalities. Consequently, such labels were imposed
artificially when Central Asia was divided into five Soviet

273. The Turks in India: Critical Chapters on the Administration of that


Country, By Henry George Keene, page 1.
560

Chapter 6 of Book IV

republics in the 1920s.274


So, if the Uzbeks adopted Turkish, then the Tajiks also have the
same Turkic culture, and the majority of them have the same
Mongolian facial features.
Henry George Keene says:

A Mongol is merely a Turk in embryo a Turk little more


than a civilized and circumcised Mongol or Tartar.275
The beauty of the adth of Khurasan.
This is the beauty of this adth that it did not mention the Turks or
Mongols as those that will form the army of the Dajjal of Khurasan,
but this great adth used the words:
The people with faces like shields
This is because some of the Tajiks claim not to be from the Turkic
or Mongols, but majority of them have facial features like of the Turkic
people, due to their intermixing with them for more than a 1000 years
of Turkic occupation.
Also the Hazaras are Mongols and have broad/fleshy faces.
So the adth covers all the races that have broad/fleshy faces

274. Library of Congress Country StudiesTajikistanHistorical and Ethnic


Background, 1996.
275. TheTurks in India: Critical Chapters on the Administration of That
Country, by Henry George Keene, page 1-2.

561

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

whether they claim to be non-Turkic or non-Mongol.


Mongols and Turks: Close relation in Iran, Khurasan, and Central
Asia.
The Turks of Central Asia originally come from the Mongols and that
is why they have Mongolic features.
It should be also noted that Central Asian Turks have a close
culture with the Mongols, and that is why they also have used the
clothes of hair, or hairy shoes as the following adth tells us (about
their common culture).

. . .
:
.
.
Abu Huraira \ reported Allahs Messenger U as saying: The
Last Hour would not come until a people wearing shoes of
hair fight against you having their faces like hammered
shields.276

276. a Muslim, Book 041, Number 6957.


562

Chapter 6 of Book IV

Turks and Mongol connection in Central Asia.


Henry George Keene (18251915)277 writes:
A Mongol is merely a Turk in embryoa Turk little more
than a civilized and circumcised Mongol or Tartar. 278
Turks of Central Asia were called Mongols in India.
Mongol in Turkic mouths becomes Moghol; the Persians,
softening still further, turn it into Mughul, or Mughul;
(See Taimurs Memoirs, quoted below), and thus the words
Mughal Empire... an evident misnomer, may have come to
be applied to the government of India by Tartar conquerors,
who had adopted Aryan manners.
By 1279, the Mongols conquered the Song Dynasty and
brought all of China under control of the Mongol Yuan
Dynasty. With the breakup of the empire, the dispersed
Mongols quickly adopted the mostly Turkic cultures
surrounding them and were assimilated, forming parts
of Tatars (not to be confused with a tribe in ancient
Mongolia), Uzbeks, Kazakhs, Yugurs, and Moghuls;
linguistic and cultural Persianization also began to be

277. Fellow of the University of Calcutta; grandson of Henry George Keene


(1781-1864), orientalist (the brother-in-law of George Harris, first baron of
Seringapatam).
278. TheTurks in India: Critical Chapters on the Administration of That
Country, by Henry George Keene, page 1-2.
563

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

prominent in these territories. 279


In the thirteenth century, the word Mongol grew into an
umbrella term for a large group of Mongolic and Turkic tribes
united under the rule of Genghis Khan.280
Turks and Mongols are closely related.
Henry George Keene (18251915)281 writes in The Turks in India,282
page 1.
Fusion of Tajiks and Mongols.
H.G Keene says: The distinction between Turk and Mongol
is not altogether a natural distinction, but one proceeding
from comparatively recent and artificial causes, cause arising
out of a fusion, more or less complete, of Tajik and Tartar.
The Mongols and Turks (of central Asia) are related. Page
1-2.

279. Juha Janhunen, The Mongolic languages, page 177. Elizabeth E. BaconObok: A Study of Social Structure in Eurasia, p.82.
280. Mongolia: Ethnography of Mongolia. Encyclopedia Britannica.
Retrieved 2007-07-22.
281. Fellow of the University of Calcutta; grandson of Henry George Keene
(17811864), orientalist (the brother-in-law of George Harris, first baron of
Seringapatam).
282. Keene, H. G. (Henry George), 1825-1915: The Turks in India; critical
chapters on the administration of that country by the Chughtai, Babar, and his
descendants, by Henry George Keene. (London, W. H. Allen and co., 1879).
564

Chapter 6 of Book IV

A Mongol is merely a Turk in embryo, a Turk little more


than a civilized and circumcised Mongol or Tartar.
Some information about the Turkic (or Mongol) races of the world.

Figure: The top of Belukha in the Altay Mountains in Mongolia


is shown here. The mountain range is thought to be the
birthplace of the Turkic people. (Source :Wikipedia)

Figure: Map showing countries and autonomous subdivisions


where a language belonging to the Turkic language
family has official status.
565

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Independent Turkic countries with an official Turkic language and


having Mongol like features:
1. Azerbaijan (Azeri)
2. Kazakhstan (Kazakh)
3. Kyrgyzstan (Kyrgyz)
4. Turkmenistan (Turkmen)
5. Uzbekistan (Uzbek)
6. Karakalpakstan (Karakalpak)
Autonomous regions with an official Turkic language:
1. Moldova
2. Territorial Autonomous Unit of Gagauzia (Gagauz Turkic)
3. Mongolia
4. Bayan Olgiy (Kazakh)
5. Peoples Republic of China
6. Xinjiang Uygur Autonomous Region (Uyghur)
7. Ili Kazakh Autonomous Prefecture (Kazakh)
8. Barkol Kazakh Autonomous County (Kazakh)
9. Mori Kazakh Autonomous County (Kazakh)
10. Aksai Kazakh Autonomous County (Kazakh)
11. Kizilsu Kirghiz Autonomous Prefecture (Kyrgyz)
12. Sunan Yugur Autonomous County (Western Yugur)
566

Chapter 6 of Book IV

13. Xunhua Salar Autonomous County (Salar)


14. Jishishan Bonan, Dongxiang and Salar Autonomous
County (Salar)
15. Russian Federation
16. Altai Republic (Altay)
17. Dagestan Republic (Azeri)
18. Dagestan Republic (Nogay)
19. Dagestan Republic (Kumyck)
20. Republic of Bashkortostan (Bashkir)
21. Chuvash Republic (Chuvash)
22. Kabardino-Balkar Republic (Karachay-Balkar
23. Karachay-Cherkess Republic (Karachay-Balkar)
24. Republic of Khakassia (Khakas)
25. Sakha Republic (Sakha)
26. Tatarstan (Tatar)
27. Tyva Republic (Tuvan)
Also in Afghanistan there are Turkic or Mongol races as:

Uzbeks

Hazara

Turkeman

Kazakh
567

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Tajik

The Tajik and Uzbek connection.


As far as the Tajiks are concerned they have mixed Iranian-Turkic
culture. The fact is that Uzbek and Tajiks have been considered the
same as told below.
Until the twentieth century, people in the region used two types of
distinction to identify themselves: way of life, either nomadic or
sedentary, and place of residence. By the late nineteenth century, the
Tajik and Uzbek peoples, who had lived in proximity for centuries and
often used each others languages, did not perceive themselves as two
distinct nationalities. Consequently, such labels were imposed
artificially when Central Asia was divided into five Soviet republics in
the 1920s.283
Conclusion
In short, in the historical region of Khurasan, we find different kinds of
Turkic races who were originally Mongols, and then divided into
different nations.Also they are Muslims and have mainly adopted
Turkish culture.

283. Library of Congress, Country StudiesTajikistanHistorical and Ethnic


Background, 1996.
568

Chapter 7

The Dajjals Army of Hypocrites


and Non Muslims

I have only mentioned before the groups of people who will be hiding
among Muslims, and will then join the Dajjal.
In fact all non-Muslims will already be following the Dajjal. The
Dajjal will become the sole leader of all the non-Muslims.
Below are some adth about the non-Muslims, especially the Jews,
who will follow the Dajjal.
The following two adth tells us about the hypocrites Muslims
leaving Madinah and joining the Dajjal.




.



569

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


2449 : :
Narrated by Anas \: our Dear Prophet Muammad U said
that: When the Dajjal will come, then he will station outside
Madinah. At that moment, three earth quakes will come in
Madinah and (due to this) all hypocrite men and women will
come out of Madinah and join the Dajjal.284













.

284. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 5, adth 2449.
570

Chapter 7 of Book IV

2 : :
Narrated by Jabir \: We came out from an opening from a
place called Hurra. We were in the company of our Dear
Prophet Muammad U. Our Dear Prophet Muammad U
said:
571

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

At the time of the appearance of the Dajjal, Madina will be


the best place (on earth). There will be angels guarding on
every opening/hole (way) of Madinah due to which the Dajjal
will not be able to enter Madinah. At that moment, three earth
quakes will come in Madinah and (due to this) all hypocrite
men and women will come out of Madinah and join the
Dajjal. The majority of them will be women. This day will be
the Day of Al Takhsees (Day of Purification), because on
this day Madinah will take out impurities from itself, just like
the furnace cleans iron from impurities.
There will be seventy thousand Jews who will be dressed in
Saaj (a green color Tayalisah is a Saaj), and they will have
swords decorated with Jewelry. He will stay at a place where
the rain water deposits nowadays. Then our Dear Prophet
Muammad U said:Till now and till the day of Qiyamah
(Judgement day), there has never been and never will be a
greater affliction than the Dajjal, and every Prophet has
warned their Ummah (nation) from him. I will tell you
something about him which no Prophet has told you before.
Then our Dear Prophet Muammad U put his beautiful hand
on his eye and said: I witness that Allah Aza wajal does not
have one eye, (Meaning that the Dajjal will have one eye). 285
Only the slaves of the Dajjal will be happy (temporarily), as the
following adth tells us:


285. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 6, adth 2.
572

Chapter 7 of Book IV




















.



573

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X
























574

Chapter 7 of Book IV

830 : :

Jabir \, reported that; Once our Dear Prophet Muammad


U said that the Dajjal will appear when laziness will come in
(practicing) the Deen (Islam). He (the Dajjal) will move
around the earth in 40 nights, out of which the first day will
be equal to one (normal) year, the second day will be equal to
one (normal) month, the third day will be equal to one
(normal) week, and the rest of the days will be like your
normal days (in duration). He will have a donkey which he
will ride, and between it is ear, the distance will be like 40
meters (approximate unit translation), and he will tell people
that he is your Rabb (Sustainer), but he will be squint, and
your Rabb (Sustainer) is not squint (not one eyed). Between
his eyes it would be written in alphabets K, F, R (root letters
575

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

for non-believer/kafir in Arabic). All (pious) Muslims will


be able to read this whether they can read (literate) or are
unable to read (illiterate). He will come at every place of water
and shore (meaning every place on earth), except Madinah,
and Makkah which will be made forbidden for him by Allah
,. He will have with him a mountain of bread (provisions)
and all people will very distressed except his followers. He will
have two rivers, the reality of which I U know more than him.
He will call one river as his Paradise, but in fact it will be Hell,
and whomever he will put in his Paradise, will found it Hell
(meaning he will enter Hell for following the Dajjal), and
whomever he puts in his Hell, will found it Paradise (meaning
he will enter paradise though the Dajjal will torture and kill
him/her).
Allah , will send Satans (devils) with him who will talk with
people. There will be great affliction with him. He will
(pretend) to order the sky and people will feel as if it is raining.
He will kill a person and then bring him to life in front of the
eyes of the people. He will tell people who else can do such
things except that he is the Sustainer (Allah) himself.
At that time, the real Muslims will escape and take shelter in
the Mountain of Dukhan in Shaam (Syria). The Dajjal will
besiege them and they will be in too much trouble. Then
Prophet Isa X will come at Suhoor time (time before the start
of morning prayers). He will ask people what is stopping you
to face (and fight) this wicked liar (the Dajjal). After hearing
this call of Prophet Isa X, people will think that it is some
576

Chapter 7 of Book IV

Jinn (supernatural creature), but when they will come out of


their shelter, they will find that it is Prophet Isa (AS). The time
of Morning Prayer will start and people will ask Prophet Isa
X to lead the prayers but he will say: No your Imam (leader)
should come forward and lead the prayers (Referring to
Imam Mahdi X).
After morning prayers, Prophet Isa X will come towards the
Dajjal. He will melt like salt melts in water. Then (all) trees
and (big) stones will call: O Rooh (title of Prophet Isa), there
is a Jew hiding behind us, so he (Isa X) will not let live any
of the followers of the Dajjal and kill them all. 286
The Dajjal will come when scholars will not mention him.






:

!


286. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 6, adth 830.
577

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X



2478 : :

Narrated by Saab bin Jathama \: I heard our Dear Prophet
Muammad U saying that: the Dajjal will not appear until
people stop talking about him.
Also another adth telling us almost the same fact.



The Dajjal will not appear until the people are surprised by
(anyone) mentioning him, and not until the imams (Muslim
Leaders) stop mentioning him on the minibars (pulpits). 287
The Dajjals army of Jews
The following adth tells us about the army of the Dajjal comprised of
seventy thousand (which means a large number) of Jews from Isphahan
(Iran) that will be with the Dajjal.

287. The Muhaddith is Al-Haythami who said this is a according to ibn
Maeen.
578

Chapter 7 of Book IV





2306 : :
Also the following adth tells the same thing:

2892 : :
1 6



2892 : :
Anas b. Malik \ reported that Allahs Messenger U said: The
Dajjal would be followed by seventy thousand Jews of Isfahan
wearing Persian shawls.

579

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

The following adth telling us about the army of the Dajjal of


seventy thousand Jews along with other people also:






















580

Chapter 7 of Book IV




:



















581

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


)
(





!


( )
!





)

! !
.
1020 : :
582

Chapter 7 of Book IV

Narrated by Abu-Nadra \: The Sahabi (Companion)


Uthman

bin Abi Al As said that our Dear Prophet

Muammad U said that: Muslims will be in three cities, one


city will be at the junction point of two rivers (it can be Basra
city of Iraq), the other will be in Al-Hirah ( ) city (in
Iraq) and (the third city) in Shaam (Syria which includes
present day Israel, Lebanon, Syria and up to the mountain
ranges in Turkey near Turkeys border with present day
Syria). People will be horrified (and scared) three times. Then
the Dajjal will appear, and he will defeat the people of the east.
Then he will first attack the city that will be at the junction
point of two rivers. Then the people (in that city) will be
divided in three groups. One group of the people will say that:
we want to go near him to see what he is is (in reality)? The
second group will join the village people, and the third group
will shift to a nearby city. At that time the Dajjal will be
accompanied by seventy thousand people who will be wearing
As-Saijan () cloaks (the green colour Tayalisah cloaks
called As-Saijan () and look exactly like Tayalisah
cloaks). Most of them will be Jews and women. Then, he will
move towards the second city. Again the people of that city
will be divided in three groups (in the same previous way).
One group of the people will say that: We want to go near
him to see what he is (in reality)? The second group will join
the village people, and the third group will shift to a nearby
city. In the west in Shaam, Muslim will gather in a mountain
pass called Afeeq (), then they will send one group to fight
(the Dajjal), and all of that group will be martyred. At that
583

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

time Muslims will be in great trouble. They will face severe


starvation and mighty strive. (To the extent) that a person will
cut strings of his bows and (try to) burn them to eat the string.
They will remain in this state until some caller will announce:
O people, your reliever has come to you (to give you relief).
People will say: This voice seems to be a person who has
eaten to ones satisfaction (because all of them will suffering
starvation). This time will be close to Fajr (morning
obligatory prayer). At this time Prophet Isa X will descend.
The leader of the Muslims will request him: O Rooh-Allah
(title of Prophet Isa X), come forward and lead the (Fajr)
prayers. He will say: People of this Ummah are Imam
(leaders) upon one another so lets pray. After completing
prayers (morning salah), he (i.e.: Prophet Isa X) will take his
spear and move towards the Dajjal. When the Dajjal will see
him, he will melt like lead. Prophet Isa X will hit him with
his spear between his chest and kill him. His followers will be
defeated. There will nothing that can hide those followers
then, (to the extent) that even if they hide behind a tree, the
tree will talk and say:Oh faithful, here is the Kafir (nonbeliever), and even a stone will talk (if they hide behind it),
and say: Oh faithful, here is the Kafir (non-believer).288
In the above adth, the city that is situated at the junction of two
rivers, is the city of Basra in Iraq.

288. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 7, adth 1020.


584

Chapter 7 of Book IV

And the following adth tells us that in Basra, the non-Arab


immigrants or refugees will be the ones who will fight the Dajjal.

( -)(3754 : )







:




:


:



:




..


Narrated Abu Bakrah \: The Apostle of Allah U said: Some
of my people will alight on low-lying ground, which they will
call al-Basrah, beside a river called the Dajjal (the Tigris) over
which there is a bridge. It is people will be numerous and it
will be one of the cities of immigrants. At the end of time the
descendants of Qantura will come with broad faces and small
eyes and alight on the bank of the river. The towns
inhabitants will then separate into three sections, one of
which will follow cattle and (live in) the desert and perish,
another of which will seek security for themselves and perish,
but a third will put their children behind their backs and fight

585

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

the invaders, and they will be the martyrs.289







.



.

.

289. Sunan Abu Dawud, adth 903.


586

B
BOOK V

TWELVE SIGNS OF
THE ARMY OF PROPHET JESUS X
AND IMAM MAHDI X
A QURAN AND HADITH VIEW








.
.

Introduction

Many books about this topic have used non-authentic adth, and also
Jewish and Christians references. I have tried to use only authentic
adth, and the Quran as references. Daif adth are only mentioned
after a a adth, when both type of adth are telling the same
thing.
One must memorize and read the first 10 verses of Srah Al Kahaf
in order to obtain clear understanding of the Quranic verses and adth
about the End of Times. In fact, we must all read them often to save
ourselves from the prevailing illusions and afflictions of todays world.
Important Note: I am only writing about the first and the
majority followers of the followers of Imam Mahdi X and
the Israeli Prophet Sayyidna Eisa X. Of course all pious
Muslims will join the sacred Army. InshahAllah.
The strong and weak Muslims of the End of Times.
It should be noted that the non-Muslims are not afraid of the Muslims
of the End of Times, except for the Muslims who will join those sacred
Army of Imam Mahdi X and Prophet Jesus X. The majority of the
Muslims will be weak in the eyes of other nations, as told in this adth:
591

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


( )





()
904 : : -
Narrated Thawban \: The Prophet said: The people will
soon summon one another to attack you as people when
eating invite others to share their dish. Someone asked: Will
that be because of our small numbers at that time? He U
replied: No, you will be numerous at that time, but you will
592

Introduction of Book V

be scum and rubbish like that carried down by a torrent, and


Allah , will take fear of you from the breasts of your enemy,
and last enervation into your hearts. Someone asked: What
is wahn (enervation). The Apostle of Allah U replied: Love
of the world and dislike of death.290
Now on the other hand, the Army of Mahdi is told to be very
strong as in the following adth:




.
154 : :
Abu Hurairah \ says that Rasulullah U said: (Armies
carrying) black flags will come from Khurasan (Land of the
rising sun, also meaning the east). No power will be able to
stop them and they will finally reach Elya (Baitul Maqdis)
where they will erect their flags.291
290. Sunan Abu Daud, adth 904, Vol. 3.
291. Jamia Tirmidhi, Vol. 2, adth 154.
593

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

The People of the Book know about the Truth of Islam and it is
promised Messiah X.
According to the Quran, a group among the of the People of the Book
(Jews and Christians) believe in the truth of the Quran and adth but
oppose it like the Satan.






.
Those to whom We gave the Scripture (Jews and Christians)
recognize him (Muammad U as they recognize their sons. But
verily, a party of them conceals the truth while they know it.
(2:146)
So, if they know who the Army of Mahdi are, they will certainly
have planned to eliminate all those who are told to be among that Sacred
Army, just the same way when Pharaoh started killing Banu Israel when
he feared that Prophet Moses X would be born among them.




Verily, Firaun (Pharaoh) exalted himself in the land and made
it is people sects, weakening (oppressing) a group (i.e.: Children
of Israel) among them, killing their sons, and letting their
females live. Verily, he was of the Mufsidn (i.e.: those who
commit great sins and crimes, oppressors, tyrants). (28:4)

594

Introduction of Book V

So, it means that the People of the Book are afraid of the Army of Isa
X and Imam Mahdi X in the End of Times.
Let us find out the signs of the majority, and the foremost followers of
the Army of Prophet Eisa X, InshahAllah.

595

596

Chapter 1

First Sign

They will come from the east.


Prophet Sayyidna Eisa X and Imam Mahdi X will come from the east,
like some of the followers of the Dajjal but this east is different from
that, as it will become clear when reach Sign No 6.

:

)): :
. .
)) . .(( .
: .(( .
. . .



( )

597

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X






( )
Thawban \ reported that our Dear Prophet U said: Three
people will fight for your treasure (and get killed). All three of
them will be the sons of a ruler but none of them will get the
treasure. Then black flags will appear from the east and will
kill you as no one (in history) has killed you before. Then our
Dear Prophet said something that I didnt remember. Then
again our Dear Prophet said: If you see him then give him
your allegiance, even if you have to crawl over ice, because he
is the Khalifa of Allah, the Mahdi (This adth is a (Most
Authentic) according to the standards of a Bukhari and
a Muslim).292
Also the following adth tells us about the Army of the east
coming to help Imam Mahdi X.
Attack of Muslims on the Army of the east of Imam Mahdi X.
The following authentic adth tells us that the Arab Muslims of
Makkah will be the first ones to attack on the Army of the east of Imam

292. Hakim Mustadrak in Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 8432.


598

Chapter 1 of Book V

Mahdi X in the Holy Mosque (Baitul Haram):

:

)): :
. .
)) . .(( .
: .(( .
. . .



( )




( )
Thawban \ reported that our Dear Prophet said: Three
people will fight for your treasure (and get killed). All three of
them will be the sons of a ruler, but none of them will get the
treasure. Then black flags will appear from the east and will
599

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

kill you as no one (in history) has killed you before. Then our
Dear Prophet said something that I didnt remember. Then
again our Dear Prophet said: If you see him then give him
your allegiance, even if you have to crawl over ice, because he
is the Khalifa of Allah, the Mahdi. (This adth is a
(Most Authentic) according to the standards of a Bukhari
and a Muslim).293
The rulers of the Arabian Peninsula will not help the Army of
Mahdi from the east, and therefore the Army of Mahdi will fight with
them, and there will be the largest killing of Arabs in their history. This
will take place at the Hands of Imam Mahdis X Army.
Why the people of that area will be attacked by the Army of Mahdi?
This will happen because the custodians of the Holy Mosques will attack
Imam Mahdi X first, to stop them from entering the Holy Mosque.
Also mentioned in the Quran we have:









2-114-





293. Hakim Mustadrak, Kitabal-Fitan, adth 8432.
600

Chapter 1 of Book V

2-114
And who is more unjust than he who forbids that in places for
the worship of Allah His name should be celebrated?Whose
zeal is (in fact) to ruin them? It was not fitting that such should
themselves enter them except in fear. For them there is nothing
but disgrace in this world and in the world to come, an
exceeding torment. (2:114)
Consequence for the bloodshed in the Kaba by the attack
on Imam Mahdi X.
This is told in the following authentic adth and is also related to the
previous adth:

:
) : ( )


-(


) ( )
136 (

:


601

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

)
(
()
8395 ( )
136( )
Narrated by Hazrat Abu Huraira \ from Hazrat Abu Qatada
\: Our Dear Prophet said: People will give allegiance (baya)
to a person (i.e.: Imam Mahdi X) between the Ruken (Hajre-Aswad) and Makam (Makam-e-Ibrahim) and no one else
but the same people who are related to that place (i.e.: the
citizens of Makkah) will destroy the respect of Kaabah (as they
will attack Imam Mahdi X in the Kaabah where it is
forbidden to fight), and when they will declare it Halal, then
do not ask about the killing of the Arabs (there will be a mass
killing of the Arabs). Then the Ethiopians (Africans) will
come and they will desolate it in such a way that it would
never be a habitat, and these will be the people who will take
out it is treasure. (This adth is a (Most Authentic)
according to the conditions of a Bukhari and a
Muslim). 294
Also check the following adth with almost the same meaning.

294. Ibn-e-Sheeba, Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 136.


Also Hakim Mustadrak, Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 8395. Can be checked at
http://www.iid-alraid.de/Hadeethlib/hadethb.html
602

Chapter 1 of Book V

Note: The adth written below is Daif (Not Authentic), but


I have mentioned it since it resembles the above authentic
adth.

. .
:
.
: .
:

. ))
. .
. . .
. .
.(( .
4082





)
(


603

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


( )


()




963
Narrated Abd Allah who said: Whilst we were with the
Prophet, some young men from Banu Hashim approached us.
When the Prophet saw them, his eyes filled with tears and the
color of his face changed. I said: We can see something has
changed in your face, and it upsets us. The Prophet said: We
are the people of a Household for whom Allah has chosen the
Hereafter rather than this world. The people of my
Household (Ahl al-Bayt) will suffer a great deal after my
death, and will be persecuted until a people carrying black
banners will come out of the east. They will instruct the
people to do good, but the people will refuse; they will fight
until they are victorious, and the people do as they asked, but
they will not accept it from them until they hand over power
to a man from my household. Then the earth will be filled
with fairness, just as it had been filled with injustice. If any of
604

Chapter 1 of Book V

you live to see this, you should go to him even if you have to
crawl across ice.295
Also the following adth written below is Daif (Not Authentic)
but I have mentioned it since it resembles the authentic adth about
the Army of Mahdi from the east.

: .
.
:
. )):
: ((
( )


( )

Abdullah bin Haris \ reported that our Dear Prophet said:
Some people will come out from the east who will make the
Kalifate (Islamic rule) easy for Imam Mahdi X.296

295. Sunan Ibn-e-Majah, Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 4082. The English translation


is from Signs before the Day of Judgment by Ibn Katheer, available at
http://www.khatm-e-nubuwwat.org/Books/book.htm.
296. Sunan Ibn Majah, Kitab-al-Fitan, adth No 4088.
605

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Two Objections
We also have adth that mentions two similar points i.e.;
1. The Dajjal will also appear from the East.
2. Dajjal will have followers from Khurasan in the East
Answer to Objection No1: The Dajjal will also appear from the
East but this East will be not Khurasan but Najad in Arabian
Peninsula.
Please read the following two adth.

( )



.





: :
2361
It was narrated by Abdullah bin Umar \ that I heard, the
Messenger of Allah U saying that: Soon among my nation
606

Chapter 1 of Book V

(Muslim Ummah) there will appear people from the east who
will recite the Quran but it will not go any deeper than their
collarbones or their throats. Whenever any of their offspring
will appear, they will be eliminated. He U repeated this ten
times, and then said until in the last of them will appear with
the Dajjal (Anti-Christ).297
Proof that the east of afflictions is from the Najd.
Following adth is related to the above adth as it tells us about the
same hypocrites who will be reading the Quran but the Quran will not
pass through their throats. It is further explained in this adth that
these people will be among the tribes of Najd in the east.






(3) (2) (1)




()
297. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 2361.
607

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X
















)
(


489 : : .
24
It was narrated that Abu Saeed Al Khudri \ said: When he
608

Chapter 1 of Book V

was in Yemen, Ali \ sent a piece of gold that was still mixed
with sediment to the Messenger of Allah U, and the
Messenger of Allah U distributed it among four people: AlAqra bin Habis Al-Hanzali, Uyaynah bin Badr Al- Fazari,
Alqamah bin Ulathah Al Amiri, who was from Banu Kilab
and Zaid At-Tai who was from Banu Nabhan. The Quraish
he said one time the chiefs of the Quraishbecame angry
and said: You give to the chiefs of Najd and not to us? He
said: I only did that so as to soften their hearts towards Islam.
Then a man with a thick beard, prominent cheeks, sunken
eyes, a high forehead, and a shaven head came and said:
Fear Allah, Muammad! He (Prophet Muammad U said:
Who would obey Allah , if I disobeyed Him? (Is it fair that)
He has entrusted me with all the people of the earth but you
do not trust me? Then the man went away, and a man from
among the people, whom they (the narrators) think was
Khalid bin Al Walid, asked for permission to kill him. The
Messenger of Allah U said: Among the offspring of this man
will be some people who will recite the Quran but it will
not go any further than their throats. They will kill the
Muslims but leave the idol worshippers alone, and they will
pass through Islam as an arrow passes through the body of
the target. If I live to see them, I will kill them all, as the people
of Ad were killed. 298
[Further discussion can be found in the book number 3, i.e.

298 Sunan Nisai,Vol 2, adth 489.


609

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Army of Dajjal Part-1 in this collection


Answer to Objection No.2: Dajjal will have followers from
Khurasan in the East.
We have adth which tells that followers of Dajjal will also come
from the East in Khurasan but these followers are the people who are
mixture of Mongols and Turks and have broad round fleshy faces (like
Mongols).
Further discussion about Dajjal followers from Khuraasn in
the East can be found in the book number 4, i.e. Army of
Dajjal Part-2 in this collection
Conclusion
The adth have mentioned two types of eastern locations. The one
from where Imam Mahdi X will come. The second eastern location is
where the Dajjal will appear. These are the differences among these two
locations:

Imam Mahdis X Army will appear from the east with a cold
climate and having snowfall.

Imam Mahdis X Army will appear from the east in the


ancient region of Khurasan.

The Dajjal will appear from the east, having a hot climate.

The Dajjal will appear in the east from a place called Najd.

Dajjal will be supported by the Arab tribes of the Najd in the


east such as Banu Tamim. (Please read book number 3, i.e.
Army of Dajjal Part-1 in this collection.)
610

Chapter 1 of Book V

Dajjal will also be supported by people having small eyes and


broad faces from Khuraan who are dicussed in Book No. 4 in
this collection, i.e. Army of Dajjal Part-2 in this collection.
About the location of Khurasan, we shall discuss it in the next
chapters.

611

612

Chapter 2

Second Sign

They will come from the Khurasan.


adth mentioning the Khurasan (The land of the rising sun, or the
east).

"

(:) "

:

(:)
Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said that: When you hear
the news of black flags coming from the Khurasan, then you
must join them even if you have to crawl over ice (to reach
them), as the Khalifa of Allah, Mahdi X will be among

613

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

them.299



-



2427 : :
Thoban \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet) reported that
our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: When you see that
black flags have appeared from Khurasan, go to (join) them
even if you have to walk over ice on your knees, as the Khalifa
of Allah, Mahdi X will be among them.300

299. Masnad Ahmad, 5:277. Also in Sunan Ibn Majah.


300. Masnad Ahmad, Volume 9, adth 2427.
614

Chapter 2 of Book V

1599 : :

Abu Huraira \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet


Muammad U) reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad
U said:Black flags will appear from the Khurasan, nothing
will stop them until they will be placed at Elya (The Holy Land
of Jerusalem).301
The above three adth are Authentic.
All the above three adth are a adth. Famous adth scholar Ali
Mutaqqi says about the above adth (of Masnad Ahmad) that these are
Authentic, and further says in the beginning of his book that:


( , . , , )


) .
( , . , ,

301. Masnad Ahmad, Volume 4, adth 1599.


615

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Translation:
Muhaddith Ali Muttaqi said that all the adth of Masnad
Ahmad are Maqbool, 302 even if it is Daif, 303 and it is almost
equal to Hasan adth.

304

(Ref: Muntakhab Kanzaul Amal,

Ali Hamish, Masnad Ahmad, page 8, Vol 1).


Also another famous adth scholar, Ibn Hajar, said the same
thing:



7


( )

302. Acceptable (Maqbool): adth that is found to be reported by truthful and


acceptable narrators. It is ruling is that it is obligatory to accept and act upon
it.
303. Daif ( ):
Is the categorization of a adth as weak. Ibn Hajar described
the cause of a adth being classified as weak as either due to discontinuity in
the chain of narrators, or due to some criticism of a narrator.
304. Hasan ( ):
Linguistically it means good, and there exist somewhat
convergent technical definitions, however, in general, it expresses the
categorization of a adth's authenticity as acceptable for use as a religious
evidence, however, not established to the extent of a.
616

Chapter 2 of Book V

Translation:
The famous scholar of adth, Hafiz Ibn Hajar also accepted
the same rule about Masnad Ahmad, and said that there is no
Daif adth in Masnad Ahmad. Also Ibn Hajar did not accept
the ruling of Ibn Jauzi considering some of the adth of
Masnad Ahmad as Daif. In fact Ibn Hajar wrote a book called
Al Qaul-ul-Masdood in which he proved the claim of Ibn
Jauzi wrong, and proved that these adth were not Daif.
(Reference from Muntakhib Kanzul Amal, Ali Hamish, page
8, 9, Volume 1). 305
Another authentic adth (from Hakim Mustadrak)

305. Aqeedah Zahur-e-Mahdi, by Dr.Mufti Nizam-ud-din Shamzai, page 68,


75.
617

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

. .
Thoban \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet Muammad U)
reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: When
you see that black flags have appeared from Khurasan, go to
(join) them even if you have to walk over ICE on your knees
as the Khalifa of Allah, MAHDI will be among them. (This
adth is a (Most Authentic) according to the conditions
of a Bukhari and a Muslim).306
Khurasan means the east, and has a cold climate.
The following authentic adth tells us about black flags coming from
the east which means east = Khurasan. Also the word Khurasan means
the land of the rising sun, i.e.: the east. So both Khurasan and east
means the same in the adth, telling us about the black flags of Islam.

:

)): :
. .
)) . .(( .
: .(( .
. . .

306. Mustadrak Hakim, adth 8531.


618

Chapter 2 of Book V



( )






( )
Thawban \ reported that our Dear Prophet said: Three
people will fight for your treasure (and get killed). All three of
them will be sons of a ruler but none of them will get the
treasure. Then black flags will appear from the east and will
kill you as no one (in history) has killed you before. Then our
Dear Prophet said something that I didnt remember. Then
again our Dear Prophet said: If you see him, then give him
your allegiance, even if you have to crawl over ice, because he
is the Khalifa of Allah, the Mahdi. (This adth is a
(Most Authentic) according to the conditions of a
Bukhari and a Muslim).307

: .
307. Hakim Mustadrak, adth 4084, Kitab-al-Fitan. Also Sunan Ibn Majah,
Ahmads Musnad and other books of adth.
619

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

.
:
:
. (( . ))
- :



( )

Abdullah bin Haris \ reported that our Dear Prophet U said:
Some people will come out from the east who will make the
Kalifate (Islamic rule) easy for Imam Mahdi X.308
More adth about Khurasan


: -:

(
)

( )
)

308. Ibn-e-Majah, Chapter Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 4088.


620

Chapter 2 of Book V

(
Abu Hurairah \ says that Rasulullah U said: Armies
(carrying) black flags will come from Khurasan (the land of
the rising sun, meaning the east). No power will be able to
stop them and they will finally reach Elya (Baitul Maqdas),
where they will erect their flags.309





)
(

Hazrat Buraidah \ says that Rasulullah U said: There will be


many armies after me. You must join that army which will
come from the Khurasan (the land of the rising sun, the
east).310





309. Sunan Tirmidhi, Chapter of Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 2371.
310. Ibn-e-Adi, Asaker and Seyuti in Jamiah Sagheer.
621

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

( : )
:

( )
( )



: )

(
Narrated by Abdur Rehman Al-Jarshi \ that I heard the
companion of our Dear Prophet, Hazrat Amr Bin Marra AlJamli \ that our Dear Prophet U said: Surely black flags will
appear from the Khurasan until the people (under the
leadership of this flag) will tie their horses with the olive trees
between Bait-e-Lahya and Harasta. We asked: Are there any
olive trees between these places? He said:If there isnt then
soon it will grow, so that those people (of Khurasan) will come
and tie their horses there.311

311. Kitab-al-Fitan, page 215. Also at page 108 in the book Islam main Imam
Mahdi X ka Tasawer by Maulana Professor Muhammad Yousaf Khan, Jamia
Ashrafia Lahore, Pakistan can be checked at http://www.khatm-enubuwwat.com.pk/kn/books.html.
622

Chapter 2 of Book V

Detailed discussion about the authenticity of the adth of Khurasan,


by Dr. Mufti Nizam-ud-Din Shamzai.
To answer to the fake propaganda, we shall now discuss in detail the
authenticity of the adth of Khurasan.
Please read the following adth:

( ,6 92
:

,6 92 )
(
Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said that: When you hear
the news of black flags coming from the east, then, you must
join them because the Khalifa of Allah, Mahdi X will be
amongst them.312
The above narration is copied by the writer of Kanz Al Amal from
Masnad Ahmad, and Mustadrak Hakim, and the writer has copied the
quote of the famous scholar and Muhaddith Imam Suyuti313 about the
adth books of Mustadrak Hakim, a Bukhari, a Ibn Haban

312. Selection Kanz-ul-Amal, page29, Vol. 6, Ali Hamish, Masnad Ahmad.


313. Imam Suyuti, Famous adth scholar of Iraq.
623

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

and Mukhtara Zia Muqadsi.


)
(
When I am copying any adth narration from the five books
(i.e.: Mustadrak Hakim, a Bukhari, a Ibn Haban, and
Mukhtara Zia Muqadsi, or giving reference to these books,
then it will be the indication of the authenticity of the adth.
However the adth of Mustadrak Hakim, which have an
objection, then I will give a warning about it. 314
Now, we see that no warning has been given by Imam Suyuti about
this adth when it is quoted from Mustadrak Hakim. This means that
this adth is 100% Authentic in Mustadrak Hakim (according to Imam
Suyuti).
Also this adth is present in Masnad Ahmad and mentioned as
a adth. This is the following adth.



(5 177 - )
Narrated by Wakee from Al-Amash from Salam

from Thoban saying that: Our Dear Prophet


Muammad U said that: When you hear the news of black

314. Selection Kanz-ul-Amal, Ali Hamish,Vol.


624

Chapter 2 of Book V

flags coming from the east, then you must join them because
the Khalifa of Allah, Mahdi X will be amongst them.315
All the narrators of the above adth are authentic Saqqa as
we shall discuss them one by one in the following.

Wakee : His name is Wekee bin Al-Jarrah . He is


a famous Muhaddith and Saqqa (Authentic). The famous
Muhaddith Hafiz ibn Hajar wrote about Wakee in
his book Taqreeb Al-Tehzeeb that he is Saqqa
(Authentic) in page 369. Also he wrote that Wakee bin Adas
or Wakee bin Mehrez , they are also
Saqqa (Authentic).

Amash : His name is Suleiman bin Meharwan .


Hafiz ibn Hajar wrote about Amash in his book
Taqreeb Al-Tehzeeb that he is
reliable and trustworthy in page 136.

Salem: His name is Salem bin Abi Al-Jad . Hafiz ibn


Hajar wrote about Salem in his book Taqreeb Al-Tehzeeb that
Salem is Saqqa (authentic) and he can Ursal
(transmit). Page 114.

The famous scholar Allama Khazarji

316

wrote in his

book Khulasa that

315. Masnad Ahmad, page 177, Vol 5.


316. Allam Khazarji (33-44).
625

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Imam Ahmad said that he has not met Salem, and Imam
Bukhari said that he has not heard from Salem.
In this case, objection can be made that Salem narrated this adth
from Thoban without any medium, and therefore the adth is Maqtoo
adth.317 The answer to this objection is that between him and Thoban
there is another Muhaddith called Maadan-bin-Talha as
told in Masnad Ahmad. (Pages 276, 280, 281, 284, Volume 5).
However, it was the habit of Salem that he transmitted adth
without mentioning his teacher Madan ibn Talha because
Madan was already known as his famous teacher. Hafiz Ibn Hajar
wrote in his book, page 343, that Madan ibn Talha is Syrian
and authentic.
In this detail we found out that this narration is authentic and the
adth is Mutasil adth. 318 Morever, the authenticity of Salam is also
written by Abu Zar-a, Yahya bin Moen, and Imam Nisai, who temselves
are Saqqa . (Foot note Khulasa Page 31).
Also Maadan is considered authentic by Majeli and Ibn Saad.
(Foot note in Khulasa Page 383).
This adth is narrated in Hakim Mustadrak from Thoban by Abu
Asma Al-rajee instead of Maadan ibn Talha .
(Mustadrak Hakim, Page 502, Vol 2).

317. That statement which is attributed to some Tabyin (students of the


Companions).
318. That adth which has successive narrators, and there are no gaps or
omission in the chain.
626

Chapter 2 of Book V

Now Abu Asma Al-rajee

is considered Authentic

according to all Muhadditeen. His real name is Amr bin Murthad


.Hafiz Ibn Hajar wrote in his book Taqreeb, page 262, that
Amr bin Murthad is authentic and a trustworthy narrator.
Also Amr bin Murthad is considered Authentic by the
statement of Ajali in the book Khulasa, page 293.
In the narration of Hakim Mustadrak, we find that Abu Qulaba
is narrating from Abu-Asma. If Abu Qulaba
mentioned in the Hakim Mustadrak adth is Abdul Malik bin
Muammad (because he is also well known as Abu-Qulaba
) then he is also considered Authentic and a truthful person
by Hafiz Ibn Hajar in his book Taqreeb, page 220.
We go further and see that Khalid Al-Haza is narrating
from Abu Qulaba and his real name is Khalid Bin Meharwan
. Hafiz Ibn Hajar 7 wrote in his book Taqreeb, page
90, that Khalid Bin Meharwan is authentic c also he is
considered Authentic in the famous book. He wrote this in his book
Khulasa Lil-Khazarji , page 103.
Also in the book Tehzeeb-al-Tehzeeb it is written by
Hafiz Ibn Hajar that famous Muhadditheen like Nisai ,

Imam Ahmad , and Yahya Bin Moeen


have also
authenticated and mentioned this adth. (Note of Khulasa LilKhazarji, page 103).
So it means that this adth is not only narrated by Salim bin Abi
Aljad but also the same adth is narrated by other authentic
narrators in Hakim Mustadrak.
627

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

(Reference: The above research about the authenticity of the


Khurasan adth is written by the famous Scholar Dr. Mufti Nizam-udDin Shamzai in his book Aqeeda Zahoor-e-Mahdi adth ki Roshni
Main, pages 69-73).
Boundaries of Khurasan
According to the references from Encyclopedia Britannica 1997:
KHURASAN, The historical region extended along the north,
from the Amu Darya (Oxus River) westward to the Caspian
Sea and, along the south, from the fringes of the central
Iranian deserts eastward to central Afghanistan. Arab
geographers even spoke of it is extending to the boundaries of
India.
This definition tells us that the following area is included in the
historical region of ancient Khurasan:
1. Some of the northern parts of Iran.
2. Most of Afghanistan.
3. North western parts of Pakistan.
4. Some southern parts of the Central Asian Turkic states like
Turkmenistan and Uzbekistan.
The geographical location of the Pathans / Pashtuns, is also the
same as told in the adth.

628

Chapter 2 of Book V

Objection: There are people from Khurasan who will be the first
followers of the Jewish King DAJJAL. To find about them,
let us check the adth.
adth about the Dajjals Army of Khurasan and Iran.
Please check the following adth telling us about the army of the Dajjal
with faces like shields from Khurasan and Iran.
Narrated Amr bin Taghlib \: The Prophet said: One of the
portents of the Hour is that you will fight with people wearing
shoes made of hair; and one of the portents of the Hour is that
you will fight with broad-faced people whose faces will look
like shields coated with leather.319
The following adth tells us that these people with faces like
shields will be in the Dajjals Army.

:
.
:
)):
(( .
4072

319. a Bukhari, Volume 4, Book 52, Number 178.


629

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X



( )
952 : :
Narrated by Amr ibn Hurayth \ who quoted Abu Bakr Al
Siddiq \ as saying that Allahs Messenger U told them the
Dajjal would come forth from a land in the east called
Khurasan, followed by people whose faces resembled shields
covered with skin.320
Location of people who have faces like shields?
We have two locations as given by the adth.
Location No 1: The Khurasan.

:
.
:
)):
(( .
4072

320. Sunan Ibn Majah, Chapter Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 4078 at http://www.iidalraid.de/Hadeethlib/. Also in a Tirmidhi, and in Mishkat, adth 5251.
630

Chapter 2 of Book V



( )
952 : :
Narrated by Amr ibn Hurayth \ quoted Abu Bakr Al Siddiq
\ as saying that Allahs Messenger U told them that the Dajjal
would come forth from a land in the east called Khurasan,
followed by people whose faces resembled shields covered
with skin. 321
Location No 2: Iran.
The following adth tells us about Khuz and Karman areas
of Iran:

321. Sunan Ibn Majah, Chapter Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 4078, at http://www.iidalraid.de/Hadeethlib/. Also in a Tirmidhi and in Mishkat, adth 5251.
631

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





: : .
812
Narrated Abu Huraira \: Our Dear Prophet said: The Hour
will not be established till you fight with the Khudh and the
Kirman from among the non-Arabs. They will be of red faces,
flat noses and small eyes; their faces will look like flat shields,
and their shoes will be of hair.322




.



: : -
1278

322. a Bukhari, adth 812, Vol. 2. (adth 3375).


632

Chapter 2 of Book V

Narrated Abu Huraira \: The Prophet said: The Dajjal


(Anti-Christ) will descend in Khuz and Karman with seventy
thousand people having faces like hammered Shields.323
You can see that again faces like shields is used to show that it
means the same Turkic-Mongol mixture.
Please note that the Turkic people are different from the
people of Turkey. Infact the Turkic of Central Asia are
originally Mongols who are Muslims and have adopted
Turkish culture
Check the following adth also about the same area, and using the
same words faces like shields.



-




1071 : :
Narrated Abu Huraira \: The Prophet said: The Hour will
not be established till you fight with the Khudh and the
Kirman from among the non-Arabs. They will be of red faces,
323. Musnad Ahmad, adth 1278, Vol. 4.
633

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

flat noses and small eyes; their faces will look like flat shields,
and their shoes will be of hair.324
Which Iranis have faces like shields (or flat faces)?
As the above adth clearly mentions, the faces of these followers of the
Dajjal will be like flat shields, it is obvious that this means the Turkic
people.
Now do the Turkic live in Iran?
Iran also has a considerable Turkic population, and they are known as
Azeri, or people from Azerbaijan.
According to Olivier Roy:
The mass of the Oghuz Turkic tribes who crossed the Amu
Darya towards the west left the Iranian plateau, which
remained Persian, and established themselves more to the
west, in Anatolia. Here they divided into Ottomans, who were
Sunni and settled, and Turkmens, who were nomads and in
part Shiite (or, rather, Alevi). The latter were to keep the name
Turkmen for a long time: from the 13th century onwards
they Turkicised the Iranian populations of Azerbaijan (who
spoke west Iranian languages such as Tat, which is still found
in residual forms), thus creating a new identity based on
Shiism and the use of Turkic. These are the people today

324. a Bukhari, Volume 4, Book 56, Number 788.


634

Chapter 2 of Book V

known as Azeris. 325


Richard Thomas, Roger East, and Alan John Day state:
The 1520 million Azeri Turks living in northern Iran,
ethnically identical to Azeris, have embraced Shia Islam, and
are well integrated into Iranian society. 326
Common point in both the above locations.
In both these locations people with Turkic culture are common and
for them the word faces like shields is commonly used.
Also the following adth clearly tells us that the people with faces
like flat shields are the Turkic people (who are actually related to
Mongols).
Narrated Abu Huraira \: The Prophet said: The Hour will
not be established till you fight a nation wearing hairy shoes,
and till you fight the Turks, who will have small eyes, red faces
and flat noses; and their faces will be like flat shields.327
And in the following adth, the Turks are mentioned to have flat
faces like shields (due to relation with Mongols in Central Asia).
Narrated Abu Huraira \: The Prophet said: The Hour will
not be established till you fight a nation wearing hairy shoes,

325. Olivier Roy, The new Central Asia, I.B. Tauris, 2007, pg 7.
326. Richard Thomas, Roger East, Alan John Day, Political and Economic
Dictionary of Eastern Europe, Routledge, 2002, pg 41.
327. a Bukhari, Volume No 4, Book No 56, No: 787.
635

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

and till you fight the Turks, who will have small eyes, red faces
and flat noses; and their faces will be like flat shields. And you
will find that the best people are those who hate responsibility
of ruling most of all, till they are chosen to be the rulers. And
the people are of different natures: the best in the pre-Islamic
period are the best in Islam. A time will come when any of
you will love to see me rather than to have his family and
property doubled.328
The above two adth have the common word faces like shields,
and it is also told that these will be Mongol-Turkic people. So the first
adth means that the Turks of Khurasan will be the followers of the
Dajjal
Further discussion is can found in Book No.4 in this
collection i.e. Army of Dajjal, Part-2.

328. Al-Tirmidhi, adth 5487.


636

Chapter 3

Third Sign

They will be from Banu Israel, also called Banu Isaac.


Imam Mahdis X army will consist in it is majority of Banu Isaac or
Banu Israel. (Only they will fight the final war with the Christians, i.e.:
The Armageddon).
Proof from the Holy Quran.






014:004

( )

4-14
We sent not a messenger except (to teach) in the language of his
(own) people, in order to make (things) clear to them. (14:4)
This tells us two things:
1. A Prophet comes amongst his own nation around him.
637

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

2. A Prophet speaks their language.


For example our Dear Prophet Muammad U is Arab, and he
came amongst the Arabs, and speaks Arabic. This is the same for all
Prophets before.
Similarly when the Banu Israeli Prophet Sayyidna Eisa X will
come, in the beginning his own nation will be around him, i.e.: the
Muslim Banu Israel.
Important Note: Prophet Eisa X will follow Islam, and will
not bring a new religion. Therefore he will not come among
the non-Muslim Banu Israel, i.e.: the Jews.
The Quran tells us that the guided Banu Israel will win a war.














.
061:014

!

( ) ()



061:014 .

638

Chapter 3 of Book V

O ye who believe! Be ye helpers of Allah: As said Jesus (AS) the


son of Mary to the Disciples, Who will be my helpers to (do the
work of) Allah? Said the disciples, We are Allahs helpers!
then a portion of the Children of Israel believed, and a portion
disbelieved: But We gave power to those who believed, against
their enemies, and they became the ones that prevailed. (61-14)
Has anybody heard about a war won by the guided Muslim Banu
Israel, who supported Prophet Eisa X against the non-believer Jews?
No. This is because the war will start when Prophet Eisa X will join
Muslim Banu Israel and then defeat the Jews. This ayat predicts the
defeat of the Jews.
Note: Muslim Banu Israel, living in the east or Khurasan, will
be the first followers of Prophet Eisa X, and this is the main
reason for their genocide in Pakistan and Afghanistan since
1979, using different names and different reason such as the
so called Taliban, Al-Qaeda, War on Terror, etc., etc.
The mentality of the leadership of the People of the Book is clearly
told in the following verse:
Those to whom We gave the Scripture (Jews and Christians)
recognize him (Muammad U) as they recognize their sons.
But verily, a party of them conceal the truth while they know it.
(2:146)

639

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Promise to the Pious Banu Israel.


Allah , promised Banu Israel, before to become the inheritors of the
Lands of the West and in the east. Once again this promise will be
fulfilled, and the Banu Israel Prophet Eisa/Jesus X will lead Banu Israel
and conquer the world, InshahAllah.











(7:137 )


()


()
7:137
And We made a people, considered weak (and of no account),
inheritors of lands in both east and West lands - whereon We
sent down our blessings. The fair promise of thy Lord was
fulfilled for the Children of Israel, because they had patience
and constancy, and We leveled to the ground the great works
and fine buildings which Pharaoh and his people erected (with
such pride). (7:137)
This is the way of Allah that the oppressed Muslims who will have
patience for Allah, will be made the inheritors of the world. The way of
640

Chapter 3 of Book V

Allah remains same as told in this verse:




(48:23)

48-23
That has been the Way of Allah already with those who passed
away before. And you will not find any change in the Way of
Allah. (48:23)
The adth below further proves that the Children of Israel or also
named Isaac will again rise and get the Khilafa (leadership) on this earth
by the Grace of Allah ,.
Who are Children of Israel?
Prophet Yaqb (Jacob) X was known as Israel. He had 12 sons. His
descendants are called the children of Israel.
Prophet Yaqb (Jacob) X is the only son of Prophet Ishaq (Isaac)
X according to many Quranic verses. [The Quran (02:136), (02:140),
(03:84), (04:163), (06:84), (11:71), (12:06), (19:49), (21:72), (29:27),
(38:45)]. So all children of Israel are also Children of Ishaq (Isaac).
The Quran tells us about the division of Banu Israel in two groups.
The Quran tells us about the two divisions among the progeny of
Prophet Isaac X.





037:113
641

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X



037:113 ( )
We blessed him and Isaac: but of their progeny are (some) that
do right, and (some) that obviously do wrong, to their own
souls. (37:113)
Again the Quran tells us the division of Muslims and nonMuslims amongst the Banu Israel at the time of Prophet Musa X.


007:159

007:159 .
Of the people of Moses X there is a section who guide and do
justice in the light of truth. (7:159)
The same is told again in this verse below, and it also shows that
Banu Israel is scattered all around the world:



007:168



( )
()
007:168 ( )
642

Chapter 3 of Book V

And We cut them up into communities on the earth; some of


them righteous, and some of them otherwise; and We proved
them with good and evil that haply they may return. (7:168)
We again see the same division between Muslims and non-Muslim
Banu Israel at the time of Prophet Eisa X.














.
061:014

!

( ) ()



061:014 .
O ye who believe! Be ye helpers of Allah: As said Jesus X the
son of Mary to the Disciples, Who will be my helpers to (the
work of) Allah? Said the disciples, We are Allahs helpers!
then a portion of the Children of Israel believed, and a portion
disbelieved: But We gave power to those who believed, against
their enemies, and they became the ones that prevailed. (61:14)

643

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Mainly the Banu Isaac ( or Banu Israel) will fight the


Armageddon with the Romans (The West).
The Armageddon with the Christians will only, and only be fought by
the Banu Isaac Muslims, and not the Arab Muslims as it is clear from
the following three adth:




644

Chapter 3 of Book V


Abu Huraira \ reported Allahs Messenger U as saying: The
Last Hour would not come until the Romans would land at
645

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

al-Amaq or in Dabiq. An army consisting of the best


(soldiers) of the people of the earth at that time will come
from a city (to counteract them). When they will arrange
themselves in ranks, the Romans would say: Do not stand
between us and those (Muslims) who took prisoners from
amongst us. Let us fight with them; and the Muslims would
say: Nay, by Allah, we would never get aside from you and
from our brethren that you may fight them. They will then
fight and a third (part) of the army would run away, whom
Allah will never forgive. A third (part of the army), which
would be constituted of excellent martyrs in Allahs eye,
would be killed, and this third who would never be put to trial
would win, and they would be conquerors of Constantinople.
And as they would be busy in distributing the spoils of war
(amongst themselves) after hanging their swords by the olive
trees, the Satan would cry: The Dajjal has taken your place
among your family. They would then come out, but it would
be of no avail. And when they would come to Syria, he would
come out while they would be still preparing themselves for
battle drawing up the ranks. Certainly, the time of prayer shall
come and then Jesus X son of Mary would descend and
would lead them in prayer. When the enemy of Allah would
see him, it would (disappear) just as the salt dissolves itself in
water and if he (Jesus X) were not to confront them at all,
even then it would dissolve completely, but Allah would kill
them by his hand and he would show them their blood on his

646

Chapter 3 of Book V

lance (the lance of Jesus X Christ). 329


Important Note: The word Madina here means a city, and
not particularly Madina Munawwara, because in Arabic the
word for city is madina.
The above adth tells us of the biggest fight with the Christians or
the Armageddon.
We see these points in this adth:
1. 1/3rd of the Muslims will survive this Armageddon.
2. The surviving 1/3rd of Muslims will conquer Constantinople.
Now, which Muslims are left to conquer Constantinople after the
Armageddon (with the West)?
The following adth will clear this question as it clearly tells us that
these Muslims are from the BANU ISAAC only.









329. a Muslim, Kitab al-Fitan, adth 2897.
647

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

-- -





!










)





648

Chapter 3 of Book V





)
()

Abu Huraira \ reported Allahs Apostle U saying: You have
heard about a city the one side of which is in the land, and the
other is in the sea (Constantinople). They said: Allahs
Messenger, yes. There upon he said: The Last Hour would
not come unless seventy thousand persons from Banu lsaac
(Children of Prophet Isaac X)

330

would attack it. When

they would land there, they will neither fight with weapons
nor would shower arrows, but they would only say: There is
no god but Allah and Allah is the Greatest, that one side of it
would fall. Thaur (one of the narrators) said: I think that he
said: The part by the side of the ocean. Then they would
say for the second time: There is no god but Allah and Allah
is the Greatest, that the second side would also fall, and they
330. Some consider the Romans as the Children of Prophet Abraham X from
his son Prophet Isaac X just as the Arabs who are Children of Prophet
Abraham X from his son Prophet Ismael. Butthis is wrong as the adth tells
us that the Arabs come from a son of Prophet Noah X called Saam, and the
Romans are from his other son called Yaafith. We should know that Prophet
Noah X is the forefather of Prophet Ibrahim X.
649

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

would say: There is no god but Allah and Allah is the


Greatest, that the gates would be opened for them and they
would enter therein, and they would be collecting the spoils
of war and distributing themamongst themselves that a noise
would be heard and it would be said: Verily, the Dajjal has
come, and thus they would leave everything there and would
turn to him.331
There is a misconception that Banu Ishaq means the Romans,
which is totally proved wrong as discussed in detail in the book
Misconceptions about the End times which is included in this
collection. Briefly the adth that proves this concept wrong are written
below note.332
331. a Muslim, Kitab al-Fitan, adth 2920.
332. Before reading these adth, remember that Prophet Ibrahim X has two
sons i.e. Prophet Ismail X and Prophet Isaac X. Also Prophet Ibrahim X
ancestor is one of the 3 sons of Prophet Nh X whose name is Saam.


.


: :
1179
Sayyidina Samurah \ reported from the Prophet that he said:
Saam was the father of the Arab, Haam the father of the Ethiopians
and Yaafith of the Romans. (Jamia Tirmidhi, Vol. 2, adth 1179.)
650

Chapter 3 of Book V

We come back to our previous discussion now.


We found proof that Banu Isaac will fight against the
Christians in the Armageddon, and 1/3rd of them will


: .


329 : :
Sayyidina Samurah \ reported from the Prophet U that he said,
Saam was the father of the Arab, Yafith the father of the Romans
and Haam the father of the Ethiopians. And the narrater called
Rooh said in the city of Baghdad that Prophet Noah has 3 sons,
namely, Saam, Haam and Yafith. (Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 9,
adth 329.)
Also at many places, Holy Quran only mentions one son of Prophet
Ishaq e.g.
021:072




() () ( )
021:072
And We bestowed upon him Ishque (Isaac), and (a grandson) Yaqb
(Jacob). Each one We made righteous. (21:72)
The above references prove that Romans have a different ancestor
than Prophet Ibrahim X and that proves son of Prophet Ibrahim
X i.e. Prophet Isaac X is not their ancestor. Further discussion
about the single son of Prophet Ishaaq X can be found on page ?.
651

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

survive to conquer Constantinople.


Now we have two more points by reading the above adth:
1. After conquering Constantinople these 1/3rd Muslims will hear
a cry of the coming out of the Dajjal.
2. Then, these 1/3rd Muslims will start preparing for prayers
(Salat) before the war when Prophet Eisa (Jesus) X will come.
Now when they Army of Mahdi will be waiting for the Prayers (Salat)
what will be the situation of the Arabs?
This is told in the following adth. When these two events will be over,
then a small number of Arabs will join these forces as told in this adth:

:
.
.
.((
)) ! :
. . .
....
The adth continues.
Sunan Ibn-e-Majah, Kitab al-Fitan, adth 4077.

) .
. (

652

Chapter 3 of Book V


( )
!

( )


.

Narrated by Hazrat Umama \, a long adth from our Dear
Prophet Muammad U where Umm Sharik \ said: Where
would be the Arabs then in that day? (Meaning why the
Arabs will not come forward and fight for Islam). He U said:
They would be small in number? and from those remaining
Arabs, most of them will be in Bait-ul-Muqaddas (Sham) and
their leader will be a pious man (Imam Mahdi X). When
their leader will move forward to lead the morning prayers,
then, Prophet Eisa X will descend from the sky. The leader
will step back so that Prophet Eisa X will lead the prayers but
Prophet Eisa X will put his hand on his back between his
shoulders and say: Move forward and lead the prayers
because the Iqamah was called for you. Then the Imam will

653

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

lead the prayers for all people.333


This adth (along with the above two adth) clearly tells us that
Arabs will join only when Banu Isaac Muslims will be preparing for war
and at the time of Salat, when Prophet Eisa X will come.
Two points are cleared here that;
1. The majority of the Arabs will not take part in the war with the
Christians, and
2. The majority of the Arabs will not participate in the conquest
of Constantinople.
The Arabs will come (in a very small number) when Banu Isaac
Muslims will be preparing for Prayers (Salat) after the conquest of
Constantinople, but before war against the Dajjal, and when Prophet
Jesus \ arrives.
Please be clear that these two adth tells us that:
1. The time of waiting for Salat (prayers), and the coming
of Prophet Jesus/Eisa X is after the Armageddon with
the Christians, and
2. After the conquest of Constantinople.
Also the following adth again clearly tells us that non-Arabs of the
east will fight the Great Wars of the End of Times:

333. Sunan Ibn-e-Majah, Kitab al-Fitan, adth 4077.


654

Chapter 3 of Book V

: : .
:

! : .
.





: --

Sharik \ reported: I heard Allahs Messenger U as saying:


The people would run away from the Dajjal seeking shelter
in the mountains. She said: Where would be the Arabs then
in that day? He said: They would be very few.334
And also it is clearly told about the Great Wars of the End of Times
that non Arabs from the east will make these lucky armies.

. .
:
)):
334. a Muslim, Book adth 2896, page 1904, Volume 3.
655

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

.((






Narrated Hazrat Abu Huraira \: When great wars will
occur, then Allah , will rise an Army from the non-Arabs
who will be greater riders, and will have better weapons than
the Arabs. Allah , will support His Deen (Islam) by them.335
Banu Israeli Muslims in Mahdis Army, and the Mahdi living among
Banu Israel.
Please check this fact from the following adth:


( )
:




:

:







:

:

335. Sunan Ibn Majah, adth 971, page 778, Volume 3.


656

Chapter 3 of Book V









187 .7367 : .






( )


187 .7367 : .
Narrated Hazrat Umama \ who reported that Rasulullah U
said: You and the Romans (Christians) will have four peace
treaties. The fourth peace treaty would be at the hands of a
person who would be from the Al-e-Harqul (family of Roman
Kind Harqul). This peace treaty would be for seven years.
Rasulullah U was asked who would be the Imam of the
Muslims at that time. Rasulullah U said: That person would
be from my family, his age would be 40 years, his face would
be bright as a start and a black spot would be on his right
cheek. He would be wearing two Qutwani Shawls. He will
appear exactly as the person from Banu Israel. He will rule
657

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

for 20 years and will conquer the cities of the Mushrikeen


(Idolaters). 336
We have two results from the above adth:
1. Imam Mahdi X will be living among Banu Israel.
2. Imam Mahdi X is wearing the clothes of Banu Israel.
Can Banu Isaac referred to in the above adth point
towards the non-Muslims?
This is not possible, as the Quran has told us that misguided persons
are not be related to the Prophets of Allah X, as we can see in the
following verse where the misguided son of Prophet Noah X is
considered to be outside of the family of Prophet Noah X.


r7
r7

.11-46-

q7

()

()
()
11-46)
(Allah) said: O Noah, in fact, he (Noahs son) is not a part of
your family. Indeed, he is (a man of) bad deeds. So do not ask
Me something of which you have no knowledge. I exhort you

336. Tabrani (Majam-al-kabeer), Book 187, adth number 7367.


658

Chapter 3 of Book V

not to be among the ignorant. (11:46)


Important Notes:
The detailed proof about the Israeli origin of Pathans can
be found in BOOK 1, The Lost Tribes of Israel, Imam
Mahdi X, and Prophet Jesus X.
We have explained before how we oppose the idea proposed
by some scholars, that the Romans are the Children of
Ibrahim X through his son Isaac X. Please read BOOK 2,
Misconceptions about Imam Mahdi X and Prophet Jesus
X, A Quran and adth View, which is included in this
collection

659

Chapter 4

Fourth Sign

They will be from the Tribe of Kash or Kish or Qais.


This sign furthers strengthens the point that followers of Prophet Eisa
X will be from Banu Israel. As we shall see the tribe of Qais is the
forefather of almost all Pathans (Muslim Banu Israel).
The Attack of Sufyani on the tribe of Qais.
The following authentic adth tells us about the fight of the Qais tribe
with a Sufyani (from the Arab tribe of Quraish), who is an enemy of
Imam Mahdi X.

:8687
( )






:

:





:

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X









.



Narrated by Hazrat Abu Huraira \: Our Dear Prophet U said:
That a person called Sufyani will appear from the suburbs of
Damascus, and his general followers will be the people of the
Kulaib Tribe (a branch of Arab Banu Tamim tribe). He will
attack (so fiercely) that he will cut the bellies of women and
kill children. To fight against him, the people of the tribe of
Qais will gather. Sufyani will fight them and kill them so much
that no valley will be left without their dead bodies.337
The Punishment of Banu Kulaib (Branch of Banu Tamim Tribe).






)
(

337. Hakim Al-Mustadrak, Volume 4, page 520; Kitab al Fitan, adth 8586.
662

Chapter 4 of Book V

( )
( )
)
( 8329
Narrated by Abu Huraira \ that: Our Dear Prophet
Muammad U said that: Disappointed will be the one who
does not receive the booty of Kalb even if it a single Aqal (a
small unit). I swear by the Name of the One who holds my
life, no doubt the women of Kulaib will be sold (as slaves) in
the way to Damascus until one of the women will be returned
back because of broken ankle.338
Banu Kulaib are Banu Tamim.
Banu Kulaib are direct descendants of Banu Tamim as we can see in the
family background of Ibn Jarir (one of the greatest and most celebrated
Muslim poets). It is stated:
Abu Hazra Jarir Ibn Atiya ibn Khudaifa (surnamed AlKhatafa) Ibn Badr Ibn Salama Ibn Auf Ibn Kulaib Ibn
Yarbu Ibn Hanzala Ibn Malik Ibn Zaid Manat Ibn Tamim
Ibn Murr at-Tamimi (descended from Tamim). 339

338. Mustadrak Hakim, Chapter of Fitan wa Malahim, adth 8329.


339. Ibn Khallikan's Biographical Dictionary, by Ibn Khallikan, page 294.
663

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

The Arabs are made Slaves by Muslims.


Previously in a adth, it has been told that Arabs are not to be made as
slaves, but in the above authentic adth, permission is given to
Muslims to make slaves of the Arabs. This permission is given in the
End of Times.
Where is the tribe of Kash or Kish or Qais?
Qais Abdur Rashid Khan (575-661 C.E.) Also known as Kash. Qais is
a legendary ancestor of the Pashtun race. It is said that he travelled to
Makkah and Medina in Arabia during the early days of Islam. (He is
believed to be the 37th descendent of King Saul (or Malik Talut in the
Quran).
The children of Israel, in Ghore (a place in Afghanistan), preserved
their knowledge of the unity of God and the purity of their religious
belief, and on the appearance of the last and greatest of the Prophets
(Muammad U) the Afghans of Ghore listened to the invitation of their
Arabian brethren, the chief of whom was Khalid (or Caled), son of
Waleed, so famous for his conquest of Syria, and marched to the aid of
the true faith, under the command of Qais, afterwards surnamed Abdul
Rasheed. His name is actually KASH or KISH but the Arabs
pronounced it QAIS.340
QAIS or KASH is actually the name of numerous personalities of
the Children of Israel according to the chapter of Chronicles in the
Bible, such as the following examples:

340 Makhzan-e-Afghan.
664

Chapter 4 of Book V

Jeiel the father of Gibeon lived in Gibeon, and the name of


his wife was Maacah. (Chronicles 30) His firstborn son:
Abdon, then Zur, Kish, Baal, Nadab. (Chronicles 29)
Gedor, Ahio, Zecher, (Chronicles 32) and Mikloth, who
became the father of Shimeah. (Chronicles 33) Ner became
the father of Kish, Kish of Saul, Saul of Jonathan, Malchishua,
Abinadab, and Esh-baal. (Chronicles 12)
The following are those who came to David at Ziklag, while
he could not move about freely because of Saul son of Kish;
they were among the mighty warriors who helped him in
war. (Chronicles)
KASH ABDUR RASHEED had his name from his Banu Israeli
forefathers. The following figure shows the genealogy of majority of the
Pathans.

665

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Figure: Pashtun Tribes Genealogy341


In Pakistan and Afghanistan we find many places where the
Pashtuns live and by the name of KISH/KASH such as:

DASHT-E-KASH (a desert in southern Afghanistan).

The city of Kish Khenjak in Afghanistan located at Velayat-e


Oruzgan.

The Solomon mountain range is also know by Pashtuns as the


KASH GHAR. (The Mountain of KASH or QAIS).

The HINDU KASH mountain range.

The KASH GHAR in China is also named after KASH since he


was the King of this area and a famous personality.

There are several other cities by his name which can be seen in
the detailed list of Biblical Israeli names in the next chapter,

341. The Pathans 55O B.C.-A.D. 1957, by Sir Olaf Caroe. Also Wikipedia.com.
666

Chapter 4 of Book V

InshahAllah.
Same meanings of Banu Israel and Tribe of Kash
Kash has Israeli origin. So we see that this sign (The Tribe of Kash) in
the adth confirms what the Quran tells us, that a Prophet always
comes among his own people and speaks the language (culture) of his
people.






014:004

( )

014:004
We sent not a messenger except (to teach) in the language of his
(own) people, in order to make (things) clear to them. Now
Allah leaves straying those whom He pleases and guides whom
He pleases: and He is Exalted in power, full of Wisdom (14:04)
So the Banu Israeli Prophet Eisa X will first come among his own
Muslim Israeli brothers insha Allah.
This is the main reason for the genocide of Pathans by the People
of the Book and their slave countries.
Important Note: Is the Above Tribe of Qais an Arab Tribe?
This is not possible since, the adth we have read before
already told us that the Arabs who will fight the Dajjal will be
667

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

few.
Also since we have the adth telling us that the supporters of
Imam Mahdi X will come from Khurasan, then the tribe of
Qais cannot point towards the Arabs.

668

Chapter 5

Fifth Sign

They will be wearing Qutwani Shawls.


This sign furthers strengthens the point that the followers of Prophet
Eisa X will be from Banu Israel. As we shall see Imam Mahdi X will
wear the clothes of the Banu Israeli Prophets, i.e.: the Qutwani shawls.
adth telling us that the Qutwani cloak are a dress of Imam
Mahdi X:


( )
:




:

:





:
:








.
187 .7367 : .

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X







( )



187 .7367 : .
Narrated Hazrat Umama \ reported that Rasulullah U said:
You and the Romans (Christians) will have four peace
treaties. The fourth peace would be at the hand of a person
who would be from the Al-e-Harqul (familyof Roman King
Harqul). This peace treaty would be for seven years.
Rasulullah U was asked who would be the Imam of the
Muslims at that time. Rasulullah U said: That person would
be from my family, his age would be 40 years, his face would
be bright as a start and a black spot would be on his right
cheek. He would be wearing two Qutwani shawls. He will
appear exactly as the person from Banu Israel. He will rule
for 20 years and will conquer the cities of the Mushrikeen

670

Chapter 5 of Book V

(Idolaters). 342
And also we have the following adth:









194-195




)
(


342. Tabrani, Majam-al-Kabeer, Book 187, adth number 7367.


671

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





)
(


194-195
The appearance of Imam Mahdi X (according to the adth) is
that he has deep wheatish complexion, light stature, medium height,
beautiful broad forehead, long straight nose, eyes brows that are round
like a bow, big natural black eyes, very white front two teeth, and with a
spacing between the teeth, a black mole mark on the right cheek, face
glowing like a shining star, a mark on the shoulder like that of our Dear
Prophet Muammad U, complexion like the Arabs, and body like the
Children of Israel, slight stutter in the tongue due to which he
sometimes hits his right hand on left thigh because of annoyance, will
appear at the age of 40, while praying to Allah , he will expand his
hands for prayers like vulture expanding their wings, will be wearing
QUTWANI SHAWLS (the clothes of Children of Israel), will resemble in
character our Dear Prophet Muammad U, but in appearance he will
be different from our Dear Prophet Muammad U, (Also because he
will wearing clothes like the Children of Israel i.e.: the QUTWANI

672

Chapter 5 of Book V

SHAWLS). 343
The Qutwani shawl is the dress of the Israeli Prophets.
This adth tells us that the Qutwani cloak as dress of Israeli Prophet
Sayyidna Musa X.

( )

:

:


:

:

:



,















13500 : .
We went with our Dear Prophet Muammad U in a Ghazwa.
They conquered a place called Al Abwa (a village in the
343. Al-Asha by Muhammad Burzanji, page 194-195, also at page 79, Islam mai
Imam Mehdi ka Tasawor by Maulana Prof. Muhammad Yusuf Khan, can be
found at http://www.khatm-e-nubuwwat.com.pk/kn/books.html.
673

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

western coast of the Arabian Peninsula). Then they reached


Al Rauha. There they passed by a placeArqAzabia. There they prayed Salah. After that our Dear Prophet
Muammad U said: Do you know what the name of this
mountain is? We said: Allah subahanahu and his Messenger
U know. Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: This is a
mountain from the mountains of Paradise. May Allah put
Barakah (blessings) in it, and among those who live here.
And then he said about the place Al Rauhathat: This
place is one of the valleys of Paradise. Here in this mosque
(pointing to the sameArq-Azabia place in Al Rawha

) seventy Prophets prayed, and Prophet Musa (AS)


passed by here wearing two Qutwaani Shawls over him,
(riding) on his camel with seventy thousand people from
Banu Israel going for Hajj (pilgrimage) to the Ancient
House (i.e.: Kaba). And the time (of Qiyamah) will not come
until (Prophet) Isa bin Maryam, Abd of Allah (Abdullah), and
Messenger of Allah U, will come for Hajj or Umrah, or Allah
will make him able to do both (Hajj and Umrah) together for
him344.
Note: The valley of Al Rawha is a place between
Makkah and Madinah.

344. Al-Majam-Al-Kabeer, Tabrani, adth 13500.


674

Chapter 5 of Book V

adth telling us that the Qutwani cloak is a dress of the Israeli


Prophet Sayyidna Isa (Jesus) X.





( )
:





:







:


:
187 23 : .




Narrated by Qatada \: Our Dear Prophet Muammad U
came at a place between Makkah and Madinah and said: No
doubt (Prophet) Musa X came to this valley and he was
saying this Talbeeh (remembrance of Allah Subhana hu
during pilgrimage):

.





And (Prophet) Yunus bin Matta was seen riding a red camel
and a cloak is placed over him and he is saying (this Talbeeh):





And (Prophet) Isa X is seen riding a red she camel and one
Qutwani Shawl is over him, and he is saying (this Talbeeh):







675

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

(Authentic adth). 345


adth telling us that the Qutwani cloak is as dress of Israeli Prophet
Sayyidna Musa (Moses) X.

,
( )
, , ,
, ,

: ,
,

--12353 :
.

Narrated by Ibn Abbas \: Our Dear Prophet Muammad U
said: (Prophet) Musa X went for Hajj riding a red bull and
having Qutwani garment over him.346
http://library.islamweb.net/adth/

( )







:

:








-12123- : .
.

345. adth 23, Al Manasik by Saeed bin Abi Arooba.


346. adth 12353, Al-Majam-Al-Kabeer, Tabaraani.
676

Chapter 5 of Book V

Seventy Prophets prayed in Masjid al-Khayf, including Musa


X. It is as if I can see him, wearing two Qutwani garments,
in ihram, riding one of the camels of Shanuah with a bridle
of twisted palm fiber.347
How are the Qutwani shawls of the Israeli Prophets?
Qutwani shawls resemble the TALLIT of present day, as
called by the Jews. Both Qutwani cloak and the TALLIT have
fringes (tzitzit) on the borders, and it is mostly made of Wool.
It generally falls across the head, neck, and shoulders.
However the Qutwani cloak is larger and a more conspicuous
prayer shawl than the Tallit.348
Now the Qutwani cloak has following features:

They are made of wool (as many scholars described it).

They are wrapped around the body (as the above adth about
Mahdi X also mentions).

It has fringes on it is borders.

It is a warm dress for cold weather.

The Qutwani cloak is exactly like the shawls worn by the Pashtun
people of Afghanistan and Pakistan, and it is also worn in the same way
that the Qutwani cloak described in the adth and it is explanation.
In fact these shawls are often the necessary part of the Pashtun
347. At-Tabaraani, narrated in al-Mujam al-Kabeer, 12283.
348. Encyclopedia Britannica, 1997.
677

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

dress. In contrast to the present day Jews who wear the so called Tzitzit
as a symbol, and which are much smaller to be wrapped around the
body. In fact it has just become something of a show off by Jews, and
not an essential part of dress.

Figure: Qutwani cloak of the Pathans.

678

Chapter 5 of Book V

Figure: Arabs do not wear woolen Qutwani shawls.


The Arabs do not wrap up the shawls around them like the
Pashtuns, and also their shawls never have fringes, and are not made of
wool because it is not so cold in Middle East.
The above mentioned adth telling us that Imam Mahdi X
would be from the family of our Dear Prophet U but would not look
like our Dear Prophet U in appearance, clearly tells us that Imam Mahdi
X will not be living among the Arabs. His appearance described as
679

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

wearing Qutwani shawls and looking like a person from Banu Israel
shows that he must have been living among the Pathans for a long time
and therefore Imam Mahdi X would be dressed also like the Pathans.
Another adth confirming the non-Arab appearance of Imam
Mahdi X:

:
:
:

:




:


..








897 : :
Hazrat Ali \ said while looking at his son, Hazrat Hassan:
This son of mine will be a chief. He was named by Allahs
Prophet Muammad U. Soon a person will be born from his
680

Chapter 5 of Book V

descendants whose name will be like Allahs Prophet (i.e.:


Muammad U), and his ikhlaq (manners, character) will
resemble Allahs Prophet (i.e.: Muammad U), but his
appearance (physical appearance and clothing) will not be
like Allahs Prophet (Muammad U).349

349. Sunan Abu Dawud, Vol. 2, adth 897.


681

Chapter 6

Sixth Sign

Extreme suffering and sacrifice.


According to the adth the Martyrs in the Army of Sayyidna Eisa X
and Imam Mahdi X will have the virtue equal to ten times that of the
Martyrs of the Battle of Badar. (Please note that this does not mean
them to be greater than the great companions of our Dear Prophet
Muammad U). Also the adth clearly tells us that these people will be
amongst the best of the Ummah of Islam.
This high level can never be achieved unless under certain
conditions. The basic condition to reach to this high level is explained
in the following verse of the Quran which tells us that:

002:214
()
()
( ) ( )

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

()
002:214 ( )
Or do you think that you will enter Paradise while such [trial]
has not yet come to you as came to those who passed on before
you? They were touched by poverty and hardship and were
shaken until [even their] Messenger and those who believed
with him said: When is the help of Allah? Unquestionably,
the help of Allah is near. (2:214)






(03:142) .
Did ye think that ye would enter Heaven without Allah testing
those of you who fought hard (in His cause) and remained
steadfast? (03:142)




(03:142)



(09:16)


( )
( )

( )

684

Chapter 6 of Book V

(09:16)
Do you think that you shall be left alone while Allah has not
yet tested those among you who have striven hard and fought
and have not taken Waljah [(Batanahhelpers, advisors and
consultants from disbelievers, pagans) giving openly to them
their secrets] besides Allah and His Messenger, and the
believers. Allah is Well-Acquainted with what you do. (09:16)
Yes, indeed, without:
1. Extreme hardships and torture for the sake of Allah ,, and
2. Great afflictions while remaining steadfast, and
3. While being expelled from the homes for the sake of Islam
(being refugee for Islam).
These high levels can never be achieved.
Also if we see the following verse, it is clearly told, that the criteria
for Khilafa of Islam in this world is extreme hardship and patience for
the sake of Allah:



028:005


( )
028:005
And We wished to do a favor to those who were weak (and
685

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

oppressed) in the land, and to make them rulers and to make


them the inheritors, (28:5)
The worldwide media hides the truth.
Today, we can see most of the Pashtun population has been expelled
from their homes since 1979, both in Pakistan and Afghanistan, using
different fake reasons of the so called Jihad, Taliban, Al Qaeda, War on
Terror. There is no Al-Qaeda, no Taliban, no terrorists, or no racists.
All these are just self-made illusions to eliminate the Pathans, and also
to hide their real intentions behind it.
The media always hides the suffering and genocide of the Pashtun
people, to hide the truth, and to hide the real target, just as the following
verse of the Quran tells us:






002:146
)
(

002:146
Those to whom We gave the Scripture (Jews and Christians)
recognize him (Muammad U) as they recognize their sons.
But verily, a party of them conceals the truth while they know
it. (2:146)

B
686

Chapter 7

Seventh Sign

They will be refugees or immigrants (Ghuraba).


Expulsion from homes or homeland is a great sacrifice. Those Muslims
who remain patient, on this great sacrifice, are greatly rewarded as told
in the Quran:








003:195




()
003:195
So those who emigrated or were evicted from their homes or
were harmed in My cause or fought or were killed - I will surely
remove from them their evil deeds, and I will surely admit them
to gardens beneath which rivers flow as reward from Allah, and

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Allah has with Him the best reward. (3:195)


The homeless refugees will join Prophet Eisa X.
We can see that in the adth it is told that people who will be expelled
from their homes or homeland will join the army of Prophet Eisa Xin
the End of Times.

, ( ) )










:
,

:
:

,

, :

.
214 :
.
:




214 : .
.
Narrated from Hazrat Abdullah bin Umar \, he said that
Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said that: The most dear
to Allah , are the Ghuraba. When asked who are the
Ghuraba, our Dear Prophet U said: The Ghuraba are
688

Chapter 7 of Book V

those who have escaped with their Deen (Islam) (i.e.:


refugees). Allah will join them with Sayyidna Eisa Bin Mariam
(Jesus) X on the Judgement Day.350
Important adth about the immigrants in Makkah.
Imam Mahdi X will be joined by the poor immigrants in Makkah, who
will be foreigners in this area. This is told in the following adth, and
the word Ghuraba (immigrant) is used for them. It is also told that
they will be immigrating to Makkah.

: ,
( )








:
,


:




:
:
,

:

,

:


:

:

350. Bayhaqi, Az-Zuhad Alkaber, adth 214.


689

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


.


187 .2370 :

187 ...


Narrated by Ibn Masood \: Our Dear Prophet Muammad
U said: Allah Subhana hu will send from this area and from
this Haram (Masjid Al Haram or Makkah) seventy thousand
people who will enter Jannah without Hisab. Each one can do
Shifaa for seventy thousand people. Their faces would
appear like the full moon (of 14th night) at night among all the
first and the last of the people. Abu Bakr \ asked: Who will
be among those people? Our Dear Prophet Muammad U
said: (They will be) from the Ghuraba (poor foreign
immigrants or foreign refugees). Abu Bakr \ asked: What
about those who die in the Haram of Allah (i.e.: Masjid-AlHaram or Makkah)? Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said:
Those who died in the Haram of Allah for Allahs sake,
they will rise in peace on the Qiyamah Day (Judgement).
Abu Bakr \ asked: What about those who die in this Haram

(Mosque of Prophet in Madinah)? Our Dear Prophet


Muammad U said: Those who died in Madinah for Allahs
sake, they will rise in peace on the Qiyamah Day
(Judgement). Abu Bakr \ asked: What about those who
died between the two Haramain (Makkah and
Madinah)? Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: Those
who died between Makkah or Madinah doing Hajj or
Umrah or seeking (or struggling) for obedience in the path
690

Chapter 7 of Book V

of Allah Az wa Jal, they will rise in peace on the Qiyamah Day


(Judgement).351

.




.





!

1518 : :
Prophet Muammad U said: Islam began as something
strange, and it shall return to being something strange, so at
the time when there will be widespread fasaad (anarchy,
oppression, and evil) give glad tidings to the strangers. I swear
by the One who hold the life of Abul Qasim (title of our Dear
351. adth,2370, Akhbar Makkah Fakihi, Baab Jamiah min Akhbar Makkah
fil Islam.
691

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Prophet U), that Faith will gather back between these two
mosques (Masjid-al-Haram and Masjid Nawawi) like a
serpent enters back to it is hole.352
The refugees will be leaders of Islam in the End of Times.




352 Masnad Ahmad, Vol 1, adth 1518.
692

Chapter 7 of Book V



, 2927 : : .
Abdullah b. Amr b. al-As \ reported that Allahs Messenger
U said: How would you be, Oh people when Persia and Rome
would be conquered for you? Abd Al-Rahman b. Auf \ said:
We would say as Allah , has commanded us and we would
express our gratitude to Allah ,. Thereupon Allahs
Messenger U said: Nothing else besides it? You would (in
fact) vie with one another, then you would feel jealous, then
your relations would be estranged, and then you will bear
enmity against one another, or something to the same effect.
Then you would go to the poor emigrants and would make
some the masters of the others. 353

353. a Muslim, Vol. 3, adth 2927.


693

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


( )





:
876 :
It was narrated from Abdullah bin Amr bin As \ that the
Messenger of Allah U said: When the treasures of Persia and
Rome are opened for you, what kind of people will you be?
Abdur-Rahman bin Awf said: We will say what Allah has
commanded us to say. The Messenger of Allah U said: Or
something other than that. You will complete with one
another, then you will envy one another, then you will turn
your backs on one another, then you will hate one another, or
something like that. Then you will go to the poor among the
Muhajirin (Muslim refugees) and appoint some of them as
leaders of others.354

354. Sunan Ibn Majah, Vol. 3, adth 876.


694

Chapter 7 of Book V

The Ghuraba (aliens or immigrants) of the End of Times means the


refugees or the Muslims who leave their homes to save their faith.





.





1856 : :
Narrated by Abdullah bin Masood \ that our Dear Prophet
Muammad U said that: Islam started as an alien (stranger),
and soon it will go back to the same state (the same way) it
started. So, good news is for the Ghuraba (alien refugees).
Someone asked which people are the Ghuraba? Our Dear
Prophet U replied that: Those who have been expelled from
their tribes. 355

355. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 2, adth 1846.


695

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Imam al-Harawi (may Allah have mercy on him) states the same
explanation:


Translation: It refers to those migrants who leave their
hometowns for the sake of Allah Taala. 356
The following adth tells us two characteristics of Ghuraba:
1. They will be extremely poor.
2. They will be refugees or immigrants.
They will not be Arabs, as our Dear Prophet U tells this to the first
Khalifa, Abu Bakr \ in this adth:

356. Fath al-Mulhim bi Sharh, a al-Imam Muslim, 1:115; a Muslim bi
Sharh an-Nawawi, 1: 455.
696

Chapter 7 of Book V



!



!


:
2560 :
Narrated by Hazrat Abdullah ibn Umar \: One day I was
sitting with Allahs Prophet U. At that time the sun was rising.
Our Dear Prophet U said that: Allah will bring some people
from a nation who will have Noor (sacred light) like the
sun. Hazrat Abu Bakr \ asked, O Prophet of Allah U, will
those be us?
Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: No, (they will not be
you), but you have Kahir-e-Katheer (abundant goodness).
(In fact) those people will be very poor people (like beggars),
and the immigrants (refugees) who will be gathered together
from (different) corners of the world. Then our Dear
Prophet Muammad U said: Glad tidings (or good news) for
the Ghuraba (the immigrants or the poor). Someone again
697

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

asked: Who are the Ghuraba? Our Dear Prophet (SAWS)


replied: A very few good (or pious) people among a large
number of bad (or sinful) people, whom very few will obey
(or listen), and a majority will disobey (or not listen to
them).357
Very important adth telling us about the non-Arab immigrants or
refugees fighting for Islam in the Arab region of Basra city.

( -)(3754 :







:




:

:


:




..


Narrated Abu Bakrah \: The Apostle of Allah U said: Some
of my people will alight on low-lying ground, which they will
call al-Basrah, beside a river called the Dajjal (the Tigris) over
which there is a bridge. It is people will be numerous and it
will be one of the cities of the immigrants. At the End of
Time the descendants of Qantura will come with broad faces
357. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 2560.
698

Chapter 7 of Book V

and small eyes and alight on the bank of the river. The towns
inhabitants will then separate into three sections, one of
which will follow cattle and (live in) the desert and perish,
another of which will seek security for themselves and perish,
but a third will put their children behind their backs and fight
the invaders, and they will be the martyrs.358
The scattered clouds. The meeting place of these refugees/immigrants
will be Hijaz (Makkah and Madinah), and they will join Imam
Mahdi X like scattered clouds from different places.












; Abul-Tufail \ narrates from Muammad Bin Al-Hanfia that
358. Sunan Abu Dawud, adth 903.
699

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Muammad Bin Al-Hanfia \ said that he was sitting in the


meeting of Ali Ibn Talib \ (companion of our Dear Prophet
Muammad U, and 4thKhalifa), then one person asked Ali Ibn
Talib \ about Imam Mahdi X. Ali ibn Talib \ said: Go
away (in a fun way as this was normal in speech to show
happiness), and then pointed with his hand and said: Mahdi
X will appear in the End of Times. (In those times) people
who say the name of Allah , will be killed. Allah subhanahau
wa ta ala will gather together a nation (it is important that the
word is used here which means a nation) to join him
(Imam Mahdi X) just like scattered clouds join together, and
Allah , will create attraction (and love) among them. They
will neither have fear of someone, nor will they get happy to
see someone. (It can also mean that their hearts will be so sad
because of great sacrifice that they will not feel happiness or
sorrows or fear anymore). These people who will gather
together will have number like the number of the Battle of
Badar (i.e.: 313). This group will have such a high level which
has neither been achieved by any group before them, nor after
them. Also this group will have the number like those
companions of Taloot (King Saul) who crossed the river AnNahar with him. After narrating these words of Sayyidna
Ali ibn Talib \, Muammad bin Al-Hanfia asked the
gathering: Do you wish to join this group (of 313)? I (AbulTufail) said: Yes. Then Muammad bin Al-Hanfia \
pointed towards two pillars of the Kaba and said: Mahdi X
will will appear between these pillars. Then Abul-Tufail said:
I swear by the name of Allah Subhana hu that I will never
700

Chapter 7 of Book V

separate myself from these pillars all my life. The narrator


says that, Abul-Tufail died in Makkah (and fulfilled his
words).
Abu Abdullah Hakim says that this adth is a
(Authentic) according to the conditions of a Muslim and
Bukhari and Ad-Dhabi. 359
This is the reason why, the following adth tells us that Islam will
come back to the Hijaz (Makkah and Madinah), and also good news
is given to the refugees and immigrants because they will be the ones
who will bring the revival of Islam to Hijaz.






.




!

359. Mustadrak Hakim, Volume 4, page 554.
701

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


1518 : :
Our Beloved Prophet Muammad U said: Islam began as
stranger and it will return as a stranger as it began. Glad
tidings to the refugees (immigrants or strangers) when evil
will spread among the people. I swear by the One (Allah
Subhana hu) who holds the life of Ab-al-Qasim U in His
power, belief (faith) will return back between these two
mosques (Masjid-al-Haram in Makkah and Masjid-eNawawi in Madinah), as a snake returns back to it is hole
(when in danger).360
One of the important qualities of the Ghuraba (immigrant refugees).
These immigrants (refugees) will be extremely poor.

360. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 1, adth 1518.


702

Chapter 7 of Book V












1672 : :
Narrated by Hazrat Abdullah bin Umar \: I hear our Dear
Prophet Muammad U saying that: My pond (the pond of
Kauthar) is as large as the distance between Adan and
Amman. It is water will be more (pleasantly) cool
than ice, more sweet (tasty) than honey, and will have a more
beautiful smell than musk. It is pots (for drinking water) will
be as numerous as starts. Whoever drinks one sip of it is
water, he/she will never get thirsty again. The first one to
come to my pond (of Kauthar) will the (extremely) poor
immigrants. Someone asked: Ya Rasul Allah U who will be
these immigrants? Our Dear Prophet Muammad U replied
that: These (immigrants) will be the people with scattered
hair, sunken (weak) faces, and shabby clothes for whom no
703

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

one opens their doors, and no one accepts their request to


marry ladies brought up in wealthy environment, and (these
immigrants) will fulfill their responsibilities but will not
demand for their (own) rights (or not ask from others what
they deserve).361
These refugees will preach Islam.





.



!


2147 : :
Narrated by Abdullah bin Umar \ that we were once sitting
in the company of Prophet Muammad U, then our Dear
Prophet U said: Glad tidings to the Ghuraba. Someone
361. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 1672.
704

Chapter 7 of Book V

asked who the Ghuraba are? Our Dear Prophet


Muammad U replied: A few pious people among a large
number of bad people whom are opposed by more (and
accepted by less).362
We do know that today that majority of the Muslim Banu Israel
(i.e.: the Pashtuns) are involved in the world wide movement of
Tablighi Jamat and preaching Islam all over the world.
What is written in the Quran about immigrant refugees?
The Quran has told us about a nation that was, as a whole, up rooted
from it is homeland and became an immigrant nation to the whole
world.
This nation is Banu Israel, as the Quran tells us:




007:168



( )
()
007:168 ( )
We broke them (Banu Israel) up into sections on this earth.
There are among them some that are the righteous, and some
that are the opposite. (7:168)
362. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 2174.
705

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

The above verse also tells us about the two division of Banu Israel,
(i.e.: the Muslim Banu Israel and the non-Muslim Banu Israel (the Jews/
Yahood).
This was in the past when Banu Israel became emigrants/ refugees,
aliens, when they had to leave their homeland and scatter around the
world.
Muslim Banu Israel is the majority of the homeless refugees
(Ghuraba) today.
Today we see that millions of the people of Muslim Banu Israel (i.e.:
Pathans), have been expelled from their homes in Pakistan and
Afghanistan, and are living as refugees in both these countries. Even as
refugees they are constantly tortured and killed using the so called fake
war of terror or other reasons.
But this suffering will end soon, InshahAllah, both in this
world, and the eternal life in the hereafter.
Arabs will be rich in the End of Times, and not poor, and this money
will put them to affliction.

( )
706

Chapter 7 of Book V











Auf bin Malik \ says: I came to Rasulullah U while he was in
his skin tent during the Tabuk expedition. He said to me:
Count six things before the advent of Qiyamah:
1. My death.
2. The conquest of Jerusalem.
3. Mass deaths amongst you people (Arabs), just as when sheep
die in large numbers during an epidemic.
4. Abundance of wealth to such an extent that if a person were to
be given a hundred Dinars he will still not be satisfied.
5. General afflictions (among Arabs), that no Arab household will
be spared from it.
6. Then a life of peace as a result of a peace agreement between
you and the Banu Asfaar (Sons of the Blonde i.e.: Romans as
707

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

they have yellow hair) which they will break and attack you
with a force consisting of eighty flags and under each flag will
be an army of twelve thousand men.363
Important Note: Most of the refugees that will lead the
Muslim Ummah will be from the cities, as these adth give
us a hint.














2306 : :
Narrated Ibn Umar \: One person asked: Ya Rasul-Allah U,

363. a Bukhari.


708

Chapter 7 of Book V

which Hijrah (migration for Allah Aza wajal) is the best?


Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: That in which you
leave (doing) those things which your Rabb (Sustainer) does
not like. And Hijrah (migration for Allah Aza wajal) is of
two kinds. One is the Hijrah (migration for Allah Aza wajal)
of a person living in a village, and the second is the Hijrah
(migration for Allah Aza wajal) of person living in a city. The
Hijrah of a villager is (just) like when he gets an invitation,
he accepts it, and when he is ordered, he obeys (means that a
villager has not so much to loose when he migrates). (On the
other hand), the person living in a city goes under a greater
test (when he migrates), and (therefore) he gets more
virtues.364

364. Musnad Ahmad, Volume 3, adth 2306.


709

Chapter 8

Eight Sign

They will be famous as fierce warriors all over the world.


A mighty and valiant warrior nation will attack and destroy the
Jewish kingom once again.
Please read the following verses carefully. The translation in Urdu
is by Hussain Ahmad Madni and in English from Ifran-al-the Quran.






017:004



017:005

017:006



017:007
017:008


MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

017:004

()
( )
) 017:005
(
( )
()017:006 ( )


( )



017:007( )
) ()
(
017:008
And We categorically conveyed to the Children of Israel in the
Book: You shall make mischief twice in the land and employ a
violent defiance (against obedience to Allah). (17:04)

712

Chapter 8 of Book V

So when the promised first time of the two came to pass We


brought upon you those of our servants who were great
warriors. Then, in (your) search they penetrated up to your
dwellings. And (this) promise was sure to be fulfilled. (17:05)
Then We turned the victory over them to your favor and
helped you with (affluence in) wealth and children and
increased your numerical strength (as well). (17:06)
Whenever you did good, it was to your own advantage; and
whenever you committed evil, it was to your own disadvantage.
So, when the time of the fulfillment of the second prophecy drew
near, (We raised other enemies that would) disfigure your faces
and entered the Temple (of Jerusalem) as they had done the
first time, and destroyed whatever they would lay their hands
on. (17:07)
It may well be that (after this) your Lord will have mercy on
you, but if you revert to the same (rebellious and defiant
behaviour), then We too will get back to the same
(tormenting once again).And We have made Hell a prison for
the disbelievers. (17:08)
Now see these two important verses: Verses 17:5, and 17:8:
So when the promised first time of the two came to pass We
brought upon you those of our servants who were great
warriors. Then, in (your) search they penetrated up to your
dwellings. And (this) promise was sure to be fulfilled. (17:05)
It may well be that (after this) your Lord will have mercy on
you, but if you revert to the same (rebellious and defiant
713

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

behaviour), then We too will get back to the same


(tormenting once again). And We have made Hell a prison for
the disbelievers. (17:08).
Please concentrate on the two main points marked above and
words described in the Verses 17:5 and 17:8 of Srah Banu Israel.




We brought upon you those of our servants who were great
warriors. (17:05)
Allah destroyed the Jews in Al Quds before at the hands of a mighty
warrior nation, and if they disobey again, it is a promise that IT WILL
HAPPEN AGAIN!

.......
( ) ()

But if you revert to the same (rebellious and defiant behaviour),
then We too will get back to the same (tormenting once again)
(17:08).
So we have three important points the verse:
1. If Banu Israel is having control of the Holy Land
(Jerusalem), and
2. They are not on the right path (of Islam),
714

Chapter 8 of Book V

3. Then Allah , will send a mighty warrior nation to destroy


them.
Today, we see the both conditions fulfilled as the Jews (the
misguided Banu Israel) are in control of Jerusalem. So once again a
great warrior nation will come to destroy them.
The warrior nature of the Muslims in Prophet Isas X Army.
The following adth confirms the warrior nature of the Army of Imam
Mahdi X and Prophet Eisa X:



: .

715

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

.395. :
Jabir b. Abdullah U reported: I heard the Messenger of Allah
U say: A section of my people will not cease fighting for the
Truth, and will prevail till the Day of Resurrection. He said:
Jesus son of Mary X would then descend and their
(Muslims) commander and would invite him to come and
lead them in prayer, but he would say: No, some amongst you
are commanders over some (amongst you). This is the honor
from Allah for this Ummah. 365
We are all well aware of the fact that Pathans have always fought
for Islam, and have never been defeated just as the above adth tells us.
This adth also confirms what is told in the above Quranic verses
that a famous warrior nation will destroy the misguided Israelis (the
Jews) in Holy Land.
It doesnt matter whether people support or do not support these
Muslim warriors.







365. a Muslim, Vol. 1, adth 395.
716

Chapter 8 of Book V

.








113 : : .

Sayyidina Thawban \ reported that Allahs Messenger U
said: I fear for the misleading of the rulers over my Ummah
He also said: A section of my Ummah will never cease to be
on the right. They will prevail, and they will not be harmed by
those who desert them till the command of Allah comes.366
I address all those so called Scholars and Leaders, who
have never said a word in the support of the Muslim Banu
Israel, and tell them that their support is not required at all.
They can keep on dreaming.

366 Jamiah Tirmzi,Vol 2, adth 113.


717

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

This time, the fierce warrior nation who will take over the Jewish
kingdom will be from the khurasan.


.





.
Thoban \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet Muammad U)
reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad U) said: When
you see that black flags have appeared from Khurasan, go to
(join) them even if you have to walk over ice on your knees as
the Khalifa of Allah, MAHDI, will be among them.
This adth is a (Most Authentic) according to the
conditions of a Bukhari and a Muslim. 367


: -:
367. Mustadrak Hakim, adth 8531.
718

Chapter 8 of Book V

(
)

( )
)
(
Abu Hurairah \ says that Rasulullah U said: (Armies
carrying) black flags will come from Khurasan (the land of the
rising sun, the east). No power will be able to stop them and
they will finally reach Elya (Baitul Maqdis) where they will
erect their flags.368
The fierce warrior nation will be from the Muslim Banu Israel.
Since the leader of the End of Times Army of Islam will be the Banu
Israeli Prophet Eisa X, therefore it also means that this fierce warrior
nation will be from Muslim Banu Israel, as the Quran tells us about the
conditions for the coming of a Prophet:






(14:04)


368. Jamia Tirmidhi, Chapter of Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 2371.


719

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

We sent not a messenger except (to teach) in the language of his


(own) people, in order to make (things) clear to them. (14:4)
This tells us two things:
1. That a Prophet comes amongst his own nation who is around
him, and
2. Speaks their own language and has their own culture.
Like our Dear Prophet Muammad U is Arab, and he came
amongst the Arabs, and speaks Arabic. In the same manner it was for
all Prophets before.
Similarly when the Banu Israeli Prophet Sayyidna Eisa X will
come, in the beginning, his own nation will be around him, i.e.: Muslim
Banu Israel.
Today only the Pathans are known to be from the Banu
Israel, and at the same time they live in the Khurasan,
where the Army of Mahdi will appear. They are also famous
all over the world as a FIERCE WARRIOR NATION.
Conclusion
Therefore it means that the warning given in the Quran is to the
misguided Banu Israel.




We brought upon you those of our servants who were great
warriors. (17:05)
720

Chapter 8 of Book V

This warning to the Jews by the Quran will be fulfilled by the


Pathans of Khurasan, insha Allah.
This is the main reason for their genocide in Pakistan and
Afghanistan since 1979, using different names and different reason such
as so called Taliban, Al-Qaeda, War on Terror, etc., etc.
No matter how much they torture and kill them with the help of
fake reasons in Pakistan and Afghanistan, this fierce warrior nation can
never be stopped. InshahAllah.

721

Chapter 9

Ninth Sign

They will be poor.


Allah , gave the kingdom of the world to the poor nation of Banu Israel
as we are told in the Quran:












007:137

( )
( )

007:137
And We made a people, considered weak (and of no account),
inheritors of lands in both the east and West,Lands whereon
We sent down our blessings. The fair promise of thy Lord was
fulfilled for the Children of Israel, because they had patience
and constancy, and We levelled to the ground the great works
and fine buildings which Pharaoh and his people erected (with

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

such pride). (7:137)


The Prophecy in the adth hints to the same thing as in the Quran
in verse (7:137).
Note that in the above verse, the Lands whereon We sent down our
blessings means the countries of Bilad-us-Shaam369 (Syria), which
includes the Holy Land of Elya (Jerusalem).
Now, the Quran has told us that poor Banu Israel will take over
Jerusalem (7:137), and the same is told in the following adth about
the Armies of Khurasan (i.e.: that they would take over Jerusalem).


: -:

(
)

( )
)
(
Abu Hurairah (RA) says that Rasulullah (SAWS) said:
(Armies carrying) black flags will come from the Khurasan
(the land of the rising sun, the east). No power will be able to
stop them, and they will finally reach Elya (Jerusalem) where

369. Bilad-us-Shaam (Syria) stands for Syria, Lebanon, part of Jordan, Israel,
Jerusalem, and Palestine all together.
724

Chapter 9 of Book V

they will erect their flags.370


Thus, as the Quran has told us that poor Banu Israel will take over
Jerusalem, the above adth (and also other adth, e.g.: adth about
Constantinople in a Muslim), further strengthens the fact that poor
Banu Israel from Khurasan will take over Jerusalem in future,
inshahAllah. This is because:




033:062


033:062
(Such was) the practice (approved) of Allah among those who
lived aforetime: No change wilt thou find in the practice
(approved) of Allah. (33:62)
This is also told in the following verse:



028:005

( )

028:005 ( )

370. Jamia Tirmidhi, Chapter of Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 2371.


725

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

And We intended to favor those (Banu Israel) who were held


as weak in the land, and to make them leaders, and make them
inheritors. (28:05)
InshahAllah, this will happen again.
This will happen again. Once again the poorest nation in the world, i.e.:
Muslim Banu Israel of Afghanistan and Pakistan, will be given the keys
of the world insha Allah. No matter how much they are tortured, killed,
and expelled from their homes, as in the present situation. In fact this
oppression will make them more worthy to be the chosen ones
inshahAllah.
Mahdis Army will be poor and will have no weapons, no shelter of
home, and no food.
The poverty of Mahdis Army is clear from the following adth:

. .
.

- -
. .
.
: . :
. !
:
726

Chapter 9 of Book V

. .



( )
)
(
( ) ()
( )


Abdullah b. Safwan \ reported the Mother of the
Faithful,Sayyida Ayesha \ as saying that Allahs Messenger U
said: They would soon seek protection in this House (Kaba),
(the defenseless) people, who would have nothing to protect
themselves in the shape of weapons or the strength of the
people. An army would be sent to fight (and kill) them and,
when they would enter a plain ground, the army would be
sunk in it. Yusuf (one of the narrators) said: It was a people
of Syria (hordes of Hujjaj) who had been on that day coming
towards Mecca for an attack (on Abdullah b. Zubair), and
Abdullah b. Safwan \ said: By God, it does not imply this

727

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

army.371









-









: -

371. a Muslim, Book 041, adth Number 6889.


728

Chapter 9 of Book V

,2743 :
Abdullah b. Safwan \ reported that the Mother of the Faithful
\ as saying that Allahs Messenger U said: They would soon
seek protection in this House (Kaba), (the defenseless) people
who would have nothing to protect themselves in the shape of
weapons or the strength of the people. An army would be sent
to fight (and kill) them, and when they would enter a plain
ground, the army would be sunk in it. Yusuf (one of the
narrators) said: It was a people of Syria (hordes of Hujjaj)
who had been on that day coming towards Mecca for an
attack (on Abdullah b. Zubair), and Abdullah b. Safwan U
said: By God, it does not imply this army
This poor army without weapons is from Banu Isaac (Banu Israel).
In the above adth we saw that the Mahdi Army is having no weapons
(at least in the beginning).
Now, if we check the adth of a Muslim (about Armageddon
with the Christians and the Conquest of Constantinople) we see that the
Banu Isaac (Banu Israel) also has no weapons.
Please check the armless Army of Mahdi attacking Constantinople
in the following adth:

) ( ) .
(

! . :
729

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

: . . .
. .
: . :
. : . .
. .
. :




!










)
730

Chapter 9 of Book V










)
()
Abu Huraira \ reported Allahs Apostle U as saying: You
have heard about a city, the one side of which is in the land
and the other is in the sea (Constantinople). They said:
Allahs Messenger, yes. There upon he U said: The Last
Hour would not come unless seventy thousand persons from
Banu Ishaq would attack it. When they would land there, they
will neither fight with weapons nor would shower arrows but
would only say: There is no god but Allah and Allah is the
Greatest, that one side of it would fall. Thaur (one of the
narrators) said: I think that he said: The part by the side of
the ocean. Then they would say for the second time: There
is no god but Allah, and Allah is the Greatest, that the second
side would also fall, and they would say: There is no god but
Allah, and Allah is the Greatest, that the gates would be
731

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

opened for them and they would enter therein and, they
would be collecting the spoils of war and distributing them
amongst themselves that a noise would be heard and it would
be said: Verily, the Dajjal has come. And thus they would
leave everything there and would turn to him. 372
This proves that the poor Mahdi Army in Kaba is also from
Banu Israel, as Banu Isaac and Banu Israel are terms
that have the same meaning.
This poor nation will be targeted long before the appearance of Imam
Mahdi X, and Prophet Eisa X.
The following adth further tells us that this poor nation from
Afghanistan has no worldly riches, but they have the treasure of Iman
(True Faith) due to which they are targeted by the enemies of Islam.
Pity poor Taliqan (a region in Afghanistan) that at that
place are treasures of Allah, but these are not of gold and
silver but consist of people who have recognized Allah as
they should have. 373
Important Note: I have not confirmed the authencity of this
adth but I have written it since it does not go against the
meaning of other authentic adth or the Quran. The word
Taliqan stands for a whole area, and not just the small town

372. a Muslim, Kitab al-Fitan, adth 2920.


373. Al-Muttaqi al-Hindi, Al-Burhan fi Alamat al-Mahdi Akhir al-Zaman,
p.59.
732

Chapter 9 of Book V

of Taliqan.
Arabs will be rich in the End of Times and not poor, and this money
will put them to affliction.






( )










Auf bin Malik \ says: I came to Rasulullah U while he was in
his skin tent during the Tabuk expedition. He said to me:
Count six things before the advent of Qiyamah:
733

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

1. My death.
2. The conquest of Jerusalem.
3. Mass deaths amongst you people (Arabs), just as when
sheep die in large numbers during an epidemic.
4. Abundance of wealth to such an extent that if a person
were to be given a hundred Dinars he will still not be
satisfied.
5. General afflictions (among Arabs), that no Arab
household will be spared from it.
6. Then a life of peace as a result of a peace agreement
between you and the Banu Asfaar (Sons of the Blonde i.e.:
Romans as they have yellow hair) which they will break
and attack you with a force consisting of eighty flags and
under each flag will be an army of twelve thousand
men.374

374 a Bukhari.


734

Chapter 10

Tenth Sign

The majority of them will be from the non Arabs.


The following adth tells us that there would be very few Arabs fighting
against the Dajjal.

: : .
:

! : .
.





: --

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Umm Sharik \ reported: I heard Allahs Messenger U as


saying: The people would run away from the Dajjal seeking
shelter in the mountains. She said: Where would be the
Arabs then in that day? He said: They would be very few.375
Also, the following adth tells us the same thing that the Arabs
will be very few who will fight the Dajjal.





-








4444 : : -

375. a Muslim, Book of adth, 2896, page 1904,Volume 3.


736

Chapter 10 of Book V

Narrated from Sayyidna Ayesha Siddiqah \. Once the


(future) difficulties at the time of the Dajjals appearance,
were mentioned. People asked: What will be the best type of
wealth at that time? Our Dear Prophet Muammad U
replied: That strong slave who can give water to his master
\, and as far as food is concerned, there will be no food.
People asked: What would be the food of Muslims? Our
Dear Prophet Muammad U said: (The food will be)
Tasbeeh (Subhan Allah) and Takbir (Allahu Akbar) and
Tamheed (Alhamdulillah). I asked: Where would be the
Arabs at that time? Our Dear Prophet Muammad U
replied: At that time, the Arabs would be very few
(Qaleel).376
Also another adth tells us that the non-Arab fighters will fight
the great wars at the end of time:

. .
:
:
))
.((

376. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 9, adth 4444.


737

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





Narrated Hazrat Abu Huraira \: When the great wars will
occur, then Allah , will rise an Army from the non-Arabs
who will be great riders, and will have better weapons than the
Arabs. Allah , will support His , Deen (Islam) by them. 377
Important Note: Their weapon will be the weapon of Imaan
(Faith), as another adth of a Muslims will tell, that they
will conquer Constantinople without physical weapons.
Imam Mahdi X does not live in an Arab area.

:
:
:

:




.. :

377. Sunan Ibn Majah, adth 971, page 778. Volume 3.


738

Chapter 10 of Book V





.
.
897 : :
Hazrat Ali \ looked at son, Hassan \, and said that: This
son of mine will be a leader just like he was named by our
Dear Prophet Muammad U, and soon a person will be born
from his progeny whose name will be like the name of your
Prophet. He will have the Akhlkaq (Character) like your
Prophet U, but his Khalaq (appearance) will not be like him.
Then he (Imam Ali \) told us a long story, and then said that:
He will fill the earth with Justice.378
The family of Prophet Muammad U is all over the world,
adopting different cultures. So Imam Mahdi X will be from the family
of the Prophet U, but living among the Banu Israel and therefore not
wearing the clothes of the Arabs.
Imam Mahdis X dress is not from the Arabs.
We already have seen this adth before:


( )
378. Sunan Abu Daud, Vol. 3, adth 897.
739

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

:







:

:






:
:









187 .7367 : .






( )


187 .7367 :
Narrated Hazrat Umama \ reported Rasulullah U said: You
and the Romans (Christians) will have four peace treaties. The
fourth peace would be at the hand of a person who would be
from the Al-e-Harqul (family of Roman King Harqul). This
peace treaty would be for seven years. Rasulullah U was
740

Chapter 10 of Book V

asked who would be the Imam of the Muslims at that time.


Rasulullah U said That person would be from my family, his
age would be 40 years, his face would be bright as a star, and
a black spot would be on his right cheek. He would be
wearing two Qutwani Shawls. He will appear exactly as the
person from Banu Israel. He will rule for 20 years and will
conquer the cities of the Mushrikeen (Idolaters).379
In this adth we see that Imam Mahdi \ is wearing the dress of
Banu Israel, and not the dress of the Arabs.
In fact woolen clothes cannot be worn in the hot climate of Arabia.
The Ghuraba: The revival of Islam will be at the hands of the very
poor foreign refugees coming to the Arabian Peninsula.
We can see that in the adth it is told that the people who will be
expelled from their homes or homeland will join the Army of Prophet
Eisa X in the End of Times.

, ( )








: ,



:


: ,

, :

379. Tabarani, Majam-al-Kabeer, Book 187, adth number 7367.


741

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

214 : .
:


214 :
.
Narrated from Hazrat Abdullah bin Umar \, he said that:
Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said that: The most dear
to Allah , are the Ghuraba. When asked who are the
Ghuraba? Our Dear Prophet U said that the Ghuraba are
those who have escaped with their Deen (Islam) (i.e.:
refugees). Allah will join them with Sayyidna Eisa (Jesus) Bin
Mariam X on the Judgement Day. 380
The refugees will be leader of Islam in the End of Times.








380. Bayhaqi, Az-Zuhad Alkaber, adth 214.
742

Chapter 10 of Book V






, 2927 : : .
Abdullah b. Amr b. al-As \ reported that Allahs Messenger
U said: How would you be, Oh people when Persia and Rome
would be conquered for you? Abd -al-Rahman b. Auf \
said: We would say as Allah , has commanded us, and we
would express our gratitude to Allah. Thereupon Allahs
Messenger U said: Nothing else besides it? You would (in
fact) vie with one another, then you would feel jealous, then
your relations would be estranged, and then you will bear
enmity against one another, or something to the same effect.
Then you would go to the poor emigrants and would make

743

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

some the masters of the others.381


Ghuraba (aliens / immigrants / stranger) of the End of Times means
the refugees or the Muslims who leave their homes to save their faith.





.





1856 : :
Narrated by Abdullah bin Masood \ that our Dear Prophet
Muammad U said that: Islam started as alien (stranger),
and soon it will go back to the same state, the way it started.
So, good news is for the Ghuraba (alien / immigrants/
strangers / refugees). Someone asked which people are the
Ghuraba? Our Dear Prophet U replied that: Those who have

381. a Muslim, Vol. 3, adth 2927.


744

Chapter 10 of Book V

been expelled from their tribes.382


Imam al-Harawi (may Allah have mercy on him) states the same
explanation:

Translation: It refers to those migrants who leave their


hometowns for the sake of Allah Taala.383
The following adth tells us the characteristics of the Ghuraba:
1. They will be extremely poor.
2. They will be refugees or immigrants.
3. They will not be from the Arabs, as our Dear Prophet U tells
this to the first Khalifa, Abu Bakar in this next adth.

382. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 2, adth 1846.


383. Fath al-Mulhim bi Sharh a al-Imam Muslim, 1:115; a Muslim bi
Sharh an-Nawawi, 1:455.
745

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X





!



!


:
2560 :
Narrated by Hazrat Abdullah ibn Umar \: One day I was
sitting with Allahs Prophet U. At that time sun was rising and
our Dear Prophet U said that: Allah will bring some people
from a nation who will have Noor (sacred light) like the sun.
Hazrat Abu Bakr \ asked, O Prophet of Allah U, will those be
us? Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: No, (they will be
not from among you), but you have Kahir-e-Katheer
(abundant goodness). (In fact) those people will be the very
poor (like beggars) people and the immigrants (refugees) who
will be gathered together from (different) corners of the
word. Then our Dear Prophet U said: Glad tidings (or good
746

Chapter 10 of Book V

news) for the Ghuraba (the strangers or the poor). Someone


again asked: Who are the Ghuraba? Our Dear Prophet U
replied: A very few good (or pious) people among a large
number of bad (or sinful) people, whom a very few will obey
(or listen), and a majority will disobey (or not listen to
them).384
Further discussion about the Ghuraba (i.e.: immigrants,
strangers, aliens, poor) people will be given in later
chapters of this book.
Abundance of money will put many Arabs in a state of afflictions.
The Arab downfall as stated in the adth will be due to the abundance
of money among the Arabs as told in the following adth.






( )


384. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 3, adth 2560.


747

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X








Auf bin Malik \ says: I came to Rasulullah U while he was
in his skin tent during the Tabuk expedition. He said to me:
Count six things before the advent of Qiyamah:
1. My death.
2. The conquest of Jerusalem.
3. Mass deaths amongst you people, just as when sheep die
in large numbers during an epidemic.
4. Abundance of wealth to such an extent that if a person
were to be given a hundred Dinars (gold coins) he will still
not be satisfied.
5. General afflictions (among the Arabs), that no Arab
household will be spared from it.
6. Then a life of peace as a result of a peace agreement
between you and the Banu Asfaar (Sons of the Blonde i.e.:
Romans as they have yellow hair), which they will break
and attack you with a force consisting of eighty flags and
under each flag will be an army of twelve thousand
748

Chapter 10 of Book V

men.385
This adth clearly tells us that after the abundance of Money
among the Arabs, they will have fitnah (afflictions) among themselves.
The following adth further confirms the above adth.
This adth tells us that how the Arabs will get rich, and build tall
buildings:



:











:



:

.


:
. :


:





:
.








:

: .


.


:







: .
:




385. a Bukhari.
749

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

) :





(



: .
:

.







: .


643 : : . :








( ) !



!




750

Chapter 10 of Book V

! !
( )






( ) !
!
( )



( ) !

: ( ) :
:





() !
751

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


643 : :
Note: It should be noted that now you will find a change in
the translation of the same adth. The word Arabs is
changed to village people or sometimes it is not even
mentioned. Astagfirullah.
I am translating in English only part of the above full adth in
Arabic.
Narrated by Abdullah bin Abbas \: Once our Dear Prophet
Muammad U was sitting in a meeting. At that time, Angel
Jibril X came (in human form) (part of a long adth)
Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said that: The female slave
should give birth to her mistress, and you see shepherds of
sheep (and goats) competing in making tall buildings, and
you see bare footed, hungry and poor people becoming rulers,
then this is among the signs of the (coming of) the Qiyamah
(Judgement Day). People asked: O Rasul Allah U who are
these shepherds of sheep (and goats), the bare footed, hungry
and needy (poor) people? Rasul Allah U replied: The Arab
people.386

386. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 2, adth 1035.


752

Chapter 10 of Book V

Figure: The Tallest buildings of the world


made by Arabs as told in adth
The first attack on Imam Mahdi X will by Arab rulers.








----
) 8395 ( )
136(

753

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


:


)
(
()
8395 ( )
136( )
Narrated by Hazrat Abu Huraira \ from Hazrat Abu Qatada
\: Our Dear Prophet U said: People will be given allegiance
(baya) to a person (i.e.: Imam Mahdi \) between the Ruken
(Hajr-e-Aswad) and the Mukam (Mukam-e-Ibrahim),
and no one else but the same people who are related to that
place (citizens of Makkah) will destroy the respect of the
Kaabah (as they will attack Imam Mahdi X in the Kaabah
where fighting is forbidden). And when they will declare it
Halal, then do not ask about the killing of the Arabs (there
will be a mass killing of the Arabs). Then Ethiopians
(Africans) will come and they will desolate it in such a way
that it would never be a habitat, and these will be the people
who will take out it is treasure.387

387. Mustadrak Hakim, adth 8385, Kitab-al-Fitan. Also in Masnaf Ibn


Sheeba, Kitab-al-Fitan.
754

Chapter 10 of Book V

The Rulers of Arabia will suffer massive killing by the hands of Imam
Mahdis X followers from the east.












( )






( )
Thawban \ reported that our Dear Prophet U said: Three
people will fight for your treasure (and get killed). All three of
them will be the sons of a ruler but none of them will get the
755

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

treasure. Then black flags will appear from the east and will
kill you as no one (in history) has killed you before. Then our
Dear Prophet U said something that I didnt remember. Then
again our Dear Prophet U said: If you see him then give him
your allegiance, even if you have to crawl over ice, because he
is the Khalifa of Allah, the Mahdi X.
This adth is most Authentic (a) according to the conditions
of a Bukhari and a Muslim.388
The second attack on Imam Mahdi X will be by the Arab army of
Syria, and it will be devoured by the earth in the outskirts of the city
of Madinah in the Arabian Peninsula.








.



388. Ibn Majah and also Hakim Mustadrak.
756

Chapter 10 of Book V









.2740. : :
2
Harith b Abi Rabia \ and Abdullah b. Safwan \ both went
to Umm Salama, the Mother of the Faithful \, and they asked
her about the army which would be sunk in the earth, and this
relates to the time when Ibn Zubair (was the governor of
Mecca). She reported that: Allahs Messenger U had said that
a seeker of refuge would seek refuge in the Sacred House, and
an army would be sent to him (in order to kill him) and when
it would enter a plain ground, it would be made to sink. I said:
Allahs Messenger U, what about who was forced to join
them? Thereupon he said: He would be made to sink along
with them but he would be raised on the Day of Resurrection
on the basis of his intention. Abu Jafar \ said: This plain
ground means the plain ground of Medina.389
389. a Muslim, Vol. 3, adth 2740.
757

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X











-



!





!


758

Chapter 10 of Book V



: :
6143
Narrated by the Mother of the Faithful, Hazrat Umm Salama
\: Once our Dearest Prophet Muammad U was sleeping in
my home, suddenly he U woke and said Inna Lillah I
asked: May my mother and father sacrificed for you. Ya Rasul
Allah U what is it? Why you are saying Inna Lillah Our
Dearest Prophet Muammad U said: An army from my
Ummah (nation) will come from Shaam (Syria) to capture a
person in Baitullah (Kaba). Allah Subhana hu will protect
that person from this army, and when they will reach from
ZUL-KHALIFA to MAQAM BAIDA, then they will all
swallowed by the earth, and they will rise from different places
on the Day of Judgement. I asked: Why is it that they will be
swallowed in earth at same place but will rise at different
places (on Judgement Day)? Our Dearest Prophet U said
three times that: Some of the people will be taken in this
army by force. 390
The 3rd attack on Imam Mahdis X followers will be by an Arab
from Quraish.

390. Masnad Ahmad, adth 6143.


759

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X









( )





760

Chapter 10 of Book V



6581 : :
Narrated by Umm Salama \ that our Dearest Prophet
Muammad U said that: Disagreement will occur after the
death of a Khalifa (note here Khalifadoesntnecessarily mean
a just Khalifa of Islam, but it can mean a king), then a person
will flee from Madinah to Makkah. Some of the people in
Makkah will come to him and take him out against his will
and will give him allegiance (baya) between the Hajar Aswad
(black stone), and the Maqam Ibrahim X. Then an army
from Sham (Syria) will come to attack to him, but will be
devoured by the earth at the place of BAIDAH. When people
will see this, then the Abdal of Sham (Syria) and the Asaeb of
Iraq (Abdal and Asaeb is a level of pious people from Shaam
and Iraq respectively, and their number is 40 according to
other narrations), will come and give allegiance (baya) to
him. Then a person from the Quraish will come forward,
whose maternal family will be from Banu Kulaib (a branch of
Banu Tamim). That person in Makkah will send an army
towards that Qureshi and will overcome him. This battle will
be called the BATH KULAIB, and a person is at a great loss if
he is not present at the distribution of the booty of that
Ghazwa (battle). He will distribute the riches and act upon the
Sunnah of your Prophet U, Islam will put it is neck on the
earth (i.e.: Islam will spread), and he will rule for 9 years on
761

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

earth.391
The Arab tribe of Banu Kulaib (Banu Tamim) will be made slaves by
Imam Mahdi X.






)
(

( )
( )
)
( 8329
Narrated by Abu Huraira \ that our Dear Prophet
Muammad U said that: Disappointed will be the one who
does not receive the booty of Kalb even if it a single Aqal (a
small unit). I swear by the Name of the One who holds my
life, no doubt the women of Kulaib will be sold (as slaves) in
the way to Damascus, until one of the women will be returned
391 Masnad Ahmad, adth 6581.
762

Chapter 10 of Book V

back because of broken ankle.392


We know in one adth it is told that the Arabs are not to be made
as slaves but in the above authentic adth permission is given to
Muslims to make slaves of the certain tribe of Arabs. This permission is
given in the End of Times and.
Banu Kulaib are Banu Tamim.
Banu Kulaib are direct descendants of Banu Tamim as we can see in the
family background of Ibn Jarir (one of the greatest and most celebrated
Muslim poets). It stated
Abu Hazra Jarir Ibn Atiya ibn Khudaifa (surnamed AlKhatafa) Ibn Badr Ibn Salama Ibn Auf Ibn Kulaib Ibn
Yarbu Ibn Hanzala Ibn Malik Ibn Zaid Manat Ibn Tamim
Ibn Murr at-Tamimi (descended from Tamim). 393
The Rule of the Quraish will be over.
Note: I am writing only part of the below adth of IbnMajah, as it is a very long adth.



















392. Mustadrak Hakim, Chapter of Fitan wa Malahim, adth 8329.
393. Ibn Khallikan's Biographical Dictionary by Ibn Khallikan, page 294.
763

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X



: . .

958 :
.

( )










( )
)
(
()
764

Chapter 10 of Book V

)
(
958 : :
Abu Umamah al-Bahili \ said: The Prophet U delivered a
speech to us, most of which dealt with the Dajjal and warned
us against him it is a part of a long adth
And then Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: Jesus son
of Mary X will be a just administrator and leader of my
Ummah. He will break the cross, kill the pigs, and abolish the
jizyah (tax on non-Muslims). He will not collect the sadaqah,
so he will not collect sheep and camels. Mutual enmity and
hatred will disappear. Every harmful animal will be made
harmless, so that a small boy will be able to put his hand into
a snakes mouth without being harmed, a small girl will be
able to make a lion run away from her, and a wolf will go
among the sheep as if he were a sheep dog. The earth will be
filled with peace as a container is filled with water. People will
be in complete agreement, and only Allah , will be
worshipped. Wars will cease, and the authority ofQuraysh
will be taken away. The earth will be like a silver basin, and
will produce fruits so abundantly A long adth that
continues.394
The Banu Israeli Prophet Eisa X will rule.

394 Sunan Ibn Majah, adth 958.


765

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X




: .
117 :
Sayyidina Abu Huraira \ reported that the Prophet U said:
By Him in Whose hand is my soul, Ibn Maryam (Eisa) X
will soon descend among you. He will rule justly. He will
break the cross, kill swine and abolish the jizyah, and wealth
will flow to such an abundance that no one will take it.395
The Quran explains why the rule of the Quraish will be over.

395. Jamia Tirmidhi, Vol. 2, adth 117, Also Masnad Ahmad, 10944.
766

Chapter 10 of Book V

014:004

( )

4-14
We sent not a messenger except (to teach) in the language of his
(own) people, in order to make (things) clear to them. (14:4)
This tells us two important things:
1. That a Prophet comes amongst his own nation around him,
and
2. They speak their own language.
Like our Dear Prophet Muammad U is an Arab, and he came
amongst the Arabs, speaks Arabic, and in the same manner it was for
all Prophets before.
Similarly when the Banu Israeli Prophet Sayyidna Eisa X will
come, in the beginning, his own nation will be around him, i.e.: the
Muslim Banu Israel.
Important Note: Prophet Eisa X will follow Islam and will
not bring a new religion. Therefore he will not come among
the non-Muslim Banu Israel, i.e.: the Jews.
The adth also explains why the rule of the Quraish will be over.
The rule of the Quraish is conditional to the obedience of the
767

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

commandments of Allah , as the following adth tells us.








. .



!




)
! ! (




768

Chapter 10 of Book V


2409 : :
Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said after reciting Kalima
Shahadah: O people of Quraish (tribe), you are eligible to
rule but with the condition that you do not disobey Allah ,.
When you will indulge in disobeying Allah ,, then Allah ,
will appoint some person (to rule over you) who will peel you
like this branch (of tree). At that time our Dear Prophet
Muammad U had a stick in his hands which he U peeled and
it then appeared white and slippery.396
More adth about the rule of non-Arabs.



-



1193 : :
Narrated by Abu Huraira \: Our Dear Prophet Muammad
U said that: The cycle of day and night will not be over until
a person from the Mawali (non-Arabs) called JHEH-JAH
396. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 2, adth 2409.
769

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

will become the ruler (of the world).397


Very Important Note: The word Mawali or mawla (Arabic:

) is a term in classical Arabic is used to address non-Arab


Muslims.398
The detailed discussion about the translation of the word
Mawali can be found at the end of this chapter.
Afflictions will start from the Arab tribe of Banu Tamim.












.
397. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 4, adth 1193.
398 Princeton University
http://www.princeton.edu/~batke/itl/denise/mawali.htm, and also
http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mawali.
770

Chapter 10 of Book V
















(58 : 9

771

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

1839 : :

Narrated Abu Said \: While The Prophet U was distributing


(something), Abdullah bin Dhil Khawaisira At-Tamimi
came and said: Be just, O Allahs Apostle! The Prophet U
said: Woe to you! Who would be just if I were not? Umar
bin Al-Khattab \ said: Allow me to cut off his neck!The
Prophet said: Leave him, for he has companions, and if
you compare your prayers with their prayers and youre
fasting with theirs, you will look down upon your prayers
and fasting, in comparison to theirs. Yet they will go out of
the religion as an arrow darts through the games body in
which case, if the Qudhadh of the arrow is examined, nothing
will be found on it, and when it is Nasl is examined, nothing
will be found on it; and then it is Nadiyi is examined, nothing
will be found on it. The arrow has been too fast to be smeared
by dung and blood. The sign by which these people will be
recognized will be a man whose one hand (or breast) will be
like the breast of a woman (or like a moving piece of flesh).
These people will appear when there will be differences
among the people (Muslims). Abu Said \ added: I testify
that I heard this from the Prophet U, and also testify that Ali
\ killed those people while I was with him. The man with the
description given by the Prophet U was brought to Ali \. The
following verses were revealed in connection with that very
person (i.e.: Abdullah bin Dhil-Khawaisira At-Tamimi):
And among them are men who accuse you (O Muammad)
772

Chapter 10 of Book V

in the matter of (the distribution of) the alms. (9.58).399


The affliction of Banu Tamim tribe will start from the Najd.
The following adth is also about the same event mentioned before in
the adth, and tells us that the afflictions will start from the offspring
of Zul-Khuwaisara of Banu Tamim, and it is location is the Najd.






(3) (2) (1)




()





399. a Bukhari, Vol. 3, adth 1839.
773

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X











)
(


489 : : .
24
It was narrated that Abu Saeed Al Khudri \ said: When he
was in Yemen, Ali \ sent a piece of gold that was still mixed
with sediment to the Messenger of Allah U and the Messenger
of Allah U distributed it among four People: Al-Aqra bin
Habis Al-Hanzali, Uyaynah bin Badr Al- Fazari, Alqamah
bin Ulathah Al Amiri, who was from Banu Kilab and Zaid
At-Tai who was from Banu Nabhan. The Quraishhe said
774

Chapter 10 of Book V

one time the chiefs of the Quraishbecame angry and


said: You give to the chiefs of Najd and not to us? He said: I
only did that, so as to soften their hearts toward Islam. Then
a man with a thick beard, prominent cheeks, sunken eyes, a
high forehead, and a shaven head came and said: Fear Allah,
Muammad! He said: Who would obey Allah if I disobeyed
Him? (Is it fair that) He has entrusted me with all the people
of the earth but you do not trust me? Then the man went
away, and a man from among the people, whom they (the
narrators) think was Khalid bin Al Walid \, asked for
permission to kill him. The Messenger of Allah U said:
Among the offspring of this man will be some people who
will recite the Quran but it will not go any further than
their throats. They will kill the Muslims but leave the idol
worshippers alone, and they will pass through Islam as an
arrow passes through the body of the target. If I live to see
them, I will kill them all, as the people of Ad were killed. 400

The offspring of this Arab tribe (Banu Tamim) will join the Dajjal.
The following adth tells us about the same incident, and this adth
further tells us that the Dajjal will come among the offspring of the Banu
Tamim tribe from Najd.

400. Sunan Nisai, Vol. 2, adth 489.


775

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X















407 : : .








776

Chapter 10 of Book V








( )

!
( )








407 : :

It was narrated that Sharik bin Shihab \ said: I used to wish
that I could meet a man among the Companions of the
777

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Prophet, and ask him about the Khawarij. Then I met Abu
Barzah \ on the day of Eid, with a number of his companions.
I said to him: Did you hear the Messenger of Allah U mention
the Khawarij? He said: Yes. I heard the Messenger of Allah
U with my own ears, and saw him with my own eyes. Some
wealth was brought to the Messenger of Allah U and he
distributed it to those on his right and on his left, but he did
not give anything to those who were behind him. Then a man
stood behind him and said: Muammad! You have not been
just in your division! He was a man with black patchy
(shaved) hair, wearing two white garments. So Allahs
Messenger U became very angry and said: By Allah! You will
not find a man after me who is more just than me. Then he
said: A people will come at the end of time, as if he is one of
them, reciting the Quran without it passing beyond their
throats. They will go through Islam just as the arrow goes
through the target. Their distinction will be shaving. They
will not cease to appear until the last of them comes with
Al-Masih Al Dajjal. So when you meet them, then kill them,
they are the worst of created beings. 401
Further discussion regarding the Affliction of Banu
Tamim tribe and Najad area can be found in the book no-3
i.e. Army of Dajjal Part-1 in this collection
More adth about the Fitnah (afflictions) among Arabs.

401. Sunan Nisai, Vol. 3, adth 407, adth Matwatar Marfu.


778

Chapter 10 of Book V

2737 : :

Zainab bint Jahsh \, the wife of Allahs Apostle U, reported


that one day Allahs Messenger U came out in a state of
excitement with his face quite red. And he was saying: There
is no god but Allah, there is a destruction in store for Arabia
because of the turmoil which is near at hand as the barrier of
779

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Gog and Magog has been opened like it, and he (in order to
explain it) made a ring with the help of his thumb and
forefinger. I said: Allahs Messenger, would we be destroyed
despite the fact that there would be pious people amongst us?
He said: Yes, when the evil would predominate.402
Knowledge will decrease among the Arabs.




!
3684 : :
Narrated by Abu Huraira \ that our Dear Prophet
Muammad U said that: Woe to the Arabs for the evil that
has come near. Knowledgewill decrease and haraj will
increase. I asked Ya Rasul Allah U, what does haraj
mean? Our Dear Prophet U said killing.403

402. a Muslim, Vol. 3, adth 2737.


403. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 4, adth number 3684.
780

Chapter 10 of Book V

The destruction of Arabs is near.



.


2493 : :
Narrated by Abu Huraira \ that: The destruction of the
Arabs is close due to an evil that is very near. Only those will
succeed who will stop their hands (from fighting).404

The destruction of Arabs due to bad deeds.

404. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 4, adth 2493.


781

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X










!
581 : :
7
Narrated Zainab bint Jahsh \: The Prophet U once came to
her in a state of fear and said: None has the right to be
worshipped but Allah. Woe unto the Arabs from a shar
(affliction) that has come near. An opening has been made in
the wall of Gog and Magog like this, making a circle with his
thumb and index finger. Zainab bint Jahsh \ said: O Allahs
Apostle! Shall we be destroyed even though there are pious
persons among us? He said: Yes, if sin and evil deeds
increase.405

405 a Bukhari, Vol. 2, adth No 581.


782

Chapter 10 of Book V

Deen (Islam) will be sold for worldly benefits.





.







1890 : :
Abu Hurairah \ said: The Prophet U said: Woe to the Arabs
from the great evil which is nearly approaching them. It will
be like patches of dark night. A man will wake up as a believer,
and be a kafir (unbeliever) by nightfall. People will sell their
religion for a small amount of worldly goods. The one who
clings to his religion on that day will be as one who is grasping
an emberor thorns. 406

406. Masnad Ahmad, Vol. 4, adth No 1890.


783

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

The destruction of Muslims by some of the Arabs of


the Quraish Tribe.




..



826 : :
5 5

Narrated Said Al-Umawi \: I was with Marwan and Abu


Huraira \ and heard Abu Huraira \ saying: I heard the
Trustworthy, and Truly Inspired One (i.e.: the Prophet U)
saying, The destruction of my followers will be brought about
by the hands of some youngsters from Quraish. Marwan
asked: Youngsters? Abu Huraira \ said: If you wish, I would
name them: They are the children of so-and-so and the

784

Chapter 10 of Book V

children of so-and-so.407
Important Note: Final discussion about the changing of the
meanings of the adth today.
The slaves of the Dajjal are trying their best to change the meaning of
the word Mawali in the following adth.

. .
:
:
))
.((




3
Narrated Hazrat Abu Huraira \: When great wars will
occur, then Allah , will rise an army from the non-Arabs
who will be greater riders and will have better weapons than
the Arabs. Allah , will support His Deen (Islam) by them.408

407. a Bukhari, Vol. 2, adth No 1890.


408. Sunan Ibn Majah, adth 971, page 778, Volume 3.
785

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Important Note: Their weapon will be the weapon of Imaan


(Faith), as another adth of a Muslims tells, that they will
conquer Constantinople without material weapons.
What does the word Mawali mean?
Mawali or mawla (Arabic: ) is a term in classical Arabic used to
address non-Arab Muslims. It is a pity that in the recent books
published by the Saudi government funded publishing houses, the
meaning of the word Mawali is deliberately changed to new Muslim
converts instead of the non-Arabs. We shall study the true meaning
of Mawali using different references.
Reference 1:
In the book Nature, man, and God in Medieval Islam, by Mahmud ibn
Abd al-Rahman Al-Isfahani, Edwin Elliott Calverley writes.
Quoting form the article, Mawla by A.J Wensinck and
Patricia Crone, The meaning of [mawla], is a person linked
by [wala] (proximity) to another person, similarly known as
[mawla]. The relation maybe one of equality or of inequality.
The root meaning of [wali] thus includes proximity, and by
derivation, power and protection. In the Quran and the
Tradition (adth), there are two senses of the term
[mawla=wali], referring to the superior of two parties in a
relationship: as tutor-trustee-helper, and as Lord. We may
supply synonyms for the trustee that would include warden,
executor, guardian, etc., and for helper that would include
kinsman, friend, ally, etc. In the relationship of inequality, the
786

Chapter 10 of Book V

lesser party would be a client of some sort to the superior


party.
Quoting the same article further:
Since the non-Arabs could only enter this society as client,
[mawla] came to be synonymous with non-Arab Muslims.
Reference 2:
The Princeton University website describes Mawali as the non-Arab
converts to Islam.
Originally the term mawla (singular of mawali) referred to a
party with whom one had an egalitarian relationship, such as
a relative, ally, or friend, but the term eventually came to
designate a party with whom one had an unequal
relationship, such as master, manumitted, and patron, and
slave, freedman, and client. Under the First Four Caliphs and
the Umayyads, the influx of non-Arab converts to Islam
created a new difficulty: how were they to be incorporated
into tribal Arab society? The solution was the contract
of wala, through which the non-Arab Muslim acquired an
Arab patron. In principle, the mawali were to enjoy the same
privileges as Arab Muslims. The mawali rapidly rose to
prominence in Muslim society in administration, military,
and scholarship.
Bibliography

Conversion and Poll-Tax in Early Islam, D.C. Dennett,


787

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Cambridge 1950.

The Encyclopedia of Islam, Second Edition

Slaves on Horses, P. Crone, Cambridge 1980.

Reference 3:
In the book Orphans of Islam: Family, Abandonment, and Secret
Adoption in Morocco, by Jamila Bargach it is written:
The meaning of Mawali has historically shifted. In the preIslamic period, the Mawali were the clients of Arab tribes,
while with Islam it came to denote simply a non-Arab
Muslims who allied themselves with the Muslim community
as clients.

Reference 4:
In the book Islam in History: Ideas, People, and Events in the Middle
East, by Bernard Lewis it is written:
The mawali (singular) of mawla, were those Muslims who
were not full members by birth of an Arab tribe. The greater
part of these were the non-Arabs converts to Islam.
Reference 5:
In the book Discovering Islam: making sense of Muslim History and
Society, by Akbar S. Ahmed, it is written that:
A mawla was a Muslim who was not a member of an Arab
788

Chapter 10 of Book V

tribe by descent, a Persian or an Egyptian for example. The


term did not include non-Muslims, dhimmis.
Summary of the meaning of the term Mawali.
In short the word Mawali means the NON ARABS only in the given
adth.

789

Chapter 11

Eleventh Sign

They will come from a place with cold climate.


Imam Mahdis forces will come from a place with cold climate and not
a hot location.
Please see the following adth (repeated before) in which the word
ice is used when the forces of Imam Mahdi X are mentioned:

:

)): :
. .
)) . .(( .
--.(( .
. . :
.


( )

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X







( )
Thawban \ reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad U
said: Three people will fight for your treasure (and get
killed). All three of them will be sons of a ruler but none of
them will get the treasure. Then black flags will appear from
the east and will kill you as no one (in history) has killed you
before. Then our Dear Prophet U said something that I
didnt remember. Then again our Dear Prophet U said: If
you see him, then give him your allegiance, even if you have
to crawl over ice, because he is the Khalifa of Allah, the Mahdi
X.
This given adth is Most Authentic (a) according to the
conditions of a Muslim and a Bukhari.409

.
. . . .
. .

409. Hakim Mustadrak, adth 4084, Kitab-al-Fitan.


792

Chapter 11 of Book V

-( ) --.((
4082

( )


()



4082 ( )
240 ..
Narrated by Hazrat Abdullah Bin Masood \, that our Dear
Prophet U said: A nation carrying black banners will come
out from the east. They will instruct the people to do good,
but the people will refuse; they will fight until they are
victorious, and the people will do as they asked, but they will
not accept it from them until they hand over power to a man
from my household. Then the earth will be filled with fairness,
just as it had been filled with injustice. If any of you live to see
this, you should go to him even if you have to crawl across

793

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

ice.410
And also the following adth. (Previously mentioned, therefore I
have not used the Arabic text of these adth here).
Our Dear Prophet Muammad U said that: When you hear
the news of black flags coming from the east, then, you must
join them even, if you have to crawl over ice (to reach
them).411
Thoban \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet Muammad U)
reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad U) said: When
you see that black flags have appeared from Khurasan, go to
(join) them even if you have to walk over ICE on your knees
as the Khalifa of Allah, the MAHDI X will be among
them.412
The clothing of Imam Mahdi X are made of wool, and he will come
from a place with ice.
We have the following adth, which mentions that Imam Mahdi X
will be wearing two woolen sheets wrapped around his body (i.e.: the

410. Al Asha by Muhammad Barzanji, page 240, Also Sunan Ibn Majah, adth
4082, Kitab-al-Fitan. Also page 10 in the Book of Signs Before the Day of
Judgement by Ibn Kathir. Also page 100 in the book Islam Main Mahdi ka
Tasawwer, by Prof Yusuf Khan.
411. Musnad Ahmad 5:277. Also in Sunan Ibn Majah. Also adth 5225 in
Mishkat al Masabeeh.
412. Baiqahee and Ahmed in Dalael-e-Nabowat, adth No 5225, in Mishkatul-Masabeeh.
794

Chapter 11 of Book V

Qutwani dress of Banu Israel), which also shows Imam Mahdi X being
from a cold climate area.


( )
:






:

:




:
:










187 .7367 : .






( )


187 .7367 :
Narrated Hazrat Umama \ who reported that Rasulullah U
795

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

said: You and the Romans (Christians) will have four peace
treaties. The fourth peace would be at the hand of a person
who would be from the Al-e-Harqul (family of the Eastern
Roman King Harqul). This peace treaty would be for seven
years. Rasulullah U was asked who would be the Imam of the
Muslims at that time. Rasulullah U said: That person would
be from my family, his age would be 40 years, his face would
be bright as a star, and a black spot would be on his right
cheek. He would be wearing two Qutwani Shawls. He will
appear exactly as a person from Banu Israel. He will rule for
20 years, and will conquer the cities of the Mushrikeen
(idolaters).413
We see we have the historical region of Khurasan, which do have
snowcapped mountains and also the people there wrap woolen sheets
to save themselves from the cold weather. This also proves that the
Pashtuns are the followers of Imam Mahdi X.

413. Tabarani, Majam-al-Kabeer, Book 187, adth number 7367.


796

Chapter 11 of Book V

Afghan winter.
Go to the Mahdi X even if you have to climb over ice
(adth).

797

Chapter 12

Twelfth Sign

They will come from the area of Taliqan.


The following adth is a weak adth, but I have included it because it
confirms an authentic adth about this topic.
Praise to Taliqan (a city in Afghanistan, but here it means
the whole area), where are the treasures of Allah ,, but
these treasures are not of gold or silver, but of men who
will recognize Allah , as He should be recognized, and they
will be helpers of the MAHDI.414
And, that is the main reason for the massacre of the Pashtuns
which started in Afghanistan in 1979, and still continues today both in
Afghanistan and Pakistan. This was even prophesized in the following
adth:
Pity poor Taliqan, that at that place there are treasures of
Allah ,, but these are not of gold and silver but consist of
people who have recognized Allah , as they should

414. Kanzul Amal, 291/14.

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

have.415
Misunderstanding of the adth of Taliqan
Some argue that in the Taliqan, the Turkic races of Khurasan live
nowadays (because most of the Pashtuns have been eleminated from
this area due to their genocide), and this adth mentions the Turkic
races of Khurasan. Their claim is wrong because of the following
reasons.
The word Taliqan not just mentions the Taliqan region of today,
but it describes the whole of the area since in older times the name of a
small region described the whole of the region.
For example, the King of the whole of Afghanistan, and many parts
of Central Asia (i.e.: Mahmud of Ghazni), was known as the King of
Zabul. (The Persian poet Fidausi always called him as SHAH-EZABUL in his famous poem Shahnama Firdausi). Zabul was a small
province but the whole region was known as Zabul at that time. So,
the word Taliqan means the whole of the area of Khurasan, and not
just the Taliqan town itself.
The second reason is that the Turkic-Mongol races of Khurasan
have been mentioned as the followers of the Dajjal, and so they can
never form the Army of the Mahdi. The adth confirms that the
Turkic-Mongol races will be part of the army of the Dajjal:

415. Al-Muttaqi al-Hindi, Al-Burhan fi Alamat al-Mahdi Akhir al-Zaman,


p.59.
800

Chapter 12 of Book V

.
:
:
. ))
4072 ((
Narrated by Amr ibn Hurayth \ who quoted Abu Bakr Al
Siddiq \ as saying that Allahs Messenger U told them the
Dajjal would come forth from a land in the east called
Khurasan, followed by people whose faces resemble shields
covered with skin.416
The difference between the Mongols and the Turks.
Narrated Abu Huraira \: Allahs Apostle U said: The Hour
will not be established until you fight with the Turks; people
with small eyes, red faces, and flat noses. Their faces will look
like shields coated with leather. The Hour will not be
established till you fight with people whose shoes are made of
hair.417
And also the following adth:

.
:

416. Sunan Ibn Majah, The Book of Trials (Fitan), adth 4072.
417. a Bukhari, Volume 4, Book 52, Number 179.
801

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


. . .
Abu Huraira \ reported Allahs Messenger U as saying: You
shall fight in the hours to come against a nation wearing shoes
made of hair and faces like hammered shields, with red
complexion and small eyes.418
Turkic People.
In the above two adth please check the that the word faces like
shields is commonly used for
1. The Turks, and
2. The Turks of Khurasan.
Which means that faces like shields and people with small eyes
are the Turkic people of Khurasan which are different nations with
same Turkic culture. These nations include Tajiks, Uzbeks, Tureman,
Kazakh, Hazaras, etc in Central Asia
Mongols.
The Mongols are people wearing hairy shoes, also called the Tartars.
Important Note: Further discussion on the Turks and
Mongols of Khurasan can be found in the book Signs of the
Army of the Dajjal - Part II

418. a Muslim, Book 041, Hadtih # 6960.


802

Chapter 12 of Book V

Conclusion
The only Muslim race with all these twelve characteristics are the
Pathans or Pashtuns of Afghanistan and Pakistan.
Their characteristics are:
1. They will come from the east.
2. They will come from the Khurasan.
3. They will be from Banu Israel, also called Banu Isaac.
4. They will be from the Tribe of Kash or Kish or Qais.
5. They will be wearing Qutwani Shawls.
6. Extreme suffering and sacrifice.
7. They will be refugees or immigrants (Ghuraba).
8. They will be famous as fierce warriors all over the world.
9. They will be poor.
10. They majority will be from the non Arabs.
11. They will come from a place with cold climate.
12. They will come from the area of Taliqan.
The Quran tells us about the progeny of Prophet Isaac (Israel) X,
and informing us about the division of his children (Banu Israel) into
two groups, the Muslim, and non-Muslim among them.

803

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


037.113

We blessed him and Isaac: but of their progeny are (some) that
do right, and (some) that obviously do wrong, to their own
souls. (37:113)
The above verse tells us about the two divisions among Banu Isaac
X, and since the Quran is for all times, this division still exists in the
form of Jews (the non-believers), and the Pashtuns (the believers, hence
Muslims). Now, insha Allah the non-believer Banu Israel will be
punished by the Faithful Banu Israel, as promised by Allah , in the
Quran.




-
( )

()
Those to whom We gave the Scripture (Jews and Christians)
recognize him (Muammad U as they recognize their sons. But
verily, a party of them conceal the truth while they know it.
(2:146)
So if the Jews know about Muslim Banu Israel and their God-given
task, then they are definitely trying to kill as many as they can from this
Muslim nation, as they fear that it will bring an end to the Jewish and
Christian powers.

804

Chapter 12 of Book V

The massive killing and oppression upon this nation is even


prophesized in the adth. The following adth clearly tells the reason
for the massive killing of the Pashtun Muslim Banu Israel.
Pity poor Taliqan (a region in Afghanistan), that at that
place are treasures of Allah ,, but these are not of gold and
silver, but consist of people who have recognized Allah ,
as they should have. 419
The continued plan for the mass killing of the forces of Imam
Mahdi X (i.e.: Muslim Banu Israel / Banu Isaac of Khurasan) since
1979 in Afghanistan (more than four million Muslim Banu Israel killed
and still continues) is now knocking the doors of Muslim Banu Israel in
PAKISTAN, using the name of the so called Taliban, and Al-Qaeda.
The two evil fitnah are sponsored by the Jews to slaughter innocent
Muslims. In fact it has started in Pakistan, but no one could have
predicted this when this was first written.
In Pakistan, the killing of Pashtuns seems to be planned in the
following stages:

In the North West Frontiers Province (KPK), they are already


bombing different areas in the name of attacking the TALIBAN
and killing hundreds on daily basis. La Qadr Allah.

In Baluchistan Province they want to accomplish this by the so


called Baluch Liberation Movement. La Qadr Allah.

In Sindh Province they want to kill the Pashtuns by using the

419. Al-Muttaqi al-Hindi, Al-Burhan fi Alamat al-Mahdi Akhir al-zaman, p.59.


805

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

political party of MQM. La Qadr Allah.

In Punjab they want to expel all the Pashtuns by creating hatred


of Pashtuns among the locals. La Qadr Allah.

In the Arabic countries there are about two million Pashtuns,


and it is not clear how they want to start their elimination. La
Qadr Allah.

The top Jewish leadership believes in the Promises of Allah , to


the Muslims, and because of prejudice they hopelessly do everything to
prevent their destiny. This is the reason why they make false pretenses
(the so called Al Qaeda, and Taliban). The objective is to kill the main
forces described in the adth that will bring an end to the Jewish and
Christian rule in the world. The present world situation confirms all
this, but these are vain efforts, and they can never succeed. InshahAllah.
I want to address their leadership, and let you know that you can
never stop their fate from ALLAH ,. By this killings they are only
making their end closer and closer. Also by the genocide of the Pashtuns
they are only making this nation more worthy to become the Army of
Imam Mahdi \, since the more sacrifice they give, the more worthy
they become to have the honor to be among the Army of the chosen
ones, as the Quran tells us. InshahAllah.

.195.


806

Chapter 12 of Book V



-3-195- .
So those who emigrated and were driven out from their homes,
and suffered harm in My Cause, and who fought, and were
killed (in My Cause), verily, I will expiate from them their
evil deeds and admit them into Gardens under which rivers
flow (in Paradise). Quran (3:195)
So, slaves of the Dajjal/Anti-Christ, who are doing these killings
and torture, no matter how many innocent Muslim Banu Israel you
drive out of their homes, torture and mercilessly kill them, you are only
making them worthy to become the chosen ones. You are cleaning them
of their sins, to have the rightful honor to be partners of Prophet Jesus
X and Imam Mahdi X.
My final message is for those so called Muslims who are killing
the innocent Muslims in Pakistan, in the name of the so called fake antiterrorism campaign. This message is from the Holy the Quran:


) )





)
()
) )

807

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


Allah mocks at them and gives them increase in their wrongdoings to wander blindly. (2:15)
These are they who have purchased error for guidance, so their
commerce was profitless. And they were not guided. (2:16)

808

B
BOOK VI

AFFLICTIONS OF THE DAJJAL


IN THE MODERN TIMES
IN LIGHT OF THE QURAN AND HADITH










.
.

Chapter 1

The Main Target of the Dajjal


and His Affliction

The mentality of the leadership of the Jews & Christians can be found
in the following verses.




(02:146) .
( )

() ()
(02:146) .
The people of the Book recognize (this revelation) as they know
their own sons; but some of them conceal the truth which they
themselves know. (02:146)
The People of the Book know the truth of the Quran and adth,
but oppose it in the same manner as Satan. They also know that one day
the Banu Israeli Prophet Eisa X will return and bring an end to their
rule. For this reason they are doing their utmost efforts to stop this from

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

happening.
Are they working to eliminate all Muslims?
There are more than 1.5 billion Muslims in the world, but the adth
tells us that they will not be of any threat to the other nations.
The Muslims who are not a big threat.


( )


814

Chapter 1 of Book VI

()
: :
904
Narrated Thawban \: The Prophet U said: The people will
soon summon one another to attack you as people when
eating invite others to share their dish. Someone asked: Will
that be because of our small numbers at that time? He U
replied: No, you will be numerous at that time, but you will
be scum and rubbish like that carried down by a torrent, and
Allah , will take fear of you from the breasts of your enemy,
and last wahn (enervation) into your hearts. Someone
asked: What is wahn (enervation)? The Apostle of Allah U
replied: Love of the world and dislike of death. [Sunan Abu
Dawud, Vol 3, adth# 904.]
The followers of Imam Mahdi X are the main threat.
On the other hand we see that a certain group among the Muslims from
Khurasan is the real threat to them.
See the following authentic adth;






815

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

1599 : :

Abu Huraira \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet


Muammad U) reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad
X said: Black flags will appear from the Khurasan, nothing
will stop them until they will be placed at Elya (The Holy Land
of Jerusalem).420
Note: Imam Ahmad considered this adth authentic (a).
Also famous adth scholars like Muhaddith Ali Muttaqi and
Hafiz Ibn Hajar considered the above adth authentic.


.





.

420 Masnad Ahmad Volume 4, adth 1599


816

Chapter 1 of Book VI

Thoban \ (Companion of our Dear Prophet Muammad U)


reported that our Dear Prophet Muammad U said: When
you see that black flags have appeared from Khurasan go to
(join) them even if you have to walk over ice on your knees as
the Khalifa of Allah, the MAHDI will be among them. (This
adth is a (Most Authentic) according to the
conditions of a Bukhari and a Muslim).421
So according to the above adth (and many more also), there is
only one Muslim army that presents a real threat to themit will come
from Khurasan.
Who in Khurasan will be in the Muslim army?
We should also know that a Prophet always remains with the majority
of his own race, therefore, the Banu Israeli Prophet Eisa X will have
followers from Banu Israel around him. This fact is told in Quran:






(14:04)
() ()
( )

(14:04) ( )

421. Mustadrak Hakim, adth 8531.


817

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

We sent not a messenger except (to teach) in the language of his


(own) people, in order to make (things) clear to them. Now
Allah leaves stray those whom He pleases and guides whom He
pleases: and He is Exalted in power, Full of Wisdom. (14:04)
The above verse proves that a large number of Banu Israel will be
the close supporters of the Banu Israeli Prophet Eisa X.
The Israeli Prophet Eisa X will follow Islam.
No new religion or Shariah Law will be brought by Prophet Eisa X, but
he will follow the Shariah of Prophet Muammad U. Therefore, he will
first come among the Banu Israelis who are already following Islam.
Who among Muslims are from Banu Israel?
According to Encyclopedia Britannica 1997:
Peoples who at various times were said to be descendants of
the lost tribes of Israel include: the Nestorians, Mormons,
Afghans (i.e.: Pashtuns), Falashas of Ethiopia, American
Indians, and the Japanese.422
Of the races listed above only the Pathans or Pashtuns are
Muslims, and at the same time live in the same geographical area of
Khurasan, as told in the adth. No other race among Muslims is
considered to be from Banu Israel, and at the same time living in the
Khurasan. Only the Pashtuns have both these characteristics.
We have written proof that is more than 1000 years old about the
422. Encyclopedia Britannica 1997, Lost Tribes of Israel.
818

Chapter 1 of Book VI

Israeli origin of the Pathans. Also their name Pathan is actually the
name of the great grandson of Israeli King Saul (Malik Talut) X.
The detailed discussion about the Israeli origin of the Pashtuns is
beyond the scope of this article but the undeniable proof can be read in
our book called: The Lost Tribes of Israel, Imam Mahdi X, and
Prophet Jesus X.423
Imam Mahdi X lives among Banu Israel in the Khurasan



(:)

:

(:)
Narrated by Thoban \ that our Dear Prophet Muammad U
said that: When you hear the news of black flags coming
from the east , then, you must join them even if you have to
crawl over ice (to reach them).424
Note: Imam Ahmad considered this adth authentic (a).
Also the famous adth scholars like Muhaddith Ali Muttaqi
423http://www.scribd.com/doc/70360662/Lost-Tribes-of-Israel-WithProphet-Isa-Imam-Mahdi.
424 Masnad Ahmad, 5:277. Also in Sunan Ibn Majah.
819

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

and Hafiz Ibn Hajar considered the above adth Authentic.


In the previous adth we read that Imam Mahdi X will come
from the Khurasan and will reach Makkah. We should note that Imam
Mahdi X is from the family of Prophet Muammad U and this family
is all over the world adopting different cultures. The following adth
explains that Imam Mahdi X will be living among the Banu Israeli
Muslims.
Banu Israeli Muslims in Mahdis Army, and Imam Mahdi X living
among Banu Israel.
Please check this fact from the following adth:


( )
:




:

:






:
:








187 .7367 : ...




820

Chapter 1 of Book VI



( )


187 .7367 : .
Narrated Hazrat Umama \ who reported that Rasulullah U
said: You and the Romans (Christians) will have four peace
treaties. The fourth peace would be at the hand of a person
who would be from the Al-e-Harqul (family of Roman King
Heraclius). This peace treaty would be for seven years.
Rasulullah U was asked who would be the Imam of the
Muslims at that time. Rasulullah U said: That person would
be from my family, his age would be 40 years, his face would
be bright as a start, and a black spot would be on his right
cheek. He would be wearing two Qutwani Shawls. He will
appear exactly as the person from Banu Israel. He will rule for
20 years and will conquer the cities of the Mushrikeen
(Idolaters). 425
We already read that Imam Mahdi X will appear from the
Khurasan, and the above adth tells us that Imam Mahdi X will be
wearing the clothes of the Children of Israel. This proves that he is living
425. Kanz-ul-Aamal, page 268, adth No 3868. Tabarn narrated it in alMujam-ul-kabr (8:101 #7495), Musnad-ush-shmiyyn (2:410 #1600); and
Haytham in Majma-uz-zawid (7:318, #319).
821

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

among the Banu Israel of Khurasan. The clothes of Imam Mahdi X is


the Israeli dress (i.e.: the Qutwani cloak), is a warm woolen shawl with
fringed ends, just like the Pashtun nation of Khurasan.
For more details check the books called: The Lost Tribes of Israel,
Imam Mahdi X, and Prophet Jesus X426, and the Twelve Signs of the
Army of Prophet Jesus X, and Imam Mahdi X427 .
It will be clear for anyone that the Muslim Banu Israel nation of
Khurasan will be the first and the majority of the followers of Imam
Mahdi X, and the Banu Israeli Prophet Eisa (Jesus) X.
The army of the Dajjal is also from Khurasan.
If we read further we shall find that the followers of the Dajjal will also
be from the Khurasan as the following adth tells us:

:
.
:
)):
(( .
4072

426. http://www.scribd.com/doc/70360662/Lost-Tribes-of-Israel-WithProphet-Isa-Imam-Mahdi.
427. http://www.scribd.com/doc/70575496/Twelve-Signs-of-Army-ofProphet-Isa-Imam-Mahdi.
822

Chapter 1 of Book VI



( )
952 : :
Narrated by Amr ibn Hurayth \ who quoted Abu Bakr Al
Siddiq \ as saying that Allahs Messenger U told them the
Dajjal would come forth from a land in the east called
Khurasan, followed by people whose faces resembled shields
covered with skin. 428
The term faces likes shields means faces which are round, broad,
fat like shields, just like covering a shield with a skin A further study of
the adth reveals that it includes the Turkic Nations of Khurasan or
Central Asia(who are originally Mongols)as have same kind of faces .
Henry George Keene (1825-1915)429 writes about Central Asian
Turk nations:
A Mongol is merely a Turk in embryo a Turk little more

428. Sunan Ibn Majah, Chapter Kitab-al-Fitan, adth 4078. Also in a
Tirmidhi. Also in Mishkat, adth 5251.
429. Fellow of the University of Calcutta; grandson of Henry George Keene
(1781-1864), orientalist (the brother-in-law of George Harris, first baron of
Seringapatam).
823

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

than a civilized and circumcised Mongol or Tartar. 430


Conclusion

The Muslim Banu Israel nation from the ten tribes of Israel will
comprise the first followers of Imam Mahdi X and Prophet
Eisa X.

This sacred Army will come from the Khurasan.

The Muslim Banu Israel of Khurasan will be the first to make


this sacred army.

The leadership of Jews and Christians have discovered this fact


from our adth and are trying to eliminate this nation from the
Khurasan. La Qadar Allah!

At present only, the Pashtun Muslims are considered to be


from the Children of Israel, and at the same time they live in
the same geographical area of the Khurasan, as told in the
adth.

This is the main reason for always having war in Pashtun


areas since 1979 starting with the Russion invasion of
Afghanistan but today they are facing genocide in Pakistan
also.

430. The Turks in India: Critical Chapters on the Administration of That


Country, by Henry George Keene, page 1-2.
824

Chapter 2

The Basis for the affliction of the Dajjals Army

The foundation for the afflictions of the army of the Dajjal is identified
in the following verses of the Quran:








(49:06)

( )
(49:06)
O you who believe! If a Fasiq (liarsinful person) comes to you
with any news verify it is correctness, lest you should harm
people in ignorance, and afterwards you become regretful for
what you have done. (49:06)
Example:
People hear news from the Fasiq431 media that there is a bomb
blast and innocent people have been killed. The Fasiq media tells the
431. Fasiq means the one who breaks the orders of Allah Subhana hu, openly
in front of others.

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

people that this bomb blast was done by some terrorists living in a
certain area of Muslims. Upon hearing this news, all people say that the
whole of that area where the so called bad guys live should be
destroyed. As a result, that area is destroyed, and only innocent people
get killed while the invisible bad guys remain active.
What does the adth tells us about justifying the killing of
Muslims?





.






76 : : .
Sayyidina Abu Huraira \ reported that Allahs Messenger U
said: Set about doing (good) deeds before trials engulf you
like a portion of a dark night (when) a man commences his
morning as a believer but becomes a disbeliever by evening,
or is a believer in the evening and morning finds him a
826

Chapter 2 of Book VI

disbeliever. He sells his religion against a little of this


world.432
Explanation of the Above adth by Sayyidna Hassan \.




.





: .
79 :
Imam Al Hassan said in explanation of this adth: A man
begins his morning a believer and turns a disbeliever in the
evening, or begins his evening as a believer and turns a
disbeliever in the morning. He said: Morning finds him
holding the blood, honor, and property of his brother sacred
(and disallowed to him), but by evening he will regard them
as lawful to him. And evening finds him holding his brothers

432. Jamia Tirmidhi, Vol. 2, adth 76, Ahmed 8036, Muslim 118.
827

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

blood, honor, and property as sacred (and forbidden to him),


but by morning he regards them as lawful to him.433
This self-justification of killing Muslims will be the last affliction
before the appearance of Dajjal.
As we see, the above two adth have told us that A Muslim will
become non-Muslim within a day or within a night, if he justifies the
killing of other Muslims. The following adth tells us that this will be
the last, and also the biggest affliction just before the appearance of
Dajjal.

433. Jamia Tirmidhi, Vol. 2, adth 79.


828

Chapter 2 of Book VI
















851 : :
Narrated Abdullah ibn Umar \: When we were sitting with
the Apostle of Allah U, he talked about periods of trial
(fitnah), mentioning many of them. When he mentioned the
one when people should stay in their houses, some asked him:
Apostle of Allah U, what is the trial (fitnah) of staying at
home? He U replied: It will be flight and plunder. Then will
come a test which is pleasant. It is murkiness is due to the fact
that it is produced by a man from the people of my house,
829

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

who will assert that he belongs to me, whereas he does not, for
my friends are only the God-fearing. Then the people will
unite under a man who will be like a hip-bone on a rib. Then
there will be the little black trial, which will leave none of this
community without giving him a slap, and when people say
that it is finished, it will be extended. During it, a man will be
a believer in the morning and an infidel in the evening, so
that the people will be in two camps: the camp of faith which
will contain no hypocrisy, and the camp of hypocrisy which
will contain no faith. When that happens, expect the
Antichrist (Dajjal) that day or the next.434
Many people consider this act of killing Muslims as justified, and
according to Islam. This is one of the greatest afflictions of the Dajjal,
and we are told this is in the last ten verses of the Quran (which are to
be read for protection against Dajjal).


()
()
( )
()
( )

Say (O Muammad U): Shall We tell you the greatest losers
in respect of (their) deeds? (18:103)
434Sunan Abu Dawud, Vol 3, adth 851.
830

Chapter 2 of Book VI

Those whose efforts have been wasted in this life and yet they
deem that they are doing well in performance. (18:104)
We see that those who are taking the lives and properties of the
innocent consider it justified, and call it just collateral damage.
This state of affliction is told in the following adth also:

878 : :
Hazrat Khalid bin Dehqan \ said that we asked Yahya bin
Yahya Al-Ghasabi about the word Aitabit Bi Qatla in the
saying of our Dear Prophet Muammad U. He replied that
this means, those people who are involved in the bloodshed
and killing during the affliction among themselves, and when
anyone of them kills someone they think that that he is on the
right path, and does not ask forgiveness from Allah , for this
831

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

sin (of killing).435


This is what exactly what is told in the last ten verses of Srah Al
Kahf, and what is happening in Pakistan and Afghanistan. People are
justifying the killing of innocent people using fake reason of terrorism.
The killers think that they are following the right path of Islam by this
killing. The fact is that, they themselves created the fake reasons of
Taliban and Al-Qaeda to kill the Muslim Banu Israel of Khurasan.
All the terrorism, bomb blasts, etc., are done by the killers themselves,
and then they put the blame on innocent people to justify their
genocide.
Collateral damage killing.
The adth clearly forbids us from having such approach. There is no
such thing as collateral damage in Islam as the following adth tells
us:






. .


435. Sunan Abu Dawud, Vol. 3, adth 878.


832

Chapter 2 of Book VI








289 : :
4 6
It has been narrated on the authority of Abu Huraira \ that
the Messenger of Allah U said: One who defected from
obedience (to the Amir), and separated from the main body
of the Muslimsif he died in that statewould die the death
of one belonging to the days of Jahiliyyah (i.e.: would not die
as a Muslim). One who fights under the banner of a people
who hate blindly (for the cause for which they are fighting,
(i.e.: do not know whether their cause is just or otherwise),
who gets flared up with family pride, calls (people) to fight for
their family honor, and supports his kith and kin (i.e.: fights
not for the cause of Allah ,, but for the sake of this family or
tribe), if he is killed (in this fight), he dies as one belonging to
the days of Jahiliyyah. Whoso attacks my Umma
(indiscriminately), killing the righteous and the wicked of
them, sparing not (even) those staunch in faith, and fulfilling
not his promise made with those who have been given a
833

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

pledge of securityhe has nothing to do with me, and I have


nothing to do with him.436
A Muslim is more important than the Kaabah. The sin of fighting
and killing Muslims.
Those who are killing Muslims, they should know the importance of the
life and property of a Muslim, as told in the following adth:








: : .
812
Narrated by Abdullah bin Omar,I saw the Messenger of
Allah U performing tawaf around the Holy Kaba saying to it:
how pure and good you are! how pure and good your
fragrance is! how great and exalted you are! and how great

436. a Muslim, Vol. 3, adth 291.


834

Chapter 2 of Book VI

and exalted your sanctity is! But by Him in Whose hand is


Muammads soul, the sanctity of a believers blood and
property in the sight of Allah is greater than your sanctity!
And having bad suspicion about a Faithful (Momin) is
forbidden in the same way. We are ordered to have good
suspicion about the Faithful.437
This adth clearly tells us that the killing of an innocent Muslim
is Kufr:





.





74 : : .
Sayyidina Ibn Abbas \ reported that Allahs Messenger U
said: Do not return to disbelief, some of you striking the neck

437. Sunan Ibn Majah, Volume 3, adth 812.


835

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

of some others, after me. 438

.
821 : :
It was narrated from Sad \ that the Messenger of Allah U
said: Verbally abusing a Muslim is Fasuq (disobedience),
and fighting him is Kufr. 439

438. Jamia Tirmidhi, Vol. 2, adth 74; and also a Bukhari, adth 1739.
439. Sunan Ibn Majah, Vol. 3, adth 821.
836

Chapter 3

What should the Muslim Banu Israel


(and all the Muslims) do in this situation?

The answer is given in the following adth: Do not fight, break your
weapons, and stay home.

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X











75 : : .
Busr ibn Saeed \ reported on the authority of Sayyidina Sad
ibn Waqas \, that Sayyidna Uthman ibn Affan \ bore
testimony that Allahs Messenger U said concerning the times
of trial: There will come a trial when the person sitting
during it will be better than one who is standing. He who
keeps standing will be better than he who walks, while the
walker will be better than the runner. He asked, What
should I do if anyone intrudes into my home and raises his
hand over me to kill me? He U said: Be like the son of
Adam. (Habil / Abel X was killed at the hands of his
brother).440
440. Jamia Tirmidhi, Vol. 2, adth 75. Also a Muslim 2887 and Ahmed
20434.
838

Chapter 3 of Book VI

And also in the following adth:






.





85 : : .
Sayyidina Abu Musa \ reported that the Prophet Usaid:
During the commotion, break your bows, cut your
bowstrings during it, and bind yourself to the inside of your
houses, and be like the son of Adam (Abel X) who let himself
be killed by Cain). 441




441. Jamia Tirmidhi, Vol. 2, adth 85. And also Ahmed 19751.
839

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X




()
( )


( )
:
863 :
Narrated Abu Bakrah \: The Apostle of Allah U said: There
will be a period of commotion in which the one who lies down
840

Chapter 3 of Book VI

will be better than the one who sits, and the one who sits is
better than the one who stands, and the one who stands is
better than the one who walks, and the one who walks is better
than the one who runs. He asked: What do you command
me to do, Apostle of Allah? He U replied: He who has
camels should remain with his camels, he who has sheep
should remain with his sheep, and he who has land should
remain with his land. He asked: If anyone has more of these,
(what should he do)? He replied: He should take his sword,
strike it is edge on a stone, and then escape if he can. 442





.


( )



442. Sunan Abu Dawud, Vol. 3, adth 863.


841

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X




864 : :


Narrated Sad ibn Abu Waqas \: I asked: Apostle of Allah!
Tell me if someone enters my house and extends his hands to
kill me (what should I do?). The Apostle of Allah U replied:
Be like the two sons of Adam. The narrator Yazid (ibn
Khalid) then recited the verse: If thou dost stretch your hand
against me to slay me. 443

443. Sunan Abu Dawud, Vol 3, adth 864.


842

Chapter 3 of Book VI

(


( )

( )
) ()
866 : : (
Narrated Abu Musa al-Ashari \: The Apostle of Allah U
said: Before the Last Hour there will be commotions like
pieces of a dark night in which a man will be a believer in the
morning and an infidel in the evening, or a believer in the
evening and infidel in the morning. He who sits during them
will be better than he who gets up and he who walks during
them is better than he who runs. So break your bows, cut your
bowstrings and strike your swords on stones. If people then
come in to one of you, let him be like the better of Adams two
sons.444

444. Sunan Abu Dawud, Vol 3, adth #866.


843

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X






()

( )
( )
841 : :
It was narrated from Abu Musa Al-Ashari \ that the
Messenger of Allah U said: Before the Hour comes, there will
be tribulations like pieces of black night, when a man will
wake up as a believer but be a disbeliever by evening, or he
will be a believer in the evening but will be a disbeliever by
morning. And the one who is sitting will be better than the
one who is standing, and the one who is standing will be better
844

Chapter 3 of Book VI

than the one who is walking, and the one who is walking will
be better than the one who is running. So break your bows,
cut their strings and strike your swords against rocks, and if
anyone enters upon anyone of you, let him be like the better
of the two sons of Adam. (i.e.: the one killed, not the killer).
445

We should keep to our homes.

445. Sunan Ibn Majah, Vol. 3, adth #841.


845

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

:
869 :
Narrated Abu Musa al-Ashari \: The Prophet U said:
Before you there will be commotions like pieces of a dark
night in which a man will be a believer in the morning and an
infidel in the evening. He who sits during them will be better
than he who gets up, and he who gets up during them is better
than he who walks, and he who walks during them is better
than he who runs. They (the people) said: What do you
order us to do? He replied: Keep to your houses.446
Avoid News Media
We are told never to believe any news which we have not seen. This is
told in the Quran. Also the adth tells us clearly that news will be
delivered by very bad people, and that good will be shown as bad, and
bad will be shown as good.

446. Sunan Abu Dawud, Vol. 3, adth# 869.


846

Chapter 3 of Book VI





916 : :
20

Narrated Hazrat Abu Huraira \ who said that our Dear


Prophet Muammad U said that: Soon people will face years
of deceit and falsehood. (In this time) The liars will be
considered as the truthful, the truthful will be considered as
the liars, the trustworthy people will be considered
untrustworthy, and the trivial and insignificant people will
discuss the general matters of the people. 447
This reflects our present day news media. Stay secluded.




.

447 Sunan Ibn Majah, Vol 3, adth 916.
847

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X




874 : :
Narrated Abu Saeed Khudri \: The Prophet U said: It is near
(time is near) that the best property of a Muslim will be his
goats, after which he will go to tall mountains, and to places
of rainfall, and will escape to protect his Deen (Faith) from
afflictions. 448











)



448. Sunan Abu Dawud, Vol. 3, adth 874.
848

Chapter 3 of Book VI


( 68 : 25 (
879 : :
Narrated Zayd ibn Thabit \: The verse If a man kills a
believer intentionally, his recompense is Hell to abide therein
forever was revealed six months after the verse And those
who invoke not with Allah any other god, nor slay such life as
Allah has made sacred, except for just cause, in Srat alFurqan.
The most important point about this evil conspiracy against
Muslim Banu Israel.
Please check the following verse again:




(02:146) .
( )

() ()
(02:146) .
The People of the Book recognize (this revelation) as they know
their own sons; but some of them conceal the truth which they
themselves know. (2:146)
And now concentrate on the following part:

849

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X


02:146) .
()
(02:146) . ()
But some of them (the Jews & Christians) conceal the truth
which they themselves know. (2:146)
You see, the whole world media is concealing the truth which they
themselves know. You will never hear any news of the genocide of
Pashtuns. Anyhow, Allah , will soon show the truth, InshahAllah.

850

Last adth

I end this book with a beautiful adth about the end times which covers
so many details about the end of times.

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X






852

Last Hadith of Book VI


853

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X




















...







( )





, .
854

Last Hadith of Book VI











( )
( )

)
(



( )


)
(
855

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X







( )

( )





( )







)
856

Last Hadith of Book VI

(





)

(





( )



( )
!

)
(
857

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X






)
(
( )
)
(






)






858

Last Hadith of Book VI

(


)

( ) (




)
(





( )





859

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X






( )
)
(
()
)
(

)
(









860

Last Hadith of Book VI


( )






)
(
( )


/ 958 / 3
It was narrated that Abu Umamah Al-Bahili said:
The Messenger of Allah U addressed us, and most of his
speech had to do with telling us about Dajjal. He warned
about him, and among the things he said was: There will not
be any tribulation on earth, since the time Allah created the
offspring of Adam, that will be greater than the tribulation of
Dajjal. Allah has not sent any Prophet but he warned his
nation about Dajjal. I am the last of the Prophets, and you are
the last of the nations. He will undoubtedly appear among
you. If he appears while I am among you, I will contend with
him on behalf of every Muslim, and if he appears while I am
not among you, then each man must fend for himself and
Allah will take care of every Muslim on my behalf. He will
861

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

emerge from Al-Khallah, between Sham and Iraq, and will


wreak havoc right and left. O slaves of Allah, remain steadfast.
I will describe him to you in a manner in which none of the
Prophets has described him before me. He will start by saying
I am a Prophet, and there is no Prophet after me. Then a
second time he will say: I am your Lord. But you will not see
your Lord until you die. He is one-eyed, and your Lord is not
one-eyed, and written between his eyes is Kafir. Every believer
will read it, whether he is literate or illiterate. Part of his
Fitnah will be that he will have with him Paradise and Hell,
but his Hell will be a Paradise and his Paradise a Hell.
Whoever is tested with his fire (hell), let him seek the help of
Allah and recite the first Verses of Al-Kahf, then it will be cool
and safe for him, as the fire was for Ibrahim. Part of his Fitnah
will be that he will say to a Bedouin: What do you think, if I
resurrect your father and mother for you, will you bear
witness that I am your Lord? He will say: Yes. Then two
devils will appear to him in the form of his father and mother
and will say: O my son, follow him, for he is your Lord. And
part of his Fitnah will be that he will overpower a single soul
and kill him, then he will cut him with a saw until he falls in
two pieces. Then he will say: Look at this slave of mine; I will
resurrect him now, then he will claim that he has a Lord other
than me. Then Allah will resurrect him and the evil one will
say to him: Who is your Lord? and he will say: Allah is my
Lord, and you are the enemy of Allah, you are Dajjal. By Allah,
I have never had more insight about you than I have today.
(An addition) Abul-Hasan Tanafisi said: Muharibi told us:
862

Last Hadith of Book VI

Ubaidullah bin al-Walid Al-Wassafi told us, from Atiyyah,


that Abu Saeed said: The Messenger of Allah U said: That
man will be the highest in status in my nation in Paradise
He said: Abu Saeed said: By Allah, we did not think that
man would be anyone other than Umar bin Khattab, until he
passed away. Muharibi said: Then we went back to the
narration of Abu Rafi. He said:Part of his Fitnah will be
that he will command the sky to rain, and it will rain, and he
will command the earth to bring forth vegetation and it will
do so. And part of his Fitnah will be that he will pass by a clan
and they will disbelieve in him, so all their flocks will perish
and none will be left. And part of his Fitnah will be that he
will pass by a clan who will believe in him, so he will
command the sky to rain, and it will rain, and he will
command the earth to bring forth vegetation and it will do so,
until their flocks will come back in the evening of that day,
bigger and fatter than they have ever been, with their flanks
stretched and their udders full of milk. There will be no part
of the earth left that he does not enter and prevail over, except
for Makkah and Al-Madinah, for he will not approach them
on any of their mountain paths but he will be met by angels
with unsheathed swords, until he will stop at the red hill at the
end of the marsh. Then Al-Madinah will be shaken with its
people three times, and no hypocrite, male or female, will be
left, all will come out to him. Thus it will be cleansed of
impurity just as the bellows cleanses the iron of dross. And
that day will be called the Day of Deliverance. Umm Sharik
bint Abi akar said: O Messenger of Allah, where will the
863

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

Arabs be that day? He said: On that day they will be few, and
most of them will be in Baitul-Maqdis (Jerusalem), and their
leader will be a righteous man. When their leader has stepped
forward to lead them in subh prayer, Eisa bin Maryam will
come down to them. Their leader will step backwards so that
Eisa can come forward and lead the people in prayer, but
Eisa will place his hand between his shoulders and say to him:
Go forward and pray, for the Iqamah was given for you.
Then their leader will lead them in prayer. When he has
finished, Eisa X, will say: Open the gate. So they will open
it and behind it will be Dajjal with seventy thousand Jews,
each of them carrying an adorned sword and wearing a
greenish cloak. When Dajjal looks at him, he will start to melt
as salt melts in water. He will run away, and Eisa X, will say:
I have only one blow for you, which you will not be able to
escape! He will catch up with him at the eastern gate of Ludd,
and will kill him. Then Allah will defeat the Jews, and there
will be nothing left that Allah has created which the Jews will
be able to hide behind, except that Allah will cause it to
speakno stone, no tree, no wall, no animalexcept for AlGharqad (the box-thorn), for it is one of their trees, and will
not speakexcept that it will say: O Muslim slave of Allah,
here is a Jews, come and kill him! The Messenger of Allah
U said: His (Dajjals) days will number forty years: a year like
half a year, a year like a month, a month like a week, and the
rest of his days will be like sparks from a fire (i.e., they will
pass quickly). One of you will enter the gate of Al-Madinah in
the morning and not reach its other gate until evening comes.
864

Last Hadith of Book VI

It was said: O Messenger of Allah, how should we pray on


those short days? He said: Estimate (the times of) the prayer,
as you do on these long days, then pray. The Messenger of
Allah U said: Eisa bin Maryam X, will be a just judge and a
just ruler among my nation. He will break the cross, slaughter
the pigs, abolish the Jizyah and charity will be left. No one will
be appointed to (collect the Zakah of) sheep and camels.
Grudges and mutual hatred will disappear and the venom of
every venomous creature will be removed, so that a baby boy
will but his hand in a snake and it will not harm him, and a
baby girl will make a lion run away, and it will not harm her;
and the wolf will be among the sheep like their sheepdog. The
earth will be filled with peace just as a vessel is filled with
water. The people will be united and none will be worshipped
except Allah. War will cease and Quraish will no longer be in
power. The earth will be like a silver platter, with its
vegetation growing as it did at the time of Adam, until a group
of people will gather around one bunch of grapes and it will
suffice them, and a group will gather around a single
pomegranate and it will suffice them. An ox will be sold for
such and such amount of money, and a horse will be sold for
a few Dirham. They said: O Messenger of Allah, why will
horses be so cheap? He said: They will never be ridden in war
again. It was said to him: Why will oxen be so expensive? He
said: Because all the land will be tilled. Before Dajjal appears
there will be three difficult years in which the people will
suffer severe famine. In the first year, Allah will command the
sky to withhold one third of its rain and the earth to withhold
865

MUSLIM BANU ISRAEL, THE MAHDI X AND PROPHET JESUS X

one third of its produce. In the second year, He will command


the sky to withhold two thirds of its rain and the earth to
withhold two-thirds of its produce. In the third year, he will
command the sky to withhold all of its rain, and not a single
drop will fall, and the earth to withhold all of its produce, and
nothing will grow. All cloven-hoofed animals will die, except
those that Allah wills. It was said: What will the people live
on at that time? He said: Tahlil, Takbir, Tasbih and Tahmid.
That will take the place of food for them. Abu Abdullah (Ibn
Majah) said: I heard Abul-Hasan Tanafisi say: I heard
Abdur-Rahman Al-Muharibi say: This adth should be
sent to every teacher so that they can teach it to the children
in the schools.449

449. Sunan Ibn Majah, adth 958, Vol. 3.


866


May Allah Az wa Jal make this effort easy to understand
and useful for everyone.


May Allah Az wa Jal make this effort beneficial for all ameen


.

.

You might also like